services: sane: Create the "scanner" account.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 3CE464558A84FDC69DB40CFB090B11993D9AEBB5
14 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL https://sv.gnu.org/people/viewgpg.php?user_id=15145
15
16 @c Base URL for downloads.
17 @set BASE-URL https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/guix
18
19 @c The official substitute server used by default.
20 @set SUBSTITUTE-SERVER ci.guix.gnu.org
21 @set SUBSTITUTE-URL https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}
22
23 @copying
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Ludovic Courtès@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2019 Leo Famulari@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Ricardo Wurmus@*
33 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
34 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018 Chris Marusich@*
35 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Efraim Flashner@*
36 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
37 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017 ng0@*
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
39 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Julien Lepiller@*
40 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele@*
41 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Christopher Baines@*
42 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Clément Lassieur@*
43 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Mathieu Othacehe@*
44 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Federico Beffa@*
45 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Carlo Zancanaro@*
46 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Thomas Danckaert@*
47 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 humanitiesNerd@*
48 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Christopher Allan Webber@*
49 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Marius Bakke@*
50 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019 Hartmut Goebel@*
51 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019 Maxim Cournoyer@*
52 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019, 2020 Tobias Geerinckx-Rice@*
53 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 George Clemmer@*
54 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Andy Wingo@*
55 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Arun Isaac@*
56 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 nee@*
57 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Rutger Helling@*
58 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Oleg Pykhalov@*
59 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Mike Gerwitz@*
60 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Pierre-Antoine Rouby@*
61 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Gábor Boskovits@*
62 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Florian Pelz@*
63 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Laura Lazzati@*
64 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Alex Vong@*
65 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Josh Holland@*
66 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Diego Nicola Barbato@*
67 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Ivan Petkov@*
68 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Jakob L. Kreuze@*
69 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Kyle Andrews@*
70 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Alex Griffin@*
71 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Guillaume Le Vaillant@*
72 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Leo Prikler@*
73 Copyright @copyright{} 2019, 2020 Simon Tournier@*
74 Copyright @copyright{} 2020 Wiktor Żelazny@*
75
76 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
77 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
78 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
79 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
80 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
81 Documentation License''.
82 @end copying
83
84 @dircategory System administration
85 @direntry
86 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
87 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
88 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
89 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
90 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
91 * guix deploy: (guix)Invoking guix deploy. Manage operating system configurations for remote hosts.
92 @end direntry
93
94 @dircategory Software development
95 @direntry
96 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
97 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
98 * guix pack: (guix)Invoking guix pack. Creating binary bundles.
99 @end direntry
100
101 @titlepage
102 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
103 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
104 @author The GNU Guix Developers
105
106 @page
107 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
108 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
109 @value{UPDATED} @*
110
111 @insertcopying
112 @end titlepage
113
114 @contents
115
116 @c *********************************************************************
117 @node Top
118 @top GNU Guix
119
120 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
121 package management tool written for the GNU system.
122
123 @c TRANSLATORS: You can replace the following paragraph with information on
124 @c how to join your own translation team and how to report issues with the
125 @c translation.
126 This manual is also available in Simplified Chinese (@pxref{Top,,, guix.zh_CN,
127 GNU Guix参考手册}), French (@pxref{Top,,, guix.fr, Manuel de référence de GNU
128 Guix}), German (@pxref{Top,,, guix.de, Referenzhandbuch zu GNU Guix}),
129 Spanish (@pxref{Top,,, guix.es, Manual de referencia de GNU Guix}), and
130 Russian (@pxref{Top,,, guix.ru, Руководство GNU Guix}). If you
131 would like to translate it in your native language, consider joining the
132 @uref{https://translationproject.org/domain/guix-manual.html, Translation
133 Project}.
134
135 @menu
136 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
137 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
138 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
139 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
140 * Development:: Guix-aided software development.
141 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
142 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
143 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
144 * Documentation:: Browsing software user manuals.
145 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
146 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
147 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
148 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
149 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
150
151 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
152 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
153 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
154 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
155
156 @detailmenu
157 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
158
159 Introduction
160
161 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
162 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
163
164 Installation
165
166 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
167 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
168 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
169 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
170 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
171 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
172
173 Setting Up the Daemon
174
175 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
176 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
177 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
178
179 System Installation
180
181 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
182 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
183 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
184 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
185 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
186 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
187 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
188 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
189 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
190
191 Manual Installation
192
193 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
194 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
195
196 Package Management
197
198 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
199 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
200 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
201 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
202 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
203 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
204 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
205 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
206 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
207 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
208 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
209
210 Substitutes
211
212 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
213 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
214 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
215 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
216 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
217 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
218
219 Development
220
221 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
222 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
223
224 Programming Interface
225
226 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
227 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
228 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
229 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
230 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
231 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
232 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
233 * Invoking guix repl:: Fiddling with Guix interactively.
234
235 Defining Packages
236
237 * package Reference:: The package data type.
238 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
239
240 Utilities
241
242 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
243 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
244 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
245 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
246 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
247 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
248 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
249 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
250 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
251 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
252 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
253 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
254 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
255 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
256 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
257
258 Invoking @command{guix build}
259
260 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
261 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
262 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
263 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
264
265 System Configuration
266
267 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
268 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
269 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
270 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
271 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
272 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
273 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
274 * Services:: Specifying system services.
275 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
276 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
277 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
278 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
279 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
280 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
281 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
282 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
283 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
284
285 Services
286
287 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
288 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
289 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
290 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
291 * X Window:: Graphical display.
292 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
293 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
294 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
295 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
296 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
297 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
298 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
299 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
300 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
301 * Web Services:: Web servers.
302 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
303 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
304 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
305 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
306 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
307 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
308 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
309 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
310 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
311 * Game Services:: Game servers.
312 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
313 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
314
315 Defining Services
316
317 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
318 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
319 * Service Reference:: API reference.
320 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
321
322 @end detailmenu
323 @end menu
324
325 @c *********************************************************************
326 @node Introduction
327 @chapter Introduction
328
329 @cindex purpose
330 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
331 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
332 management tool for and distribution of the GNU system.
333 Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
334 users to install, upgrade, or remove software packages, to roll back to a
335 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
336 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
337
338 @cindex Guix System
339 @cindex GuixSD, now Guix System
340 @cindex Guix System Distribution, now Guix System
341 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system where it
342 complements the available tools without interference (@pxref{Installation}),
343 or you can use it as a standalone operating system distribution,
344 @dfn{Guix@tie{}System}@footnote{We used to refer to Guix System as ``Guix
345 System Distribution'' or ``GuixSD''. We now consider it makes more sense to
346 group everything under the ``Guix'' banner since, after all, Guix System is
347 readily available through the @command{guix system} command, even if you're
348 using a different distro underneath!}. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
349
350 @menu
351 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
352 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
353 @end menu
354
355 @node Managing Software the Guix Way
356 @section Managing Software the Guix Way
357
358 @cindex user interfaces
359 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
360 (@pxref{Package Management}), tools to help with software development
361 (@pxref{Development}), command-line utilities for more advanced usage,
362 (@pxref{Utilities}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
363 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
364 @cindex build daemon
365 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
366 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
367 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
368
369 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
370 @cindex customization, of packages
371 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
372 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
373 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
374 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
375 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
376 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
377 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
378 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
379
380 @cindex functional package management
381 @cindex isolation
382 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
383 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
384 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
385 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
386 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
387 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
388 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
389 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
390 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
391 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
392 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
393 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
394 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
395 explicit inputs are visible.
396
397 @cindex store
398 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
399 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
400 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
401 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
402 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
403 input yields a different directory name.
404
405 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
406 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
407 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
408
409
410 @node GNU Distribution
411 @section GNU Distribution
412
413 @cindex Guix System
414 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
415 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
416 @url{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
417 users of that software}.}. The
418 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
419 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
420 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). When we need to
421 distinguish between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as
422 Guix@tie{}System.
423
424 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
425 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
426 list of available packages can be browsed
427 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
428 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
429
430 @example
431 guix package --list-available
432 @end example
433
434 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
435 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
436 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
437 tools that help users exert that freedom.
438
439 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
440
441 @table @code
442
443 @item x86_64-linux
444 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
445
446 @item i686-linux
447 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
448
449 @item armhf-linux
450 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
451 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
452 and Linux-Libre kernel.
453
454 @item aarch64-linux
455 little-endian 64-bit ARMv8-A processors, Linux-Libre kernel.
456
457 @item mips64el-linux
458 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
459 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel. This configuration is no longer fully
460 supported; in particular, the project's build farms no longer provide
461 substitutes for this architecture.
462
463 @end table
464
465 With Guix@tie{}System, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system
466 configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the configuration in a
467 transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion (@pxref{System
468 Configuration}). Guix System uses the Linux-libre kernel, the Shepherd
469 initialization system (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
470 Manual}), the well-known GNU utilities and tool chain, as well as the
471 graphical environment or system services of your choice.
472
473 Guix System is available on all the above platforms except
474 @code{mips64el-linux}.
475
476 @noindent
477 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
478 @pxref{Porting}.
479
480 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
481 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
482
483
484 @c *********************************************************************
485 @node Installation
486 @chapter Installation
487
488 @cindex installing Guix
489
490 @quotation Note
491 We recommend the use of this
492 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
493 shell installer script} to install Guix on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
494 thereafter called a @dfn{foreign distro}.@footnote{This section is concerned
495 with the installation of the package manager, which can be done on top of a
496 running GNU/Linux system. If, instead, you want to install the complete GNU
497 operating system, @pxref{System Installation}.} The script automates the
498 download, installation, and initial configuration of Guix. It should be run
499 as the root user.
500 @end quotation
501
502 @cindex foreign distro
503 @cindex directories related to foreign distro
504 When installed on a foreign distro, GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available
505 tools without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
506 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your system,
507 such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
508
509 Once installed, Guix can be updated by running @command{guix pull}
510 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}).
511
512 If you prefer to perform the installation steps manually or want to tweak
513 them, you may find the following subsections useful. They describe the
514 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it manually and get
515 ready to use it.
516
517 @menu
518 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
519 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
520 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
521 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
522 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
523 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
524 * Upgrading Guix:: Upgrading Guix and its build daemon.
525 @end menu
526
527 @node Binary Installation
528 @section Binary Installation
529
530 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
531 @cindex installer script
532 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
533 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
534 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
535 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
536 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
537
538 @c Note duplicated from the ``Installation'' node.
539 @quotation Note
540 We recommend the use of this
541 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
542 shell installer script}. The script automates the download, installation, and
543 initial configuration steps described below. It should be run as the root
544 user.
545 @end quotation
546
547 Installing goes along these lines:
548
549 @enumerate
550 @item
551 @cindex downloading Guix binary
552 Download the binary tarball from
553 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz},
554 where @var{system} is @code{x86_64-linux} for an @code{x86_64} machine
555 already running the kernel Linux, and so on.
556
557 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
558 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
559 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
560
561 @example
562 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
563 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
564 @end example
565
566 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
567 then run this command to import it:
568
569 @example
570 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
571 -qO - | gpg --import -
572 @end example
573
574 @noindent
575 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
576
577 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
578 signature!'' is normal.
579
580 @c end authentication part
581
582 @item
583 Now, you need to become the @code{root} user. Depending on your distribution,
584 you may have to run @code{su -} or @code{sudo -i}. As @code{root}, run:
585
586 @example
587 # cd /tmp
588 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
589 /path/to/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz
590 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
591 @end example
592
593 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
594 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
595 step.)
596
597 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
598 would overwrite its own essential files.
599
600 The @code{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
601 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
602 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
603 versions are fine.)
604 They stem from the fact that all the
605 files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
606 means January 1st, 1970.) This is done on purpose to make sure the
607 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
608 reproducible.
609
610 @item
611 Make the profile available under @file{~root/.config/guix/current}, which is
612 where @command{guix pull} will install updates (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
613
614 @example
615 # mkdir -p ~root/.config/guix
616 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix \
617 ~root/.config/guix/current
618 @end example
619
620 Source @file{etc/profile} to augment @code{PATH} and other relevant
621 environment variables:
622
623 @example
624 # GUIX_PROFILE="`echo ~root`/.config/guix/current" ; \
625 source $GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile
626 @end example
627
628 @item
629 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
630 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
631
632 @item
633 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
634
635 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
636 with these commands:
637
638 @c Versions of systemd that supported symlinked service files are not
639 @c yet widely deployed, so we should suggest that users copy the service
640 @c files into place.
641 @c
642 @c See this thread for more information:
643 @c https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2017-01/msg01199.html
644
645 @example
646 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
647 /etc/systemd/system/
648 # systemctl start guix-daemon && systemctl enable guix-daemon
649 @end example
650
651 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
652
653 @example
654 # initctl reload-configuration
655 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf \
656 /etc/init/
657 # start guix-daemon
658 @end example
659
660 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
661
662 @example
663 # ~root/.config/guix/current/bin/guix-daemon \
664 --build-users-group=guixbuild
665 @end example
666
667 @item
668 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
669 for instance with:
670
671 @example
672 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
673 # cd /usr/local/bin
674 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/bin/guix
675 @end example
676
677 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
678 there:
679
680 @example
681 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
682 # cd /usr/local/share/info
683 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/share/info/* ;
684 do ln -s $i ; done
685 @end example
686
687 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
688 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
689 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
690 Info search path.)
691
692 @item
693 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
694 To use substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or one of its mirrors
695 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
696
697 @example
698 # guix archive --authorize < \
699 ~root/.config/guix/current/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
700 @end example
701
702 @item
703 Each user may need to perform a few additional steps to make their Guix
704 environment ready for use, @pxref{Application Setup}.
705 @end enumerate
706
707 Voilà, the installation is complete!
708
709 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
710 the root profile:
711
712 @example
713 # guix install hello
714 @end example
715
716 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
717 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
718
719 @example
720 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
721 @end example
722
723 @noindent
724 ...@: which, in turn, runs:
725
726 @example
727 guix pack -s @var{system} --localstatedir \
728 --profile-name=current-guix guix
729 @end example
730
731 @xref{Invoking guix pack}, for more info on this handy tool.
732
733 @node Requirements
734 @section Requirements
735
736 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
737 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
738 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
739 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
740
741 @cindex official website
742 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
743 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}.
744
745 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
746
747 @itemize
748 @item @url{https://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 3.0.x or
749 2.2.x;
750 @item @url{https://notabug.org/cwebber/guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt}, version
751 0.1.0 or later;
752 @item
753 @uref{https://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS}, specifically its Guile bindings
754 (@pxref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings for
755 Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile});
756 @item
757 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-sqlite3/guile-sqlite3, Guile-SQLite3}, version 0.1.0
758 or later;
759 @item
760 @c FIXME: Specify a version number once a release has been made.
761 @uref{https://gitlab.com/guile-git/guile-git, Guile-Git}, from August
762 2017 or later;
763 @item @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON} 3.x;
764 @item @url{https://zlib.net, zlib};
765 @item @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
766 @end itemize
767
768 The following dependencies are optional:
769
770 @itemize
771 @item
772 @c Note: We need at least 0.10.2 for 'channel-send-eof'.
773 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) and
774 @command{guix copy} (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}) depends on
775 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
776 version 0.10.2 or later.
777
778 @item
779 When @url{https://www.nongnu.org/lzip/lzlib.html, lzlib} is available, lzlib
780 substitutes can be used and @command{guix publish} can compress substitutes
781 with lzlib.
782
783 @item
784 When @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2} is available,
785 @command{guix-daemon} can use it to compress build logs.
786 @end itemize
787
788 Unless @code{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
789 following packages are also needed:
790
791 @itemize
792 @item @url{https://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
793 @item @url{https://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
794 @item @url{https://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
795 C++11 standard.
796 @end itemize
797
798 @cindex state directory
799 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
800 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
801 using the @code{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
802 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
803 GNU Coding Standards}). Usually, this @var{localstatedir} option is
804 set to the value @file{/var}. The @command{configure} script protects
805 against unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
806 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
807
808 @node Running the Test Suite
809 @section Running the Test Suite
810
811 @cindex test suite
812 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
813 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
814 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
815 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
816 suite, type:
817
818 @example
819 make check
820 @end example
821
822 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
823 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
824 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
825 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
826 cache.
827
828 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
829 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
830
831 @example
832 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
833 @end example
834
835 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
836 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
837 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
838
839 @example
840 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
841 @end example
842
843 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
844 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
845 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
846 your message.
847
848 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
849 Guix System instances. It can only run on systems where
850 Guix is already installed, using:
851
852 @example
853 make check-system
854 @end example
855
856 @noindent
857 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
858
859 @example
860 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
861 @end example
862
863 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
864 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
865 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
866 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
867 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
868 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
869
870 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
871 all the details.
872
873 @node Setting Up the Daemon
874 @section Setting Up the Daemon
875
876 @cindex daemon
877 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
878 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
879 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
880 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
881 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
882 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
883 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
884
885 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
886 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
887 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
888
889 @menu
890 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
891 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
892 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
893 @end menu
894
895 @node Build Environment Setup
896 @subsection Build Environment Setup
897
898 @cindex build environment
899 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
900 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
901 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
902 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
903 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
904 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
905 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
906
907 @cindex build users
908 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
909 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
910 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
911 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
912 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
913 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
914 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
915 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
916 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
917 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
918
919 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
920 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
921
922 @c See https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
923 @c for why `-G' is needed.
924 @example
925 # groupadd --system guixbuild
926 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
927 do
928 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
929 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
930 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
931 guixbuilder$i;
932 done
933 @end example
934
935 @noindent
936 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
937 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
938 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
939 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
940 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
941 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
942 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
943
944 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
945 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
946 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
947 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
948 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
949 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
950 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
951 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
952
953 @example
954 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
955 @end example
956
957 @cindex chroot
958 @noindent
959 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
960 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
961 environment contains nothing but:
962
963 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
964 @itemize
965 @item
966 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
967 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
968 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
969 can only be created if the host has them.};
970
971 @item
972 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
973 since a separate PID name space is used;
974
975 @item
976 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
977 user @file{nobody};
978
979 @item
980 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
981
982 @item
983 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
984 @code{127.0.0.1};
985
986 @item
987 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
988 @end itemize
989
990 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
991 @i{via} the @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
992 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
993 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
994 This way, the value of @code{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
995 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
996 capture the name of their build tree.
997
998 @vindex http_proxy
999 The daemon also honors the @code{http_proxy} environment variable for
1000 HTTP downloads it performs, be it for fixed-output derivations
1001 (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1002
1003 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
1004 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @code{--disable-chroot}.
1005 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
1006 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
1007 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
1008 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
1009 @emph{pure} functions.
1010
1011
1012 @node Daemon Offload Setup
1013 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
1014
1015 @cindex offloading
1016 @cindex build hook
1017 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
1018 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
1019 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
1020 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
1021 present.}. When that
1022 feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
1023 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build is requested, for
1024 instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
1025 of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the derivation, in
1026 particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
1027 prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
1028 which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
1029 build are copied back to the initial machine.
1030
1031 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
1032
1033 @lisp
1034 (list (build-machine
1035 (name "eightysix.example.org")
1036 (system "x86_64-linux")
1037 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
1038 (user "bob")
1039 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
1040
1041 (build-machine
1042 (name "meeps.example.org")
1043 (system "mips64el-linux")
1044 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
1045 (user "alice")
1046 (private-key
1047 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
1048 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
1049 @end lisp
1050
1051 @noindent
1052 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
1053 the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{mips64el}
1054 architecture.
1055
1056 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
1057 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
1058 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
1059 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
1060 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
1061 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
1062 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
1063 detailed below.
1064
1065 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
1066 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
1067 builds. The important fields are:
1068
1069 @table @code
1070
1071 @item name
1072 The host name of the remote machine.
1073
1074 @item system
1075 The system type of the remote machine---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
1076
1077 @item user
1078 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
1079 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
1080 allow non-interactive logins.
1081
1082 @item host-key
1083 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
1084 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
1085 long string that looks like this:
1086
1087 @example
1088 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
1089 @end example
1090
1091 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
1092 key can be found in a file such as
1093 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
1094
1095 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
1096 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
1097 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
1098 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
1099
1100 @example
1101 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
1102 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
1103 @end example
1104
1105 @end table
1106
1107 A number of optional fields may be specified:
1108
1109 @table @asis
1110
1111 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
1112 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
1113
1114 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~root/.ssh/id_rsa})
1115 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
1116 OpenSSH format. This key must not be protected with a passphrase.
1117
1118 Note that the default value is the private key @emph{of the root
1119 account}. Make sure it exists if you use the default.
1120
1121 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
1122 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
1123 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
1124
1125 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
1126 when transferring files to and from build machines.
1127
1128 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
1129 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
1130 to on that machine.
1131
1132 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
1133 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
1134
1135 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
1136 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
1137 machines with a higher speed factor.
1138
1139 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
1140 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
1141 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
1142 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
1143 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
1144
1145 @end table
1146 @end deftp
1147
1148 The @command{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
1149 machines. You can check whether this is the case by running:
1150
1151 @example
1152 ssh build-machine guix repl --version
1153 @end example
1154
1155 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
1156 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
1157 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
1158 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
1159 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
1160
1161 @example
1162 # guix archive --generate-key
1163 @end example
1164
1165 @noindent
1166 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
1167 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
1168
1169 @example
1170 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
1171 @end example
1172
1173 @noindent
1174 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
1175
1176 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
1177 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
1178 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
1179 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
1180 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
1181
1182 @cindex offload test
1183 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
1184 master node:
1185
1186 @example
1187 # guix offload test
1188 @end example
1189
1190 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
1191 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guile and the Guix modules are
1192 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
1193 from it, and report any error in the process.
1194
1195 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1196 command line:
1197
1198 @example
1199 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1200 @end example
1201
1202 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1203 regular expression like this:
1204
1205 @example
1206 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1207 @end example
1208
1209 @cindex offload status
1210 To display the current load of all build hosts, run this command on the
1211 main node:
1212
1213 @example
1214 # guix offload status
1215 @end example
1216
1217
1218 @node SELinux Support
1219 @subsection SELinux Support
1220
1221 @cindex SELinux, daemon policy
1222 @cindex mandatory access control, SELinux
1223 @cindex security, guix-daemon
1224 Guix includes an SELinux policy file at @file{etc/guix-daemon.cil} that
1225 can be installed on a system where SELinux is enabled, in order to label
1226 Guix files and to specify the expected behavior of the daemon. Since
1227 Guix System does not provide an SELinux base policy, the daemon policy cannot
1228 be used on Guix System.
1229
1230 @subsubsection Installing the SELinux policy
1231 @cindex SELinux, policy installation
1232 To install the policy run this command as root:
1233
1234 @example
1235 semodule -i etc/guix-daemon.cil
1236 @end example
1237
1238 Then relabel the file system with @code{restorecon} or by a different
1239 mechanism provided by your system.
1240
1241 Once the policy is installed, the file system has been relabeled, and
1242 the daemon has been restarted, it should be running in the
1243 @code{guix_daemon_t} context. You can confirm this with the following
1244 command:
1245
1246 @example
1247 ps -Zax | grep guix-daemon
1248 @end example
1249
1250 Monitor the SELinux log files as you run a command like @code{guix build
1251 hello} to convince yourself that SELinux permits all necessary
1252 operations.
1253
1254 @subsubsection Limitations
1255 @cindex SELinux, limitations
1256
1257 This policy is not perfect. Here is a list of limitations or quirks
1258 that should be considered when deploying the provided SELinux policy for
1259 the Guix daemon.
1260
1261 @enumerate
1262 @item
1263 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t} isn’t actually used. None of the socket
1264 operations involve contexts that have anything to do with
1265 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t}. It doesn’t hurt to have this unused label,
1266 but it would be preferrable to define socket rules for only this label.
1267
1268 @item
1269 @code{guix gc} cannot access arbitrary links to profiles. By design,
1270 the file label of the destination of a symlink is independent of the
1271 file label of the link itself. Although all profiles under
1272 $localstatedir are labelled, the links to these profiles inherit the
1273 label of the directory they are in. For links in the user’s home
1274 directory this will be @code{user_home_t}. But for links from the root
1275 user’s home directory, or @file{/tmp}, or the HTTP server’s working
1276 directory, etc, this won’t work. @code{guix gc} would be prevented from
1277 reading and following these links.
1278
1279 @item
1280 The daemon’s feature to listen for TCP connections might no longer work.
1281 This might require extra rules, because SELinux treats network sockets
1282 differently from files.
1283
1284 @item
1285 Currently all files with a name matching the regular expression
1286 @code{/gnu/store/.+-(guix-.+|profile)/bin/guix-daemon} are assigned the
1287 label @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}; this means that @emph{any} file with
1288 that name in any profile would be permitted to run in the
1289 @code{guix_daemon_t} domain. This is not ideal. An attacker could
1290 build a package that provides this executable and convince a user to
1291 install and run it, which lifts it into the @code{guix_daemon_t} domain.
1292 At that point SELinux could not prevent it from accessing files that are
1293 allowed for processes in that domain.
1294
1295 We could generate a much more restrictive policy at installation time,
1296 so that only the @emph{exact} file name of the currently installed
1297 @code{guix-daemon} executable would be labelled with
1298 @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}, instead of using a broad regular expression.
1299 The downside is that root would have to install or upgrade the policy at
1300 installation time whenever the Guix package that provides the
1301 effectively running @code{guix-daemon} executable is upgraded.
1302 @end enumerate
1303
1304 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1305 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1306
1307 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1308 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1309 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1310 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1311
1312 @example
1313 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1314 @end example
1315
1316 @noindent
1317 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1318
1319 @cindex chroot
1320 @cindex container, build environment
1321 @cindex build environment
1322 @cindex reproducible builds
1323 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1324 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1325 @code{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1326 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1327 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1328 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1329 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1330 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1331 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1332 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1333 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1334
1335 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1336 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1337 its @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. This directory is shared with
1338 the container for the duration of the build, though within the container,
1339 the build tree is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0}.
1340
1341 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1342 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1343 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1344
1345 The daemon listens for connections and spawns one sub-process for each session
1346 started by a client (one of the @command{guix} sub-commands.) The
1347 @command{guix processes} command allows you to get an overview of the activity
1348 on your system by viewing each of the active sessions and clients.
1349 @xref{Invoking guix processes}, for more information.
1350
1351 The following command-line options are supported:
1352
1353 @table @code
1354 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1355 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1356 the Daemon, build users}).
1357
1358 @item --no-substitutes
1359 @cindex substitutes
1360 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1361 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1362 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1363
1364 When the daemon runs with @code{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1365 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1366 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1367
1368 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1369 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1370 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1371 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1372 @indicateurl{https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is used.
1373
1374 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1375 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1376
1377 @cindex offloading
1378 @item --no-offload
1379 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1380 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
1381 builds to remote machines.
1382
1383 @item --cache-failures
1384 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1385
1386 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1387 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1388 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1389 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1390
1391 @item --cores=@var{n}
1392 @itemx -c @var{n}
1393 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1394 as available.
1395
1396 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1397 as the @code{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1398 guix build}).
1399
1400 The effect is to define the @code{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1401 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1402 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1403
1404 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1405 @itemx -M @var{n}
1406 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1407 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1408 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1409 Setup}), or simply fail.
1410
1411 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
1412 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
1413 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1414
1415 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1416
1417 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1418 Build Options, @code{--max-silent-time}}).
1419
1420 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
1421 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
1422 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1423
1424 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1425
1426 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1427 Build Options, @code{--timeout}}).
1428
1429 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1430 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1431 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1432 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1433 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1434
1435 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1436 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1437 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1438
1439 @item --debug
1440 Produce debugging output.
1441
1442 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1443 overridden by clients, for example the @code{--verbosity} option of
1444 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1445
1446 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1447 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1448
1449 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1450 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1451 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1452 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1453 needs.
1454
1455 @item --disable-chroot
1456 Disable chroot builds.
1457
1458 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1459 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1460 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1461 account.
1462
1463 @item --log-compression=@var{type}
1464 Compress build logs according to @var{type}, one of @code{gzip},
1465 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
1466
1467 Unless @code{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1468 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1469 them with bzip2 by default.
1470
1471 @item --disable-deduplication
1472 @cindex deduplication
1473 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1474
1475 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1476 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1477 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1478 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1479 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1480 this optimization.
1481
1482 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1483 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1484 derivations.
1485
1486 @cindex GC roots
1487 @cindex garbage collector roots
1488 When set to ``yes'', the GC will keep the outputs of any live derivation
1489 available in the store---the @code{.drv} files. The default is ``no'',
1490 meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are reachable from a GC
1491 root. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for more on GC roots.
1492
1493 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1494 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1495 corresponding to live outputs.
1496
1497 When set to ``yes'', as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1498 derivations---i.e., @code{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1499 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1500 items in their store. Setting it to ``no'' saves a bit of disk space.
1501
1502 In this way, setting @code{--gc-keep-derivations} to ``yes'' causes liveness
1503 to flow from outputs to derivations, and setting @code{--gc-keep-outputs} to
1504 ``yes'' causes liveness to flow from derivations to outputs. When both are
1505 set to ``yes'', the effect is to keep all the build prerequisites (the
1506 sources, compiler, libraries, and other build-time tools) of live objects in
1507 the store, regardless of whether these prerequisites are reachable from a GC
1508 root. This is convenient for developers since it saves rebuilds or downloads.
1509
1510 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1511 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1512 kernel's @code{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1513
1514 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1515 on the kernel version number.
1516
1517 @item --lose-logs
1518 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1519 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1520
1521 @item --system=@var{system}
1522 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1523 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1524 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1525
1526 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
1527 Listen for connections on @var{endpoint}. @var{endpoint} is interpreted
1528 as the file name of a Unix-domain socket if it starts with
1529 @code{/} (slash sign). Otherwise, @var{endpoint} is interpreted as a
1530 host name or host name and port to listen to. Here are a few examples:
1531
1532 @table @code
1533 @item --listen=/gnu/var/daemon
1534 Listen for connections on the @file{/gnu/var/daemon} Unix-domain socket,
1535 creating it if needed.
1536
1537 @item --listen=localhost
1538 @cindex daemon, remote access
1539 @cindex remote access to the daemon
1540 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
1541 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
1542 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1543 @code{localhost}, on port 44146.
1544
1545 @item --listen=128.0.0.42:1234
1546 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1547 @code{128.0.0.42}, on port 1234.
1548 @end table
1549
1550 This option can be repeated multiple times, in which case
1551 @command{guix-daemon} accepts connections on all the specified
1552 endpoints. Users can tell client commands what endpoint to connect to
1553 by setting the @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable
1554 (@pxref{The Store, @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}}).
1555
1556 @quotation Note
1557 The daemon protocol is @emph{unauthenticated and unencrypted}. Using
1558 @code{--listen=@var{host}} is suitable on local networks, such as
1559 clusters, where only trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon. In
1560 other cases where remote access to the daemon is needed, we recommend
1561 using Unix-domain sockets along with SSH.
1562 @end quotation
1563
1564 When @code{--listen} is omitted, @command{guix-daemon} listens for
1565 connections on the Unix-domain socket located at
1566 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
1567 @end table
1568
1569
1570 @node Application Setup
1571 @section Application Setup
1572
1573 @cindex foreign distro
1574 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than Guix System---a
1575 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1576 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1577
1578 @subsection Locales
1579
1580 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1581 @cindex locales, when not on Guix System
1582 @vindex LOCPATH
1583 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1584 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1585 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1586 available with Guix and then define the @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1587 variable:
1588
1589 @example
1590 $ guix install glibc-locales
1591 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1592 @end example
1593
1594 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1595 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1596 110@tie{}MiB. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1597 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1598
1599 The @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @code{LOCPATH}
1600 (@pxref{Locale Names, @code{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1601 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1602
1603 @enumerate
1604 @item
1605 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1606 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1607 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1608 incompatible locale data.
1609
1610 @item
1611 libc suffixes each entry of @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1612 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1613 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1614 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1615 data in the right format.
1616 @end enumerate
1617
1618 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1619 versions may be incompatible.
1620
1621 @subsection Name Service Switch
1622
1623 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1624 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1625 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1626 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1627 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1628 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1629 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1630 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1631 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1632 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1633
1634 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1635 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1636 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1637 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1638 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1639
1640 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1641 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1642 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1643 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1644 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1645 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1646 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1647 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1648 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1649 Reference Manual}).
1650
1651 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1652 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1653 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1654 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1655 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1656 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1657 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1658 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1659 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1660
1661 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1662 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1663 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1664 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1665
1666 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1667 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1668 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1669 themselves.
1670
1671 @subsection X11 Fonts
1672
1673 @cindex fonts
1674 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1675 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1676 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1677 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1678 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1679 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1680 @code{font-gnu-freefont-ttf}.
1681
1682 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1683 graphical applications, consider installing
1684 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1685 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1686 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1687 for Chinese languages:
1688
1689 @example
1690 guix install font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1691 @end example
1692
1693 @cindex @code{xterm}
1694 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1695 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1696 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1697
1698 @example
1699 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1700 @end example
1701
1702 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1703 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1704
1705 @c Note: 'xset' does not accept symlinks so the trick below arranges to
1706 @c get at the real directory. See <https://bugs.gnu.org/30655>.
1707 @example
1708 xset +fp $(dirname $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype/fonts.dir))
1709 @end example
1710
1711 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1712 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1713 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1714
1715 @cindex @code{fc-cache}
1716 @cindex font cache
1717 After installing fonts you may have to refresh the font cache to use
1718 them in applications. The same applies when applications installed via
1719 Guix do not seem to find fonts. To force rebuilding of the font cache
1720 run @code{fc-cache -rv}. The @code{fc-cache} command is provided by
1721 the @code{fontconfig} package.
1722
1723 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1724
1725 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1726 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1727 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1728
1729 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1730 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1731 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1732 information.
1733
1734 @subsection Emacs Packages
1735
1736 @cindex @code{emacs}
1737 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the elisp files may be placed
1738 either in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/} or in
1739 sub-directories of
1740 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d/}. The latter
1741 directory exists because potentially there may exist thousands of Emacs
1742 packages and storing all their files in a single directory may not be
1743 reliable (because of name conflicts). So we think using a separate
1744 directory for each package is a good idea. It is very similar to how
1745 the Emacs package system organizes the file structure (@pxref{Package
1746 Files,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1747
1748 By default, Emacs (installed with Guix) ``knows'' where these packages
1749 are placed, so you do not need to perform any configuration. If, for
1750 some reason, you want to avoid auto-loading Emacs packages installed
1751 with Guix, you can do so by running Emacs with @code{--no-site-file}
1752 option (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1753
1754 @subsection The GCC toolchain
1755
1756 @cindex GCC
1757 @cindex ld-wrapper
1758
1759 Guix offers individual compiler packages such as @code{gcc} but if you
1760 are in need of a complete toolchain for compiling and linking source
1761 code what you really want is the @code{gcc-toolchain} package. This
1762 package provides a complete GCC toolchain for C/C++ development,
1763 including GCC itself, the GNU C Library (headers and binaries, plus
1764 debugging symbols in the @code{debug} output), Binutils, and a linker
1765 wrapper.
1766
1767 The wrapper's purpose is to inspect the @code{-L} and @code{-l} switches
1768 passed to the linker, add corresponding @code{-rpath} arguments, and
1769 invoke the actual linker with this new set of arguments. You can instruct the
1770 wrapper to refuse to link against libraries not in the store by setting the
1771 @code{GUIX_LD_WRAPPER_ALLOW_IMPURITIES} environment variable to @code{no}.
1772
1773 @node Upgrading Guix
1774 @section Upgrading Guix
1775
1776 @cindex Upgrading Guix, on a foreign distro
1777
1778 To upgrade Guix, run:
1779
1780 @example
1781 guix pull
1782 @end example
1783
1784 @xref{Invoking guix pull}, for more information.
1785
1786 @cindex upgrading Guix for the root user, on a foreign distro
1787 @cindex upgrading the Guix daemon, on a foreign distro
1788 @cindex @command{guix pull} for the root user, on a foreign distro
1789
1790 On a foreign distro, you can upgrade the build daemon by running:
1791
1792 @example
1793 sudo -i guix pull
1794 @end example
1795
1796 @noindent
1797 followed by (assuming your distro uses the systemd service management
1798 tool):
1799
1800 @example
1801 systemctl restart guix-daemon.service
1802 @end example
1803
1804 On Guix System, upgrading the daemon is achieved by reconfiguring the
1805 system (@pxref{Invoking guix system, @code{guix system reconfigure}}).
1806
1807 @c TODO What else?
1808
1809 @c *********************************************************************
1810 @node System Installation
1811 @chapter System Installation
1812
1813 @cindex installing Guix System
1814 @cindex Guix System, installation
1815 This section explains how to install Guix System
1816 on a machine. Guix, as a package manager, can
1817 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
1818 @pxref{Installation}.
1819
1820 @ifinfo
1821 @quotation Note
1822 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
1823 @c installation image.
1824 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
1825 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
1826 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
1827 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
1828
1829 Alternately, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
1830 available.
1831 @end quotation
1832 @end ifinfo
1833
1834 @menu
1835 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
1836 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
1837 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
1838 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
1839 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
1840 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
1841 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
1842 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
1843 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
1844 @end menu
1845
1846 @node Limitations
1847 @section Limitations
1848
1849 We consider Guix System to be ready for a wide range of ``desktop'' and server
1850 use cases. The reliability guarantees it provides---transactional upgrades
1851 and rollbacks, reproducibility---make it a solid foundation.
1852
1853 Nevertheless, before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the
1854 following noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
1855
1856 @itemize
1857 @item
1858 Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
1859
1860 @item
1861 More and more system services are provided (@pxref{Services}), but some
1862 may be missing.
1863
1864 @item
1865 GNOME, Xfce, LXDE, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
1866 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, KDE is currently
1867 missing.
1868 @end itemize
1869
1870 More than a disclaimer, this is an invitation to report issues (and success
1871 stories!), and to join us in improving it. @xref{Contributing}, for more
1872 info.
1873
1874
1875 @node Hardware Considerations
1876 @section Hardware Considerations
1877
1878 @cindex hardware support on Guix System
1879 GNU@tie{}Guix focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
1880 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
1881 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
1882 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
1883 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
1884 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
1885 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
1886 hardware is not supported on Guix System.
1887
1888 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
1889 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
1890 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
1891 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
1892 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
1893 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
1894 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
1895 out-of-the-box on Guix System, as part of @code{%base-firmware}
1896 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
1897
1898 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
1899 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
1900 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
1901 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
1902 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
1903 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
1904
1905 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
1906 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
1907 about their support in GNU/Linux.
1908
1909
1910 @node USB Stick and DVD Installation
1911 @section USB Stick and DVD Installation
1912
1913 An ISO-9660 installation image that can be written to a USB stick or
1914 burnt to a DVD can be downloaded from
1915 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz},
1916 where @var{system} is one of:
1917
1918 @table @code
1919 @item x86_64-linux
1920 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
1921
1922 @item i686-linux
1923 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
1924 @end table
1925
1926 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
1927 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
1928 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
1929
1930 @example
1931 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz.sig
1932 $ gpg --verify guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz.sig
1933 @end example
1934
1935 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
1936 then run this command to import it:
1937
1938 @example
1939 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
1940 -qO - | gpg --import -
1941 @end example
1942
1943 @noindent
1944 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
1945
1946 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
1947 signature!'' is normal.
1948
1949 @c end duplication
1950
1951 This image contains the tools necessary for an installation.
1952 It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough USB stick or DVD.
1953
1954 @unnumberedsubsec Copying to a USB Stick
1955
1956 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
1957
1958 @enumerate
1959 @item
1960 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
1961
1962 @example
1963 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz
1964 @end example
1965
1966 @item
1967 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
1968 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
1969 copy the image with:
1970
1971 @example
1972 dd if=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso of=/dev/sdX
1973 sync
1974 @end example
1975
1976 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
1977 @end enumerate
1978
1979 @unnumberedsubsec Burning on a DVD
1980
1981 To copy the image to a DVD, follow these steps:
1982
1983 @enumerate
1984 @item
1985 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
1986
1987 @example
1988 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz
1989 @end example
1990
1991 @item
1992 Insert a blank DVD into your machine, and determine
1993 its device name. Assuming that the DVD drive is known as @file{/dev/srX},
1994 copy the image with:
1995
1996 @example
1997 growisofs -dvd-compat -Z /dev/srX=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
1998 @end example
1999
2000 Access to @file{/dev/srX} usually requires root privileges.
2001 @end enumerate
2002
2003 @unnumberedsubsec Booting
2004
2005 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
2006 the USB stick or DVD. The latter usually requires you to get in the
2007 BIOS or UEFI boot menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
2008 In order to boot from Libreboot, switch to the command mode by pressing
2009 the @kbd{c} key and type @command{search_grub usb}.
2010
2011 @xref{Installing Guix in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
2012 Guix System in a virtual machine (VM).
2013
2014
2015 @node Preparing for Installation
2016 @section Preparing for Installation
2017
2018 Once you have booted, you can use the guided graphical installer, which makes
2019 it easy to get started (@pxref{Guided Graphical Installation}). Alternately,
2020 if you are already familiar with GNU/Linux and if you want more control than
2021 what the graphical installer provides, you can choose the ``manual''
2022 installation process (@pxref{Manual Installation}).
2023
2024 The graphical installer is available on TTY1. You can obtain root shells on
2025 TTYs 3 to 6 by hitting @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, etc. TTY2 shows
2026 this documentation and you can reach it with @kbd{ctrl-alt-f2}. Documentation
2027 is browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
2028 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
2029 which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste it
2030 with the middle button.
2031
2032 @quotation Note
2033 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
2034 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
2035 ``Networking'' section below.
2036 @end quotation
2037
2038 @node Guided Graphical Installation
2039 @section Guided Graphical Installation
2040
2041 The graphical installer is a text-based user interface. It will guide you,
2042 with dialog boxes, through the steps needed to install GNU@tie{}Guix System.
2043
2044 The first dialog boxes allow you to set up the system as you use it during the
2045 installation: you can choose the language, keyboard layout, and set up
2046 networking, which will be used during the installation. The image below shows
2047 the networking dialog.
2048
2049 @image{images/installer-network,5in,, networking setup with the graphical installer}
2050
2051 Later steps allow you to partition your hard disk, as shown in the image
2052 below, to choose whether or not to use encrypted file systems, to enter the
2053 host name and root password, and to create an additional account, among other
2054 things.
2055
2056 @image{images/installer-partitions,5in,, partitioning with the graphical installer}
2057
2058 Note that, at any time, the installer allows you to exit the current
2059 installation step and resume at a previous step, as show in the image below.
2060
2061 @image{images/installer-resume,5in,, resuming the installation process}
2062
2063 Once you're done, the installer produces an operating system configuration and
2064 displays it (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). At that point you can
2065 hit ``OK'' and installation will proceed. On success, you can reboot into the
2066 new system and enjoy. @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2067
2068
2069 @node Manual Installation
2070 @section Manual Installation
2071
2072 This section describes how you would ``manually'' install GNU@tie{}Guix System
2073 on your machine. This option requires familiarity with GNU/Linux, with the
2074 shell, and with common administration tools. If you think this is not for
2075 you, consider using the guided graphical installer (@pxref{Guided Graphical
2076 Installation}).
2077
2078 The installation system provides root shells on TTYs 3 to 6; press
2079 @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, and so on to reach them. It includes
2080 many common tools needed to install the system. But it is also a full-blown
2081 Guix System, which means that you can install additional packages, should you
2082 need it, using @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2083
2084 @menu
2085 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
2086 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
2087 @end menu
2088
2089 @node Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning
2090 @subsection Keyboard Layout, Networking, and Partitioning
2091
2092 Before you can install the system, you may want to adjust the keyboard layout,
2093 set up networking, and partition your target hard disk. This section will
2094 guide you through this.
2095
2096 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
2097
2098 @cindex keyboard layout
2099 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
2100 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
2101 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
2102
2103 @example
2104 loadkeys dvorak
2105 @end example
2106
2107 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
2108 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
2109 more information.
2110
2111 @subsubsection Networking
2112
2113 Run the following command to see what your network interfaces are called:
2114
2115 @example
2116 ifconfig -a
2117 @end example
2118
2119 @noindent
2120 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2121
2122 @example
2123 ip address
2124 @end example
2125
2126 @c https://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
2127 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
2128 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
2129 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
2130 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
2131
2132 @table @asis
2133 @item Wired connection
2134 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
2135 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
2136
2137 @example
2138 ifconfig @var{interface} up
2139 @end example
2140
2141 @noindent
2142 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2143
2144 @example
2145 ip link set @var{interface} up
2146 @end example
2147
2148 @item Wireless connection
2149 @cindex wireless
2150 @cindex WiFi
2151 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
2152 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
2153 important) using one of the available text editors such as
2154 @command{nano}:
2155
2156 @example
2157 nano wpa_supplicant.conf
2158 @end example
2159
2160 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
2161 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
2162 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
2163
2164 @example
2165 network=@{
2166 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
2167 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
2168 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
2169 @}
2170 @end example
2171
2172 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
2173 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
2174 network interface you want to use):
2175
2176 @example
2177 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
2178 @end example
2179
2180 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
2181 @end table
2182
2183 @cindex DHCP
2184 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
2185 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
2186
2187 @example
2188 dhclient -v @var{interface}
2189 @end example
2190
2191 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
2192
2193 @example
2194 ping -c 3 gnu.org
2195 @end example
2196
2197 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
2198 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
2199
2200 @cindex installing over SSH
2201 If you want to, you can continue the installation remotely by starting
2202 an SSH server:
2203
2204 @example
2205 herd start ssh-daemon
2206 @end example
2207
2208 Make sure to either set a password with @command{passwd}, or configure
2209 OpenSSH public key authentication before logging in.
2210
2211 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
2212
2213 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
2214 then format the target partition(s).
2215
2216 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
2217 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
2218 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
2219 the partition layout you want:
2220
2221 @example
2222 cfdisk
2223 @end example
2224
2225 If your disk uses the GUID Partition Table (GPT) format and you plan to
2226 install BIOS-based GRUB (which is the default), make sure a BIOS Boot
2227 Partition is available (@pxref{BIOS installation,,, grub, GNU GRUB
2228 manual}).
2229
2230 @cindex EFI, installation
2231 @cindex UEFI, installation
2232 @cindex ESP, EFI system partition
2233 If you instead wish to use EFI-based GRUB, a FAT32 @dfn{EFI System Partition}
2234 (ESP) is required. This partition can be mounted at @file{/boot/efi} for
2235 instance and must have the @code{esp} flag set. E.g., for @command{parted}:
2236
2237 @example
2238 parted /dev/sda set 1 esp on
2239 @end example
2240
2241 @quotation Note
2242 @vindex grub-bootloader
2243 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
2244 Unsure whether to use EFI- or BIOS-based GRUB? If the directory
2245 @file{/sys/firmware/efi} exists in the installation image, then you should
2246 probably perform an EFI installation, using @code{grub-efi-bootloader}.
2247 Otherwise you should use the BIOS-based GRUB, known as
2248 @code{grub-bootloader}. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more info on
2249 bootloaders.
2250 @end quotation
2251
2252 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
2253 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
2254 Guix System only supports ext4, btrfs, and JFS file systems. In particular,
2255 code that reads file system UUIDs and labels only works for these file system
2256 types.}. For the ESP, if you have one and assuming it is
2257 @file{/dev/sda1}, run:
2258
2259 @example
2260 mkfs.fat -F32 /dev/sda1
2261 @end example
2262
2263 Preferably, assign file systems a label so that you can easily and
2264 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
2265 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
2266 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
2267 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda2}, a file system with the label
2268 @code{my-root} can be created with:
2269
2270 @example
2271 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda2
2272 @end example
2273
2274 @cindex encrypted disk
2275 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
2276 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
2277 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
2278 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information.) Assuming you want to
2279 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, the command sequence would
2280 be along these lines:
2281
2282 @example
2283 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda2
2284 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda2 my-partition
2285 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
2286 @end example
2287
2288 Once that is done, mount the target file system under @file{/mnt}
2289 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
2290 root file system):
2291
2292 @example
2293 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
2294 @end example
2295
2296 Also mount any other file systems you would like to use on the target
2297 system relative to this path. If you have opted for @file{/boot/efi} as an
2298 EFI mount point for example, mount it at @file{/mnt/boot/efi} now so it is
2299 found by @code{guix system init} afterwards.
2300
2301 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
2302 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
2303 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
2304 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda3}, you would run:
2305
2306 @example
2307 mkswap /dev/sda3
2308 swapon /dev/sda3
2309 @end example
2310
2311 Alternatively, you may use a swap file. For example, assuming that in
2312 the new system you want to use the file @file{/swapfile} as a swap file,
2313 you would run@footnote{This example will work for many types of file
2314 systems (e.g., ext4). However, for copy-on-write file systems (e.g.,
2315 btrfs), the required steps may be different. For details, see the
2316 manual pages for @command{mkswap} and @command{swapon}.}:
2317
2318 @example
2319 # This is 10 GiB of swap space. Adjust "count" to change the size.
2320 dd if=/dev/zero of=/mnt/swapfile bs=1MiB count=10240
2321 # For security, make the file readable and writable only by root.
2322 chmod 600 /mnt/swapfile
2323 mkswap /mnt/swapfile
2324 swapon /mnt/swapfile
2325 @end example
2326
2327 Note that if you have encrypted the root partition and created a swap
2328 file in its file system as described above, then the encryption also
2329 protects the swap file, just like any other file in that file system.
2330
2331 @node Proceeding with the Installation
2332 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
2333
2334 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
2335 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
2336
2337 @example
2338 herd start cow-store /mnt
2339 @end example
2340
2341 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
2342 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
2343 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
2344 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
2345 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
2346
2347 Next, you have to edit a file and
2348 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
2349 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors. We
2350 recommend GNU nano (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), which
2351 supports syntax highlighting and parentheses matching; other editors
2352 include GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
2353 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
2354 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
2355 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
2356 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
2357
2358 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
2359 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
2360 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
2361 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
2362 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
2363 something along these lines:
2364
2365 @example
2366 # mkdir /mnt/etc
2367 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
2368 # nano /mnt/etc/config.scm
2369 @end example
2370
2371 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
2372 in particular:
2373
2374 @itemize
2375 @item
2376 Make sure the @code{bootloader-configuration} form refers to the target
2377 you want to install GRUB on. It should mention @code{grub-bootloader} if
2378 you are installing GRUB in the legacy way, or @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
2379 for newer UEFI systems. For legacy systems, the @code{target} field
2380 names a device, like @code{/dev/sda}; for UEFI systems it names a path
2381 to a mounted EFI partition, like @code{/boot/efi}; do make sure the path is
2382 currently mounted and a @code{file-system} entry is specified in your
2383 configuration.
2384
2385 @item
2386 Be sure that your file system labels match the value of their respective
2387 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
2388 your @code{file-system} configuration uses the @code{file-system-label}
2389 procedure in its @code{device} field.
2390
2391 @item
2392 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
2393 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
2394 @end itemize
2395
2396 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
2397 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
2398 under @file{/mnt}):
2399
2400 @example
2401 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
2402 @end example
2403
2404 @noindent
2405 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
2406 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-bootloader} option. For
2407 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
2408 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
2409
2410 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
2411 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
2412 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
2413 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
2414 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
2415 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
2416 @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2417
2418
2419 @node After System Installation
2420 @section After System Installation
2421
2422 Success, you've now booted into Guix System! From then on, you can update the
2423 system whenever you want by running, say:
2424
2425 @example
2426 guix pull
2427 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2428 @end example
2429
2430 @noindent
2431 This builds a new system generation with the latest packages and services
2432 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). We recommend doing that regularly so that
2433 your system includes the latest security updates (@pxref{Security Updates}).
2434
2435 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2019-01/msg00268.html>.
2436 @quotation Note
2437 @cindex sudo vs. @command{guix pull}
2438 Note that @command{sudo guix} runs your user's @command{guix} command and
2439 @emph{not} root's, because @command{sudo} leaves @code{PATH} unchanged. To
2440 explicitly run root's @command{guix}, type @command{sudo -i guix @dots{}}.
2441 @end quotation
2442
2443 Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
2444 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience!
2445
2446
2447 @node Installing Guix in a VM
2448 @section Installing Guix in a Virtual Machine
2449
2450 @cindex virtual machine, Guix System installation
2451 @cindex virtual private server (VPS)
2452 @cindex VPS (virtual private server)
2453 If you'd like to install Guix System in a virtual machine (VM) or on a
2454 virtual private server (VPS) rather than on your beloved machine, this
2455 section is for you.
2456
2457 To boot a @uref{https://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing Guix System in a
2458 disk image, follow these steps:
2459
2460 @enumerate
2461 @item
2462 First, retrieve and decompress the Guix system installation image as
2463 described previously (@pxref{USB Stick and DVD Installation}).
2464
2465 @item
2466 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
2467 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
2468
2469 @example
2470 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guix-system.img 50G
2471 @end example
2472
2473 The resulting file will be much smaller than 50 GB (typically less than
2474 1 MB), but it will grow as the virtualized storage device is filled up.
2475
2476 @item
2477 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
2478
2479 @example
2480 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 -enable-kvm \
2481 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci -boot menu=on,order=d \
2482 -drive file=guix-system.img \
2483 -drive media=cdrom,file=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
2484 @end example
2485
2486 @code{-enable-kvm} is optional, but significantly improves performance,
2487 @pxref{Running Guix in a VM}.
2488
2489 @item
2490 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
2491 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
2492 @end enumerate
2493
2494 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
2495 @file{guix-system.img} image. @xref{Running Guix in a VM}, for how to do
2496 that.
2497
2498 @node Building the Installation Image
2499 @section Building the Installation Image
2500
2501 @cindex installation image
2502 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
2503 system} command, specifically:
2504
2505 @example
2506 guix system disk-image --file-system-type=iso9660 \
2507 gnu/system/install.scm
2508 @end example
2509
2510 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
2511 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
2512 about the installation image.
2513
2514 @section Building the Installation Image for ARM Boards
2515
2516 Many ARM boards require a specific variant of the
2517 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot} bootloader.
2518
2519 If you build a disk image and the bootloader is not available otherwise
2520 (on another boot drive etc), it's advisable to build an image that
2521 includes the bootloader, specifically:
2522
2523 @example
2524 guix system disk-image --system=armhf-linux -e '((@@ (gnu system install) os-with-u-boot) (@@ (gnu system install) installation-os) "A20-OLinuXino-Lime2")'
2525 @end example
2526
2527 @code{A20-OLinuXino-Lime2} is the name of the board. If you specify an invalid
2528 board, a list of possible boards will be printed.
2529
2530 @c *********************************************************************
2531 @node Package Management
2532 @chapter Package Management
2533
2534 @cindex packages
2535 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
2536 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
2537 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
2538 features.
2539
2540 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the
2541 package management tools it provides. Along with the command-line
2542 interface described below (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix
2543 package}}), you may also use the Emacs-Guix interface (@pxref{Top,,,
2544 emacs-guix, The Emacs-Guix Reference Manual}), after installing
2545 @code{emacs-guix} package (run @kbd{M-x guix-help} command to start
2546 with it):
2547
2548 @example
2549 guix install emacs-guix
2550 @end example
2551
2552 @menu
2553 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
2554 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
2555 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
2556 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
2557 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
2558 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
2559 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
2560 * Invoking guix time-machine:: Running an older revision of Guix.
2561 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
2562 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
2563 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
2564 @end menu
2565
2566 @node Features
2567 @section Features
2568
2569 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
2570 own directory---something that resembles
2571 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string.
2572
2573 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
2574 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
2575 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
2576 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
2577
2578 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
2579 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
2580 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
2581 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
2582 simply continues to point to
2583 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
2584 coexist on the same system without any interference.
2585
2586 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
2587 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
2588 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
2589
2590 @cindex transactions
2591 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
2592 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
2593 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
2594 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
2595 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
2596 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
2597
2598 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
2599 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
2600 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
2601 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
2602 system configuration on Guix is subject to
2603 transactional upgrades and roll-back
2604 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
2605
2606 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
2607 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
2608 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
2609 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
2610 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
2611 collected.
2612
2613 @cindex reproducibility
2614 @cindex reproducible builds
2615 Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
2616 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
2617 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
2618 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
2619 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
2620 given package installation matches the current state of their
2621 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
2622 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
2623 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
2624 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
2625
2626 @cindex substitutes
2627 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
2628 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
2629 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
2630 downloads it and unpacks it;
2631 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
2632 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
2633 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
2634 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
2635 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
2636
2637 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
2638 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
2639 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
2640 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
2641 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
2642
2643 @cindex replication, of software environments
2644 @cindex provenance tracking, of software artifacts
2645 All of Guix and its package definitions is version-controlled, and
2646 @command{guix pull} allows you to ``travel in time'' on the history of Guix
2647 itself (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). This makes it possible to replicate a
2648 Guix instance on a different machine or at a later point in time, which in
2649 turn allows you to @emph{replicate complete software environments}, while
2650 retaining precise @dfn{provenance tracking} of the software.
2651
2652 @node Invoking guix package
2653 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
2654
2655 @cindex installing packages
2656 @cindex removing packages
2657 @cindex package installation
2658 @cindex package removal
2659 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
2660 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
2661 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
2662 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
2663 is:
2664
2665 @example
2666 guix package @var{options}
2667 @end example
2668
2669 @cindex transactions
2670 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
2671 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
2672 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
2673 want to roll back.
2674
2675 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
2676 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
2677
2678 @example
2679 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
2680 @end example
2681
2682 @cindex aliases, for @command{guix package}
2683 For your convenience, we also provide the following aliases:
2684
2685 @itemize
2686 @item
2687 @command{guix search} is an alias for @command{guix package -s},
2688 @item
2689 @command{guix install} is an alias for @command{guix package -i},
2690 @item
2691 @command{guix remove} is an alias for @command{guix package -r},
2692 @item
2693 @command{guix upgrade} is an alias for @command{guix package -u},
2694 @item
2695 and @command{guix show} is an alias for @command{guix package --show=}.
2696 @end itemize
2697
2698 These aliases are less expressive than @command{guix package} and provide
2699 fewer options, so in some cases you'll probably want to use @command{guix
2700 package} directly.
2701
2702 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
2703 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
2704 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
2705 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
2706
2707 @cindex profile
2708 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
2709 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
2710 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
2711 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @code{PATH} environment
2712 variable, and so on.
2713 @cindex search paths
2714 If you are not using Guix System, consider adding the
2715 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
2716 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
2717 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
2718
2719 @example
2720 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" ; \
2721 source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
2722 @end example
2723
2724 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
2725 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
2726 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
2727 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
2728 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
2729 @code{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
2730 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
2731 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
2732 package}.
2733
2734 The @var{options} can be among the following:
2735
2736 @table @code
2737
2738 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
2739 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
2740 Install the specified @var{package}s.
2741
2742 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
2743 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
2744 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
2745 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected.)
2746
2747 If no version number is specified, the
2748 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
2749 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
2750 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
2751 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
2752 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
2753 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
2754
2755 @cindex propagated inputs
2756 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
2757 that automatically get installed along with the required package
2758 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
2759 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
2760 package definitions).
2761
2762 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
2763 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
2764 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
2765 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
2766 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
2767 also been explicitly installed by the user.
2768
2769 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
2770 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
2771 @code{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
2772 environment variable definitions are reported here.
2773
2774 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
2775 @itemx -e @var{exp}
2776 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
2777
2778 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
2779 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
2780 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
2781 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
2782
2783 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
2784 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
2785 multiple-output package.
2786
2787 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
2788 @itemx -f @var{file}
2789 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
2790
2791 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
2792 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
2793
2794 @lisp
2795 @include package-hello.scm
2796 @end lisp
2797
2798 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
2799 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
2800 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
2801 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
2802
2803 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
2804 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
2805 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
2806
2807 As for @code{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
2808 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
2809 @code{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
2810 @code{glibc}.
2811
2812 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2813 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2814 @cindex upgrading packages
2815 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
2816 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
2817 @var{regexp}. Also see the @code{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
2818
2819 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
2820 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
2821 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2822 pull}).
2823
2824 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2825 When used together with the @code{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
2826 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
2827 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
2828 substring ``emacs'':
2829
2830 @example
2831 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
2832 @end example
2833
2834 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
2835 @itemx -m @var{file}
2836 @cindex profile declaration
2837 @cindex profile manifest
2838 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
2839 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
2840 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
2841
2842 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
2843 constructing it through a sequence of @code{--install} and similar
2844 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
2845 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
2846 so on.
2847
2848 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
2849 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
2850 of packages:
2851
2852 @findex packages->manifest
2853 @lisp
2854 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
2855
2856 (packages->manifest
2857 (list emacs
2858 guile-2.0
2859 ;; Use a specific package output.
2860 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
2861 @end lisp
2862
2863 @findex specifications->manifest
2864 In this example we have to know which modules define the @code{emacs}
2865 and @code{guile-2.0} variables to provide the right
2866 @code{use-package-modules} line, which can be cumbersome. We can
2867 instead provide regular package specifications and let
2868 @code{specifications->manifest} look up the corresponding package
2869 objects, like this:
2870
2871 @lisp
2872 (specifications->manifest
2873 '("emacs" "guile@@2.2" "guile@@2.2:debug"))
2874 @end lisp
2875
2876 @item --roll-back
2877 @cindex rolling back
2878 @cindex undoing transactions
2879 @cindex transactions, undoing
2880 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
2881 the last transaction.
2882
2883 When combined with options such as @code{--install}, roll back occurs
2884 before any other actions.
2885
2886 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
2887 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
2888 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
2889
2890 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
2891 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
2892 generations in a profile is always linear.
2893
2894 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
2895 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
2896 @cindex generations
2897 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
2898
2899 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
2900 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
2901 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
2902 the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
2903 @code{--switch-generation=+1}.
2904
2905 The difference between @code{--roll-back} and
2906 @code{--switch-generation=-1} is that @code{--switch-generation} will
2907 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
2908 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
2909
2910 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
2911 @cindex search paths
2912 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
2913 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
2914 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
2915 of the installed packages.
2916
2917 For example, GCC needs the @code{CPATH} and @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
2918 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
2919 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
2920 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
2921 library are installed in the profile, then @code{--search-paths} will
2922 suggest setting these variables to @code{@var{profile}/include} and
2923 @code{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
2924
2925 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
2926 shell:
2927
2928 @example
2929 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
2930 @end example
2931
2932 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
2933 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
2934 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
2935 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
2936
2937 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
2938 of several profiles. Consider this example:
2939
2940 @example
2941 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
2942 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
2943 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
2944 @end example
2945
2946 The last command above reports about the @code{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
2947 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
2948 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
2949
2950
2951 @item --profile=@var{profile}
2952 @itemx -p @var{profile}
2953 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
2954
2955 @var{profile} must be the name of a file that will be created upon
2956 completion. Concretely, @var{profile} will be a mere symbolic link
2957 (``symlink'') pointing to the actual profile where packages are
2958 installed:
2959
2960 @example
2961 $ guix install hello -p ~/code/my-profile
2962 @dots{}
2963 $ ~/code/my-profile/bin/hello
2964 Hello, world!
2965 @end example
2966
2967 All it takes to get rid of the profile is to remove this symlink and its
2968 siblings that point to specific generations:
2969
2970 @example
2971 $ rm ~/code/my-profile ~/code/my-profile-*-link
2972 @end example
2973
2974 @item --list-profiles
2975 List all the user's profiles:
2976
2977 @example
2978 $ guix package --list-profiles
2979 /home/charlie/.guix-profile
2980 /home/charlie/code/my-profile
2981 /home/charlie/code/devel-profile
2982 /home/charlie/tmp/test
2983 @end example
2984
2985 When running as root, list all the profiles of all the users.
2986
2987 @cindex collisions, in a profile
2988 @cindex colliding packages in profiles
2989 @cindex profile collisions
2990 @item --allow-collisions
2991 Allow colliding packages in the new profile. Use at your own risk!
2992
2993 By default, @command{guix package} reports as an error @dfn{collisions}
2994 in the profile. Collisions happen when two or more different versions
2995 or variants of a given package end up in the profile.
2996
2997 @item --bootstrap
2998 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
2999 useful to distribution developers.
3000
3001 @end table
3002
3003 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
3004 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
3005 availability of packages:
3006
3007 @table @option
3008
3009 @item --search=@var{regexp}
3010 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
3011 @cindex searching for packages
3012 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
3013 @var{regexp} (in a case-insensitive fashion), sorted by relevance.
3014 Print all the metadata of matching packages in
3015 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
3016 GNU recutils manual}).
3017
3018 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
3019 command, for instance:
3020
3021 @example
3022 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version,relevance
3023 name: jemalloc
3024 version: 4.5.0
3025 relevance: 6
3026
3027 name: glibc
3028 version: 2.25
3029 relevance: 1
3030
3031 name: libgc
3032 version: 7.6.0
3033 relevance: 1
3034 @end example
3035
3036 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
3037 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
3038
3039 @example
3040 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
3041 name: elfutils
3042
3043 name: gmp
3044 @dots{}
3045 @end example
3046
3047 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s} flags to
3048 @command{guix package}, or several arguments to @command{guix search}. For
3049 example, the following command returns a list of board games (this time using
3050 the @command{guix search} alias):
3051
3052 @example
3053 $ guix search '\<board\>' game | recsel -p name
3054 name: gnubg
3055 @dots{}
3056 @end example
3057
3058 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
3059 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
3060 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
3061 keyboards.
3062
3063 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
3064 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
3065 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
3066
3067 @example
3068 $ guix search crypto library | \
3069 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
3070 @end example
3071
3072 @noindent
3073 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
3074 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
3075
3076 @item --show=@var{package}
3077 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
3078 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
3079 recutils manual}).
3080
3081 @example
3082 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
3083 name: python
3084 version: 2.7.6
3085
3086 name: python
3087 version: 3.3.5
3088 @end example
3089
3090 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
3091 specific version of it (this time using the @command{guix show} alias):
3092 @example
3093 $ guix show python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
3094 name: python
3095 version: 3.4.3
3096 @end example
3097
3098
3099
3100 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
3101 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
3102 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
3103 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
3104 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3105
3106 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3107 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
3108 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
3109 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
3110 the store.
3111
3112 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
3113 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
3114 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
3115 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
3116 installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3117
3118 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
3119 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
3120 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
3121
3122 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3123 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3124 @cindex generations
3125 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
3126 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
3127 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
3128 shown.
3129
3130 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3131 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
3132 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
3133 location of this package in the store.
3134
3135 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
3136 generations. Valid patterns include:
3137
3138 @itemize
3139 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
3140 generation numbers. For instance, @code{--list-generations=1} returns
3141 the first one.
3142
3143 And @code{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
3144 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
3145
3146 @item @emph{Ranges}. @code{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
3147 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
3148 a range must be smaller than its end.
3149
3150 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
3151 @code{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
3152 second one.
3153
3154 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
3155 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
3156 duration. For example, @code{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
3157 that are up to 20 days old.
3158 @end itemize
3159
3160 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3161 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3162 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3163 one.
3164
3165 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3166 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3167 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3168 specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
3169 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3170
3171 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
3172 zeroth generation is never deleted.
3173
3174 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3175 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3176
3177 @end table
3178
3179 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
3180 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
3181 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
3182 @option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
3183 However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
3184 preserve transformations across upgrades, you should define your own
3185 package variant in a Guile module and add it to @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
3186 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
3187
3188 @node Substitutes
3189 @section Substitutes
3190
3191 @cindex substitutes
3192 @cindex pre-built binaries
3193 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
3194 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
3195 server, or both. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they
3196 are substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
3197 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
3198
3199 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
3200 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
3201 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
3202 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
3203
3204 @menu
3205 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
3206 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
3207 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
3208 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
3209 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
3210 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
3211 @end menu
3212
3213 @node Official Substitute Server
3214 @subsection Official Substitute Server
3215
3216 @cindex build farm
3217 The @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} server is a front-end to an official build farm
3218 that builds packages from Guix continuously for some
3219 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes. This is the
3220 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
3221 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
3222 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
3223 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
3224 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
3225 option}).
3226
3227 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS.
3228 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
3229 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
3230 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
3231 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
3232
3233 Substitutes from the official build farm are enabled by default when
3234 using Guix System (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). However,
3235 they are disabled by default when using Guix on a foreign distribution,
3236 unless you have explicitly enabled them via one of the recommended
3237 installation steps (@pxref{Installation}). The following paragraphs
3238 describe how to enable or disable substitutes for the official build
3239 farm; the same procedure can also be used to enable substitutes for any
3240 other substitute server.
3241
3242 @node Substitute Server Authorization
3243 @subsection Substitute Server Authorization
3244
3245 @cindex security
3246 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
3247 @cindex access control list (ACL), for substitutes
3248 @cindex ACL (access control list), for substitutes
3249 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or a
3250 mirror thereof, you
3251 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
3252 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3253 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to not
3254 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
3255
3256 The public key for @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is installed along with Guix, in
3257 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
3258 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
3259 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
3260 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
3261 Then, you can run something like this:
3262
3263 @example
3264 # guix archive --authorize < @var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
3265 @end example
3266
3267 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
3268 should change from something like:
3269
3270 @example
3271 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3272 The following derivations would be built:
3273 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
3274 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
3275 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
3276 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
3277 @dots{}
3278 @end example
3279
3280 @noindent
3281 to something like:
3282
3283 @example
3284 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3285 112.3 MB would be downloaded:
3286 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
3287 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
3288 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
3289 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
3290 @dots{}
3291 @end example
3292
3293 @noindent
3294 This indicates that substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} are usable and
3295 will be downloaded, when possible, for future builds.
3296
3297 @cindex substitutes, how to disable
3298 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
3299 @code{guix-daemon} with @code{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
3300 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
3301 @code{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package}, @command{guix
3302 build}, and other command-line tools.
3303
3304 @node Substitute Authentication
3305 @subsection Substitute Authentication
3306
3307 @cindex digital signatures
3308 Guix detects and raises an error when attempting to use a substitute
3309 that has been tampered with. Likewise, it ignores substitutes that are
3310 not signed, or that are not signed by one of the keys listed in the ACL.
3311
3312 There is one exception though: if an unauthorized server provides
3313 substitutes that are @emph{bit-for-bit identical} to those provided by
3314 an authorized server, then the unauthorized server becomes eligible for
3315 downloads. For example, assume we have chosen two substitute servers
3316 with this option:
3317
3318 @example
3319 --substitute-urls="https://a.example.org https://b.example.org"
3320 @end example
3321
3322 @noindent
3323 @cindex reproducible builds
3324 If the ACL contains only the key for @code{b.example.org}, and if
3325 @code{a.example.org} happens to serve the @emph{exact same} substitutes,
3326 then Guix will download substitutes from @code{a.example.org} because it
3327 comes first in the list and can be considered a mirror of
3328 @code{b.example.org}. In practice, independent build machines usually
3329 produce the same binaries, thanks to bit-reproducible builds (see
3330 below).
3331
3332 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
3333 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
3334 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
3335 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
3336 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
3337 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys.)
3338
3339 @node Proxy Settings
3340 @subsection Proxy Settings
3341
3342 @vindex http_proxy
3343 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS.
3344 The @code{http_proxy} environment
3345 variable can be set in the environment of @command{guix-daemon} and is
3346 honored for downloads of substitutes. Note that the value of
3347 @code{http_proxy} in the environment where @command{guix build},
3348 @command{guix package}, and other client commands are run has
3349 @emph{absolutely no effect}.
3350
3351 @node Substitution Failure
3352 @subsection Substitution Failure
3353
3354 Even when a substitute for a derivation is available, sometimes the
3355 substitution attempt will fail. This can happen for a variety of
3356 reasons: the substitute server might be offline, the substitute may
3357 recently have been deleted, the connection might have been interrupted,
3358 etc.
3359
3360 When substitutes are enabled and a substitute for a derivation is
3361 available, but the substitution attempt fails, Guix will attempt to
3362 build the derivation locally depending on whether or not
3363 @code{--fallback} was given (@pxref{fallback-option,, common build
3364 option @code{--fallback}}). Specifically, if @code{--fallback} was
3365 omitted, then no local build will be performed, and the derivation is
3366 considered to have failed. However, if @code{--fallback} was given,
3367 then Guix will attempt to build the derivation locally, and the success
3368 or failure of the derivation depends on the success or failure of the
3369 local build. Note that when substitutes are disabled or no substitute
3370 is available for the derivation in question, a local build will
3371 @emph{always} be performed, regardless of whether or not
3372 @code{--fallback} was given.
3373
3374 To get an idea of how many substitutes are available right now, you can
3375 try running the @command{guix weather} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3376 weather}). This command provides statistics on the substitutes provided
3377 by a server.
3378
3379 @node On Trusting Binaries
3380 @subsection On Trusting Binaries
3381
3382 @cindex trust, of pre-built binaries
3383 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
3384 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
3385 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
3386 weaknesses. While using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} substitutes can be
3387 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
3388 their own build farm, such that @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is less of an
3389 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
3390 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
3391 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
3392
3393 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
3394 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
3395 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
3396 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
3397 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
3398 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
3399 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
3400 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
3401 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
3402 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
3403 @command{guix build --check}}).
3404
3405 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
3406 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
3407 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
3408
3409 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
3410 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
3411
3412 @cindex multiple-output packages
3413 @cindex package outputs
3414 @cindex outputs
3415
3416 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
3417 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
3418 @command{guix install glibc}, one installs the default output of the
3419 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
3420 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
3421 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
3422 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
3423 files.
3424
3425 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
3426 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
3427 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
3428 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
3429 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
3430 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
3431 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
3432
3433 @example
3434 guix install glib
3435 @end example
3436
3437 @cindex documentation
3438 The command to install its documentation is:
3439
3440 @example
3441 guix install glib:doc
3442 @end example
3443
3444 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
3445 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
3446 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
3447 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
3448 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
3449 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
3450 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
3451 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
3452 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
3453
3454 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
3455 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
3456 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
3457 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
3458 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
3459 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
3460 guix package}).
3461
3462
3463 @node Invoking guix gc
3464 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
3465
3466 @cindex garbage collector
3467 @cindex disk space
3468 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
3469 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
3470 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
3471 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
3472 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
3473
3474 @cindex GC roots
3475 @cindex garbage collector roots
3476 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
3477 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
3478 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
3479 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots (``GC roots'' for short)
3480 includes default user profiles; by default, the symlinks under
3481 @file{/var/guix/gcroots} represent these GC roots. New GC roots can be
3482 added with @command{guix build --root}, for example (@pxref{Invoking
3483 guix build}). The @command{guix gc --list-roots} command lists them.
3484
3485 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
3486 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
3487 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
3488 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
3489 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3490
3491 Our recommendation is to run a garbage collection periodically, or when
3492 you are short on disk space. For instance, to guarantee that at least
3493 5@tie{}GB are available on your disk, simply run:
3494
3495 @example
3496 guix gc -F 5G
3497 @end example
3498
3499 It is perfectly safe to run as a non-interactive periodic job
3500 (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}, for how to set up such a job).
3501 Running @command{guix gc} with no arguments will collect as
3502 much garbage as it can, but that is often inconvenient: you may find
3503 yourself having to rebuild or re-download software that is ``dead'' from
3504 the GC viewpoint but that is necessary to build other pieces of
3505 software---e.g., the compiler tool chain.
3506
3507 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
3508 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
3509 files (the @code{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
3510 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
3511 options are as follows:
3512
3513 @table @code
3514 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
3515 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
3516 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
3517 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
3518 specified.
3519
3520 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
3521 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
3522 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
3523 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
3524
3525 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
3526
3527 @item --free-space=@var{free}
3528 @itemx -F @var{free}
3529 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
3530 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
3531 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
3532
3533 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
3534 nothing and exit immediately.
3535
3536 @item --delete-generations[=@var{duration}]
3537 @itemx -d [@var{duration}]
3538 Before starting the garbage collection process, delete all the generations
3539 older than @var{duration}, for all the user profiles; when run as root, this
3540 applies to all the profiles @emph{of all the users}.
3541
3542 For example, this command deletes all the generations of all your profiles
3543 that are older than 2 months (except generations that are current), and then
3544 proceeds to free space until at least 10 GiB are available:
3545
3546 @example
3547 guix gc -d 2m -F 10G
3548 @end example
3549
3550 @item --delete
3551 @itemx -D
3552 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
3553 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
3554 they are still live.
3555
3556 @item --list-failures
3557 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
3558
3559 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
3560 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
3561 @option{--cache-failures}}).
3562
3563 @item --list-roots
3564 List the GC roots owned by the user; when run as root, list @emph{all} the GC
3565 roots.
3566
3567 @item --list-busy
3568 List store items in use by currently running processes. These store
3569 items are effectively considered GC roots: they cannot be deleted.
3570
3571 @item --clear-failures
3572 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
3573
3574 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
3575 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
3576
3577 @item --list-dead
3578 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
3579 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
3580
3581 @item --list-live
3582 Show the list of live store files and directories.
3583
3584 @end table
3585
3586 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
3587
3588 @table @code
3589
3590 @item --references
3591 @itemx --referrers
3592 @cindex package dependencies
3593 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
3594 as arguments.
3595
3596 @item --requisites
3597 @itemx -R
3598 @cindex closure
3599 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
3600 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
3601 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
3602 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
3603
3604 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
3605 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
3606 the graph of references.
3607
3608 @item --derivers
3609 @cindex derivation
3610 Return the derivation(s) leading to the given store items
3611 (@pxref{Derivations}).
3612
3613 For example, this command:
3614
3615 @example
3616 guix gc --derivers `guix package -I ^emacs$ | cut -f4`
3617 @end example
3618
3619 @noindent
3620 returns the @file{.drv} file(s) leading to the @code{emacs} package
3621 installed in your profile.
3622
3623 Note that there may be zero matching @file{.drv} files, for instance
3624 because these files have been garbage-collected. There can also be more
3625 than one matching @file{.drv} due to fixed-output derivations.
3626 @end table
3627
3628 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
3629 store and to control disk usage.
3630
3631 @table @option
3632
3633 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
3634 @cindex integrity, of the store
3635 @cindex integrity checking
3636 Verify the integrity of the store.
3637
3638 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
3639 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
3640
3641 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
3642 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
3643
3644 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
3645 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
3646 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
3647 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
3648 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
3649
3650 @cindex repairing the store
3651 @cindex corruption, recovering from
3652 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
3653 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
3654 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
3655 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
3656 system administrator. A lightweight alternative, when you know exactly
3657 which items in the store are corrupt, is @command{guix build --repair}
3658 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
3659
3660 @item --optimize
3661 @cindex deduplication
3662 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
3663 @dfn{deduplication}.
3664
3665 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
3666 import, unless it was started with @code{--disable-deduplication}
3667 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @code{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
3668 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
3669 @code{--disable-deduplication}.
3670
3671 @end table
3672
3673 @node Invoking guix pull
3674 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
3675
3676 @cindex upgrading Guix
3677 @cindex updating Guix
3678 @cindex @command{guix pull}
3679 @cindex pull
3680 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
3681 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
3682 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
3683 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
3684 descriptions, and deploys it. Source code is downloaded from a
3685 @uref{https://git-scm.com, Git} repository, by default the official
3686 GNU@tie{}Guix repository, though this can be customized.
3687
3688 Specifically, @command{guix pull} downloads code from the @dfn{channels}
3689 (@pxref{Channels}) specified by one of the followings, in this order:
3690
3691 @enumerate
3692 @item
3693 the @option{--channels} option;
3694 @item
3695 the user's @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file;
3696 @item
3697 the system-wide @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm} file;
3698 @item
3699 the built-in default channels specified in the @code{%default-channels}
3700 variable.
3701 @end enumerate
3702
3703 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
3704 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
3705 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
3706 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
3707 become available.
3708
3709 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
3710 effect is limited to the user who ran @command{guix pull}. For
3711 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
3712 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
3713 versa.
3714
3715 The result of running @command{guix pull} is a @dfn{profile} available
3716 under @file{~/.config/guix/current} containing the latest Guix. Thus,
3717 make sure to add it to the beginning of your search path so that you use
3718 the latest version, and similarly for the Info manual
3719 (@pxref{Documentation}):
3720
3721 @example
3722 export PATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/bin:$PATH"
3723 export INFOPATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/share/info:$INFOPATH"
3724 @end example
3725
3726 The @code{--list-generations} or @code{-l} option lists past generations
3727 produced by @command{guix pull}, along with details about their provenance:
3728
3729 @example
3730 $ guix pull -l
3731 Generation 1 Jun 10 2018 00:18:18
3732 guix 65956ad
3733 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3734 branch: origin/master
3735 commit: 65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe
3736
3737 Generation 2 Jun 11 2018 11:02:49
3738 guix e0cc7f6
3739 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3740 branch: origin/master
3741 commit: e0cc7f669bec22c37481dd03a7941c7d11a64f1d
3742 2 new packages: keepalived, libnfnetlink
3743 6 packages upgraded: emacs-nix-mode@@2.0.4,
3744 guile2.0-guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac, guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac,
3745 heimdal@@7.5.0, milkytracker@@1.02.00, nix@@2.0.4
3746
3747 Generation 3 Jun 13 2018 23:31:07 (current)
3748 guix 844cc1c
3749 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3750 branch: origin/master
3751 commit: 844cc1c8f394f03b404c5bb3aee086922373490c
3752 28 new packages: emacs-helm-ls-git, emacs-helm-mu, @dots{}
3753 69 packages upgraded: borg@@1.1.6, cheese@@3.28.0, @dots{}
3754 @end example
3755
3756 @xref{Invoking guix describe, @command{guix describe}}, for other ways to
3757 describe the current status of Guix.
3758
3759 This @code{~/.config/guix/current} profile works exactly like the profiles
3760 created by @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). That
3761 is, you can list generations, roll back to the previous
3762 generation---i.e., the previous Guix---and so on:
3763
3764 @example
3765 $ guix pull --roll-back
3766 switched from generation 3 to 2
3767 $ guix pull --delete-generations=1
3768 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
3769 @end example
3770
3771 You can also use @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package})
3772 to manage the profile by naming it explicitly:
3773 @example
3774 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --roll-back
3775 switched from generation 3 to 2
3776 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --delete-generations=1
3777 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
3778 @end example
3779
3780 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
3781 but it supports the following options:
3782
3783 @table @code
3784 @item --url=@var{url}
3785 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
3786 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
3787 Download code for the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
3788 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
3789 string), or @var{branch}.
3790
3791 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
3792 @cindex configuration file for channels
3793 These options are provided for convenience, but you can also specify your
3794 configuration in the @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file or using the
3795 @option{--channels} option (see below).
3796
3797 @item --channels=@var{file}
3798 @itemx -C @var{file}
3799 Read the list of channels from @var{file} instead of
3800 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} or @file{/etc/guix/channels.scm}.
3801 @var{file} must contain Scheme code that
3802 evaluates to a list of channel objects. @xref{Channels}, for more
3803 information.
3804
3805 @cindex channel news
3806 @item --news
3807 @itemx -N
3808 Display the list of packages added or upgraded since the previous
3809 generation, as well as, occasionally, news written by channel authors
3810 for their users (@pxref{Channels, Writing Channel News}).
3811
3812 The package information is the same as displayed upon @command{guix
3813 pull} completion, but without ellipses; it is also similar to the output
3814 of @command{guix pull -l} for the last generation (see below).
3815
3816 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3817 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3818 List all the generations of @file{~/.config/guix/current} or, if @var{pattern}
3819 is provided, the subset of generations that match @var{pattern}.
3820 The syntax of @var{pattern} is the same as with @code{guix package
3821 --list-generations} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3822
3823 @item --roll-back
3824 @cindex rolling back
3825 @cindex undoing transactions
3826 @cindex transactions, undoing
3827 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of @file{~/.config/guix/current}---i.e.,
3828 undo the last transaction.
3829
3830 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
3831 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
3832 @cindex generations
3833 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
3834
3835 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
3836 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
3837 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
3838 the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
3839 @code{--switch-generation=+1}.
3840
3841 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3842 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3843 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3844 one.
3845
3846 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3847 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3848 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3849 specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
3850 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3851
3852 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted.
3853
3854 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3855 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3856
3857 @xref{Invoking guix describe}, for a way to display information about the
3858 current generation only.
3859
3860 @item --profile=@var{profile}
3861 @itemx -p @var{profile}
3862 Use @var{profile} instead of @file{~/.config/guix/current}.
3863
3864 @item --dry-run
3865 @itemx -n
3866 Show which channel commit(s) would be used and what would be built or
3867 substituted but do not actually do it.
3868
3869 @item --system=@var{system}
3870 @itemx -s @var{system}
3871 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
3872 the system type of the build host.
3873
3874 @item --verbose
3875 Produce verbose output, writing build logs to the standard error output.
3876
3877 @item --bootstrap
3878 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
3879 useful to Guix developers.
3880 @end table
3881
3882 The @dfn{channel} mechanism allows you to instruct @command{guix pull} which
3883 repository and branch to pull from, as well as @emph{additional} repositories
3884 containing package modules that should be deployed. @xref{Channels}, for more
3885 information.
3886
3887 In addition, @command{guix pull} supports all the common build options
3888 (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
3889
3890 @node Channels
3891 @section Channels
3892
3893 @cindex channels
3894 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
3895 @cindex configuration file for channels
3896 @cindex @command{guix pull}, configuration file
3897 @cindex configuration of @command{guix pull}
3898 Guix and its package collection are updated by running @command{guix pull}
3899 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). By default @command{guix pull} downloads and
3900 deploys Guix itself from the official GNU@tie{}Guix repository. This can be
3901 customized by defining @dfn{channels} in the
3902 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file. A channel specifies a URL and branch
3903 of a Git repository to be deployed, and @command{guix pull} can be instructed
3904 to pull from one or more channels. In other words, channels can be used to
3905 @emph{customize} and to @emph{extend} Guix, as we will see below.
3906
3907 @subsection Using a Custom Guix Channel
3908
3909 The channel called @code{guix} specifies where Guix itself---its command-line
3910 tools as well as its package collection---should be downloaded. For instance,
3911 suppose you want to update from your own copy of the Guix repository at
3912 @code{example.org}, and specifically the @code{super-hacks} branch, you can
3913 write in @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} this specification:
3914
3915 @lisp
3916 ;; Tell 'guix pull' to use my own repo.
3917 (list (channel
3918 (name 'guix)
3919 (url "https://example.org/my-guix.git")
3920 (branch "super-hacks")))
3921 @end lisp
3922
3923 @noindent
3924 From there on, @command{guix pull} will fetch code from the @code{super-hacks}
3925 branch of the repository at @code{example.org}.
3926
3927 @subsection Specifying Additional Channels
3928
3929 @cindex extending the package collection (channels)
3930 @cindex personal packages (channels)
3931 @cindex channels, for personal packages
3932 You can also specify @emph{additional channels} to pull from. Let's say you
3933 have a bunch of custom package variants or personal packages that you think
3934 would make little sense to contribute to the Guix project, but would like to
3935 have these packages transparently available to you at the command line. You
3936 would first write modules containing those package definitions (@pxref{Package
3937 Modules}), maintain them in a Git repository, and then you and anyone else can
3938 use it as an additional channel to get packages from. Neat, no?
3939
3940 @c What follows stems from discussions at
3941 @c <https://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=22629#134> as well as
3942 @c earlier discussions on guix-devel@gnu.org.
3943 @quotation Warning
3944 Before you, dear user, shout---``woow this is @emph{soooo coool}!''---and
3945 publish your personal channel to the world, we would like to share a few words
3946 of caution:
3947
3948 @itemize
3949 @item
3950 Before publishing a channel, please consider contributing your package
3951 definitions to Guix proper (@pxref{Contributing}). Guix as a project is open
3952 to free software of all sorts, and packages in Guix proper are readily
3953 available to all Guix users and benefit from the project's quality assurance
3954 process.
3955
3956 @item
3957 When you maintain package definitions outside Guix, we, Guix developers,
3958 consider that @emph{the compatibility burden is on you}. Remember that
3959 package modules and package definitions are just Scheme code that uses various
3960 programming interfaces (APIs). We want to remain free to change these APIs to
3961 keep improving Guix, possibly in ways that break your channel. We never
3962 change APIs gratuitously, but we will @emph{not} commit to freezing APIs
3963 either.
3964
3965 @item
3966 Corollary: if you're using an external channel and that channel breaks, please
3967 @emph{report the issue to the channel authors}, not to the Guix project.
3968 @end itemize
3969
3970 You've been warned! Having said this, we believe external channels are a
3971 practical way to exert your freedom to augment Guix' package collection and to
3972 share your improvements, which are basic tenets of
3973 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, free software}. Please
3974 email us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} if you'd like to discuss this.
3975 @end quotation
3976
3977 To use a channel, write @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} to instruct
3978 @command{guix pull} to pull from it @emph{in addition} to the default Guix
3979 channel(s):
3980
3981 @vindex %default-channels
3982 @lisp
3983 ;; Add my personal packages to those Guix provides.
3984 (cons (channel
3985 (name 'my-personal-packages)
3986 (url "https://example.org/personal-packages.git"))
3987 %default-channels)
3988 @end lisp
3989
3990 @noindent
3991 Note that the snippet above is (as always!)@: Scheme code; we use @code{cons} to
3992 add a channel the list of channels that the variable @code{%default-channels}
3993 is bound to (@pxref{Pairs, @code{cons} and lists,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
3994 Manual}). With this file in place, @command{guix pull} builds not only Guix
3995 but also the package modules from your own repository. The result in
3996 @file{~/.config/guix/current} is the union of Guix with your own package
3997 modules:
3998
3999 @example
4000 $ guix pull --list-generations
4001 @dots{}
4002 Generation 19 Aug 27 2018 16:20:48
4003 guix d894ab8
4004 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4005 branch: master
4006 commit: d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300
4007 my-personal-packages dd3df5e
4008 repository URL: https://example.org/personal-packages.git
4009 branch: master
4010 commit: dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb
4011 11 new packages: my-gimp, my-emacs-with-cool-features, @dots{}
4012 4 packages upgraded: emacs-racket-mode@@0.0.2-2.1b78827, @dots{}
4013 @end example
4014
4015 @noindent
4016 The output of @command{guix pull} above shows that Generation@tie{}19 includes
4017 both Guix and packages from the @code{my-personal-packages} channel. Among
4018 the new and upgraded packages that are listed, some like @code{my-gimp} and
4019 @code{my-emacs-with-cool-features} might come from
4020 @code{my-personal-packages}, while others come from the Guix default channel.
4021
4022 To create a channel, create a Git repository containing your own package
4023 modules and make it available. The repository can contain anything, but a
4024 useful channel will contain Guile modules that export packages. Once you
4025 start using a channel, Guix will behave as if the root directory of that
4026 channel's Git repository has been added to the Guile load path (@pxref{Load
4027 Paths,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For example, if your channel
4028 contains a file at @file{my-packages/my-tools.scm} that defines a Guile
4029 module, then the module will be available under the name @code{(my-packages
4030 my-tools)}, and you will be able to use it like any other module
4031 (@pxref{Modules,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
4032
4033 @cindex dependencies, channels
4034 @cindex meta-data, channels
4035 @subsection Declaring Channel Dependencies
4036
4037 Channel authors may decide to augment a package collection provided by other
4038 channels. They can declare their channel to be dependent on other channels in
4039 a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel}, which is to be placed in the root of
4040 the channel repository.
4041
4042 The meta-data file should contain a simple S-expression like this:
4043
4044 @lisp
4045 (channel
4046 (version 0)
4047 (dependencies
4048 (channel
4049 (name some-collection)
4050 (url "https://example.org/first-collection.git"))
4051 (channel
4052 (name some-other-collection)
4053 (url "https://example.org/second-collection.git")
4054 (branch "testing"))))
4055 @end lisp
4056
4057 In the above example this channel is declared to depend on two other channels,
4058 which will both be fetched automatically. The modules provided by the channel
4059 will be compiled in an environment where the modules of all these declared
4060 channels are available.
4061
4062 For the sake of reliability and maintainability, you should avoid dependencies
4063 on channels that you don't control, and you should aim to keep the number of
4064 dependencies to a minimum.
4065
4066 @cindex subdirectory, channels
4067 @subsection Package Modules in a Sub-directory
4068
4069 As a channel author, you may want to keep your channel modules in a
4070 sub-directory. If your modules are in the sub-directory @file{guix}, you must
4071 add a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel} that contains:
4072
4073 @lisp
4074 (channel
4075 (version 0)
4076 (directory "guix"))
4077 @end lisp
4078
4079 @cindex news, for channels
4080 @subsection Writing Channel News
4081
4082 Channel authors may occasionally want to communicate to their users
4083 information about important changes in the channel. You'd send them all
4084 an email, but that's not convenient.
4085
4086 Instead, channels can provide a @dfn{news file}; when the channel users
4087 run @command{guix pull}, that news file is automatically read and
4088 @command{guix pull --news} can display the announcements that correspond
4089 to the new commits that have been pulled, if any.
4090
4091 To do that, channel authors must first declare the name of the news file
4092 in their @file{.guix-channel} file:
4093
4094 @lisp
4095 (channel
4096 (version 0)
4097 (news-file "etc/news.txt"))
4098 @end lisp
4099
4100 The news file itself, @file{etc/news.txt} in this example, must look
4101 something like this:
4102
4103 @lisp
4104 (channel-news
4105 (version 0)
4106 (entry (tag "the-bug-fix")
4107 (title (en "Fixed terrible bug")
4108 (fr "Oh la la"))
4109 (body (en "@@emph@{Good news@}! It's fixed!")
4110 (eo "Certe ĝi pli bone funkcias nun!")))
4111 (entry (commit "bdcabe815cd28144a2d2b4bc3c5057b051fa9906")
4112 (title (en "Added a great package")
4113 (ca "Què vol dir guix?"))
4114 (body (en "Don't miss the @@code@{hello@} package!"))))
4115 @end lisp
4116
4117 The file consists of a list of @dfn{news entries}. Each entry is
4118 associated with a commit or tag: it describes changes made in this
4119 commit, possibly in preceding commits as well. Users see entries only
4120 the first time they obtain the commit the entry refers to.
4121
4122 The @code{title} field should be a one-line summary while @code{body}
4123 can be arbitrarily long, and both can contain Texinfo markup
4124 (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). Both the title and body are
4125 a list of language tag/message tuples, which allows @command{guix pull}
4126 to display news in the language that corresponds to the user's locale.
4127
4128 If you want to translate news using a gettext-based workflow, you can
4129 extract translatable strings with @command{xgettext} (@pxref{xgettext
4130 Invocation,,, gettext, GNU Gettext Utilities}). For example, assuming
4131 you write news entries in English first, the command below creates a PO
4132 file containing the strings to translate:
4133
4134 @example
4135 xgettext -o news.po -l scheme -ken etc/news.scm
4136 @end example
4137
4138 To sum up, yes, you could use your channel as a blog. But beware, this
4139 is @emph{not quite} what your users might expect.
4140
4141 @subsection Replicating Guix
4142
4143 @cindex pinning, channels
4144 @cindex replicating Guix
4145 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
4146 The @command{guix pull --list-generations} output above shows precisely which
4147 commits were used to build this instance of Guix. We can thus replicate it,
4148 say, on another machine, by providing a channel specification in
4149 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} that is ``pinned'' to these commits:
4150
4151 @lisp
4152 ;; Deploy specific commits of my channels of interest.
4153 (list (channel
4154 (name 'guix)
4155 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4156 (commit "d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300"))
4157 (channel
4158 (name 'my-personal-packages)
4159 (url "https://example.org/personal-packages.git")
4160 (branch "dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb")))
4161 @end lisp
4162
4163 The @command{guix describe --format=channels} command can even generate this
4164 list of channels directly (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}). The resulting
4165 file can be used with the -C options of @command{guix pull}
4166 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}) or @command{guix time-machine}
4167 (@pxref{Invoking guix time-machine}).
4168
4169 At this point the two machines run the @emph{exact same Guix}, with access to
4170 the @emph{exact same packages}. The output of @command{guix build gimp} on
4171 one machine will be exactly the same, bit for bit, as the output of the same
4172 command on the other machine. It also means both machines have access to all
4173 the source code of Guix and, transitively, to all the source code of every
4174 package it defines.
4175
4176 This gives you super powers, allowing you to track the provenance of binary
4177 artifacts with very fine grain, and to reproduce software environments at
4178 will---some sort of ``meta reproducibility'' capabilities, if you will.
4179 @xref{Inferiors}, for another way to take advantage of these super powers.
4180
4181 @node Invoking guix time-machine
4182 @section Invoking @command{guix time-machine}
4183
4184 @cindex @command{guix time-machine}
4185 @cindex pinning, channels
4186 @cindex replicating Guix
4187 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
4188
4189 The @command{guix time-machine} command provides access to other
4190 revisions of Guix, for example to install older versions of packages,
4191 or to reproduce a computation in an identical environment. The revision
4192 of Guix to be used is defined by a commit or by a channel
4193 description file created by @command{guix describe}
4194 (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}).
4195
4196 The general syntax is:
4197
4198 @example
4199 guix time-machine @var{options}@dots{} -- @var{command} @var {arg}@dots{}
4200 @end example
4201
4202 where @var{command} and @var{arg}@dots{} are passed unmodified to the
4203 @command{guix} command if the specified revision. The @var{options} that define
4204 this revision are the same as for @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
4205
4206 @table @code
4207 @item --url=@var{url}
4208 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
4209 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
4210 Use the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
4211 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
4212 string), or @var{branch}.
4213
4214 @item --channels=@var{file}
4215 @itemx -C @var{file}
4216 Read the list of channels from @var{file}. @var{file} must contain
4217 Scheme code that evaluates to a list of channel objects.
4218 @xref{Channels} for more information.
4219 @end table
4220
4221 As for @command{guix pull}, the absence of any options means that the
4222 the latest commit on the master branch will be used. The command
4223
4224 @example
4225 guix time-machine -- build hello
4226 @end example
4227
4228 will thus build the package @code{hello} as defined in the master branch,
4229 which is in general a newer revison of Guix than you have installed.
4230 Time travel works in both directions!
4231
4232 Note that @command{guix time-machine} can trigger builds of channels and
4233 their dependencies, and these are controlled by the standard build
4234 options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4235
4236 @node Inferiors
4237 @section Inferiors
4238
4239 @c TODO: Remove this once we're more confident about API stability.
4240 @quotation Note
4241 The functionality described here is a ``technology preview'' as of version
4242 @value{VERSION}. As such, the interface is subject to change.
4243 @end quotation
4244
4245 @cindex inferiors
4246 @cindex composition of Guix revisions
4247 Sometimes you might need to mix packages from the revision of Guix you're
4248 currently running with packages available in a different revision of Guix.
4249 Guix @dfn{inferiors} allow you to achieve that by composing different Guix
4250 revisions in arbitrary ways.
4251
4252 @cindex inferior packages
4253 Technically, an ``inferior'' is essentially a separate Guix process connected
4254 to your main Guix process through a REPL (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). The
4255 @code{(guix inferior)} module allows you to create inferiors and to
4256 communicate with them. It also provides a high-level interface to browse and
4257 manipulate the packages that an inferior provides---@dfn{inferior packages}.
4258
4259 When combined with channels (@pxref{Channels}), inferiors provide a simple way
4260 to interact with a separate revision of Guix. For example, let's assume you
4261 want to install in your profile the current @code{guile} package, along with
4262 the @code{guile-json} as it existed in an older revision of Guix---perhaps
4263 because the newer @code{guile-json} has an incompatible API and you want to
4264 run your code against the old API@. To do that, you could write a manifest for
4265 use by @code{guix package --manifest} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}); in that
4266 manifest, you would create an inferior for that old Guix revision you care
4267 about, and you would look up the @code{guile-json} package in the inferior:
4268
4269 @lisp
4270 (use-modules (guix inferior) (guix channels)
4271 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'first'
4272
4273 (define channels
4274 ;; This is the old revision from which we want to
4275 ;; extract guile-json.
4276 (list (channel
4277 (name 'guix)
4278 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4279 (commit
4280 "65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe"))))
4281
4282 (define inferior
4283 ;; An inferior representing the above revision.
4284 (inferior-for-channels channels))
4285
4286 ;; Now create a manifest with the current "guile" package
4287 ;; and the old "guile-json" package.
4288 (packages->manifest
4289 (list (first (lookup-inferior-packages inferior "guile-json"))
4290 (specification->package "guile")))
4291 @end lisp
4292
4293 On its first run, @command{guix package --manifest} might have to build the
4294 channel you specified before it can create the inferior; subsequent runs will
4295 be much faster because the Guix revision will be cached.
4296
4297 The @code{(guix inferior)} module provides the following procedures to open an
4298 inferior:
4299
4300 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-for-channels @var{channels} @
4301 [#:cache-directory] [#:ttl]
4302 Return an inferior for @var{channels}, a list of channels. Use the cache at
4303 @var{cache-directory}, where entries can be reclaimed after @var{ttl} seconds.
4304 This procedure opens a new connection to the build daemon.
4305
4306 As a side effect, this procedure may build or substitute binaries for
4307 @var{channels}, which can take time.
4308 @end deffn
4309
4310 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-inferior @var{directory} @
4311 [#:command "bin/guix"]
4312 Open the inferior Guix in @var{directory}, running
4313 @code{@var{directory}/@var{command} repl} or equivalent. Return @code{#f} if
4314 the inferior could not be launched.
4315 @end deffn
4316
4317 @cindex inferior packages
4318 The procedures listed below allow you to obtain and manipulate inferior
4319 packages.
4320
4321 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-packages @var{inferior}
4322 Return the list of packages known to @var{inferior}.
4323 @end deffn
4324
4325 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-inferior-packages @var{inferior} @var{name} @
4326 [@var{version}]
4327 Return the sorted list of inferior packages matching @var{name} in
4328 @var{inferior}, with highest version numbers first. If @var{version} is true,
4329 return only packages with a version number prefixed by @var{version}.
4330 @end deffn
4331
4332 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package? @var{obj}
4333 Return true if @var{obj} is an inferior package.
4334 @end deffn
4335
4336 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-name @var{package}
4337 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-version @var{package}
4338 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-synopsis @var{package}
4339 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-description @var{package}
4340 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-home-page @var{package}
4341 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-location @var{package}
4342 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-inputs @var{package}
4343 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-inputs @var{package}
4344 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4345 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4346 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-search-paths @var{package}
4347 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-native-search-paths @var{package}
4348 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-search-paths @var{package}
4349 These procedures are the counterpart of package record accessors
4350 (@pxref{package Reference}). Most of them work by querying the inferior
4351 @var{package} comes from, so the inferior must still be live when you call
4352 these procedures.
4353 @end deffn
4354
4355 Inferior packages can be used transparently like any other package or
4356 file-like object in G-expressions (@pxref{G-Expressions}). They are also
4357 transparently handled by the @code{packages->manifest} procedure, which is
4358 commonly use in manifests (@pxref{Invoking guix package, the
4359 @option{--manifest} option of @command{guix package}}). Thus you can insert
4360 an inferior package pretty much anywhere you would insert a regular package:
4361 in manifests, in the @code{packages} field of your @code{operating-system}
4362 declaration, and so on.
4363
4364 @node Invoking guix describe
4365 @section Invoking @command{guix describe}
4366
4367 @cindex reproducibility
4368 @cindex replicating Guix
4369 Often you may want to answer questions like: ``Which revision of Guix am I
4370 using?'' or ``Which channels am I using?'' This is useful information in many
4371 situations: if you want to @emph{replicate} an environment on a different
4372 machine or user account, if you want to report a bug or to determine what
4373 change in the channels you are using caused it, or if you want to record your
4374 system state for reproducibility purposes. The @command{guix describe}
4375 command answers these questions.
4376
4377 When run from a @command{guix pull}ed @command{guix}, @command{guix describe}
4378 displays the channel(s) that it was built from, including their repository URL
4379 and commit IDs (@pxref{Channels}):
4380
4381 @example
4382 $ guix describe
4383 Generation 10 Sep 03 2018 17:32:44 (current)
4384 guix e0fa68c
4385 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4386 branch: master
4387 commit: e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727
4388 @end example
4389
4390 If you're familiar with the Git version control system, this is similar in
4391 spirit to @command{git describe}; the output is also similar to that of
4392 @command{guix pull --list-generations}, but limited to the current generation
4393 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{--list-generations} option}). Because
4394 the Git commit ID shown above unambiguously refers to a snapshot of Guix, this
4395 information is all it takes to describe the revision of Guix you're using, and
4396 also to replicate it.
4397
4398 To make it easier to replicate Guix, @command{guix describe} can also be asked
4399 to return a list of channels instead of the human-readable description above:
4400
4401 @example
4402 $ guix describe -f channels
4403 (list (channel
4404 (name 'guix)
4405 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4406 (commit
4407 "e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727")))
4408 @end example
4409
4410 @noindent
4411 You can save this to a file and feed it to @command{guix pull -C} on some
4412 other machine or at a later point in time, which will instantiate @emph{this
4413 exact Guix revision} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{-C} option}).
4414 From there on, since you're able to deploy the same revision of Guix, you can
4415 just as well @emph{replicate a complete software environment}. We humbly
4416 think that this is @emph{awesome}, and we hope you'll like it too!
4417
4418 The details of the options supported by @command{guix describe} are as
4419 follows:
4420
4421 @table @code
4422 @item --format=@var{format}
4423 @itemx -f @var{format}
4424 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
4425
4426 @table @code
4427 @item human
4428 produce human-readable output;
4429 @item channels
4430 produce a list of channel specifications that can be passed to @command{guix
4431 pull -C} or installed as @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} (@pxref{Invoking
4432 guix pull});
4433 @item json
4434 @cindex JSON
4435 produce a list of channel specifications in JSON format;
4436 @item recutils
4437 produce a list of channel specifications in Recutils format.
4438 @end table
4439
4440 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4441 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4442 Display information about @var{profile}.
4443 @end table
4444
4445 @node Invoking guix archive
4446 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
4447
4448 @cindex @command{guix archive}
4449 @cindex archive
4450 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
4451 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them on
4452 a machine that runs Guix.
4453 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
4454 to the store on another machine.
4455
4456 @quotation Note
4457 If you're looking for a way to produce archives in a format suitable for
4458 tools other than Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix pack}.
4459 @end quotation
4460
4461 @cindex exporting store items
4462 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
4463
4464 @example
4465 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
4466 @end example
4467
4468 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
4469 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
4470 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
4471 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
4472 output of @code{emacs}:
4473
4474 @example
4475 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
4476 @end example
4477
4478 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
4479 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
4480 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4481
4482 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
4483 one would run:
4484
4485 @example
4486 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4487 @end example
4488
4489 @noindent
4490 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
4491 to another like this:
4492
4493 @example
4494 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
4495 ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4496 @end example
4497
4498 @noindent
4499 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
4500 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
4501 @code{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on the
4502 target machine. The @code{--missing} option can help figure out which
4503 items are missing from the target store. The @command{guix copy}
4504 command simplifies and optimizes this whole process, so this is probably
4505 what you should use in this case (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
4506
4507 @cindex nar, archive format
4508 @cindex normalized archive (nar)
4509 Archives are stored in the ``normalized archive'' or ``nar'' format, which is
4510 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with differences
4511 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
4512 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the nar format only mentions
4513 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
4514 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
4515 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
4516 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
4517 deterministic.
4518
4519 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
4520 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
4521 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
4522 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
4523 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
4524
4525 The main options are:
4526
4527 @table @code
4528 @item --export
4529 Export the specified store files or packages (see below.) Write the
4530 resulting archive to the standard output.
4531
4532 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
4533 @code{--recursive} is passed.
4534
4535 @item -r
4536 @itemx --recursive
4537 When combined with @code{--export}, this instructs @command{guix
4538 archive} to include dependencies of the given items in the archive.
4539 Thus, the resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure
4540 of the exported store items.
4541
4542 @item --import
4543 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
4544 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
4545 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
4546 keys (see @code{--authorize} below.)
4547
4548 @item --missing
4549 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
4550 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
4551 the store.
4552
4553 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
4554 @cindex signing, archives
4555 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
4556 archives can be exported with @code{--export}. Note that this operation
4557 usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy to
4558 generate the key pair.
4559
4560 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
4561 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
4562 key, which must be kept secret.) When @var{parameters} is omitted,
4563 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
4564 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
4565 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
4566 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
4567 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
4568 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
4569
4570 @item --authorize
4571 @cindex authorizing, archives
4572 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
4573 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
4574 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
4575
4576 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
4577 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
4578 @url{https://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
4579 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
4580 @url{https://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
4581 (SPKI)}.
4582
4583 @item --extract=@var{directory}
4584 @itemx -x @var{directory}
4585 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4586 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
4587 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
4588
4589 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
4590 served by @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
4591
4592 @example
4593 $ wget -O - \
4594 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
4595 | bunzip2 | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
4596 @end example
4597
4598 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
4599 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
4600 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
4601 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
4602 unsafe.
4603
4604 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
4605 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers.
4606
4607 @item --list
4608 @itemx -t
4609 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4610 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and print the list of files it contains, as in
4611 this example:
4612
4613 @example
4614 $ wget -O - \
4615 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/lzip/@dots{}-emacs-26.3 \
4616 | lzip -d | guix archive -t
4617 @end example
4618
4619 @end table
4620
4621
4622 @c *********************************************************************
4623 @node Development
4624 @chapter Development
4625
4626 @cindex software development
4627 If you are a software developer, Guix provides tools that you should find
4628 helpful---independently of the language you're developing in. This is what
4629 this chapter is about.
4630
4631 The @command{guix environment} command provides a convenient way to set up
4632 @dfn{development environments} containing all the dependencies and tools
4633 necessary to work on the software package of your choice. The @command{guix
4634 pack} command allows you to create @dfn{application bundles} that can be
4635 easily distributed to users who do not run Guix.
4636
4637 @menu
4638 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
4639 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
4640 @end menu
4641
4642 @node Invoking guix environment
4643 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
4644
4645 @cindex reproducible build environments
4646 @cindex development environments
4647 @cindex @command{guix environment}
4648 @cindex environment, package build environment
4649 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
4650 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
4651 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
4652 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
4653 environment to use them.
4654
4655 The general syntax is:
4656
4657 @example
4658 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4659 @end example
4660
4661 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
4662 GNU@tie{}Guile:
4663
4664 @example
4665 guix environment guile
4666 @end example
4667
4668 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
4669 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an augmented
4670 version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was run in.
4671 It contains the necessary search paths for building the given package
4672 added to the existing environment variables. To create a ``pure''
4673 environment, in which the original environment variables have been unset,
4674 use the @code{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes wrongfully augment
4675 environment variables such as @code{PATH} in their @file{~/.bashrc}
4676 file. As a consequence, when @code{guix environment} launches it, Bash
4677 may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby introducing ``impurities'' in these
4678 environment variables. It is an error to define such environment
4679 variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead, they should be defined in
4680 @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by log-in shells.
4681 @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}, for
4682 details on Bash start-up files.}.
4683
4684 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
4685 @command{guix environment} defines the @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
4686 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
4687 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
4688 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
4689 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
4690
4691 @example
4692 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
4693 then
4694 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
4695 fi
4696 @end example
4697
4698 @noindent
4699 ...@: or to browse the profile:
4700
4701 @example
4702 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
4703 @end example
4704
4705 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
4706 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
4707 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
4708 and Emacs are available:
4709
4710 @example
4711 guix environment guile emacs
4712 @end example
4713
4714 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
4715 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
4716 command from the rest of the arguments:
4717
4718 @example
4719 guix environment guile -- make -j4
4720 @end example
4721
4722 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
4723 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
4724 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
4725 NumPy:
4726
4727 @example
4728 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
4729 @end example
4730
4731 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
4732 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
4733 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
4734 @code{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
4735 @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
4736 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
4737 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
4738 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
4739 additionally includes Git and strace:
4740
4741 @example
4742 guix environment guix --ad-hoc git strace
4743 @end example
4744
4745 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
4746 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
4747 using Guix on a host distro that is not Guix System, it is desirable to
4748 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
4749 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
4750 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
4751 working directory are mounted:
4752
4753 @example
4754 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
4755 @end example
4756
4757 @quotation Note
4758 The @code{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
4759 @end quotation
4760
4761 The available options are summarized below.
4762
4763 @table @code
4764 @item --root=@var{file}
4765 @itemx -r @var{file}
4766 @cindex persistent environment
4767 @cindex garbage collector root, for environments
4768 Make @var{file} a symlink to the profile for this environment, and
4769 register it as a garbage collector root.
4770
4771 This is useful if you want to protect your environment from garbage
4772 collection, to make it ``persistent''.
4773
4774 When this option is omitted, the environment is protected from garbage
4775 collection only for the duration of the @command{guix environment}
4776 session. This means that next time you recreate the same environment,
4777 you could have to rebuild or re-download packages. @xref{Invoking guix
4778 gc}, for more on GC roots.
4779
4780 @item --expression=@var{expr}
4781 @itemx -e @var{expr}
4782 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
4783 @var{expr} evaluates to.
4784
4785 For example, running:
4786
4787 @example
4788 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
4789 @end example
4790
4791 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
4792 PETSc package.
4793
4794 Running:
4795
4796 @example
4797 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
4798 @end example
4799
4800 starts a shell with all the base system packages available.
4801
4802 The above commands only use the default output of the given packages.
4803 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
4804
4805 @example
4806 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
4807 @end example
4808
4809 @item --load=@var{file}
4810 @itemx -l @var{file}
4811 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
4812 within @var{file} evaluates to.
4813
4814 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
4815 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
4816
4817 @lisp
4818 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
4819 @end lisp
4820
4821 @item --manifest=@var{file}
4822 @itemx -m @var{file}
4823 Create an environment for the packages contained in the manifest object
4824 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated
4825 several times, in which case the manifests are concatenated.
4826
4827 This is similar to the same-named option in @command{guix package}
4828 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the same
4829 manifest files.
4830
4831 @item --ad-hoc
4832 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
4833 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
4834 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
4835 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
4836
4837 For instance, the command:
4838
4839 @example
4840 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
4841 @end example
4842
4843 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
4844 available.
4845
4846 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
4847 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
4848 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
4849 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
4850
4851 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
4852 environment}. Packages appearing before @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted
4853 as packages whose dependencies will be added to the environment, the
4854 default behavior. Packages appearing after are interpreted as packages
4855 that will be added to the environment directly.
4856
4857 @item --pure
4858 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment, except
4859 those specified with @option{--preserve} (see below.) This has the effect of
4860 creating an environment in which search paths only contain package inputs.
4861
4862 @item --preserve=@var{regexp}
4863 @itemx -E @var{regexp}
4864 When used alongside @option{--pure}, preserve the environment variables
4865 matching @var{regexp}---in other words, put them on a ``white list'' of
4866 environment variables that must be preserved. This option can be repeated
4867 several times.
4868
4869 @example
4870 guix environment --pure --preserve=^SLURM --ad-hoc openmpi @dots{} \
4871 -- mpirun @dots{}
4872 @end example
4873
4874 This example runs @command{mpirun} in a context where the only environment
4875 variables defined are @code{PATH}, environment variables whose name starts
4876 with @code{SLURM}, as well as the usual ``precious'' variables (@code{HOME},
4877 @code{USER}, etc.)
4878
4879 @item --search-paths
4880 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
4881 environment.
4882
4883 @item --system=@var{system}
4884 @itemx -s @var{system}
4885 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
4886
4887 @item --container
4888 @itemx -C
4889 @cindex container
4890 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
4891 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
4892 Additionally, unless overridden with @code{--user}, a dummy home
4893 directory is created that matches the current user's home directory, and
4894 @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
4895
4896 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container. Inside
4897 the container, it has the same UID and GID as the current user, unless
4898 @option{--user} is passed (see below.)
4899
4900 @item --network
4901 @itemx -N
4902 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
4903 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
4904 device.
4905
4906 @item --link-profile
4907 @itemx -P
4908 For containers, link the environment profile to
4909 @file{~/.guix-profile} within the container. This is equivalent to
4910 running the command @command{ln -s $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT ~/.guix-profile}
4911 within the container. Linking will fail and abort the environment if
4912 the directory already exists, which will certainly be the case if
4913 @command{guix environment} was invoked in the user's home directory.
4914
4915 Certain packages are configured to look in
4916 @code{~/.guix-profile} for configuration files and data;@footnote{For
4917 example, the @code{fontconfig} package inspects
4918 @file{~/.guix-profile/share/fonts} for additional fonts.}
4919 @code{--link-profile} allows these programs to behave as expected within
4920 the environment.
4921
4922 @item --user=@var{user}
4923 @itemx -u @var{user}
4924 For containers, use the username @var{user} in place of the current
4925 user. The generated @file{/etc/passwd} entry within the container will
4926 contain the name @var{user}, the home directory will be
4927 @file{/home/@var{user}}, and no user GECOS data will be copied. Furthermore,
4928 the UID and GID inside the container are 1000. @var{user}
4929 need not exist on the system.
4930
4931 Additionally, any shared or exposed path (see @code{--share} and
4932 @code{--expose} respectively) whose target is within the current user's
4933 home directory will be remapped relative to @file{/home/USER}; this
4934 includes the automatic mapping of the current working directory.
4935
4936 @example
4937 # will expose paths as /home/foo/wd, /home/foo/test, and /home/foo/target
4938 cd $HOME/wd
4939 guix environment --container --user=foo \
4940 --expose=$HOME/test \
4941 --expose=/tmp/target=$HOME/target
4942 @end example
4943
4944 While this will limit the leaking of user identity through home paths
4945 and each of the user fields, this is only one useful component of a
4946 broader privacy/anonymity solution---not one in and of itself.
4947
4948 @item --no-cwd
4949 For containers, the default behavior is to share the current working
4950 directory with the isolated container and immediately change to that
4951 directory within the container. If this is undesirable, @code{--no-cwd}
4952 will cause the current working directory to @emph{not} be automatically
4953 shared and will change to the user's home directory within the container
4954 instead. See also @code{--user}.
4955
4956 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
4957 For containers, expose the file system @var{source} from the host system
4958 as the read-only file system @var{target} within the container. If
4959 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
4960 point in the container.
4961
4962 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
4963 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
4964 directory:
4965
4966 @example
4967 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
4968 @end example
4969
4970 @item --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
4971 For containers, share the file system @var{source} from the host system
4972 as the writable file system @var{target} within the container. If
4973 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
4974 point in the container.
4975
4976 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
4977 home directory is accessible for both reading and writing via the
4978 @file{/exchange} directory:
4979
4980 @example
4981 guix environment --container --share=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
4982 @end example
4983 @end table
4984
4985 @command{guix environment}
4986 also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
4987 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}) as well as package
4988 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
4989
4990 @node Invoking guix pack
4991 @section Invoking @command{guix pack}
4992
4993 Occasionally you want to pass software to people who are not (yet!)
4994 lucky enough to be using Guix. You'd tell them to run @command{guix
4995 package -i @var{something}}, but that's not possible in this case. This
4996 is where @command{guix pack} comes in.
4997
4998 @quotation Note
4999 If you are looking for ways to exchange binaries among machines that
5000 already run Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix copy}, @ref{Invoking guix
5001 publish}, and @ref{Invoking guix archive}.
5002 @end quotation
5003
5004 @cindex pack
5005 @cindex bundle
5006 @cindex application bundle
5007 @cindex software bundle
5008 The @command{guix pack} command creates a shrink-wrapped @dfn{pack} or
5009 @dfn{software bundle}: it creates a tarball or some other archive
5010 containing the binaries of the software you're interested in, and all
5011 its dependencies. The resulting archive can be used on any machine that
5012 does not have Guix, and people can run the exact same binaries as those
5013 you have with Guix. The pack itself is created in a bit-reproducible
5014 fashion, so anyone can verify that it really contains the build results
5015 that you pretend to be shipping.
5016
5017 For example, to create a bundle containing Guile, Emacs, Geiser, and all
5018 their dependencies, you can run:
5019
5020 @example
5021 $ guix pack guile emacs geiser
5022 @dots{}
5023 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pack.tar.gz
5024 @end example
5025
5026 The result here is a tarball containing a @file{/gnu/store} directory
5027 with all the relevant packages. The resulting tarball contains a
5028 @dfn{profile} with the three packages of interest; the profile is the
5029 same as would be created by @command{guix package -i}. It is this
5030 mechanism that is used to create Guix's own standalone binary tarball
5031 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
5032
5033 Users of this pack would have to run
5034 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/guile} to run Guile, which you may
5035 find inconvenient. To work around it, you can create, say, a
5036 @file{/opt/gnu/bin} symlink to the profile:
5037
5038 @example
5039 guix pack -S /opt/gnu/bin=bin guile emacs geiser
5040 @end example
5041
5042 @noindent
5043 That way, users can happily type @file{/opt/gnu/bin/guile} and enjoy.
5044
5045 @cindex relocatable binaries, with @command{guix pack}
5046 What if the recipient of your pack does not have root privileges on
5047 their machine, and thus cannot unpack it in the root file system? In
5048 that case, you will want to use the @code{--relocatable} option (see
5049 below). This option produces @dfn{relocatable binaries}, meaning they
5050 they can be placed anywhere in the file system hierarchy: in the example
5051 above, users can unpack your tarball in their home directory and
5052 directly run @file{./opt/gnu/bin/guile}.
5053
5054 @cindex Docker, build an image with guix pack
5055 Alternatively, you can produce a pack in the Docker image format using
5056 the following command:
5057
5058 @example
5059 guix pack -f docker guile emacs geiser
5060 @end example
5061
5062 @noindent
5063 The result is a tarball that can be passed to the @command{docker load}
5064 command. See the
5065 @uref{https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/load/, Docker
5066 documentation} for more information.
5067
5068 @cindex Singularity, build an image with guix pack
5069 @cindex SquashFS, build an image with guix pack
5070 Yet another option is to produce a SquashFS image with the following
5071 command:
5072
5073 @example
5074 guix pack -f squashfs bash guile emacs geiser
5075 @end example
5076
5077 @noindent
5078 The result is a SquashFS file system image that can either be mounted or
5079 directly be used as a file system container image with the
5080 @uref{https://singularity.lbl.gov, Singularity container execution
5081 environment}, using commands like @command{singularity shell} or
5082 @command{singularity exec}.
5083
5084 Several command-line options allow you to customize your pack:
5085
5086 @table @code
5087 @item --format=@var{format}
5088 @itemx -f @var{format}
5089 Produce a pack in the given @var{format}.
5090
5091 The available formats are:
5092
5093 @table @code
5094 @item tarball
5095 This is the default format. It produces a tarball containing all the
5096 specified binaries and symlinks.
5097
5098 @item docker
5099 This produces a tarball that follows the
5100 @uref{https://github.com/docker/docker/blob/master/image/spec/v1.2.md,
5101 Docker Image Specification}. The ``repository name'' as it appears in
5102 the output of the @command{docker images} command is computed from
5103 package names passed on the command line or in the manifest file.
5104
5105 @item squashfs
5106 This produces a SquashFS image containing all the specified binaries and
5107 symlinks, as well as empty mount points for virtual file systems like
5108 procfs.
5109
5110 @quotation Note
5111 Singularity @emph{requires} you to provide @file{/bin/sh} in the image.
5112 For that reason, @command{guix pack -f squashfs} always implies @code{-S
5113 /bin=bin}. Thus, your @command{guix pack} invocation must always start
5114 with something like:
5115
5116 @example
5117 guix pack -f squashfs bash @dots{}
5118 @end example
5119
5120 If you forget the @code{bash} (or similar) package, @command{singularity
5121 run} and @command{singularity exec} will fail with an unhelpful ``no
5122 such file or directory'' message.
5123 @end quotation
5124 @end table
5125
5126 @cindex relocatable binaries
5127 @item --relocatable
5128 @itemx -R
5129 Produce @dfn{relocatable binaries}---i.e., binaries that can be placed
5130 anywhere in the file system hierarchy and run from there.
5131
5132 When this option is passed once, the resulting binaries require support for
5133 @dfn{user namespaces} in the kernel Linux; when passed
5134 @emph{twice}@footnote{Here's a trick to memorize it: @code{-RR}, which adds
5135 PRoot support, can be thought of as the abbreviation of ``Really
5136 Relocatable''. Neat, isn't it?}, relocatable binaries fall to back to PRoot
5137 if user namespaces are unavailable, and essentially work anywhere---see below
5138 for the implications.
5139
5140 For example, if you create a pack containing Bash with:
5141
5142 @example
5143 guix pack -RR -S /mybin=bin bash
5144 @end example
5145
5146 @noindent
5147 ...@: you can copy that pack to a machine that lacks Guix, and from your
5148 home directory as a normal user, run:
5149
5150 @example
5151 tar xf pack.tar.gz
5152 ./mybin/sh
5153 @end example
5154
5155 @noindent
5156 In that shell, if you type @code{ls /gnu/store}, you'll notice that
5157 @file{/gnu/store} shows up and contains all the dependencies of
5158 @code{bash}, even though the machine actually lacks @file{/gnu/store}
5159 altogether! That is probably the simplest way to deploy Guix-built
5160 software on a non-Guix machine.
5161
5162 @quotation Note
5163 By default, relocatable binaries rely on the @dfn{user namespace} feature of
5164 the kernel Linux, which allows unprivileged users to mount or change root.
5165 Old versions of Linux did not support it, and some GNU/Linux distributions
5166 turn it off.
5167
5168 To produce relocatable binaries that work even in the absence of user
5169 namespaces, pass @option{--relocatable} or @option{-R} @emph{twice}. In that
5170 case, binaries will try user namespace support and fall back to PRoot if user
5171 namespaces are not supported.
5172
5173 The @uref{https://proot-me.github.io/, PRoot} program provides the necessary
5174 support for file system virtualization. It achieves that by using the
5175 @code{ptrace} system call on the running program. This approach has the
5176 advantage to work without requiring special kernel support, but it incurs
5177 run-time overhead every time a system call is made.
5178 @end quotation
5179
5180 @cindex entry point, for Docker images
5181 @item --entry-point=@var{command}
5182 Use @var{command} as the @dfn{entry point} of the resulting pack, if the pack
5183 format supports it---currently @code{docker} and @code{squashfs} (Singularity)
5184 support it. @var{command} must be relative to the profile contained in the
5185 pack.
5186
5187 The entry point specifies the command that tools like @code{docker run} or
5188 @code{singularity run} automatically start by default. For example, you can
5189 do:
5190
5191 @example
5192 guix pack -f docker --entry-point=bin/guile guile
5193 @end example
5194
5195 The resulting pack can easily be loaded and @code{docker run} with no extra
5196 arguments will spawn @code{bin/guile}:
5197
5198 @example
5199 docker load -i pack.tar.gz
5200 docker run @var{image-id}
5201 @end example
5202
5203 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5204 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5205 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
5206
5207 This has the same purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
5208 build} (@pxref{Additional Build Options, @code{--expression} in
5209 @command{guix build}}).
5210
5211 @item --manifest=@var{file}
5212 @itemx -m @var{file}
5213 Use the packages contained in the manifest object returned by the Scheme
5214 code in @var{file}. This option can be repeated several times, in which
5215 case the manifests are concatenated.
5216
5217 This has a similar purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
5218 package} (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the
5219 same manifest files. It allows you to define a collection of packages
5220 once and use it both for creating profiles and for creating archives
5221 for use on machines that do not have Guix installed. Note that you can
5222 specify @emph{either} a manifest file @emph{or} a list of packages,
5223 but not both.
5224
5225 @item --system=@var{system}
5226 @itemx -s @var{system}
5227 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
5228 the system type of the build host.
5229
5230 @item --target=@var{triplet}
5231 @cindex cross-compilation
5232 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
5233 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying target triplets, GNU
5234 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
5235
5236 @item --compression=@var{tool}
5237 @itemx -C @var{tool}
5238 Compress the resulting tarball using @var{tool}---one of @code{gzip},
5239 @code{bzip2}, @code{xz}, @code{lzip}, or @code{none} for no compression.
5240
5241 @item --symlink=@var{spec}
5242 @itemx -S @var{spec}
5243 Add the symlinks specified by @var{spec} to the pack. This option can
5244 appear several times.
5245
5246 @var{spec} has the form @code{@var{source}=@var{target}}, where
5247 @var{source} is the symlink that will be created and @var{target} is the
5248 symlink target.
5249
5250 For instance, @code{-S /opt/gnu/bin=bin} creates a @file{/opt/gnu/bin}
5251 symlink pointing to the @file{bin} sub-directory of the profile.
5252
5253 @item --save-provenance
5254 Save provenance information for the packages passed on the command line.
5255 Provenance information includes the URL and commit of the channels in use
5256 (@pxref{Channels}).
5257
5258 Provenance information is saved in the
5259 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/manifest} file in the pack, along with the
5260 usual package metadata---the name and version of each package, their
5261 propagated inputs, and so on. It is useful information to the recipient of
5262 the pack, who then knows how the pack was (supposedly) obtained.
5263
5264 This option is not enabled by default because, like timestamps, provenance
5265 information contributes nothing to the build process. In other words, there
5266 is an infinity of channel URLs and commit IDs that can lead to the same pack.
5267 Recording such ``silent'' metadata in the output thus potentially breaks the
5268 source-to-binary bitwise reproducibility property.
5269
5270 @item --root=@var{file}
5271 @itemx -r @var{file}
5272 @cindex garbage collector root, for packs
5273 Make @var{file} a symlink to the resulting pack, and register it as a garbage
5274 collector root.
5275
5276 @item --localstatedir
5277 @itemx --profile-name=@var{name}
5278 Include the ``local state directory'', @file{/var/guix}, in the resulting
5279 pack, and notably the @file{/var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/@var{name}}
5280 profile---by default @var{name} is @code{guix-profile}, which corresponds to
5281 @file{~root/.guix-profile}.
5282
5283 @file{/var/guix} contains the store database (@pxref{The Store}) as well
5284 as garbage-collector roots (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Providing it in
5285 the pack means that the store is ``complete'' and manageable by Guix;
5286 not providing it pack means that the store is ``dead'': items cannot be
5287 added to it or removed from it after extraction of the pack.
5288
5289 One use case for this is the Guix self-contained binary tarball
5290 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
5291
5292 @item --derivation
5293 @itemx -d
5294 Print the name of the derivation that builds the pack.
5295
5296 @item --bootstrap
5297 Use the bootstrap binaries to build the pack. This option is only
5298 useful to Guix developers.
5299 @end table
5300
5301 In addition, @command{guix pack} supports all the common build options
5302 (@pxref{Common Build Options}) and all the package transformation
5303 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
5304
5305
5306 @c *********************************************************************
5307 @node Programming Interface
5308 @chapter Programming Interface
5309
5310 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
5311 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
5312 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
5313 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
5314 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
5315 turned into concrete build actions.
5316
5317 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
5318 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
5319 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
5320 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under a specific
5321 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
5322
5323 @cindex derivation
5324 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
5325 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
5326 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
5327 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
5328 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
5329 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
5330 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
5331
5332 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
5333 package definitions.
5334
5335 @menu
5336 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
5337 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
5338 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
5339 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
5340 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
5341 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
5342 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
5343 * Invoking guix repl:: Fiddling with Guix interactively.
5344 @end menu
5345
5346 @node Package Modules
5347 @section Package Modules
5348
5349 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
5350 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
5351 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
5352 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
5353 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
5354 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
5355 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
5356 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
5357 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
5358 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
5359 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5360
5361 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
5362 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
5363 instance, when running @code{guix install emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
5364 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
5365 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
5366 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
5367
5368 @cindex customization, of packages
5369 @cindex package module search path
5370 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
5371 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
5372 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
5373 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
5374 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
5375 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
5376 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. There are two ways to make
5377 these package definitions visible to the user interfaces:
5378
5379 @enumerate
5380 @item
5381 By adding the directory containing your package modules to the search path
5382 with the @code{-L} flag of @command{guix package} and other commands
5383 (@pxref{Common Build Options}), or by setting the @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
5384 environment variable described below.
5385
5386 @item
5387 By defining a @dfn{channel} and configuring @command{guix pull} so that it
5388 pulls from it. A channel is essentially a Git repository containing package
5389 modules. @xref{Channels}, for more information on how to define and use
5390 channels.
5391 @end enumerate
5392
5393 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} works similarly to other search path variables:
5394
5395 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
5396 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
5397 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
5398 over the own modules of the distribution.
5399 @end defvr
5400
5401 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
5402 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
5403 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
5404 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
5405 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
5406 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
5407
5408 @node Defining Packages
5409 @section Defining Packages
5410
5411 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
5412 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
5413 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
5414 package looks like this:
5415
5416 @lisp
5417 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
5418 #:use-module (guix packages)
5419 #:use-module (guix download)
5420 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
5421 #:use-module (guix licenses)
5422 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
5423
5424 (define-public hello
5425 (package
5426 (name "hello")
5427 (version "2.10")
5428 (source (origin
5429 (method url-fetch)
5430 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
5431 ".tar.gz"))
5432 (sha256
5433 (base32
5434 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
5435 (build-system gnu-build-system)
5436 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
5437 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
5438 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
5439 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
5440 (home-page "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
5441 (license gpl3+)))
5442 @end lisp
5443
5444 @noindent
5445 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
5446 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
5447 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
5448 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
5449 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
5450 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
5451 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
5452
5453 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
5454 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
5455 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
5456
5457 In the example above, @var{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
5458 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
5459 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
5460 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
5461 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
5462
5463 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
5464
5465 @itemize
5466 @item
5467 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
5468 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
5469 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
5470 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
5471
5472 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
5473 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
5474
5475 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
5476 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
5477 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
5478 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
5479 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
5480 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
5481
5482 @cindex patches
5483 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
5484 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
5485 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
5486
5487 @item
5488 @cindex GNU Build System
5489 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
5490 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
5491 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
5492 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
5493 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
5494
5495 @item
5496 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
5497 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
5498 @var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
5499 @code{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
5500
5501 @cindex quote
5502 @cindex quoting
5503 @findex '
5504 @findex quote
5505 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
5506 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
5507 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
5508 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
5509 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
5510 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
5511 Manual}).
5512
5513 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
5514 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
5515 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
5516 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
5517 Reference Manual}).
5518
5519 @item
5520 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
5521 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
5522 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
5523 variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
5524
5525 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
5526 @findex `
5527 @findex quasiquote
5528 @cindex comma (unquote)
5529 @findex ,
5530 @findex unquote
5531 @findex ,@@
5532 @findex unquote-splicing
5533 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
5534 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
5535 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
5536 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
5537 Reference Manual}).
5538
5539 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
5540 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
5541 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
5542
5543 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
5544 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
5545 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
5546 @end itemize
5547
5548 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
5549
5550 Once a package definition is in place, the
5551 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
5552 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}), troubleshooting any build failures
5553 you encounter (@pxref{Debugging Build Failures}). You can easily jump back to the
5554 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
5555 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
5556 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
5557 more information on how to test package definitions, and
5558 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
5559 for style conformance.
5560 @vindex GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
5561 Lastly, @pxref{Channels}, for information
5562 on how to extend the distribution by adding your own package definitions
5563 in a ``channel''.
5564
5565 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
5566 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
5567 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
5568
5569 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
5570 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
5571 That derivation is stored in a @code{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
5572 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
5573 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
5574
5575 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
5576 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
5577 (@pxref{Derivations}).
5578
5579 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
5580 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
5581 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
5582 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
5583 (@pxref{The Store}).
5584 @end deffn
5585
5586 @noindent
5587 @cindex cross-compilation
5588 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
5589 package for some other system:
5590
5591 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
5592 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
5593 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
5594 @var{system} to @var{target}.
5595
5596 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
5597 and operating system, such as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"}
5598 (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets,,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
5599 @end deffn
5600
5601 @cindex package transformations
5602 @cindex input rewriting
5603 @cindex dependency tree rewriting
5604 Packages can be manipulated in arbitrary ways. An example of a useful
5605 transformation is @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency tree of
5606 a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others:
5607
5608 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
5609 [@var{rewrite-name}]
5610 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
5611 indirect dependencies (but not its implicit inputs) according to
5612 @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of package pairs; the
5613 first element of each pair is the package to replace, and the second one
5614 is the replacement.
5615
5616 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
5617 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
5618 @end deffn
5619
5620 @noindent
5621 Consider this example:
5622
5623 @lisp
5624 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
5625 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
5626 ;; recursively.
5627 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
5628
5629 (define git-with-libressl
5630 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
5631 @end lisp
5632
5633 @noindent
5634 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
5635 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
5636 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
5637 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
5638 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
5639
5640 The following variant of @code{package-input-rewriting} can match packages to
5641 be replaced by name rather than by identity.
5642
5643 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting/spec @var{replacements}
5644 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies the given @var{replacements} to
5645 all the package graph (excluding implicit inputs). @var{replacements} is a list of
5646 spec/procedures pair; each spec is a package specification such as @code{"gcc"} or
5647 @code{"guile@@2"}, and each procedure takes a matching package and returns a
5648 replacement for that package.
5649 @end deffn
5650
5651 The example above could be rewritten this way:
5652
5653 @lisp
5654 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
5655 ;; Replace all the packages called "openssl" with LibreSSL.
5656 (package-input-rewriting/spec `(("openssl" . ,(const libressl)))))
5657 @end lisp
5658
5659 The key difference here is that, this time, packages are matched by spec and
5660 not by identity. In other words, any package in the graph that is called
5661 @code{openssl} will be replaced.
5662
5663 A more generic procedure to rewrite a package dependency graph is
5664 @code{package-mapping}: it supports arbitrary changes to nodes in the
5665 graph.
5666
5667 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-mapping @var{proc} [@var{cut?}]
5668 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies @var{proc} to all the packages
5669 depended on and returns the resulting package. The procedure stops recursion
5670 when @var{cut?} returns true for a given package.
5671 @end deffn
5672
5673 @menu
5674 * package Reference:: The package data type.
5675 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
5676 @end menu
5677
5678
5679 @node package Reference
5680 @subsection @code{package} Reference
5681
5682 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
5683 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5684
5685 @deftp {Data Type} package
5686 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
5687
5688 @table @asis
5689 @item @code{name}
5690 The name of the package, as a string.
5691
5692 @item @code{version}
5693 The version of the package, as a string.
5694
5695 @item @code{source}
5696 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
5697 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
5698 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
5699 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
5700 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
5701 @code{local-file}}).
5702
5703 @item @code{build-system}
5704 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
5705 Systems}).
5706
5707 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
5708 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
5709 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
5710
5711 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5712 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5713 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5714 @cindex inputs, of packages
5715 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
5716 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
5717 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
5718 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
5719 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
5720 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
5721 inputs:
5722
5723 @lisp
5724 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
5725 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
5726 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
5727 @end lisp
5728
5729 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
5730 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
5731 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
5732 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
5733 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
5734 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
5735
5736 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
5737 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
5738 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
5739 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
5740
5741 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
5742 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
5743 specified packages will be automatically installed alongside the package
5744 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
5745 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
5746 propagated inputs.)
5747
5748 For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
5749 another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
5750 one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
5751
5752 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
5753 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
5754 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
5755 more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
5756 library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
5757 listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
5758
5759 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
5760 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
5761 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
5762
5763 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
5764 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
5765 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
5766 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
5767
5768 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
5769 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
5770 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
5771 for details.
5772
5773 @item @code{synopsis}
5774 A one-line description of the package.
5775
5776 @item @code{description}
5777 A more elaborate description of the package.
5778
5779 @item @code{license}
5780 @cindex license, of packages
5781 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
5782 or a list of such values.
5783
5784 @item @code{home-page}
5785 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
5786
5787 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @var{%supported-systems})
5788 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
5789 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
5790
5791 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
5792 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
5793 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
5794 automatically corrected.
5795 @end table
5796 @end deftp
5797
5798 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-package
5799 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of a package field definition, this
5800 identifier resolves to the package being defined.
5801
5802 The example below shows how to add a package as a native input of itself when
5803 cross-compiling:
5804
5805 @lisp
5806 (package
5807 (name "guile")
5808 ;; ...
5809
5810 ;; When cross-compiled, Guile, for example, depends on
5811 ;; a native version of itself. Add it here.
5812 (native-inputs (if (%current-target-system)
5813 `(("self" ,this-package))
5814 '())))
5815 @end lisp
5816
5817 It is an error to refer to @code{this-package} outside a package definition.
5818 @end deffn
5819
5820 @node origin Reference
5821 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
5822
5823 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
5824 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5825
5826 @deftp {Data Type} origin
5827 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
5828
5829 @table @asis
5830 @item @code{uri}
5831 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
5832 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
5833 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
5834 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
5835
5836 @item @code{method}
5837 A procedure that handles the URI.
5838
5839 Examples include:
5840
5841 @table @asis
5842 @item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
5843 download a file from the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
5844 @code{uri} field;
5845
5846 @vindex git-fetch
5847 @item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
5848 clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
5849 specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
5850 @code{git-reference} looks like this:
5851
5852 @lisp
5853 (git-reference
5854 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
5855 (commit "v2.10"))
5856 @end lisp
5857 @end table
5858
5859 @item @code{sha256}
5860 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. Typically the
5861 @code{base32} form is used here to generate the bytevector from a
5862 base-32 string.
5863
5864 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
5865 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
5866 guix hash}).
5867
5868 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
5869 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
5870 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
5871 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
5872 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
5873 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
5874
5875 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
5876 A list of file names, origins, or file-like objects (@pxref{G-Expressions,
5877 file-like objects}) pointing to patches to be applied to the source.
5878
5879 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
5880 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
5881 @code{%current-target-system}.
5882
5883 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
5884 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
5885 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
5886 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
5887
5888 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
5889 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
5890 command.
5891
5892 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
5893 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
5894 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
5895 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
5896
5897 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
5898 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
5899 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
5900
5901 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
5902 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
5903 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
5904 @end table
5905 @end deftp
5906
5907
5908 @node Build Systems
5909 @section Build Systems
5910
5911 @cindex build system
5912 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
5913 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
5914 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
5915 dependencies of that build procedure.
5916
5917 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
5918 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
5919 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
5920
5921 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
5922 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
5923 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
5924 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
5925 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
5926 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
5927 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
5928
5929 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
5930 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
5931 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
5932 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
5933 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
5934 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
5935 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
5936
5937 The main build system is @code{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
5938 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
5939 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
5940
5941 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
5942 @code{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
5943 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
5944 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
5945
5946 @cindex build phases
5947 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
5948 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
5949 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
5950 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
5951 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
5952 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
5953
5954 @table @code
5955 @item unpack
5956 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
5957 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
5958 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
5959
5960 @item patch-source-shebangs
5961 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
5962 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
5963 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
5964
5965 @item configure
5966 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
5967 as @code{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
5968 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
5969
5970 @item build
5971 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
5972 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
5973 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
5974
5975 @item check
5976 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
5977 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
5978 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
5979 check -j}.
5980
5981 @item install
5982 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
5983
5984 @item patch-shebangs
5985 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
5986
5987 @item strip
5988 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
5989 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
5990 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
5991 @end table
5992
5993 @vindex %standard-phases
5994 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
5995 @code{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
5996 @code{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
5997 procedure implements the actual phase.
5998
5999 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
6000 @code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
6001
6002 @example
6003 #:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases (delete 'configure))
6004 @end example
6005
6006 means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
6007 @code{configure} phase.
6008
6009 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
6010 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
6011 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
6012 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
6013 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
6014 have to mention them.
6015 @end defvr
6016
6017 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
6018 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
6019 of @code{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
6020 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
6021 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
6022
6023 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
6024 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
6025 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
6026 @url{https://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
6027
6028 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
6029 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
6030 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
6031 parameters, respectively.
6032
6033 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
6034 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
6035 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
6036 archive. In this case the parameter @code{#:source-dir} can be used to
6037 specify the source sub-directory, defaulting to ``src''.
6038
6039 The @code{#:main-class} parameter can be used with the minimal ant
6040 buildfile to specify the main class of the resulting jar. This makes the
6041 jar file executable. The @code{#:test-include} parameter can be used to
6042 specify the list of junit tests to run. It defaults to
6043 @code{(list "**/*Test.java")}. The @code{#:test-exclude} can be used to
6044 disable some tests. It defaults to @code{(list "**/Abstract*.java")},
6045 because abstract classes cannot be run as tests.
6046
6047 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
6048 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
6049 ``jar'' task will be run.
6050
6051 @end defvr
6052
6053 @defvr {Scheme Variable} android-ndk-build-system
6054 @cindex Android distribution
6055 @cindex Android NDK build system
6056 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system android-ndk)}. It
6057 implements a build procedure for Android NDK (native development kit)
6058 packages using a Guix-specific build process.
6059
6060 The build system assumes that packages install their public interface
6061 (header) files to the subdirectory "include" of the "out" output and
6062 their libraries to the subdirectory "lib" of the "out" output.
6063
6064 It's also assumed that the union of all the dependencies of a package
6065 has no conflicting files.
6066
6067 For the time being, cross-compilation is not supported - so right now
6068 the libraries and header files are assumed to be host tools.
6069
6070 @end defvr
6071
6072 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
6073 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
6074 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
6075
6076 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
6077 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
6078 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
6079 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
6080
6081 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
6082 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
6083 ASDF. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
6084 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
6085 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
6086 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
6087
6088 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
6089 package name should be prefixed with the lisp implementation, such as
6090 @code{sbcl-} for @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}.
6091
6092 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
6093 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
6094 the @code{cl-} prefix.
6095
6096 For binary packages, each system should be defined as a Guix package.
6097 If one package @code{origin} contains several systems, package variants
6098 can be created in order to build all the systems. Source packages,
6099 which use @code{asdf-build-system/source}, may contain several systems.
6100
6101 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
6102 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
6103 They should be called in a build phase after the @code{create-symlinks}
6104 phase, so that the system which was just built can be used within the
6105 resulting image. @code{build-program} requires a list of Common Lisp
6106 expressions to be passed as the @code{#:entry-program} argument.
6107
6108 If the system is not defined within its own @code{.asd} file of the same
6109 name, then the @code{#:asd-file} parameter should be used to specify
6110 which file the system is defined in. Furthermore, if the package
6111 defines a system for its tests in a separate file, it will be loaded
6112 before the tests are run if it is specified by the
6113 @code{#:test-asd-file} parameter. If it is not set, the files
6114 @code{<system>-tests.asd}, @code{<system>-test.asd}, @code{tests.asd},
6115 and @code{test.asd} will be tried if they exist.
6116
6117 If for some reason the package must be named in a different way than the
6118 naming conventions suggest, the @code{#:asd-system-name} parameter can
6119 be used to specify the name of the system.
6120
6121 @end defvr
6122
6123 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cargo-build-system
6124 @cindex Rust programming language
6125 @cindex Cargo (Rust build system)
6126 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cargo)}. It
6127 supports builds of packages using Cargo, the build tool of the
6128 @uref{https://www.rust-lang.org, Rust programming language}.
6129
6130 It adds @code{rustc} and @code{cargo} to the set of inputs.
6131 A different Rust package can be specified with the @code{#:rust} parameter.
6132
6133 Regular cargo dependencies should be added to the package definition via the
6134 @code{#:cargo-inputs} parameter as a list of name and spec pairs, where the
6135 spec can be a package or a source definition. Note that the spec must
6136 evaluate to a path to a gzipped tarball which includes a @code{Cargo.toml}
6137 file at its root, or it will be ignored. Similarly, cargo dev-dependencies
6138 should be added to the package definition via the
6139 @code{#:cargo-development-inputs} parameter.
6140
6141 In its @code{configure} phase, this build system will make any source inputs
6142 specified in the @code{#:cargo-inputs} and @code{#:cargo-development-inputs}
6143 parameters available to cargo. It will also remove an included
6144 @code{Cargo.lock} file to be recreated by @code{cargo} during the
6145 @code{build} phase. The @code{install} phase installs any crate the binaries
6146 if they are defined by the crate.
6147 @end defvr
6148
6149 @cindex Clojure (programming language)
6150 @cindex simple Clojure build system
6151 @defvr {Scheme Variable} clojure-build-system
6152 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system clojure)}. It implements
6153 a simple build procedure for @uref{https://clojure.org/, Clojure} packages
6154 using plain old @code{compile} in Clojure. Cross-compilation is not supported
6155 yet.
6156
6157 It adds @code{clojure}, @code{icedtea} and @code{zip} to the set of inputs.
6158 Different packages can be specified with the @code{#:clojure}, @code{#:jdk} and
6159 @code{#:zip} parameters, respectively.
6160
6161 A list of source directories, test directories and jar names can be specified
6162 with the @code{#:source-dirs}, @code{#:test-dirs} and @code{#:jar-names}
6163 parameters, respectively. Compile directory and main class can be specified
6164 with the @code{#:compile-dir} and @code{#:main-class} parameters, respectively.
6165 Other parameters are documented below.
6166
6167 This build system is an extension of @code{ant-build-system}, but with the
6168 following phases changed:
6169
6170 @table @code
6171
6172 @item build
6173 This phase calls @code{compile} in Clojure to compile source files and runs
6174 @command{jar} to create jars from both source files and compiled files
6175 according to the include list and exclude list specified in
6176 @code{#:aot-include} and @code{#:aot-exclude}, respectively. The exclude list
6177 has priority over the include list. These lists consist of symbols
6178 representing Clojure libraries or the special keyword @code{#:all} representing
6179 all Clojure libraries found under the source directories. The parameter
6180 @code{#:omit-source?} decides if source should be included into the jars.
6181
6182 @item check
6183 This phase runs tests according to the include list and exclude list specified
6184 in @code{#:test-include} and @code{#:test-exclude}, respectively. Their
6185 meanings are analogous to that of @code{#:aot-include} and
6186 @code{#:aot-exclude}, except that the special keyword @code{#:all} now
6187 stands for all Clojure libraries found under the test directories. The
6188 parameter @code{#:tests?} decides if tests should be run.
6189
6190 @item install
6191 This phase installs all jars built previously.
6192 @end table
6193
6194 Apart from the above, this build system also contains an additional phase:
6195
6196 @table @code
6197
6198 @item install-doc
6199 This phase installs all top-level files with base name matching
6200 @code{%doc-regex}. A different regex can be specified with the
6201 @code{#:doc-regex} parameter. All files (recursively) inside the documentation
6202 directories specified in @code{#:doc-dirs} are installed as well.
6203 @end table
6204 @end defvr
6205
6206 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
6207 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
6208 implements the build procedure for packages using the
6209 @url{https://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
6210
6211 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
6212 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
6213 parameter.
6214
6215 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
6216 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
6217 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
6218 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
6219 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
6220 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
6221 @end defvr
6222
6223 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dune-build-system
6224 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dune)}. It
6225 supports builds of packages using @uref{https://dune.build/, Dune}, a build
6226 tool for the OCaml programming language. It is implemented as an extension
6227 of the @code{ocaml-build-system} which is described below. As such, the
6228 @code{#:ocaml} and @code{#:findlib} parameters can be passed to this build
6229 system.
6230
6231 It automatically adds the @code{dune} package to the set of inputs.
6232 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:dune}
6233 parameter.
6234
6235 There is no @code{configure} phase because dune packages typically don't
6236 need to be configured. The @code{#:build-flags} parameter is taken as a
6237 list of flags passed to the @code{dune} command during the build.
6238
6239 The @code{#:jbuild?} parameter can be passed to use the @code{jbuild}
6240 command instead of the more recent @code{dune} command while building
6241 a package. Its default value is @code{#f}.
6242
6243 The @code{#:package} parameter can be passed to specify a package name, which
6244 is useful when a package contains multiple packages and you want to build
6245 only one of them. This is equivalent to passing the @code{-p} argument to
6246 @code{dune}.
6247 @end defvr
6248
6249 @defvr {Scheme Variable} go-build-system
6250 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system go)}. It
6251 implements a build procedure for Go packages using the standard
6252 @url{https://golang.org/cmd/go/#hdr-Compile_packages_and_dependencies,
6253 Go build mechanisms}.
6254
6255 The user is expected to provide a value for the key @code{#:import-path}
6256 and, in some cases, @code{#:unpack-path}. The
6257 @url{https://golang.org/doc/code.html#ImportPaths, import path}
6258 corresponds to the file system path expected by the package's build
6259 scripts and any referring packages, and provides a unique way to
6260 refer to a Go package. It is typically based on a combination of the
6261 package source code's remote URI and file system hierarchy structure. In
6262 some cases, you will need to unpack the package's source code to a
6263 different directory structure than the one indicated by the import path,
6264 and @code{#:unpack-path} should be used in such cases.
6265
6266 Packages that provide Go libraries should install their source code into
6267 the built output. The key @code{#:install-source?}, which defaults to
6268 @code{#t}, controls whether or not the source code is installed. It can
6269 be set to @code{#f} for packages that only provide executable files.
6270 @end defvr
6271
6272 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
6273 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
6274 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
6275
6276 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
6277 @code{gnu-build-system}:
6278
6279 @table @code
6280 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
6281 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
6282 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
6283 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
6284 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
6285 that appropriately set the @code{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @code{GTK_PATH}
6286 environment variables.
6287
6288 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
6289 process by listing their names in the
6290 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
6291 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
6292 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
6293 GLib and GTK+.
6294
6295 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
6296 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
6297 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
6298 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
6299 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
6300 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
6301 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
6302 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
6303 @end table
6304
6305 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
6306 @end defvr
6307
6308 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guile-build-system
6309 This build system is for Guile packages that consist exclusively of Scheme
6310 code and that are so lean that they don't even have a makefile, let alone a
6311 @file{configure} script. It compiles Scheme code using @command{guild
6312 compile} (@pxref{Compilation,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) and
6313 installs the @file{.scm} and @file{.go} files in the right place. It also
6314 installs documentation.
6315
6316 This build system supports cross-compilation by using the @code{--target}
6317 option of @command{guild compile}.
6318
6319 Packages built with @code{guile-build-system} must provide a Guile package in
6320 their @code{native-inputs} field.
6321 @end defvr
6322
6323 @defvr {Scheme Variable} julia-build-system
6324 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system julia)}. It implements
6325 the build procedure used by @uref{https://julialang.org/, julia} packages,
6326 which essentially is similar to running @command{julia -e 'using Pkg;
6327 Pkg.add(package)'} in an environment where @code{JULIA_LOAD_PATH} contains the
6328 paths to all Julia package inputs. Tests are run not run.
6329
6330 Julia packages require the source @code{file-name} to be the real name of the
6331 package, correctly capitalized.
6332
6333 For packages requiring shared library dependencies, you may need to write the
6334 @file{/deps/deps.jl} file manually. It's usually a line of @code{const
6335 variable = /gnu/store/library.so} for each dependency, plus a void function
6336 @code{check_deps() = nothing}.
6337
6338 Some older packages that aren't using @file{Package.toml} yet, will require
6339 this file to be created, too. The function @code{julia-create-package-toml}
6340 helps creating the file. You need to pass the outputs and the source of the
6341 package, it's name (the same as the @code{file-name} parameter), the package
6342 uuid, the package version, and a list of dependencies specified by their name
6343 and their uuid.
6344 @end defvr
6345
6346 @defvr {Scheme Variable} minify-build-system
6347 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system minify)}. It
6348 implements a minification procedure for simple JavaScript packages.
6349
6350 It adds @code{uglify-js} to the set of inputs and uses it to compress
6351 all JavaScript files in the @file{src} directory. A different minifier
6352 package can be specified with the @code{#:uglify-js} parameter, but it
6353 is expected that the package writes the minified code to the standard
6354 output.
6355
6356 When the input JavaScript files are not all located in the @file{src}
6357 directory, the parameter @code{#:javascript-files} can be used to
6358 specify a list of file names to feed to the minifier.
6359 @end defvr
6360
6361 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ocaml-build-system
6362 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ocaml)}. It implements
6363 a build procedure for @uref{https://ocaml.org, OCaml} packages, which consists
6364 of choosing the correct set of commands to run for each package. OCaml
6365 packages can expect many different commands to be run. This build system will
6366 try some of them.
6367
6368 When the package has a @file{setup.ml} file present at the top-level, it will
6369 run @code{ocaml setup.ml -configure}, @code{ocaml setup.ml -build} and
6370 @code{ocaml setup.ml -install}. The build system will assume that this file
6371 was generated by @uref{http://oasis.forge.ocamlcore.org/, OASIS} and will take
6372 care of setting the prefix and enabling tests if they are not disabled. You
6373 can pass configure and build flags with the @code{#:configure-flags} and
6374 @code{#:build-flags}. The @code{#:test-flags} key can be passed to change the
6375 set of flags used to enable tests. The @code{#:use-make?} key can be used to
6376 bypass this system in the build and install phases.
6377
6378 When the package has a @file{configure} file, it is assumed that it is a
6379 hand-made configure script that requires a different argument format than
6380 in the @code{gnu-build-system}. You can add more flags with the
6381 @code{#:configure-flags} key.
6382
6383 When the package has a @file{Makefile} file (or @code{#:use-make?} is
6384 @code{#t}), it will be used and more flags can be passed to the build and
6385 install phases with the @code{#:make-flags} key.
6386
6387 Finally, some packages do not have these files and use a somewhat standard
6388 location for its build system. In that case, the build system will run
6389 @code{ocaml pkg/pkg.ml} or @code{ocaml pkg/build.ml} and take care of
6390 providing the path to the required findlib module. Additional flags can
6391 be passed via the @code{#:build-flags} key. Install is taken care of by
6392 @command{opam-installer}. In this case, the @code{opam} package must
6393 be added to the @code{native-inputs} field of the package definition.
6394
6395 Note that most OCaml packages assume they will be installed in the same
6396 directory as OCaml, which is not what we want in guix. In particular, they
6397 will install @file{.so} files in their module's directory, which is usually
6398 fine because it is in the OCaml compiler directory. In guix though, these
6399 libraries cannot be found and we use @code{CAML_LD_LIBRARY_PATH}. This
6400 variable points to @file{lib/ocaml/site-lib/stubslibs} and this is where
6401 @file{.so} libraries should be installed.
6402 @end defvr
6403
6404 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
6405 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
6406 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
6407 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
6408 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
6409
6410 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
6411 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @code{PYTHONPATH}
6412 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
6413
6414 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
6415 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
6416 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
6417 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
6418 interpreter version.
6419
6420 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
6421 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
6422 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
6423 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools?} parameter to @code{#f}.
6424 @end defvr
6425
6426 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
6427 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
6428 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
6429 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
6430 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
6431 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
6432 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
6433 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
6434 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
6435 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
6436 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
6437 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
6438
6439 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
6440 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
6441 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
6442
6443 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
6444 @end defvr
6445
6446 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qt-build-system
6447 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system qt)}. It
6448 is intended for use with applications using Qt or KDE.
6449
6450 This build system adds the phase @code{qt-wrap} to the ones defined by
6451 @code{cmake-build-system}, after the @code{install} phase.
6452
6453 This phase searches for Qt5 plugin paths, QML paths and some XDG in the inputs
6454 and output. In case some path is found, all programs in the output's
6455 @file{bin/}, @file{sbin/}, @file{libexec/} and @file{lib/libexec/} directories
6456 are wrapped in scripts defining the necessary environment variables.
6457
6458 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping process
6459 by listing their names in the @code{#:qt-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter.
6460 This is useful when an output is known not to contain any Qt binaries, and
6461 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on Qt, KDE,
6462 or such.
6463 @end defvr
6464
6465 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
6466 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
6467 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://r-project.org, R}
6468 packages, which essentially is little more than running @code{R CMD
6469 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
6470 @code{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests
6471 are run after installation using the R function
6472 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
6473 @end defvr
6474
6475 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rakudo-build-system
6476 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system rakudo)}. It
6477 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://rakudo.org/,
6478 Rakudo} for @uref{https://perl6.org/, Perl6} packages. It installs the
6479 package to @code{/gnu/store/@dots{}/NAME-VERSION/share/perl6} and
6480 installs the binaries, library files and the resources, as well as wrap
6481 the files under the @code{bin/} directory. Tests can be skipped by
6482 passing @code{#f} to the @code{tests?} parameter.
6483
6484 Which rakudo package is used can be specified with @code{rakudo}.
6485 Which perl6-tap-harness package used for the tests can be specified with
6486 @code{#:prove6} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
6487 @code{with-prove6?} parameter.
6488 Which perl6-zef package used for tests and installing can be specified
6489 with @code{#:zef} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
6490 @code{with-zef?} parameter.
6491 @end defvr
6492
6493 @defvr {Scheme Variable} texlive-build-system
6494 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system texlive)}. It is
6495 used to build TeX packages in batch mode with a specified engine. The
6496 build system sets the @code{TEXINPUTS} variable to find all TeX source
6497 files in the inputs.
6498
6499 By default it runs @code{luatex} on all files ending on @code{ins}. A
6500 different engine and format can be specified with the
6501 @code{#:tex-format} argument. Different build targets can be specified
6502 with the @code{#:build-targets} argument, which expects a list of file
6503 names. The build system adds only @code{texlive-bin} and
6504 @code{texlive-latex-base} (both from @code{(gnu packages tex}) to the
6505 inputs. Both can be overridden with the arguments @code{#:texlive-bin}
6506 and @code{#:texlive-latex-base}, respectively.
6507
6508 The @code{#:tex-directory} parameter tells the build system where to
6509 install the built files under the texmf tree.
6510 @end defvr
6511
6512 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
6513 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
6514 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
6515 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
6516
6517 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
6518 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
6519 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
6520 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
6521 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
6522 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
6523 a traditional source release tarball.
6524
6525 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
6526 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
6527 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
6528 @end defvr
6529
6530 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
6531 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
6532 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
6533 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
6534 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
6535 script.
6536
6537 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
6538 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
6539 @code{#:python} parameter.
6540 @end defvr
6541
6542 @defvr {Scheme Variable} scons-build-system
6543 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system scons)}. It
6544 implements the build procedure used by the SCons software construction
6545 tool. This build system runs @code{scons} to build the package,
6546 @code{scons test} to run tests, and then @code{scons install} to install
6547 the package.
6548
6549 Additional flags to be passed to @code{scons} can be specified with the
6550 @code{#:scons-flags} parameter. The default build and install targets
6551 can be overridden with @code{#:build-targets} and
6552 @code{#:install-targets} respectively. The version of Python used to
6553 run SCons can be specified by selecting the appropriate SCons package
6554 with the @code{#:scons} parameter.
6555 @end defvr
6556
6557 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
6558 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
6559 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
6560 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
6561 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
6562 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
6563 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
6564 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
6565 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
6566 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
6567 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
6568 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
6569 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
6570 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
6571
6572 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
6573 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
6574 @end defvr
6575
6576 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dub-build-system
6577 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dub)}. It
6578 implements the Dub build procedure used by D packages, which
6579 involves running @code{dub build} and @code{dub run}.
6580 Installation is done by copying the files manually.
6581
6582 Which D compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:ldc}
6583 parameter which defaults to @code{ldc}.
6584 @end defvr
6585
6586 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
6587 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
6588 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
6589 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
6590
6591 It first creates the @code{@code{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
6592 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
6593 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
6594 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. Each
6595 package is installed in its own directory under
6596 @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d}.
6597 @end defvr
6598
6599 @defvr {Scheme Variable} font-build-system
6600 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system font)}. It
6601 implements an installation procedure for font packages where upstream
6602 provides pre-compiled TrueType, OpenType, etc.@: font files that merely
6603 need to be copied into place. It copies font files to standard
6604 locations in the output directory.
6605 @end defvr
6606
6607 @defvr {Scheme Variable} meson-build-system
6608 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system meson)}. It
6609 implements the build procedure for packages that use
6610 @url{https://mesonbuild.com, Meson} as their build system.
6611
6612 It adds both Meson and @uref{https://ninja-build.org/, Ninja} to the set
6613 of inputs, and they can be changed with the parameters @code{#:meson}
6614 and @code{#:ninja} if needed. The default Meson is
6615 @code{meson-for-build}, which is special because it doesn't clear the
6616 @code{RUNPATH} of binaries and libraries when they are installed.
6617
6618 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
6619 following phases changed to some specific for Meson:
6620
6621 @table @code
6622
6623 @item configure
6624 The phase runs @code{meson} with the flags specified in
6625 @code{#:configure-flags}. The flag @code{--build-type} is always set to
6626 @code{plain} unless something else is specified in @code{#:build-type}.
6627
6628 @item build
6629 The phase runs @code{ninja} to build the package in parallel by default, but
6630 this can be changed with @code{#:parallel-build?}.
6631
6632 @item check
6633 The phase runs @code{ninja} with the target specified in @code{#:test-target},
6634 which is @code{"test"} by default.
6635
6636 @item install
6637 The phase runs @code{ninja install} and can not be changed.
6638 @end table
6639
6640 Apart from that, the build system also adds the following phases:
6641
6642 @table @code
6643
6644 @item fix-runpath
6645 This phase ensures that all binaries can find the libraries they need.
6646 It searches for required libraries in subdirectories of the package being
6647 built, and adds those to @code{RUNPATH} where needed. It also removes
6648 references to libraries left over from the build phase by
6649 @code{meson-for-build}, such as test dependencies, that aren't actually
6650 required for the program to run.
6651
6652 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
6653 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
6654 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
6655
6656 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
6657 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
6658 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
6659 @end table
6660 @end defvr
6661
6662 @defvr {Scheme Variable} linux-module-build-system
6663 @code{linux-module-build-system} allows building Linux kernel modules.
6664
6665 @cindex build phases
6666 This build system is an extension of @code{gnu-build-system}, but with the
6667 following phases changed:
6668
6669 @table @code
6670
6671 @item configure
6672 This phase configures the environment so that the Linux kernel's Makefile
6673 can be used to build the external kernel module.
6674
6675 @item build
6676 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to build the external
6677 kernel module.
6678
6679 @item install
6680 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to install the external
6681 kernel module.
6682 @end table
6683
6684 It is possible and useful to specify the Linux kernel to use for building
6685 the module (in the "arguments" form of a package using the
6686 linux-module-build-system, use the key #:linux to specify it).
6687 @end defvr
6688
6689 @defvr {Scheme Variable} node-build-system
6690 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system node)}. It
6691 implements the build procedure used by @uref{http://nodejs.org,
6692 Node.js}, which implements an approximation of the @code{npm install}
6693 command, followed by an @code{npm test} command.
6694
6695 Which Node.js package is used to interpret the @code{npm} commands can
6696 be specified with the @code{#:node} parameter which defaults to
6697 @code{node}.
6698 @end defvr
6699
6700 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
6701 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
6702 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
6703 and does not have a notion of build phases.
6704
6705 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
6706 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
6707
6708 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
6709 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
6710 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
6711 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
6712 @end defvr
6713
6714 @node The Store
6715 @section The Store
6716
6717 @cindex store
6718 @cindex store items
6719 @cindex store paths
6720
6721 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
6722 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
6723 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
6724 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
6725 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
6726 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
6727 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
6728 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
6729 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
6730
6731 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
6732 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
6733 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
6734 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
6735
6736 @quotation Note
6737 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
6738 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
6739 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
6740
6741 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
6742 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
6743 accidental modifications.
6744 @end quotation
6745
6746 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
6747 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below. By default,
6748 @code{open-connection}, and thus all the @command{guix} commands,
6749 connect to the local daemon or to the URI specified by the
6750 @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable.
6751
6752 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET
6753 When set, the value of this variable should be a file name or a URI
6754 designating the daemon endpoint. When it is a file name, it denotes a
6755 Unix-domain socket to connect to. In addition to file names, the
6756 supported URI schemes are:
6757
6758 @table @code
6759 @item file
6760 @itemx unix
6761 These are for Unix-domain sockets.
6762 @code{file:///var/guix/daemon-socket/socket} is equivalent to
6763 @file{/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
6764
6765 @item guix
6766 @cindex daemon, remote access
6767 @cindex remote access to the daemon
6768 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
6769 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
6770 These URIs denote connections over TCP/IP, without encryption nor
6771 authentication of the remote host. The URI must specify the host name
6772 and optionally a port number (by default port 44146 is used):
6773
6774 @example
6775 guix://master.guix.example.org:1234
6776 @end example
6777
6778 This setup is suitable on local networks, such as clusters, where only
6779 trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon at
6780 @code{master.guix.example.org}.
6781
6782 The @code{--listen} option of @command{guix-daemon} can be used to
6783 instruct it to listen for TCP connections (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
6784 @code{--listen}}).
6785
6786 @item ssh
6787 @cindex SSH access to build daemons
6788 These URIs allow you to connect to a remote daemon over
6789 SSH@footnote{This feature requires Guile-SSH (@pxref{Requirements}).}.
6790 A typical URL might look like this:
6791
6792 @example
6793 ssh://charlie@@guix.example.org:22
6794 @end example
6795
6796 As for @command{guix copy}, the usual OpenSSH client configuration files
6797 are honored (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
6798 @end table
6799
6800 Additional URI schemes may be supported in the future.
6801
6802 @c XXX: Remove this note when the protocol incurs fewer round trips
6803 @c and when (guix derivations) no longer relies on file system access.
6804 @quotation Note
6805 The ability to connect to remote build daemons is considered
6806 experimental as of @value{VERSION}. Please get in touch with us to
6807 share any problems or suggestions you may have (@pxref{Contributing}).
6808 @end quotation
6809 @end defvr
6810
6811 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{uri}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
6812 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{uri} (a string). When
6813 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
6814 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
6815 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
6816
6817 @var{file} defaults to @code{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
6818 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
6819 @end deffn
6820
6821 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
6822 Close the connection to @var{server}.
6823 @end deffn
6824
6825 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
6826 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
6827 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
6828 @end defvr
6829
6830 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
6831 argument.
6832
6833 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
6834 @cindex invalid store items
6835 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
6836 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
6837 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
6838 build.)
6839
6840 A @code{&store-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
6841 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
6842 @end deffn
6843
6844 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
6845 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
6846 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
6847 resulting store path.
6848 @end deffn
6849
6850 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{store} @var{derivations} @
6851 [@var{mode}]
6852 Build @var{derivations}, a list of @code{<derivation>} objects, @file{.drv}
6853 file names, or derivation/output pairs, using the specified
6854 @var{mode}---@code{(build-mode normal)} by default.
6855 @end deffn
6856
6857 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
6858 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
6859 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
6860 Store Monad}).
6861
6862 @c FIXME
6863 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
6864
6865 @node Derivations
6866 @section Derivations
6867
6868 @cindex derivations
6869 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
6870 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
6871 following pieces of information:
6872
6873 @itemize
6874 @item
6875 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
6876 directory in the store, but may produce more.
6877
6878 @item
6879 @cindex build-time dependencies
6880 @cindex dependencies, build-time
6881 The inputs of the derivations---i.e., its build-time dependencies---which may
6882 be other derivations or plain files in the store (patches, build scripts,
6883 etc.)
6884
6885 @item
6886 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
6887
6888 @item
6889 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
6890 to be passed.
6891
6892 @item
6893 A list of environment variables to be defined.
6894
6895 @end itemize
6896
6897 @cindex derivation path
6898 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
6899 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
6900 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
6901 name end in @code{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
6902 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
6903 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
6904 Store}).
6905
6906 @cindex fixed-output derivations
6907 Operations such as file downloads and version-control checkouts for
6908 which the expected content hash is known in advance are modeled as
6909 @dfn{fixed-output derivations}. Unlike regular derivations, the outputs
6910 of a fixed-output derivation are independent of its inputs---e.g., a
6911 source code download produces the same result regardless of the download
6912 method and tools being used.
6913
6914 @cindex references
6915 @cindex run-time dependencies
6916 @cindex dependencies, run-time
6917 The outputs of derivations---i.e., the build results---have a set of
6918 @dfn{references}, as reported by the @code{references} RPC or the
6919 @command{guix gc --references} command (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). References
6920 are the set of run-time dependencies of the build results. References are a
6921 subset of the inputs of the derivation; this subset is automatically computed
6922 by the build daemon by scanning all the files in the outputs.
6923
6924 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
6925 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
6926 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
6927 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
6928
6929 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
6930 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
6931 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
6932 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
6933 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
6934 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
6935 [#:substitutable? #t] [#:properties '()]
6936 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
6937 @code{<derivation>} object.
6938
6939 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
6940 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
6941 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
6942 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
6943 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
6944 containing this output.
6945
6946 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
6947 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
6948 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
6949 a simple text format.
6950
6951 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
6952 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
6953 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
6954 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
6955
6956 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
6957 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
6958 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
6959 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
6960 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
6961 derivations that download files.
6962
6963 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
6964 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
6965 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
6966 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
6967
6968 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
6969 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
6970 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
6971 host CPU instruction set.
6972
6973 @var{properties} must be an association list describing ``properties'' of the
6974 derivation. It is kept as-is, uninterpreted, in the derivation.
6975 @end deffn
6976
6977 @noindent
6978 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
6979 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
6980 to a Bash executable in the store:
6981
6982 @lisp
6983 (use-modules (guix utils)
6984 (guix store)
6985 (guix derivations))
6986
6987 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
6988 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
6989 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
6990 (derivation store "foo"
6991 bash `("-e" ,builder)
6992 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
6993 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
6994 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
6995 @end lisp
6996
6997 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
6998 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
6999 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
7000 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
7001 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
7002
7003 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
7004 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
7005 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
7006 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
7007
7008 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
7009 @var{name} @var{exp} @
7010 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
7011 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
7012 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
7013 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
7014 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
7015 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
7016 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
7017 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
7018 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
7019 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
7020 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
7021 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
7022 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
7023 gnu-build-system))}.
7024
7025 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
7026 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
7027 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
7028 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
7029 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
7030 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
7031 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
7032
7033 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
7034 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
7035 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
7036
7037 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
7038 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
7039 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
7040 @var{substitutable?}.
7041 @end deffn
7042
7043 @noindent
7044 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
7045 containing one file:
7046
7047 @lisp
7048 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
7049 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
7050 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
7051 (lambda (p)
7052 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
7053 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
7054
7055 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
7056 @end lisp
7057
7058
7059 @node The Store Monad
7060 @section The Store Monad
7061
7062 @cindex monad
7063
7064 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
7065 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
7066 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
7067 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
7068
7069 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
7070 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
7071 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
7072 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
7073 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
7074
7075 @cindex monadic values
7076 @cindex monadic functions
7077 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
7078 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
7079 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
7080 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
7081 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
7082 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
7083 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
7084 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
7085 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
7086
7087 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
7088
7089 @lisp
7090 (define (sh-symlink store)
7091 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
7092 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
7093 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
7094 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
7095 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
7096 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
7097 @end lisp
7098
7099 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
7100 as a monadic function:
7101
7102 @lisp
7103 (define (sh-symlink)
7104 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
7105 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
7106 (gexp->derivation "sh"
7107 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
7108 #$output))))
7109 @end lisp
7110
7111 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
7112 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
7113 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
7114 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
7115 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
7116
7117 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
7118 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
7119 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
7120
7121 @lisp
7122 (define (sh-symlink)
7123 (gexp->derivation "sh"
7124 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
7125 #$output)))
7126 @end lisp
7127
7128 @c See
7129 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
7130 @c for the funny quote.
7131 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
7132 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
7133 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
7134 @code{run-with-store}:
7135
7136 @lisp
7137 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
7138 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
7139 @end lisp
7140
7141 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
7142 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
7143 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
7144 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
7145
7146 @example
7147 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
7148 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
7149 @end example
7150
7151 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
7152 automatically run through the store:
7153
7154 @example
7155 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
7156 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
7157 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
7158 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
7159 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
7160 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
7161 scheme@@(guile-user)>
7162 @end example
7163
7164 @noindent
7165 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
7166 @code{store-monad} REPL.
7167
7168 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
7169 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
7170
7171 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
7172 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
7173 in @var{monad}.
7174 @end deffn
7175
7176 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
7177 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
7178 @end deffn
7179
7180 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
7181 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
7182 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
7183 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
7184 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
7185 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
7186 in this example:
7187
7188 @lisp
7189 (run-with-state
7190 (with-monad %state-monad
7191 (>>= (return 1)
7192 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
7193 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
7194 'some-state)
7195
7196 @result{} 4
7197 @result{} some-state
7198 @end lisp
7199 @end deffn
7200
7201 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
7202 @var{body} ...
7203 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
7204 @var{body} ...
7205 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
7206 @var{body}, which is a sequence of expressions. As with the bind
7207 operator, this can be thought of as ``unpacking'' the raw, non-monadic
7208 value ``contained'' in @var{mval} and making @var{var} refer to that
7209 raw, non-monadic value within the scope of the @var{body}. The form
7210 (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the ``normal'' value
7211 @var{val}, as per @code{let}. The binding operations occur in sequence
7212 from left to right. The last expression of @var{body} must be a monadic
7213 expression, and its result will become the result of the @code{mlet} or
7214 @code{mlet*} when run in the @var{monad}.
7215
7216 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
7217 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
7218 @end deffn
7219
7220 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
7221 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
7222 returning the result of the last expression. Every expression in the
7223 sequence must be a monadic expression.
7224
7225 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
7226 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
7227 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
7228 @end deffn
7229
7230 @deffn {Scheme System} mwhen @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
7231 When @var{condition} is true, evaluate the sequence of monadic
7232 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
7233 @var{condition} is false, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
7234 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
7235 @end deffn
7236
7237 @deffn {Scheme System} munless @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
7238 When @var{condition} is false, evaluate the sequence of monadic
7239 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
7240 @var{condition} is true, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
7241 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
7242 @end deffn
7243
7244 @cindex state monad
7245 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
7246 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
7247 monadic procedure calls.
7248
7249 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
7250 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
7251 the state that is threaded.
7252
7253 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
7254 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
7255 increments the current state value:
7256
7257 @lisp
7258 (define (square x)
7259 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
7260 (mbegin %state-monad
7261 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
7262 (return (* x x)))))
7263
7264 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
7265 @result{} (0 1 4)
7266 @result{} 3
7267 @end lisp
7268
7269 When ``run'' through @var{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
7270 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
7271 @end defvr
7272
7273 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
7274 Return the current state as a monadic value.
7275 @end deffn
7276
7277 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
7278 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
7279 monadic value.
7280 @end deffn
7281
7282 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
7283 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
7284 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
7285 @end deffn
7286
7287 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
7288 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
7289 The state is assumed to be a list.
7290 @end deffn
7291
7292 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
7293 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
7294 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
7295 @end deffn
7296
7297 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
7298 store)} module, is as follows.
7299
7300 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
7301 The store monad---an alias for @var{%state-monad}.
7302
7303 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
7304 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
7305 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below.)
7306 @end defvr
7307
7308 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
7309 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
7310 open store connection.
7311 @end deffn
7312
7313 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
7314 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
7315 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
7316 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
7317 @end deffn
7318
7319 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} binary-file @var{name} @var{data} [@var{references}]
7320 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
7321 containing @var{data}, a bytevector. @var{references} is a list of store
7322 items that the resulting binary file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
7323 @end deffn
7324
7325 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
7326 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
7327 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
7328 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
7329 @var{name} is omitted.
7330
7331 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
7332 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
7333 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
7334
7335 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
7336 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
7337 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
7338 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
7339
7340 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
7341
7342 @lisp
7343 (run-with-store (open-connection)
7344 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
7345 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
7346 (return (list a b))))
7347
7348 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
7349 @end lisp
7350
7351 @end deffn
7352
7353 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
7354 monadic procedures:
7355
7356 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
7357 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
7358 [#:output "out"]
7359 Return as a monadic
7360 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
7361 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
7362 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
7363 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
7364 @end deffn
7365
7366 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
7367 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
7368 @var{target} [@var{system}]
7369 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
7370 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
7371 @end deffn
7372
7373
7374 @node G-Expressions
7375 @section G-Expressions
7376
7377 @cindex G-expression
7378 @cindex build code quoting
7379 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
7380 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
7381 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
7382 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
7383 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
7384
7385 @cindex strata of code
7386 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
7387 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
7388 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
7389 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
7390 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
7391 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
7392 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
7393 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
7394 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
7395 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
7396 @command{make}, etc.
7397
7398 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
7399 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
7400 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
7401 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
7402 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
7403 expressions.
7404
7405 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
7406 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
7407 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
7408 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
7409 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
7410 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
7411 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
7412 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
7413
7414 @itemize
7415 @item
7416 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
7417 processes.
7418
7419 @item
7420 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
7421 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
7422 introduced.
7423
7424 @item
7425 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
7426 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
7427 processes that use them.
7428 @end itemize
7429
7430 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
7431 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
7432 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
7433 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
7434 such that these objects can also be inserted
7435 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
7436 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
7437 add files to the store and to refer to them in
7438 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
7439 below.)
7440
7441 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
7442
7443 @lisp
7444 (define build-exp
7445 #~(begin
7446 (mkdir #$output)
7447 (chdir #$output)
7448 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
7449 "list-files")))
7450 @end lisp
7451
7452 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
7453 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
7454 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
7455
7456 @lisp
7457 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
7458 @end lisp
7459
7460 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
7461 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
7462 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
7463 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
7464 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
7465 output of the derivation.
7466
7467 @cindex cross compilation
7468 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
7469 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
7470 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
7471 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
7472 native package build:
7473
7474 @lisp
7475 (gexp->derivation "vi"
7476 #~(begin
7477 (mkdir #$output)
7478 (mkdir (string-append #$output "/bin"))
7479 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
7480 "-s"
7481 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
7482 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
7483 #:target "mips64el-linux-gnu")
7484 @end lisp
7485
7486 @noindent
7487 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
7488 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
7489 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
7490
7491 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
7492 @findex with-imported-modules
7493 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
7494 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
7495 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
7496 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
7497
7498 @lisp
7499 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
7500 #~(begin
7501 (use-modules (guix build utils))
7502 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
7503 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
7504 #~(begin
7505 #$build
7506 (display "success!\n")
7507 #t)))
7508 @end lisp
7509
7510 @noindent
7511 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
7512 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
7513 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
7514
7515 @cindex module closure
7516 @findex source-module-closure
7517 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
7518 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
7519 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
7520 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
7521 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
7522 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
7523
7524 @lisp
7525 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
7526
7527 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
7528 '((guix build utils)
7529 (gnu build vm)))
7530 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
7531 #~(begin
7532 (use-modules (guix build utils)
7533 (gnu build vm))
7534 @dots{})))
7535 @end lisp
7536
7537 @cindex extensions, for gexps
7538 @findex with-extensions
7539 In the same vein, sometimes you want to import not just pure-Scheme
7540 modules, but also ``extensions'' such as Guile bindings to C libraries
7541 or other ``full-blown'' packages. Say you need the @code{guile-json}
7542 package available on the build side, here's how you would do it:
7543
7544 @lisp
7545 (use-modules (gnu packages guile)) ;for 'guile-json'
7546
7547 (with-extensions (list guile-json)
7548 (gexp->derivation "something-with-json"
7549 #~(begin
7550 (use-modules (json))
7551 @dots{})))
7552 @end lisp
7553
7554 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
7555
7556 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
7557 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
7558 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
7559 or more of the following forms:
7560
7561 @table @code
7562 @item #$@var{obj}
7563 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
7564 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
7565 supported types, for example a package or a
7566 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
7567 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
7568
7569 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
7570 objects are substituted similarly.
7571
7572 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
7573 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
7574
7575 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
7576
7577 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
7578 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
7579 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
7580 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
7581 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
7582
7583 @item #+@var{obj}
7584 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
7585 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
7586 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
7587 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
7588 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
7589
7590 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
7591 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
7592 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
7593 output when @var{output} is omitted.
7594
7595 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
7596
7597 @item #$@@@var{lst}
7598 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
7599 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
7600 containing list.
7601
7602 @item #+@@@var{lst}
7603 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
7604 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
7605 @var{lst}.
7606
7607 @end table
7608
7609 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
7610 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below.)
7611 @end deffn
7612
7613 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
7614 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
7615 in their execution environment.
7616
7617 Each item in @var{modules} can be the name of a module, such as
7618 @code{(guix build utils)}, or it can be a module name, followed by an
7619 arrow, followed by a file-like object:
7620
7621 @lisp
7622 `((guix build utils)
7623 (guix gcrypt)
7624 ((guix config) => ,(scheme-file "config.scm"
7625 #~(define-module @dots{}))))
7626 @end lisp
7627
7628 @noindent
7629 In the example above, the first two modules are taken from the search
7630 path, and the last one is created from the given file-like object.
7631
7632 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
7633 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
7634 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
7635 @end deffn
7636
7637 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-extensions @var{extensions} @var{body}@dots{}
7638 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring
7639 @var{extensions} in their build and execution environment.
7640 @var{extensions} is typically a list of package objects such as those
7641 defined in the @code{(gnu packages guile)} module.
7642
7643 Concretely, the packages listed in @var{extensions} are added to the
7644 load path while compiling imported modules in @var{body}@dots{}; they
7645 are also added to the load path of the gexp returned by
7646 @var{body}@dots{}.
7647 @end deffn
7648
7649 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
7650 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
7651 @end deffn
7652
7653 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
7654 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
7655 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
7656 information about monads.)
7657
7658 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
7659 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
7660 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
7661 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
7662 [#:module-path @var{%load-path}] @
7663 [#:effective-version "2.2"] @
7664 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
7665 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
7666 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
7667 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
7668 [#:deprecation-warnings #f] @
7669 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] @
7670 [#:properties '()] [#:guile-for-build #f]
7671 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
7672 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
7673 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
7674 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
7675 to by @var{exp}.
7676
7677 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
7678 Its meaning is to
7679 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
7680 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
7681 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
7682 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
7683 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
7684
7685 @var{effective-version} determines the string to use when adding extensions of
7686 @var{exp} (see @code{with-extensions}) to the search path---e.g., @code{"2.2"}.
7687
7688 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
7689 applicable.
7690
7691 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
7692 following forms:
7693
7694 @example
7695 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
7696 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
7697 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
7698 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
7699 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
7700 @end example
7701
7702 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
7703 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
7704 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
7705 text format.
7706
7707 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
7708 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
7709 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
7710 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
7711 referenced by the outputs.
7712
7713 @var{deprecation-warnings} determines whether to show deprecation warnings while
7714 compiling modules. It can be @code{#f}, @code{#t}, or @code{'detailed}.
7715
7716 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
7717 @end deffn
7718
7719 @cindex file-like objects
7720 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
7721 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
7722 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
7723 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
7724
7725 @lisp
7726 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
7727 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
7728 @end lisp
7729
7730 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
7731 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
7732 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
7733 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
7734 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
7735 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
7736 content is directly passed as a string.
7737
7738 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
7739 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
7740 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store;
7741 this object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a literal string
7742 denoting a relative file name, it is looked up relative to the source
7743 file where it appears; if @var{file} is not a literal string, it is
7744 looked up relative to the current working directory at run time.
7745 @var{file} will be added to the store under @var{name}--by default the
7746 base name of @var{file}.
7747
7748 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
7749 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
7750 permission bits are kept.
7751
7752 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
7753 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
7754 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
7755 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
7756
7757 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
7758 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
7759 @end deffn
7760
7761 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
7762 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
7763 @var{content} (a string or a bytevector) to be added to the store.
7764
7765 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
7766 @end deffn
7767
7768 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
7769 [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
7770 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
7771 directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{options}
7772 is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
7773
7774 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
7775 @end deffn
7776
7777 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp} @
7778 [#:guile (default-guile)] [#:module-path %load-path] @
7779 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f]
7780 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
7781 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
7782 Look up @var{exp}'s modules in @var{module-path}.
7783
7784 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
7785 command:
7786
7787 @lisp
7788 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
7789
7790 (gexp->script "list-files"
7791 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
7792 "ls"))
7793 @end lisp
7794
7795 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
7796 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
7797 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
7798
7799 @example
7800 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
7801 !#
7802 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
7803 @end example
7804 @end deffn
7805
7806 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
7807 [#:guile #f] [#:module-path %load-path]
7808 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
7809 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
7810 script. Imported modules of @var{gexp} are looked up in @var{module-path}.
7811
7812 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
7813 @end deffn
7814
7815 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
7816 [#:set-load-path? #t] [#:module-path %load-path] @
7817 [#:splice? #f] @
7818 [#:guile (default-guile)]
7819 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
7820 When @var{splice?} is true, @var{exp} is considered to be a list of
7821 expressions that will be spliced in the resulting file.
7822
7823 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
7824 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
7825 @var{exp}'s imported modules. Look up @var{exp}'s modules in
7826 @var{module-path}.
7827
7828 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
7829 or a subset thereof.
7830 @end deffn
7831
7832 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp} [#:splice? #f]
7833 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
7834 @var{exp}.
7835
7836 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
7837 @end deffn
7838
7839 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
7840 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
7841 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
7842 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
7843 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
7844 references to all these.
7845
7846 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
7847 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
7848 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
7849 like this:
7850
7851 @lisp
7852 (define (profile.sh)
7853 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
7854 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
7855 (text-file* "profile.sh"
7856 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
7857 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
7858 @end lisp
7859
7860 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
7861 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
7862 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
7863 @end deffn
7864
7865 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
7866 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
7867 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
7868 as in:
7869
7870 @lisp
7871 (mixed-text-file "profile"
7872 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
7873 @end lisp
7874
7875 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
7876 @end deffn
7877
7878 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-union @var{name} @var{files}
7879 Return a @code{<computed-file>} that builds a directory containing all of @var{files}.
7880 Each item in @var{files} must be a two-element list where the first element is the
7881 file name to use in the new directory, and the second element is a gexp
7882 denoting the target file. Here's an example:
7883
7884 @lisp
7885 (file-union "etc"
7886 `(("hosts" ,(plain-file "hosts"
7887 "127.0.0.1 localhost"))
7888 ("bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc"
7889 "alias ls='ls --color=auto'"))))
7890 @end lisp
7891
7892 This yields an @code{etc} directory containing these two files.
7893 @end deffn
7894
7895 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-union @var{name} @var{things}
7896 Return a directory that is the union of @var{things}, where @var{things} is a list of
7897 file-like objects denoting directories. For example:
7898
7899 @lisp
7900 (directory-union "guile+emacs" (list guile emacs))
7901 @end lisp
7902
7903 yields a directory that is the union of the @code{guile} and @code{emacs} packages.
7904 @end deffn
7905
7906 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
7907 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
7908 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
7909 @var{suffix} is a string.
7910
7911 As an example, consider this gexp:
7912
7913 @lisp
7914 (gexp->script "run-uname"
7915 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
7916 "/bin/uname")))
7917 @end lisp
7918
7919 The same effect could be achieved with:
7920
7921 @lisp
7922 (gexp->script "run-uname"
7923 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
7924 "/bin/uname")))
7925 @end lisp
7926
7927 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
7928 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
7929 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
7930 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
7931 @end deffn
7932
7933
7934 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
7935 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
7936 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
7937 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
7938
7939 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
7940 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
7941 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
7942 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
7943 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
7944
7945 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
7946 [#:target #f]
7947 Return as a value in @var{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
7948 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
7949 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
7950 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
7951 @end deffn
7952
7953 @node Invoking guix repl
7954 @section Invoking @command{guix repl}
7955
7956 @cindex REPL, read-eval-print loop
7957 The @command{guix repl} command spawns a Guile @dfn{read-eval-print loop}
7958 (REPL) for interactive programming (@pxref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile,
7959 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). Compared to just launching the @command{guile}
7960 command, @command{guix repl} guarantees that all the Guix modules and all its
7961 dependencies are available in the search path. You can use it this way:
7962
7963 @example
7964 $ guix repl
7965 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,use (gnu packages base)
7966 scheme@@(guile-user)> coreutils
7967 $1 = #<package coreutils@@8.29 gnu/packages/base.scm:327 3e28300>
7968 @end example
7969
7970 @cindex inferiors
7971 In addition, @command{guix repl} implements a simple machine-readable REPL
7972 protocol for use by @code{(guix inferior)}, a facility to interact with
7973 @dfn{inferiors}, separate processes running a potentially different revision
7974 of Guix.
7975
7976 The available options are as follows:
7977
7978 @table @code
7979 @item --type=@var{type}
7980 @itemx -t @var{type}
7981 Start a REPL of the given @var{TYPE}, which can be one of the following:
7982
7983 @table @code
7984 @item guile
7985 This is default, and it spawns a standard full-featured Guile REPL.
7986 @item machine
7987 Spawn a REPL that uses the machine-readable protocol. This is the protocol
7988 that the @code{(guix inferior)} module speaks.
7989 @end table
7990
7991 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
7992 By default, @command{guix repl} reads from standard input and writes to
7993 standard output. When this option is passed, it will instead listen for
7994 connections on @var{endpoint}. Here are examples of valid options:
7995
7996 @table @code
7997 @item --listen=tcp:37146
7998 Accept connections on localhost on port 37146.
7999
8000 @item --listen=unix:/tmp/socket
8001 Accept connections on the Unix-domain socket @file{/tmp/socket}.
8002 @end table
8003
8004 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
8005 @itemx -L @var{directory}
8006 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
8007 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
8008
8009 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
8010 the command-line tool.
8011
8012 @item -q
8013 Inhibit loading of the @file{~/.guile} file. By default, that
8014 configuration file is loaded when spawning a @code{guile} REPL.
8015 @end table
8016
8017 @c *********************************************************************
8018 @node Utilities
8019 @chapter Utilities
8020
8021 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
8022 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
8023 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
8024 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
8025
8026 @menu
8027 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
8028 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
8029 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
8030 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
8031 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
8032 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
8033 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
8034 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
8035 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
8036 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
8037 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
8038 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
8039 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
8040 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
8041 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
8042 @end menu
8043
8044 @node Invoking guix build
8045 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
8046
8047 @cindex package building
8048 @cindex @command{guix build}
8049 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
8050 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
8051 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
8052 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
8053 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
8054
8055 The general syntax is:
8056
8057 @example
8058 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
8059 @end example
8060
8061 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
8062 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
8063 resulting directories:
8064
8065 @example
8066 guix build emacs guile
8067 @end example
8068
8069 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
8070
8071 @example
8072 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
8073 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
8074 @end example
8075
8076 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
8077 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
8078 @code{coreutils@@8.20}, or a derivation such as
8079 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
8080 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
8081 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
8082
8083 Alternatively, the @code{--expression} option may be used to specify a
8084 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
8085 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
8086 needed.
8087
8088 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
8089 described in the subsections below.
8090
8091 @menu
8092 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
8093 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
8094 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
8095 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
8096 @end menu
8097
8098 @node Common Build Options
8099 @subsection Common Build Options
8100
8101 A number of options that control the build process are common to
8102 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
8103 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
8104 following:
8105
8106 @table @code
8107
8108 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
8109 @itemx -L @var{directory}
8110 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
8111 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
8112
8113 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
8114 the command-line tools.
8115
8116 @item --keep-failed
8117 @itemx -K
8118 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
8119 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
8120 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
8121 @xref{Debugging Build Failures}, for tips and tricks on how to debug
8122 build issues.
8123
8124 This option implies @option{--no-offload}, and it has no effect when
8125 connecting to a remote daemon with a @code{guix://} URI (@pxref{The
8126 Store, the @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} variable}).
8127
8128 @item --keep-going
8129 @itemx -k
8130 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
8131 all the builds have either completed or failed.
8132
8133 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
8134 derivations has failed.
8135
8136 @item --dry-run
8137 @itemx -n
8138 Do not build the derivations.
8139
8140 @anchor{fallback-option}
8141 @item --fallback
8142 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
8143 packages locally (@pxref{Substitution Failure}).
8144
8145 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
8146 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
8147 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
8148 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
8149 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
8150
8151 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
8152 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
8153 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
8154
8155 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
8156 disabled.
8157
8158 @item --no-substitutes
8159 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
8160 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
8161 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
8162
8163 @item --no-grafts
8164 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
8165 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
8166 information on grafts.
8167
8168 @item --rounds=@var{n}
8169 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
8170 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
8171
8172 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
8173 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
8174 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
8175 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
8176
8177 Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
8178 so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
8179 stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export}
8180 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), then rebuilding, and finally comparing
8181 the two results.
8182
8183 @item --no-offload
8184 Do not use offload builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload
8185 Setup}). That is, always build things locally instead of offloading
8186 builds to remote machines.
8187
8188 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
8189 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
8190 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
8191
8192 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
8193 guix-daemon, @code{--max-silent-time}}).
8194
8195 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
8196 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
8197 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
8198
8199 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
8200 guix-daemon, @code{--timeout}}).
8201
8202 @c Note: This option is actually not part of %standard-build-options but
8203 @c most programs honor it.
8204 @cindex verbosity, of the command-line tools
8205 @cindex build logs, verbosity
8206 @item -v @var{level}
8207 @itemx --verbosity=@var{level}
8208 Use the given verbosity @var{level}, an integer. Choosing 0 means that no
8209 output is produced, 1 is for quiet output, and 2 shows all the build log
8210 output on standard error.
8211
8212 @item --cores=@var{n}
8213 @itemx -c @var{n}
8214 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
8215 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
8216
8217 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
8218 @itemx -M @var{n}
8219 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
8220 guix-daemon, @code{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
8221 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
8222
8223 @item --debug=@var{level}
8224 Produce debugging output coming from the build daemon. @var{level} must be an
8225 integer between 0 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of
8226 4 or more may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
8227
8228 @end table
8229
8230 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
8231 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
8232 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
8233 derivations)} module.
8234
8235 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
8236 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
8237 building honor the @code{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
8238
8239 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
8240 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
8241 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
8242 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
8243 below:
8244
8245 @example
8246 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
8247 @end example
8248
8249 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
8250 the parsed command-line options.
8251 @end defvr
8252
8253
8254 @node Package Transformation Options
8255 @subsection Package Transformation Options
8256
8257 @cindex package variants
8258 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
8259 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
8260 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
8261 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
8262 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
8263 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
8264 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8265
8266 @table @code
8267
8268 @item --with-source=@var{source}
8269 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}=@var{source}
8270 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}@@@var{version}=@var{source}
8271 Use @var{source} as the source of @var{package}, and @var{version} as
8272 its version number.
8273 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
8274 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
8275
8276 When @var{package} is omitted,
8277 it is taken to be the package name specified on the
8278 command line that matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
8279 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
8280 package is @code{guile}.
8281
8282 Likewise, when @var{version} is omitted, the version string is inferred from
8283 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
8284
8285 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
8286 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
8287 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
8288 the @code{ed} package:
8289
8290 @example
8291 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
8292 @end example
8293
8294 As a developer, @code{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
8295 candidates:
8296
8297 @example
8298 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
8299 @end example
8300
8301 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
8302
8303 @example
8304 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
8305 $ guix build guix --with-source=guix@@1.0=./guix
8306 @end example
8307
8308 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
8309 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
8310 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
8311 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
8312 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
8313
8314 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
8315 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
8316 the legacy version of Guile, @code{guile@@2.0}:
8317
8318 @example
8319 guix build --with-input=guile=guile@@2.0 guix
8320 @end example
8321
8322 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
8323 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
8324 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile@@2.0}.
8325
8326 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
8327 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
8328
8329 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
8330 This is similar to @code{--with-input} but with an important difference:
8331 instead of rebuilding the whole dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
8332 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
8333 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
8334 information on grafts.
8335
8336 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
8337 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
8338 they currently refer to:
8339
8340 @example
8341 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
8342 @end example
8343
8344 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
8345 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
8346 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
8347 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
8348 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
8349 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
8350 care!
8351
8352 @item --with-git-url=@var{package}=@var{url}
8353 @cindex Git, using the latest commit
8354 @cindex latest commit, building
8355 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of the @code{master} branch of the
8356 Git repository at @var{url}. Git sub-modules of the repository are fetched,
8357 recursively.
8358
8359 For example, the following command builds the NumPy Python library against the
8360 latest commit of the master branch of Python itself:
8361
8362 @example
8363 guix build python-numpy \
8364 --with-git-url=python=https://github.com/python/cpython
8365 @end example
8366
8367 This option can also be combined with @code{--with-branch} or
8368 @code{--with-commit} (see below).
8369
8370 @cindex continuous integration
8371 Obviously, since it uses the latest commit of the given branch, the result of
8372 such a command varies over time. Nevertheless it is a convenient way to
8373 rebuild entire software stacks against the latest commit of one or more
8374 packages. This is particularly useful in the context of continuous
8375 integration (CI).
8376
8377 Checkouts are kept in a cache under @file{~/.cache/guix/checkouts} to speed up
8378 consecutive accesses to the same repository. You may want to clean it up once
8379 in a while to save disk space.
8380
8381 @item --with-branch=@var{package}=@var{branch}
8382 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of @var{branch}. If the
8383 @code{source} field of @var{package} is an origin with the @code{git-fetch}
8384 method (@pxref{origin Reference}) or a @code{git-checkout} object, the
8385 repository URL is taken from that @code{source}. Otherwise you have to use
8386 @code{--with-git-url} to specify the URL of the Git repository.
8387
8388 For instance, the following command builds @code{guile-sqlite3} from the
8389 latest commit of its @code{master} branch, and then builds @code{guix} (which
8390 depends on it) and @code{cuirass} (which depends on @code{guix}) against this
8391 specific @code{guile-sqlite3} build:
8392
8393 @example
8394 guix build --with-branch=guile-sqlite3=master cuirass
8395 @end example
8396
8397 @item --with-commit=@var{package}=@var{commit}
8398 This is similar to @code{--with-branch}, except that it builds from
8399 @var{commit} rather than the tip of a branch. @var{commit} must be a valid
8400 Git commit SHA1 identifier or a tag.
8401 @end table
8402
8403 @node Additional Build Options
8404 @subsection Additional Build Options
8405
8406 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
8407 build}.
8408
8409 @table @code
8410
8411 @item --quiet
8412 @itemx -q
8413 Build quietly, without displaying the build log; this is equivalent to
8414 @code{--verbosity=0}. Upon completion, the build log is kept in @file{/var}
8415 (or similar) and can always be retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
8416
8417 @item --file=@var{file}
8418 @itemx -f @var{file}
8419 Build the package, derivation, or other file-like object that the code within
8420 @var{file} evaluates to (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
8421
8422 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
8423 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
8424
8425 @lisp
8426 @include package-hello.scm
8427 @end lisp
8428
8429 @item --expression=@var{expr}
8430 @itemx -e @var{expr}
8431 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
8432
8433 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
8434 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
8435 version 1.8 of Guile.
8436
8437 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
8438 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
8439 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
8440
8441 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
8442 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
8443 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
8444
8445 @item --source
8446 @itemx -S
8447 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
8448 themselves.
8449
8450 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
8451 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
8452 source tarball.
8453
8454 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
8455 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
8456 Packages}).
8457
8458 Note that @command{guix build -S} compiles the sources only of the
8459 specified packages. They do not include the sources of statically
8460 linked dependencies and by themselves are insufficient for reproducing
8461 the packages.
8462
8463 @item --sources
8464 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
8465 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
8466 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
8467 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
8468 of the @code{--source} option and can accept one of the following
8469 optional argument values:
8470
8471 @table @code
8472 @item package
8473 This value causes the @code{--sources} option to behave in the same way
8474 as the @code{--source} option.
8475
8476 @item all
8477 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
8478 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
8479
8480 @example
8481 $ guix build --sources tzdata
8482 The following derivations will be built:
8483 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
8484 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
8485 @end example
8486
8487 @item transitive
8488 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
8489 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g.@: to
8490 prefetch package source for later offline building.
8491
8492 @example
8493 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
8494 The following derivations will be built:
8495 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
8496 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
8497 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
8498 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
8499 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
8500 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
8501 @dots{}
8502 @end example
8503
8504 @end table
8505
8506 @item --system=@var{system}
8507 @itemx -s @var{system}
8508 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
8509 the system type of the build host. The @command{guix build} command allows
8510 you to repeat this option several times, in which case it builds for all the
8511 specified systems; other commands ignore extraneous @option{-s} options.
8512
8513 @quotation Note
8514 The @code{--system} flag is for @emph{native} compilation and must not
8515 be confused with cross-compilation. See @code{--target} below for
8516 information on cross-compilation.
8517 @end quotation
8518
8519 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
8520 different personalities. For instance, passing
8521 @code{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system or
8522 @code{--system=armhf-linux} on an @code{aarch64-linux} system allows you
8523 to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
8524
8525 @quotation Note
8526 Building for an @code{armhf-linux} system is unconditionally enabled on
8527 @code{aarch64-linux} machines, although certain aarch64 chipsets do not
8528 allow for this functionality, notably the ThunderX.
8529 @end quotation
8530
8531 Similarly, when transparent emulation with QEMU and @code{binfmt_misc}
8532 is enabled (@pxref{Virtualization Services,
8533 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type}}), you can build for any system for
8534 which a QEMU @code{binfmt_misc} handler is installed.
8535
8536 Builds for a system other than that of the machine you are using can
8537 also be offloaded to a remote machine of the right architecture.
8538 @xref{Daemon Offload Setup}, for more information on offloading.
8539
8540 @item --target=@var{triplet}
8541 @cindex cross-compilation
8542 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
8543 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets, GNU
8544 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
8545
8546 @anchor{build-check}
8547 @item --check
8548 @cindex determinism, checking
8549 @cindex reproducibility, checking
8550 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
8551 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
8552 identical.
8553
8554 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
8555 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
8556 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
8557 background information and tools.
8558
8559 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
8560 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
8561 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
8562
8563 @item --repair
8564 @cindex repairing store items
8565 @cindex corruption, recovering from
8566 Attempt to repair the specified store items, if they are corrupt, by
8567 re-downloading or rebuilding them.
8568
8569 This operation is not atomic and thus restricted to @code{root}.
8570
8571 @item --derivations
8572 @itemx -d
8573 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
8574 packages.
8575
8576 @item --root=@var{file}
8577 @itemx -r @var{file}
8578 @cindex GC roots, adding
8579 @cindex garbage collector roots, adding
8580 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
8581 collector root.
8582
8583 Consequently, the results of this @command{guix build} invocation are
8584 protected from garbage collection until @var{file} is removed. When
8585 that option is omitted, build results are eligible for garbage
8586 collection as soon as the build completes. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for
8587 more on GC roots.
8588
8589 @item --log-file
8590 @cindex build logs, access
8591 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
8592 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
8593 missing.
8594
8595 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
8596 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
8597
8598 @example
8599 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
8600 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
8601 guix build --log-file guile
8602 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
8603 @end example
8604
8605 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @code{--no-substitutes} is
8606 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
8607 substitute servers (as specified with @code{--substitute-urls}.)
8608
8609 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
8610 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
8611
8612 @example
8613 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s mips64el-linux
8614 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
8615 @end example
8616
8617 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
8618 @end table
8619
8620 @node Debugging Build Failures
8621 @subsection Debugging Build Failures
8622
8623 @cindex build failures, debugging
8624 When defining a new package (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will
8625 probably find yourself spending some time debugging and tweaking the
8626 build until it succeeds. To do that, you need to operate the build
8627 commands yourself in an environment as close as possible to the one the
8628 build daemon uses.
8629
8630 To that end, the first thing to do is to use the @option{--keep-failed}
8631 or @option{-K} option of @command{guix build}, which will keep the
8632 failed build tree in @file{/tmp} or whatever directory you specified as
8633 @code{TMPDIR} (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--keep-failed}}).
8634
8635 From there on, you can @command{cd} to the failed build tree and source
8636 the @file{environment-variables} file, which contains all the
8637 environment variable definitions that were in place when the build
8638 failed. So let's say you're debugging a build failure in package
8639 @code{foo}; a typical session would look like this:
8640
8641 @example
8642 $ guix build foo -K
8643 @dots{} @i{build fails}
8644 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
8645 $ source ./environment-variables
8646 $ cd foo-1.2
8647 @end example
8648
8649 Now, you can invoke commands as if you were the daemon (almost) and
8650 troubleshoot your build process.
8651
8652 Sometimes it happens that, for example, a package's tests pass when you
8653 run them manually but they fail when the daemon runs them. This can
8654 happen because the daemon runs builds in containers where, unlike in our
8655 environment above, network access is missing, @file{/bin/sh} does not
8656 exist, etc. (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
8657
8658 In such cases, you may need to run inspect the build process from within
8659 a container similar to the one the build daemon creates:
8660
8661 @example
8662 $ guix build -K foo
8663 @dots{}
8664 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
8665 $ guix environment --no-grafts -C foo --ad-hoc strace gdb
8666 [env]# source ./environment-variables
8667 [env]# cd foo-1.2
8668 @end example
8669
8670 Here, @command{guix environment -C} creates a container and spawns a new
8671 shell in it (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}). The @command{--ad-hoc
8672 strace gdb} part adds the @command{strace} and @command{gdb} commands to
8673 the container, which would may find handy while debugging. The
8674 @option{--no-grafts} option makes sure we get the exact same
8675 environment, with ungrafted packages (@pxref{Security Updates}, for more
8676 info on grafts).
8677
8678 To get closer to a container like that used by the build daemon, we can
8679 remove @file{/bin/sh}:
8680
8681 @example
8682 [env]# rm /bin/sh
8683 @end example
8684
8685 (Don't worry, this is harmless: this is all happening in the throw-away
8686 container created by @command{guix environment}.)
8687
8688 The @command{strace} command is probably not in the search path, but we
8689 can run:
8690
8691 @example
8692 [env]# $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin/strace -f -o log make check
8693 @end example
8694
8695 In this way, not only you will have reproduced the environment variables
8696 the daemon uses, you will also be running the build process in a container
8697 similar to the one the daemon uses.
8698
8699
8700 @node Invoking guix edit
8701 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
8702
8703 @cindex @command{guix edit}
8704 @cindex package definition, editing
8705 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
8706 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
8707 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
8708 For instance:
8709
8710 @example
8711 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
8712 @end example
8713
8714 @noindent
8715 launches the program specified in the @code{VISUAL} or in the
8716 @code{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
8717 and that of Vim.
8718
8719 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
8720 have created your own packages on @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
8721 (@pxref{Package Modules}), you will be able to edit the package
8722 recipes. In other cases, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
8723 for packages currently in the store.
8724
8725 Instead of @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}, the command-line option
8726 @code{--load-path=@var{directory}} (or in short @code{-L
8727 @var{directory}}) allows you to add @var{directory} to the front of the
8728 package module search path and so make your own packages visible.
8729
8730 @node Invoking guix download
8731 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
8732
8733 @cindex @command{guix download}
8734 @cindex downloading package sources
8735 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
8736 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
8737 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
8738 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
8739 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
8740 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
8741
8742 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
8743 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
8744 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
8745 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
8746 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
8747 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
8748
8749 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
8750 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
8751 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
8752 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
8753 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
8754 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
8755 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
8756
8757 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
8758 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
8759 the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
8760 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
8761
8762 The following options are available:
8763
8764 @table @code
8765 @item --format=@var{fmt}
8766 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
8767 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
8768 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
8769
8770 @item --no-check-certificate
8771 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
8772
8773 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
8774 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
8775 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
8776
8777 @item --output=@var{file}
8778 @itemx -o @var{file}
8779 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
8780 store.
8781 @end table
8782
8783 @node Invoking guix hash
8784 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
8785
8786 @cindex @command{guix hash}
8787 The @command{guix hash} command computes the SHA256 hash of a file.
8788 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
8789 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
8790 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8791
8792 The general syntax is:
8793
8794 @example
8795 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
8796 @end example
8797
8798 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
8799 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
8800 following options:
8801
8802 @table @code
8803
8804 @item --format=@var{fmt}
8805 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
8806 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
8807
8808 Supported formats: @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
8809 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
8810
8811 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
8812 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
8813 in the definitions of packages.
8814
8815 @item --recursive
8816 @itemx -r
8817 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
8818
8819 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
8820 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
8821 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
8822 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
8823 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
8824 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
8825 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
8826 @c it exists.
8827
8828 @item --exclude-vcs
8829 @itemx -x
8830 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
8831 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.)
8832
8833 @vindex git-fetch
8834 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
8835 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
8836 Reference}):
8837
8838 @example
8839 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
8840 $ cd foo
8841 $ guix hash -rx .
8842 @end example
8843 @end table
8844
8845 @node Invoking guix import
8846 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
8847
8848 @cindex importing packages
8849 @cindex package import
8850 @cindex package conversion
8851 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
8852 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
8853 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
8854 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
8855 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
8856 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
8857 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8858
8859 The general syntax is:
8860
8861 @example
8862 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
8863 @end example
8864
8865 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
8866 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
8867 options specific to @var{importer}.
8868
8869 Some of the importers rely on the ability to run the @command{gpgv} command.
8870 For these, GnuPG must be installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install
8871 gnupg} if needed.
8872
8873 Currently, the available ``importers'' are:
8874
8875 @table @code
8876 @item gnu
8877 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
8878 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
8879 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
8880
8881 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
8882 license needs to be figured out manually.
8883
8884 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
8885 GNU@tie{}Hello:
8886
8887 @example
8888 guix import gnu hello
8889 @end example
8890
8891 Specific command-line options are:
8892
8893 @table @code
8894 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
8895 As for @code{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing OpenPGP
8896 keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
8897 refresh, @code{--key-download}}.
8898 @end table
8899
8900 @item pypi
8901 @cindex pypi
8902 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
8903 Index}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted description
8904 available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all the relevant
8905 information, including package dependencies. For maximum efficiency, it
8906 is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so that the
8907 importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
8908
8909 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
8910 package:
8911
8912 @example
8913 guix import pypi itsdangerous
8914 @end example
8915
8916 @table @code
8917 @item --recursive
8918 @itemx -r
8919 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8920 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8921 in Guix.
8922 @end table
8923
8924 @item gem
8925 @cindex gem
8926 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/, RubyGems}. Information
8927 is taken from the JSON-formatted description available at
8928 @code{rubygems.org} and includes most relevant information, including
8929 runtime dependencies. There are some caveats, however. The metadata
8930 doesn't distinguish between synopses and descriptions, so the same string
8931 is used for both fields. Additionally, the details of non-Ruby
8932 dependencies required to build native extensions is unavailable and left
8933 as an exercise to the packager.
8934
8935 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
8936
8937 @example
8938 guix import gem rails
8939 @end example
8940
8941 @table @code
8942 @item --recursive
8943 @itemx -r
8944 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8945 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8946 in Guix.
8947 @end table
8948
8949 @item cpan
8950 @cindex CPAN
8951 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
8952 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
8953 @uref{https://fastapi.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
8954 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
8955 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
8956 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
8957 list of dependencies.
8958
8959 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Acme::Boolean}
8960 Perl module:
8961
8962 @example
8963 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
8964 @end example
8965
8966 @item cran
8967 @cindex CRAN
8968 @cindex Bioconductor
8969 Import metadata from @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
8970 central repository for the @uref{https://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
8971 statistical and graphical environment}.
8972
8973 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
8974
8975 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Cairo}
8976 R package:
8977
8978 @example
8979 guix import cran Cairo
8980 @end example
8981
8982 When @code{--recursive} is added, the importer will traverse the
8983 dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively and generate
8984 package expressions for all those packages that are not yet in Guix.
8985
8986 When @code{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
8987 @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
8988 packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
8989 genomic data in bioinformatics.
8990
8991 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file contained in the
8992 package archive.
8993
8994 The command below imports metadata for the @code{GenomicRanges}
8995 R package:
8996
8997 @example
8998 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
8999 @end example
9000
9001 Finally, you can also import R packages that have not yet been published on
9002 CRAN or Bioconductor as long as they are in a git repository. Use
9003 @code{--archive=git} followed by the URL of the git repository:
9004
9005 @example
9006 guix import cran --archive=git https://github.com/immunogenomics/harmony
9007 @end example
9008
9009 @item texlive
9010 @cindex TeX Live
9011 @cindex CTAN
9012 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.ctan.org/, CTAN}, the
9013 comprehensive TeX archive network for TeX packages that are part of the
9014 @uref{https://www.tug.org/texlive/, TeX Live distribution}.
9015
9016 Information about the package is obtained through the XML API provided
9017 by CTAN, while the source code is downloaded from the SVN repository of
9018 the Tex Live project. This is done because the CTAN does not keep
9019 versioned archives.
9020
9021 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{fontspec}
9022 TeX package:
9023
9024 @example
9025 guix import texlive fontspec
9026 @end example
9027
9028 When @code{--archive=DIRECTORY} is added, the source code is downloaded
9029 not from the @file{latex} sub-directory of the @file{texmf-dist/source}
9030 tree in the TeX Live SVN repository, but from the specified sibling
9031 directory under the same root.
9032
9033 The command below imports metadata for the @code{ifxetex} package from
9034 CTAN while fetching the sources from the directory
9035 @file{texmf/source/generic}:
9036
9037 @example
9038 guix import texlive --archive=generic ifxetex
9039 @end example
9040
9041 @item json
9042 @cindex JSON, import
9043 Import package metadata from a local JSON file. Consider the following
9044 example package definition in JSON format:
9045
9046 @example
9047 @{
9048 "name": "hello",
9049 "version": "2.10",
9050 "source": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
9051 "build-system": "gnu",
9052 "home-page": "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/",
9053 "synopsis": "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package",
9054 "description": "GNU Hello prints a greeting.",
9055 "license": "GPL-3.0+",
9056 "native-inputs": ["gettext"]
9057 @}
9058 @end example
9059
9060 The field names are the same as for the @code{<package>} record
9061 (@xref{Defining Packages}). References to other packages are provided
9062 as JSON lists of quoted package specification strings such as
9063 @code{guile} or @code{guile@@2.0}.
9064
9065 The importer also supports a more explicit source definition using the
9066 common fields for @code{<origin>} records:
9067
9068 @example
9069 @{
9070 @dots{}
9071 "source": @{
9072 "method": "url-fetch",
9073 "uri": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
9074 "sha256": @{
9075 "base32": "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"
9076 @}
9077 @}
9078 @dots{}
9079 @}
9080 @end example
9081
9082 The command below reads metadata from the JSON file @code{hello.json}
9083 and outputs a package expression:
9084
9085 @example
9086 guix import json hello.json
9087 @end example
9088
9089 @item nix
9090 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
9091 @uref{https://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
9092 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
9093 @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
9094 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
9095 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
9096 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
9097 package definition.
9098
9099 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
9100 by their canonical upstream variant.
9101
9102 Usually, you will first need to do:
9103
9104 @example
9105 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
9106 @end example
9107
9108 @noindent
9109 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
9110
9111 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
9112 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
9113 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
9114
9115 @example
9116 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
9117 @end example
9118
9119 @item hackage
9120 @cindex hackage
9121 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
9122 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
9123 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
9124 dependencies.
9125
9126 Specific command-line options are:
9127
9128 @table @code
9129 @item --stdin
9130 @itemx -s
9131 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
9132 @item --no-test-dependencies
9133 @itemx -t
9134 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
9135 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
9136 @itemx -e @var{alist}
9137 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
9138 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
9139 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
9140 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
9141 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
9142 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
9143 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
9144 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
9145 @item --recursive
9146 @itemx -r
9147 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9148 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9149 in Guix.
9150 @end table
9151
9152 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
9153 @code{HTTP} Haskell package without including test dependencies and
9154 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
9155
9156 @example
9157 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
9158 @end example
9159
9160 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
9161 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
9162
9163 @example
9164 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
9165 @end example
9166
9167 @item stackage
9168 @cindex stackage
9169 The @code{stackage} importer is a wrapper around the @code{hackage} one.
9170 It takes a package name, looks up the package version included in a
9171 long-term support (LTS) @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage}
9172 release and uses the @code{hackage} importer to retrieve its metadata.
9173 Note that it is up to you to select an LTS release compatible with the
9174 GHC compiler used by Guix.
9175
9176 Specific command-line options are:
9177
9178 @table @code
9179 @item --no-test-dependencies
9180 @itemx -t
9181 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
9182 @item --lts-version=@var{version}
9183 @itemx -l @var{version}
9184 @var{version} is the desired LTS release version. If omitted the latest
9185 release is used.
9186 @item --recursive
9187 @itemx -r
9188 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9189 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9190 in Guix.
9191 @end table
9192
9193 The command below imports metadata for the @code{HTTP} Haskell package
9194 included in the LTS Stackage release version 7.18:
9195
9196 @example
9197 guix import stackage --lts-version=7.18 HTTP
9198 @end example
9199
9200 @item elpa
9201 @cindex elpa
9202 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
9203 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
9204
9205 Specific command-line options are:
9206
9207 @table @code
9208 @item --archive=@var{repo}
9209 @itemx -a @var{repo}
9210 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
9211 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
9212 are:
9213 @itemize -
9214 @item
9215 @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
9216 identifier. This is the default.
9217
9218 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
9219 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
9220 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
9221 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
9222 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
9223
9224 @item
9225 @uref{https://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
9226 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
9227
9228 @item
9229 @uref{https://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
9230 identifier.
9231 @end itemize
9232
9233 @item --recursive
9234 @itemx -r
9235 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9236 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9237 in Guix.
9238 @end table
9239
9240 @item crate
9241 @cindex crate
9242 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
9243 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}, as in this example:
9244
9245 @example
9246 guix import crate blake2-rfc
9247 @end example
9248
9249 The crate importer also allows you to specify a version string:
9250
9251 @example
9252 guix import crate constant-time-eq@@0.1.0
9253 @end example
9254
9255 Additional options include:
9256
9257 @table @code
9258 @item --recursive
9259 @itemx -r
9260 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
9261 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
9262 in Guix.
9263 @end table
9264
9265 @item opam
9266 @cindex OPAM
9267 @cindex OCaml
9268 Import metadata from the @uref{https://opam.ocaml.org/, OPAM} package
9269 repository used by the OCaml community.
9270 @end table
9271
9272 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
9273 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
9274 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
9275
9276 @node Invoking guix refresh
9277 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
9278
9279 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
9280 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
9281 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
9282 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
9283 upstream version, like this:
9284
9285 @example
9286 $ guix refresh
9287 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
9288 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
9289 @end example
9290
9291 Alternately, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
9292 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
9293
9294 @example
9295 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
9296 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
9297 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
9298 @end example
9299
9300 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
9301 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
9302 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
9303 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
9304 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
9305 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
9306 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
9307
9308 @table @code
9309
9310 @item --recursive
9311 Consider the packages specified, and all the packages upon which they depend.
9312
9313 @example
9314 $ guix refresh --recursive coreutils
9315 gnu/packages/acl.scm:35:2: warning: no updater for acl
9316 gnu/packages/m4.scm:30:12: info: 1.4.18 is already the latest version of m4
9317 gnu/packages/xml.scm:68:2: warning: no updater for expat
9318 gnu/packages/multiprecision.scm:40:12: info: 6.1.2 is already the latest version of gmp
9319 @dots{}
9320 @end example
9321
9322 @end table
9323
9324 Sometimes the upstream name differs from the package name used in Guix,
9325 and @command{guix refresh} needs a little help. Most updaters honor the
9326 @code{upstream-name} property in package definitions, which can be used
9327 to that effect:
9328
9329 @lisp
9330 (define-public network-manager
9331 (package
9332 (name "network-manager")
9333 ;; @dots{}
9334 (properties '((upstream-name . "NetworkManager")))))
9335 @end lisp
9336
9337 When passed @code{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
9338 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
9339 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
9340 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
9341 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
9342 using @command{gpgv}, and finally computing its hash---note that GnuPG must be
9343 installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install gnupg} if needed.
9344
9345 When the public
9346 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
9347 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
9348 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
9349 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
9350
9351 The following options are supported:
9352
9353 @table @code
9354
9355 @item --expression=@var{expr}
9356 @itemx -e @var{expr}
9357 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
9358
9359 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
9360
9361 @example
9362 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
9363 @end example
9364
9365 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
9366 the packages.)
9367
9368 @item --update
9369 @itemx -u
9370 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
9371 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
9372 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
9373
9374 @example
9375 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
9376 @end example
9377
9378 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
9379
9380 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
9381 @itemx -s @var{subset}
9382 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
9383 @code{non-core}.
9384
9385 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
9386 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
9387 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
9388 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
9389 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
9390 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
9391
9392 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
9393 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
9394 inconvenient.
9395
9396 @item --manifest=@var{file}
9397 @itemx -m @var{file}
9398 Select all the packages from the manifest in @var{file}. This is useful to
9399 check if any packages of the user manifest can be updated.
9400
9401 @item --type=@var{updater}
9402 @itemx -t @var{updater}
9403 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
9404 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
9405
9406 @table @code
9407 @item gnu
9408 the updater for GNU packages;
9409 @item gnome
9410 the updater for GNOME packages;
9411 @item kde
9412 the updater for KDE packages;
9413 @item xorg
9414 the updater for X.org packages;
9415 @item kernel.org
9416 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
9417 @item elpa
9418 the updater for @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
9419 @item cran
9420 the updater for @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
9421 @item bioconductor
9422 the updater for @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
9423 @item cpan
9424 the updater for @uref{https://www.cpan.org/, CPAN} packages;
9425 @item pypi
9426 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
9427 @item gem
9428 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
9429 @item github
9430 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
9431 @item hackage
9432 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
9433 @item stackage
9434 the updater for @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage} packages.
9435 @item crate
9436 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
9437 @item launchpad
9438 the updater for @uref{https://launchpad.net, Launchpad} packages.
9439 @end table
9440
9441 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
9442 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
9443
9444 @example
9445 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
9446 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
9447 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
9448 @end example
9449
9450 @end table
9451
9452 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
9453 names, as in this example:
9454
9455 @example
9456 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
9457 @end example
9458
9459 @noindent
9460 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
9461 @code{idutils} packages. The @code{--select} option would have no
9462 effect in this case.
9463
9464 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
9465 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
9466 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
9467 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
9468
9469 @table @code
9470
9471 @item --list-updaters
9472 @itemx -L
9473 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above.)
9474
9475 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
9476 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
9477
9478 @item --list-dependent
9479 @itemx -l
9480 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
9481 result of upgrading one or more packages.
9482
9483 @xref{Invoking guix graph, the @code{reverse-package} type of
9484 @command{guix graph}}, for information on how to visualize the list of
9485 dependents of a package.
9486
9487 @end table
9488
9489 Be aware that the @code{--list-dependent} option only
9490 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
9491 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
9492
9493 @example
9494 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
9495 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
9496 hop@@2.4.0 geiser@@0.4 notmuch@@0.18 mu@@0.9.9.5 cflow@@1.4 idutils@@4.6 @dots{}
9497 @end example
9498
9499 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
9500 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
9501
9502 @table @code
9503
9504 @item --list-transitive
9505 List all the packages which one or more packages depend upon.
9506
9507 @example
9508 $ guix refresh --list-transitive flex
9509 flex@@2.6.4 depends on the following 25 packages: perl@@5.28.0 help2man@@1.47.6
9510 bison@@3.0.5 indent@@2.2.10 tar@@1.30 gzip@@1.9 bzip2@@1.0.6 xz@@5.2.4 file@@5.33 @dots{}
9511 @end example
9512
9513 @end table
9514
9515 The command above lists a set of packages which, when changed, would cause
9516 @code{flex} to be rebuilt.
9517
9518 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
9519
9520 @table @code
9521
9522 @item --gpg=@var{command}
9523 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
9524 for in @code{$PATH}.
9525
9526 @item --keyring=@var{file}
9527 Use @var{file} as the keyring for upstream keys. @var{file} must be in the
9528 @dfn{keybox format}. Keybox files usually have a name ending in @file{.kbx}
9529 and the GNU@tie{}Privacy Guard (GPG) can manipulate these files
9530 (@pxref{kbxutil, @command{kbxutil},, gnupg, Using the GNU Privacy Guard}, for
9531 information on a tool to manipulate keybox files).
9532
9533 When this option is omitted, @command{guix refresh} uses
9534 @file{~/.config/guix/upstream/trustedkeys.kbx} as the keyring for upstream
9535 signing keys. OpenPGP signatures are checked against keys from this keyring;
9536 missing keys are downloaded to this keyring as well (see
9537 @option{--key-download} below.)
9538
9539 You can export keys from your default GPG keyring into a keybox file using
9540 commands like this one:
9541
9542 @example
9543 gpg --export rms@@gnu.org | kbxutil --import-openpgp >> mykeyring.kbx
9544 @end example
9545
9546 Likewise, you can fetch keys to a specific keybox file like this:
9547
9548 @example
9549 gpg --no-default-keyring --keyring mykeyring.kbx \
9550 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
9551 @end example
9552
9553 @ref{GPG Configuration Options, @option{--keyring},, gnupg, Using the GNU
9554 Privacy Guard}, for more information on GPG's @option{--keyring} option.
9555
9556 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
9557 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
9558 of:
9559
9560 @table @code
9561 @item always
9562 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
9563 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
9564
9565 @item never
9566 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
9567
9568 @item interactive
9569 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
9570 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
9571 @end table
9572
9573 @item --key-server=@var{host}
9574 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
9575
9576 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
9577 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
9578 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9579
9580 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
9581 the command-line tools.
9582
9583 @end table
9584
9585 The @code{github} updater uses the
9586 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
9587 releases. When used repeatedly e.g.@: when refreshing all packages,
9588 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
9589 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
9590 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
9591 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
9592 an API token, set the environment variable @code{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
9593 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
9594 otherwise.
9595
9596
9597 @node Invoking guix lint
9598 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
9599
9600 @cindex @command{guix lint}
9601 @cindex package, checking for errors
9602 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
9603 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
9604 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
9605 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
9606 @code{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
9607
9608 @table @code
9609 @item synopsis
9610 @itemx description
9611 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
9612 descriptions and synopses.
9613
9614 @item inputs-should-be-native
9615 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
9616
9617 @item source
9618 @itemx home-page
9619 @itemx mirror-url
9620 @itemx github-url
9621 @itemx source-file-name
9622 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
9623 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. If the
9624 @code{source} URL redirects to a GitHub URL, recommend usage of the GitHub
9625 URL. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g.@: is not just a
9626 version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared @code{file-name}
9627 (@pxref{origin Reference}).
9628
9629 @item source-unstable-tarball
9630 Parse the @code{source} URL to determine if a tarball from GitHub is
9631 autogenerated or if it is a release tarball. Unfortunately GitHub's
9632 autogenerated tarballs are sometimes regenerated.
9633
9634 @item archival
9635 @cindex Software Heritage, source code archive
9636 @cindex archival of source code, Software Heritage
9637 Checks whether the package's source code is archived at
9638 @uref{https://www.softwareheritage.org, Software Heritage}.
9639
9640 When the source code that is not archived comes from a version-control system
9641 (VCS)---e.g., it's obtained with @code{git-fetch}, send Software Heritage a
9642 ``save'' request so that it eventually archives it. This ensures that the
9643 source will remain available in the long term, and that Guix can fall back to
9644 Software Heritage should the source code disappear from its original host.
9645 The status of recent ``save'' requests can be
9646 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/save/#requests, viewed on-line}.
9647
9648 When source code is a tarball obtained with @code{url-fetch}, simply print a
9649 message when it is not archived. As of this writing, Software Heritage does
9650 not allow requests to save arbitrary tarballs; we are working on ways to
9651 ensure that non-VCS source code is also archived.
9652
9653 Software Heritage
9654 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/api/#rate-limiting, limits the
9655 request rate per IP address}. When the limit is reached, @command{guix lint}
9656 prints a message and the @code{archival} checker stops doing anything until
9657 that limit has been reset.
9658
9659 @item cve
9660 @cindex security vulnerabilities
9661 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
9662 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
9663 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
9664 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/vuln/data-feeds, published by the US
9665 NIST}.
9666
9667 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
9668
9669 @itemize
9670 @item
9671 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
9672 @item
9673 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
9674 @end itemize
9675
9676 @noindent
9677 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
9678 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
9679
9680 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
9681 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/products/cpe,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
9682 name and version of the package when they differ from the name or version
9683 that Guix uses, as in this example:
9684
9685 @lisp
9686 (package
9687 (name "grub")
9688 ;; @dots{}
9689 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
9690 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2")
9691 (cpe-version . "2.3"))))
9692 @end lisp
9693
9694 @c See <https://www.openwall.com/lists/oss-security/2017/03/15/3>.
9695 Some entries in the CVE database do not specify which version of a
9696 package they apply to, and would thus ``stick around'' forever. Package
9697 developers who found CVE alerts and verified they can be ignored can
9698 declare them as in this example:
9699
9700 @lisp
9701 (package
9702 (name "t1lib")
9703 ;; @dots{}
9704 ;; These CVEs no longer apply and can be safely ignored.
9705 (properties `((lint-hidden-cve . ("CVE-2011-0433"
9706 "CVE-2011-1553"
9707 "CVE-2011-1554"
9708 "CVE-2011-5244")))))
9709 @end lisp
9710
9711 @item formatting
9712 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
9713 use of tabulations, etc.
9714 @end table
9715
9716 The general syntax is:
9717
9718 @example
9719 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
9720 @end example
9721
9722 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
9723 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
9724
9725 @table @code
9726 @item --list-checkers
9727 @itemx -l
9728 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
9729 and exit.
9730
9731 @item --checkers
9732 @itemx -c
9733 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
9734 names returned by @code{--list-checkers}.
9735
9736 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
9737 @itemx -L @var{directory}
9738 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
9739 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9740
9741 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
9742 the command-line tools.
9743
9744 @end table
9745
9746 @node Invoking guix size
9747 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
9748
9749 @cindex size
9750 @cindex package size
9751 @cindex closure
9752 @cindex @command{guix size}
9753 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
9754 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
9755 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
9756 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
9757 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
9758 @command{guix size} can highlight.
9759
9760 The command can be passed one or more package specifications
9761 such as @code{gcc@@4.8}
9762 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
9763 example:
9764
9765 @example
9766 $ guix size coreutils
9767 store item total self
9768 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-5.5.0-lib 60.4 30.1 38.1%
9769 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.27 30.3 28.8 36.6%
9770 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.28 78.9 15.0 19.0%
9771 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.1.2 63.1 2.7 3.4%
9772 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-static-4.4.12 1.5 1.5 1.9%
9773 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 61.1 0.4 0.5%
9774 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.47 60.6 0.2 0.3%
9775 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libcap-2.25 60.5 0.2 0.2%
9776 total: 78.9 MiB
9777 @end example
9778
9779 @cindex closure
9780 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
9781 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
9782 would be returned by:
9783
9784 @example
9785 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
9786 @end example
9787
9788 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
9789 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
9790 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
9791 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
9792 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
9793 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
9794
9795 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
9796 79@tie{}MiB, most of which is taken by libc and GCC's run-time support
9797 libraries. (That libc and GCC's libraries represent a large fraction of
9798 the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because they are always available
9799 on the system anyway.)
9800
9801 When the package(s) passed to @command{guix size} are available in the
9802 store@footnote{More precisely, @command{guix size} looks for the
9803 @emph{ungrafted} variant of the given package(s), as returned by
9804 @code{guix build @var{package} --no-grafts}. @xref{Security Updates},
9805 for information on grafts.}, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
9806 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
9807 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
9808 Coreutils}).
9809
9810 When the given packages are @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
9811 reports information based on the available substitutes
9812 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
9813 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
9814
9815 You can also specify several package names:
9816
9817 @example
9818 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
9819 store item total self
9820 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
9821 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
9822 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
9823 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
9824 @dots{}
9825 total: 102.3 MiB
9826 @end example
9827
9828 @noindent
9829 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
9830 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
9831 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
9832
9833 The available options are:
9834
9835 @table @option
9836
9837 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
9838 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
9839 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
9840
9841 @item --sort=@var{key}
9842 Sort lines according to @var{key}, one of the following options:
9843
9844 @table @code
9845 @item self
9846 the size of each item (the default);
9847 @item closure
9848 the total size of the item's closure.
9849 @end table
9850
9851 @item --map-file=@var{file}
9852 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
9853
9854 For the example above, the map looks like this:
9855
9856 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
9857 produced by @command{guix size}}
9858
9859 This option requires that
9860 @uref{https://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
9861 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
9862 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
9863
9864 @item --system=@var{system}
9865 @itemx -s @var{system}
9866 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
9867
9868 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
9869 @itemx -L @var{directory}
9870 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
9871 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9872
9873 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
9874 the command-line tools.
9875 @end table
9876
9877 @node Invoking guix graph
9878 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
9879
9880 @cindex DAG
9881 @cindex @command{guix graph}
9882 @cindex package dependencies
9883 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
9884 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
9885 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
9886 provides a visual representation of the DAG. By default,
9887 @command{guix graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
9888 @uref{https://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
9889 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. It can also emit an
9890 HTML page with embedded JavaScript code to display a ``chord diagram''
9891 in a Web browser, using the @uref{https://d3js.org/, d3.js} library, or
9892 emit Cypher queries to construct a graph in a graph database supporting
9893 the @uref{https://www.opencypher.org/, openCypher} query language.
9894 The general syntax is:
9895
9896 @example
9897 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
9898 @end example
9899
9900 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
9901 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
9902 dependencies:
9903
9904 @example
9905 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
9906 @end example
9907
9908 The output looks like this:
9909
9910 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
9911
9912 Nice little graph, no?
9913
9914 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
9915 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
9916 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
9917 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
9918 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
9919
9920 @table @code
9921 @item package
9922 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
9923 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
9924 filters out many details.
9925
9926 @item reverse-package
9927 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. For example:
9928
9929 @example
9930 guix graph --type=reverse-package ocaml
9931 @end example
9932
9933 ...@: yields the graph of packages that @emph{explicitly} depend on OCaml (if
9934 you are also interested in cases where OCaml is an implicit dependency, see
9935 @code{reverse-bag} below.)
9936
9937 Note that for core packages this can yield huge graphs. If all you want
9938 is to know the number of packages that depend on a given package, use
9939 @command{guix refresh --list-dependent} (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh,
9940 @option{--list-dependent}}).
9941
9942 @item bag-emerged
9943 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
9944
9945 For instance, the following command:
9946
9947 @example
9948 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
9949 @end example
9950
9951 ...@: yields this bigger graph:
9952
9953 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
9954
9955 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
9956 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
9957
9958 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
9959 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
9960 here, for conciseness.
9961
9962 @item bag
9963 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
9964 dependencies.
9965
9966 @item bag-with-origins
9967 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
9968
9969 @item reverse-bag
9970 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. Unlike @code{reverse-package},
9971 it also takes implicit dependencies into account. For example:
9972
9973 @example
9974 guix graph -t reverse-bag dune
9975 @end example
9976
9977 @noindent
9978 ...@: yields the graph of all packages that depend on Dune, directly or
9979 indirectly. Since Dune is an @emph{implicit} dependency of many packages
9980 @i{via} @code{dune-build-system}, this shows a large number of packages,
9981 whereas @code{reverse-package} would show very few if any.
9982
9983 @item derivation
9984 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
9985 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
9986 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
9987 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
9988
9989 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
9990 name instead of a package name, as in:
9991
9992 @example
9993 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
9994 @end example
9995
9996 @item module
9997 This is the graph of @dfn{package modules} (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9998 For example, the following command shows the graph for the package
9999 module that defines the @code{guile} package:
10000
10001 @example
10002 guix graph -t module guile | dot -Tpdf > module-graph.pdf
10003 @end example
10004 @end table
10005
10006 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
10007 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
10008
10009 @table @code
10010 @item references
10011 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
10012 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
10013
10014 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
10015 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
10016
10017 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
10018 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
10019 (which can be big!):
10020
10021 @example
10022 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
10023 @end example
10024
10025 @item referrers
10026 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
10027 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
10028
10029 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
10030 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
10031 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
10032 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
10033 to it.
10034
10035 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
10036 collected.
10037
10038 @end table
10039
10040 The available options are the following:
10041
10042 @table @option
10043 @item --type=@var{type}
10044 @itemx -t @var{type}
10045 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
10046 the values listed above.
10047
10048 @item --list-types
10049 List the supported graph types.
10050
10051 @item --backend=@var{backend}
10052 @itemx -b @var{backend}
10053 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
10054
10055 @item --list-backends
10056 List the supported graph backends.
10057
10058 Currently, the available backends are Graphviz and d3.js.
10059
10060 @item --expression=@var{expr}
10061 @itemx -e @var{expr}
10062 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
10063
10064 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
10065
10066 @example
10067 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
10068 @end example
10069
10070 @item --system=@var{system}
10071 @itemx -s @var{system}
10072 Display the graph for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
10073
10074 The package dependency graph is largely architecture-independent, but there
10075 are some architecture-dependent bits that this option allows you to visualize.
10076
10077 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
10078 @itemx -L @var{directory}
10079 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
10080 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10081
10082 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
10083 the command-line tools.
10084 @end table
10085
10086 On top of that, @command{guix graph} supports all the usual package
10087 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}). This
10088 makes it easy to view the effect of a graph-rewriting transformation
10089 such as @option{--with-input}. For example, the command below outputs
10090 the graph of @code{git} once @code{openssl} has been replaced by
10091 @code{libressl} everywhere in the graph:
10092
10093 @example
10094 guix graph git --with-input=openssl=libressl
10095 @end example
10096
10097 So many possibilities, so much fun!
10098
10099 @node Invoking guix publish
10100 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
10101
10102 @cindex @command{guix publish}
10103 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
10104 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
10105 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
10106
10107 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
10108 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
10109 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
10110 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Cuirass, the software behind
10111 the @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} build farm.
10112
10113 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
10114 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
10115 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
10116 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
10117 @code{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
10118
10119 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
10120 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
10121 guix archive}).
10122
10123 The general syntax is:
10124
10125 @example
10126 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
10127 @end example
10128
10129 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
10130 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
10131
10132 @example
10133 guix publish
10134 @end example
10135
10136 Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
10137 archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
10138
10139 @example
10140 guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
10141 @end example
10142
10143 By default, @command{guix publish} compresses archives on the fly as it
10144 serves them. This ``on-the-fly'' mode is convenient in that it requires
10145 no setup and is immediately available. However, when serving lots of
10146 clients, we recommend using the @option{--cache} option, which enables
10147 caching of the archives before they are sent to clients---see below for
10148 details. The @command{guix weather} command provides a handy way to
10149 check what a server provides (@pxref{Invoking guix weather}).
10150
10151 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
10152 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
10153 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
10154 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
10155 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
10156 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
10157
10158 @example
10159 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
10160 @end example
10161
10162 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
10163 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
10164
10165 @cindex build logs, publication
10166 Build logs are available from @code{/log} URLs like:
10167
10168 @example
10169 http://example.org/log/gwspk@dots{}-guile-2.2.3
10170 @end example
10171
10172 @noindent
10173 When @command{guix-daemon} is configured to save compressed build logs,
10174 as is the case by default (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}), @code{/log}
10175 URLs return the compressed log as-is, with an appropriate
10176 @code{Content-Type} and/or @code{Content-Encoding} header. We recommend
10177 running @command{guix-daemon} with @code{--log-compression=gzip} since
10178 Web browsers can automatically decompress it, which is not the case with
10179 bzip2 compression.
10180
10181 The following options are available:
10182
10183 @table @code
10184 @item --port=@var{port}
10185 @itemx -p @var{port}
10186 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
10187
10188 @item --listen=@var{host}
10189 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
10190 accept connections from any interface.
10191
10192 @item --user=@var{user}
10193 @itemx -u @var{user}
10194 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
10195 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
10196
10197 @item --compression[=@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
10198 @itemx -C [@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
10199 Compress data using the given @var{method} and @var{level}. @var{method} is
10200 one of @code{lzip} and @code{gzip}; when @var{method} is omitted, @code{gzip}
10201 is used.
10202
10203 When @var{level} is zero, disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds
10204 to different compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best
10205 (CPU-intensive). The default is 3.
10206
10207 Usually, @code{lzip} compresses noticeably better than @code{gzip} for a small
10208 increase in CPU usage; see
10209 @uref{https://nongnu.org/lzip/lzip_benchmark.html,benchmarks on the lzip Web
10210 page}.
10211
10212 Unless @option{--cache} is used, compression occurs on the fly and
10213 the compressed streams are not
10214 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
10215 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, to
10216 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy, or to use
10217 @option{--cache}. Using @option{--cache} has the advantage that it
10218 allows @command{guix publish} to add @code{Content-Length} HTTP header
10219 to its responses.
10220
10221 This option can be repeated, in which case every substitute gets compressed
10222 using all the selected methods, and all of them are advertised. This is
10223 useful when users may not support all the compression methods: they can select
10224 the one they support.
10225
10226 @item --cache=@var{directory}
10227 @itemx -c @var{directory}
10228 Cache archives and meta-data (@code{.narinfo} URLs) to @var{directory}
10229 and only serve archives that are in cache.
10230
10231 When this option is omitted, archives and meta-data are created
10232 on-the-fly. This can reduce the available bandwidth, especially when
10233 compression is enabled, since this may become CPU-bound. Another
10234 drawback of the default mode is that the length of archives is not known
10235 in advance, so @command{guix publish} does not add a
10236 @code{Content-Length} HTTP header to its responses, which in turn
10237 prevents clients from knowing the amount of data being downloaded.
10238
10239 Conversely, when @option{--cache} is used, the first request for a store
10240 item (@i{via} a @code{.narinfo} URL) returns 404 and triggers a
10241 background process to @dfn{bake} the archive---computing its
10242 @code{.narinfo} and compressing the archive, if needed. Once the
10243 archive is cached in @var{directory}, subsequent requests succeed and
10244 are served directly from the cache, which guarantees that clients get
10245 the best possible bandwidth.
10246
10247 The ``baking'' process is performed by worker threads. By default, one
10248 thread per CPU core is created, but this can be customized. See
10249 @option{--workers} below.
10250
10251 When @option{--ttl} is used, cached entries are automatically deleted
10252 when they have expired.
10253
10254 @item --workers=@var{N}
10255 When @option{--cache} is used, request the allocation of @var{N} worker
10256 threads to ``bake'' archives.
10257
10258 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
10259 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
10260 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
10261 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
10262
10263 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
10264 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
10265 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
10266 for as long as @var{ttl}.
10267
10268 Additionally, when @option{--cache} is used, cached entries that have
10269 not been accessed for @var{ttl} and that no longer have a corresponding
10270 item in the store, may be deleted.
10271
10272 @item --nar-path=@var{path}
10273 Use @var{path} as the prefix for the URLs of ``nar'' files
10274 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive, normalized archives}).
10275
10276 By default, nars are served at a URL such as
10277 @code{/nar/gzip/@dots{}-coreutils-8.25}. This option allows you to
10278 change the @code{/nar} part to @var{path}.
10279
10280 @item --public-key=@var{file}
10281 @itemx --private-key=@var{file}
10282 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
10283 the store items being published.
10284
10285 The files must correspond to the same key pair (the private key is used
10286 for signing and the public key is merely advertised in the signature
10287 metadata). They must contain keys in the canonical s-expression format
10288 as produced by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
10289 guix archive}). By default, @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.pub} and
10290 @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.sec} are used.
10291
10292 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
10293 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
10294 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
10295 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
10296 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
10297 @end table
10298
10299 Enabling @command{guix publish} on Guix System is a one-liner: just
10300 instantiate a @code{guix-publish-service-type} service in the @code{services} field
10301 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service-type,
10302 @code{guix-publish-service-type}}).
10303
10304 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
10305 instructions:
10306
10307 @itemize
10308 @item
10309 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
10310
10311 @example
10312 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
10313 /etc/systemd/system/
10314 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
10315 @end example
10316
10317 @item
10318 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
10319
10320 @example
10321 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
10322 # start guix-publish
10323 @end example
10324
10325 @item
10326 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
10327 @end itemize
10328
10329 @node Invoking guix challenge
10330 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
10331
10332 @cindex reproducible builds
10333 @cindex verifiable builds
10334 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
10335 @cindex challenge
10336 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
10337 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
10338 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
10339 answer.
10340
10341 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
10342 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
10343 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
10344 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
10345 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
10346 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
10347 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
10348
10349 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
10350 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
10351 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
10352 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
10353 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
10354 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
10355 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
10356 any given store item.
10357
10358 The command output looks like this:
10359
10360 @smallexample
10361 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
10362 updating list of substitutes from 'https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'... 100.0%
10363 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
10364 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
10365 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
10366 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
10367 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
10368 differing files:
10369 /lib/libcrypto.so.1.1
10370 /lib/libssl.so.1.1
10371
10372 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
10373 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
10374 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
10375 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
10376 differing file:
10377 /libexec/git-core/git-fsck
10378
10379 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
10380 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
10381 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
10382 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
10383 differing file:
10384 /share/man/man1/pius.1.gz
10385
10386 @dots{}
10387
10388 6,406 store items were analyzed:
10389 - 4,749 (74.1%) were identical
10390 - 525 (8.2%) differed
10391 - 1,132 (17.7%) were inconclusive
10392 @end smallexample
10393
10394 @noindent
10395 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
10396 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
10397 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
10398 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
10399 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
10400
10401 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
10402 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
10403 Conversely, @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} agrees with local builds, except in the
10404 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
10405 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
10406 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
10407 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
10408 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
10409 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
10410 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
10411 more information.
10412
10413 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, the easiest approach is
10414 to run:
10415
10416 @example
10417 guix challenge git \
10418 --diff=diffoscope \
10419 --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
10420 @end example
10421
10422 This automatically invokes @command{diffoscope}, which displays detailed
10423 information about files that differ.
10424
10425 Alternately, we can do something along these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix
10426 archive}):
10427
10428 @example
10429 $ wget -q -O - https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
10430 | guix archive -x /tmp/git
10431 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
10432 @end example
10433
10434 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
10435 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
10436 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
10437 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
10438 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
10439 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
10440 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
10441
10442 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
10443 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
10444 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
10445 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
10446 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
10447 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
10448 the problem.
10449
10450 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
10451 whether @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} and other substitute servers obtain the
10452 same build result as you did with:
10453
10454 @example
10455 $ guix challenge @var{package}
10456 @end example
10457
10458 @noindent
10459 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
10460 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
10461
10462 The general syntax is:
10463
10464 @example
10465 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
10466 @end example
10467
10468 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
10469 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
10470 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
10471 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
10472 errors.)
10473
10474 The one option that matters is:
10475
10476 @table @code
10477
10478 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10479 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
10480 URLs to compare to.
10481
10482 @item --diff=@var{mode}
10483 Upon mismatches, show differences according to @var{mode}, one of:
10484
10485 @table @asis
10486 @item @code{simple} (the default)
10487 Show the list of files that differ.
10488
10489 @item @code{diffoscope}
10490 @itemx @var{command}
10491 Invoke @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, passing it
10492 two directories whose contents do not match.
10493
10494 When @var{command} is an absolute file name, run @var{command} instead
10495 of Diffoscope.
10496
10497 @item @code{none}
10498 Do not show further details about the differences.
10499 @end table
10500
10501 Thus, unless @code{--diff=none} is passed, @command{guix challenge}
10502 downloads the store items from the given substitute servers so that it
10503 can compare them.
10504
10505 @item --verbose
10506 @itemx -v
10507 Show details about matches (identical contents) in addition to
10508 information about mismatches.
10509
10510 @end table
10511
10512 @node Invoking guix copy
10513 @section Invoking @command{guix copy}
10514
10515 @cindex copy, of store items, over SSH
10516 @cindex SSH, copy of store items
10517 @cindex sharing store items across machines
10518 @cindex transferring store items across machines
10519 The @command{guix copy} command copies items from the store of one
10520 machine to that of another machine over a secure shell (SSH)
10521 connection@footnote{This command is available only when Guile-SSH was
10522 found. @xref{Requirements}, for details.}. For example, the following
10523 command copies the @code{coreutils} package, the user's profile, and all
10524 their dependencies over to @var{host}, logged in as @var{user}:
10525
10526 @example
10527 guix copy --to=@var{user}@@@var{host} \
10528 coreutils `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
10529 @end example
10530
10531 If some of the items to be copied are already present on @var{host},
10532 they are not actually sent.
10533
10534 The command below retrieves @code{libreoffice} and @code{gimp} from
10535 @var{host}, assuming they are available there:
10536
10537 @example
10538 guix copy --from=@var{host} libreoffice gimp
10539 @end example
10540
10541 The SSH connection is established using the Guile-SSH client, which is
10542 compatible with OpenSSH: it honors @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} and
10543 @file{~/.ssh/config}, and uses the SSH agent for authentication.
10544
10545 The key used to sign items that are sent must be accepted by the remote
10546 machine. Likewise, the key used by the remote machine to sign items you
10547 are retrieving must be in @file{/etc/guix/acl} so it is accepted by your
10548 own daemon. @xref{Invoking guix archive}, for more information about
10549 store item authentication.
10550
10551 The general syntax is:
10552
10553 @example
10554 guix copy [--to=@var{spec}|--from=@var{spec}] @var{items}@dots{}
10555 @end example
10556
10557 You must always specify one of the following options:
10558
10559 @table @code
10560 @item --to=@var{spec}
10561 @itemx --from=@var{spec}
10562 Specify the host to send to or receive from. @var{spec} must be an SSH
10563 spec such as @code{example.org}, @code{charlie@@example.org}, or
10564 @code{charlie@@example.org:2222}.
10565 @end table
10566
10567 The @var{items} can be either package names, such as @code{gimp}, or
10568 store items, such as @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-idutils-4.6}.
10569
10570 When specifying the name of a package to send, it is first built if
10571 needed, unless @option{--dry-run} was specified. Common build options
10572 are supported (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
10573
10574
10575 @node Invoking guix container
10576 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
10577 @cindex container
10578 @cindex @command{guix container}
10579 @quotation Note
10580 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
10581 is subject to radical change in the future.
10582 @end quotation
10583
10584 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
10585 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
10586 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
10587 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
10588 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
10589
10590 The general syntax is:
10591
10592 @example
10593 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
10594 @end example
10595
10596 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
10597 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
10598
10599 The following actions are available:
10600
10601 @table @code
10602 @item exec
10603 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
10604
10605 The syntax is:
10606
10607 @example
10608 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
10609 @end example
10610
10611 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
10612 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
10613 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
10614 will be passed to @var{program}.
10615
10616 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
10617 Guix system container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
10618 process ID is 9001:
10619
10620 @example
10621 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
10622 @end example
10623
10624 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
10625 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
10626
10627 @end table
10628
10629 @node Invoking guix weather
10630 @section Invoking @command{guix weather}
10631
10632 Occasionally you're grumpy because substitutes are lacking and you end
10633 up building packages by yourself (@pxref{Substitutes}). The
10634 @command{guix weather} command reports on substitute availability on the
10635 specified servers so you can have an idea of whether you'll be grumpy
10636 today. It can sometimes be useful info as a user, but it is primarily
10637 useful to people running @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking guix
10638 publish}).
10639
10640 @cindex statistics, for substitutes
10641 @cindex availability of substitutes
10642 @cindex substitute availability
10643 @cindex weather, substitute availability
10644 Here's a sample run:
10645
10646 @example
10647 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=https://guix.example.org
10648 computing 5,872 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
10649 looking for 6,128 store items on https://guix.example.org..
10650 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
10651 https://guix.example.org
10652 43.4% substitutes available (2,658 out of 6,128)
10653 7,032.5 MiB of nars (compressed)
10654 19,824.2 MiB on disk (uncompressed)
10655 0.030 seconds per request (182.9 seconds in total)
10656 33.5 requests per second
10657
10658 9.8% (342 out of 3,470) of the missing items are queued
10659 867 queued builds
10660 x86_64-linux: 518 (59.7%)
10661 i686-linux: 221 (25.5%)
10662 aarch64-linux: 128 (14.8%)
10663 build rate: 23.41 builds per hour
10664 x86_64-linux: 11.16 builds per hour
10665 i686-linux: 6.03 builds per hour
10666 aarch64-linux: 6.41 builds per hour
10667 @end example
10668
10669 @cindex continuous integration, statistics
10670 As you can see, it reports the fraction of all the packages for which
10671 substitutes are available on the server---regardless of whether
10672 substitutes are enabled, and regardless of whether this server's signing
10673 key is authorized. It also reports the size of the compressed archives
10674 (``nars'') provided by the server, the size the corresponding store
10675 items occupy in the store (assuming deduplication is turned off), and
10676 the server's throughput. The second part gives continuous integration
10677 (CI) statistics, if the server supports it. In addition, using the
10678 @option{--coverage} option, @command{guix weather} can list ``important''
10679 package substitutes missing on the server (see below).
10680
10681 To achieve that, @command{guix weather} queries over HTTP(S) meta-data
10682 (@dfn{narinfos}) for all the relevant store items. Like @command{guix
10683 challenge}, it ignores signatures on those substitutes, which is
10684 innocuous since the command only gathers statistics and cannot install
10685 those substitutes.
10686
10687 The general syntax is:
10688
10689 @example
10690 guix weather @var{options}@dots{} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
10691 @end example
10692
10693 When @var{packages} is omitted, @command{guix weather} checks the availability
10694 of substitutes for @emph{all} the packages, or for those specified with
10695 @option{--manifest}; otherwise it only considers the specified packages. It
10696 is also possible to query specific system types with @option{--system}. The
10697 available options are listed below.
10698
10699 @table @code
10700 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10701 @var{urls} is the space-separated list of substitute server URLs to
10702 query. When this option is omitted, the default set of substitute
10703 servers is queried.
10704
10705 @item --system=@var{system}
10706 @itemx -s @var{system}
10707 Query substitutes for @var{system}---e.g., @code{aarch64-linux}. This
10708 option can be repeated, in which case @command{guix weather} will query
10709 substitutes for several system types.
10710
10711 @item --manifest=@var{file}
10712 Instead of querying substitutes for all the packages, only ask for those
10713 specified in @var{file}. @var{file} must contain a @dfn{manifest}, as
10714 with the @code{-m} option of @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking
10715 guix package}).
10716
10717 @item --coverage[=@var{count}]
10718 @itemx -c [@var{count}]
10719 Report on substitute coverage for packages: list packages with at least
10720 @var{count} dependents (zero by default) for which substitutes are
10721 unavailable. Dependent packages themselves are not listed: if @var{b} depends
10722 on @var{a} and @var{a} has no substitutes, only @var{a} is listed, even though
10723 @var{b} usually lacks substitutes as well. The result looks like this:
10724
10725 @example
10726 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL} -c 10
10727 computing 8,983 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
10728 looking for 9,343 store items on @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}...
10729 updating substitutes from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}'... 100.0%
10730 @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}
10731 64.7% substitutes available (6,047 out of 9,343)
10732 @dots{}
10733 2502 packages are missing from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}' for 'x86_64-linux', among which:
10734 58 kcoreaddons@@5.49.0 /gnu/store/@dots{}-kcoreaddons-5.49.0
10735 46 qgpgme@@1.11.1 /gnu/store/@dots{}-qgpgme-1.11.1
10736 37 perl-http-cookiejar@@0.008 /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-http-cookiejar-0.008
10737 @dots{}
10738 @end example
10739
10740 What this example shows is that @code{kcoreaddons} and presumably the 58
10741 packages that depend on it have no substitutes at @code{ci.guix.info};
10742 likewise for @code{qgpgme} and the 46 packages that depend on it.
10743
10744 If you are a Guix developer, or if you are taking care of this build farm,
10745 you'll probably want to have a closer look at these packages: they may simply
10746 fail to build.
10747 @end table
10748
10749 @node Invoking guix processes
10750 @section Invoking @command{guix processes}
10751
10752 The @command{guix processes} command can be useful to developers and system
10753 administrators, especially on multi-user machines and on build farms: it lists
10754 the current sessions (connections to the daemon), as well as information about
10755 the processes involved@footnote{Remote sessions, when @command{guix-daemon} is
10756 started with @option{--listen} specifying a TCP endpoint, are @emph{not}
10757 listed.}. Here's an example of the information it returns:
10758
10759 @example
10760 $ sudo guix processes
10761 SessionPID: 19002
10762 ClientPID: 19090
10763 ClientCommand: guix environment --ad-hoc python
10764
10765 SessionPID: 19402
10766 ClientPID: 19367
10767 ClientCommand: guix publish -u guix-publish -p 3000 -C 9 @dots{}
10768
10769 SessionPID: 19444
10770 ClientPID: 19419
10771 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
10772 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-ipc-cmd-0.96.lock
10773 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-python-six-bootstrap-1.11.0.lock
10774 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-libjpeg-turbo-2.0.0.lock
10775 ChildProcess: 20495: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10776 ChildProcess: 27733: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10777 ChildProcess: 27793: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10778 @end example
10779
10780 In this example we see that @command{guix-daemon} has three clients:
10781 @command{guix environment}, @command{guix publish}, and the Cuirass continuous
10782 integration tool; their process identifier (PID) is given by the
10783 @code{ClientPID} field. The @code{SessionPID} field gives the PID of the
10784 @command{guix-daemon} sub-process of this particular session.
10785
10786 The @code{LockHeld} fields show which store items are currently locked by this
10787 session, which corresponds to store items being built or substituted (the
10788 @code{LockHeld} field is not displayed when @command{guix processes} is not
10789 running as root.) Last, by looking at the @code{ChildProcess} field, we
10790 understand that these three builds are being offloaded (@pxref{Daemon Offload
10791 Setup}).
10792
10793 The output is in Recutils format so we can use the handy @command{recsel}
10794 command to select sessions of interest (@pxref{Selection Expressions,,,
10795 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). As an example, the command shows the command
10796 line and PID of the client that triggered the build of a Perl package:
10797
10798 @example
10799 $ sudo guix processes | \
10800 recsel -p ClientPID,ClientCommand -e 'LockHeld ~ "perl"'
10801 ClientPID: 19419
10802 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
10803 @end example
10804
10805 @node System Configuration
10806 @chapter System Configuration
10807
10808 @cindex system configuration
10809 Guix System supports a consistent whole-system configuration
10810 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
10811 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
10812 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
10813 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
10814
10815 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
10816 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
10817 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
10818 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
10819 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
10820 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
10821 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
10822 the own tools of the system.
10823 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
10824
10825 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
10826 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
10827 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
10828 instance to support new system services.
10829
10830 @menu
10831 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
10832 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
10833 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
10834 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
10835 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
10836 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
10837 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
10838 * Services:: Specifying system services.
10839 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
10840 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
10841 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
10842 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
10843 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
10844 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
10845 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
10846 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
10847 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
10848 @end menu
10849
10850 @node Using the Configuration System
10851 @section Using the Configuration System
10852
10853 The operating system is configured by providing an
10854 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
10855 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
10856 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
10857 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
10858
10859 @findex operating-system
10860 @lisp
10861 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
10862 @end lisp
10863
10864 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
10865 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
10866 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
10867 which case they get a default value.
10868
10869 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
10870 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
10871 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
10872 @command{guix system}.
10873
10874 @unnumberedsubsec Bootloader
10875
10876 @cindex legacy boot, on Intel machines
10877 @cindex BIOS boot, on Intel machines
10878 @cindex UEFI boot
10879 @cindex EFI boot
10880 The @code{bootloader} field describes the method that will be used to boot
10881 your system. Machines based on Intel processors can boot in ``legacy'' BIOS
10882 mode, as in the example above. However, more recent machines rely instead on
10883 the @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI) to boot. In that case,
10884 the @code{bootloader} field should contain something along these lines:
10885
10886 @lisp
10887 (bootloader-configuration
10888 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
10889 (target "/boot/efi"))
10890 @end lisp
10891
10892 @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more information on the available
10893 configuration options.
10894
10895 @unnumberedsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
10896
10897 @vindex %base-packages
10898 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
10899 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @code{PATH}
10900 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
10901 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @code{%base-packages} variable
10902 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
10903 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
10904 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
10905 etc. The example above adds GNU@tie{}Screen to those,
10906 taken from the @code{(gnu packages screen)}
10907 module (@pxref{Package Modules}). The
10908 @code{(list package output)} syntax can be used to add a specific output
10909 of a package:
10910
10911 @lisp
10912 (use-modules (gnu packages))
10913 (use-modules (gnu packages dns))
10914
10915 (operating-system
10916 ;; ...
10917 (packages (cons (list bind "utils")
10918 %base-packages)))
10919 @end lisp
10920
10921 @findex specification->package
10922 Referring to packages by variable name, like @code{bind} above, has
10923 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
10924 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
10925 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
10926 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
10927 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
10928 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
10929 version:
10930
10931 @lisp
10932 (use-modules (gnu packages))
10933
10934 (operating-system
10935 ;; ...
10936 (packages (append (map specification->package
10937 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
10938 %base-packages)))
10939 @end lisp
10940
10941 @unnumberedsubsec System Services
10942
10943 @cindex services
10944 @vindex %base-services
10945 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
10946 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
10947 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
10948 addition to the basic services, we want the OpenSSH secure shell
10949 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
10950 @code{openssh-service-type}}). Under the hood,
10951 @code{openssh-service-type} arranges so that @command{sshd} is started with the
10952 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
10953 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
10954
10955 @cindex customization, of services
10956 @findex modify-services
10957 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
10958 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
10959 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
10960
10961 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
10962 (the console log-in) in the @code{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
10963 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
10964 following in your operating system declaration:
10965
10966 @lisp
10967 (define %my-services
10968 ;; My very own list of services.
10969 (modify-services %base-services
10970 (guix-service-type config =>
10971 (guix-configuration
10972 (inherit config)
10973 (use-substitutes? #f)
10974 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
10975 (mingetty-service-type config =>
10976 (mingetty-configuration
10977 (inherit config)))))
10978
10979 (operating-system
10980 ;; @dots{}
10981 (services %my-services))
10982 @end lisp
10983
10984 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
10985 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
10986 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @code{%base-services} list.
10987 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
10988 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
10989 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
10990 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
10991 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
10992 configuration, but with a few modifications.
10993
10994 @cindex encrypted disk
10995 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
10996 root partition, the X11 display
10997 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
10998 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
10999 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
11000
11001 @lisp
11002 @include os-config-desktop.texi
11003 @end lisp
11004
11005 A graphical system with a choice of lightweight window managers
11006 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
11007
11008 @lisp
11009 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
11010 @end lisp
11011
11012 This example refers to the @file{/boot/efi} file system by its UUID,
11013 @code{1234-ABCD}. Replace this UUID with the right UUID on your system,
11014 as returned by the @command{blkid} command.
11015
11016 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
11017 @code{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
11018 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
11019
11020 Again, @code{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
11021 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
11022 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
11023 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
11024 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
11025 @code{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
11026
11027 @lisp
11028 (remove (lambda (service)
11029 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
11030 %desktop-services)
11031 @end lisp
11032
11033 @unnumberedsubsec Instantiating the System
11034
11035 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
11036 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
11037 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
11038 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
11039 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
11040
11041 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
11042 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
11043 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
11044 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
11045 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
11046 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
11047 system, should you ever need to.
11048
11049 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
11050 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
11051 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
11052 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
11053 an entry in the bootloader boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
11054 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
11055 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
11056 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
11057 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
11058 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
11059
11060 Although the @command{guix system reconfigure} command will not modify
11061 previous generations, you must take care when the current generation is not
11062 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
11063 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
11064 system}).
11065
11066 @unnumberedsubsec The Programming Interface
11067
11068 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
11069 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
11070 Monad}):
11071
11072 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
11073 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
11074 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
11075
11076 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
11077 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
11078 instantiate @var{os}.
11079 @end deffn
11080
11081 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
11082 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
11083 guts of Guix System. Make sure to visit it!
11084
11085
11086 @node operating-system Reference
11087 @section @code{operating-system} Reference
11088
11089 This section summarizes all the options available in
11090 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
11091 System}).
11092
11093 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
11094 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
11095 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
11096 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
11097
11098 @table @asis
11099 @item @code{kernel} (default: @var{linux-libre})
11100 The package object of the operating system kernel to use@footnote{Currently
11101 only the Linux-libre kernel is supported. In the future, it will be
11102 possible to use the GNU@tie{}Hurd.}.
11103
11104 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{'("quiet")})
11105 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
11106 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
11107
11108 @item @code{bootloader}
11109 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}.
11110
11111 @item @code{label}
11112 This is the label (a string) as it appears in the bootloader's menu entry.
11113 The default label includes the kernel name and version.
11114
11115 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
11116 This field specifies the keyboard layout to use in the console. It can be
11117 either @code{#f}, in which case the default keyboard layout is used (usually
11118 US English), or a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record.
11119
11120 This keyboard layout is in effect as soon as the kernel has booted. For
11121 instance, it is the keyboard layout in effect when you type a passphrase if
11122 your root file system is on a @code{luks-device-mapping} mapped device
11123 (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
11124
11125 @quotation Note
11126 This does @emph{not} specify the keyboard layout used by the bootloader, nor
11127 that used by the graphical display server. @xref{Bootloader Configuration},
11128 for information on how to specify the bootloader's keyboard layout. @xref{X
11129 Window}, for information on how to specify the keyboard layout used by the X
11130 Window System.
11131 @end quotation
11132
11133 @item @code{initrd-modules} (default: @code{%base-initrd-modules})
11134 @cindex initrd
11135 @cindex initial RAM disk
11136 The list of Linux kernel modules that need to be available in the
11137 initial RAM disk. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
11138
11139 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
11140 A procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for the Linux
11141 kernel. This field is provided to support low-level customization and
11142 should rarely be needed for casual use. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
11143
11144 @item @code{firmware} (default: @code{%base-firmware})
11145 @cindex firmware
11146 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
11147
11148 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
11149 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
11150 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
11151 supported hardware.
11152
11153 @item @code{host-name}
11154 The host name.
11155
11156 @item @code{hosts-file}
11157 @cindex hosts file
11158 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
11159 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11160 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
11161 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
11162
11163 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
11164 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
11165
11166 @item @code{file-systems}
11167 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
11168
11169 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
11170 @cindex swap devices
11171 A list of strings identifying devices or files to be used for ``swap
11172 space'' (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
11173 Manual}). For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")} or @code{'("/swapfile")}.
11174 It is possible to specify a swap file in a file system on a mapped
11175 device, provided that the necessary device mapping and file system are
11176 also specified. @xref{Mapped Devices} and @ref{File Systems}.
11177
11178 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
11179 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @code{%base-groups})
11180 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
11181
11182 If the @code{users} list lacks a user account with UID@tie{}0, a
11183 ``root'' account with UID@tie{}0 is automatically added.
11184
11185 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
11186 A list target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
11187 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
11188 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
11189
11190 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
11191
11192 @lisp
11193 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
11194 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
11195 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
11196 (activate-readline)")))
11197 @end lisp
11198
11199 @item @code{issue} (default: @code{%default-issue})
11200 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
11201 displayed when users log in on a text console.
11202
11203 @item @code{packages} (default: @code{%base-packages})
11204 The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
11205 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
11206
11207 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
11208 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
11209 package}).
11210
11211 @item @code{timezone}
11212 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
11213
11214 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
11215 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
11216 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
11217
11218 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
11219 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
11220 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
11221
11222 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @code{%default-locale-definitions})
11223 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
11224 run time. @xref{Locales}.
11225
11226 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
11227 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
11228 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
11229 considerations that justify this option.
11230
11231 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @code{%default-nss})
11232 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
11233 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
11234 details.
11235
11236 @item @code{services} (default: @code{%base-services})
11237 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
11238
11239 @cindex essential services
11240 @item @code{essential-services} (default: ...)
11241 The list of ``essential services''---i.e., things like instances of
11242 @code{system-service-type} and @code{host-name-service-type} (@pxref{Service
11243 Reference}), which are derived from the operating system definition itself.
11244 As a user you should @emph{never} need to touch this field.
11245
11246 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
11247 @cindex PAM
11248 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
11249 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
11250 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
11251
11252 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @var{%setuid-programs})
11253 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
11254 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
11255
11256 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @var{%sudoers-specification})
11257 @cindex sudoers file
11258 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
11259 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
11260
11261 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
11262 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
11263 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
11264 @code{sudo}.
11265
11266 @end table
11267
11268 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-operating-system
11269 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of an operating system field definition,
11270 this identifier resolves to the operating system being defined.
11271
11272 The example below shows how to refer to the operating system being defined in
11273 the definition of the @code{label} field:
11274
11275 @lisp
11276 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
11277
11278 (operating-system
11279 ;; ...
11280 (label (package-full-name
11281 (operating-system-kernel this-operating-system))))
11282 @end lisp
11283
11284 It is an error to refer to @code{this-operating-system} outside an operating
11285 system definition.
11286 @end deffn
11287
11288 @end deftp
11289
11290 @node File Systems
11291 @section File Systems
11292
11293 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
11294 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
11295 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
11296 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
11297
11298 @lisp
11299 (file-system
11300 (mount-point "/home")
11301 (device "/dev/sda3")
11302 (type "ext4"))
11303 @end lisp
11304
11305 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
11306 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
11307
11308 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
11309 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
11310 contain the following members:
11311
11312 @table @asis
11313 @item @code{type}
11314 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
11315 @code{"ext4"}.
11316
11317 @item @code{mount-point}
11318 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
11319
11320 @item @code{device}
11321 This names the ``source'' of the file system. It can be one of three
11322 things: a file system label, a file system UUID, or the name of a
11323 @file{/dev} node. Labels and UUIDs offer a way to refer to file
11324 systems without having to hard-code their actual device
11325 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
11326 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
11327 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
11328 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
11329 mounted.}.
11330
11331 @findex file-system-label
11332 File system labels are created using the @code{file-system-label}
11333 procedure, UUIDs are created using @code{uuid}, and @file{/dev} node are
11334 plain strings. Here's an example of a file system referred to by its
11335 label, as shown by the @command{e2label} command:
11336
11337 @lisp
11338 (file-system
11339 (mount-point "/home")
11340 (type "ext4")
11341 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
11342 @end lisp
11343
11344 @findex uuid
11345 UUIDs are converted from their string representation (as shown by the
11346 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
11347 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
11348 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
11349 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
11350 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
11351 like this:
11352
11353 @lisp
11354 (file-system
11355 (mount-point "/home")
11356 (type "ext4")
11357 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
11358 @end lisp
11359
11360 When the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
11361 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
11362 device name---e.g., @file{"/dev/mapper/root-partition"}.
11363 This is required so that
11364 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
11365 corresponding device mapping established.
11366
11367 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
11368 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
11369 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
11370 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
11371 bits), @code{no-atime} (do not update file access times),
11372 @code{strict-atime} (update file access time), @code{lazy-time} (only
11373 update time on the in-memory version of the file inode), and
11374 @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution).
11375 @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
11376 Manual}, for more information on these flags.
11377
11378 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
11379 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options passed to the
11380 file system driver. @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11381 Reference Manual}, for details and run @command{man 8 mount} for options for
11382 various file systems.
11383
11384 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
11385 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
11386 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
11387 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
11388 is not automatically mounted.
11389
11390 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
11391 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
11392 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
11393 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
11394 instance, for the root file system.
11395
11396 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
11397 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
11398 errors before being mounted.
11399
11400 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
11401 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
11402
11403 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
11404 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
11405 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
11406 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
11407
11408 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
11409 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
11410 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
11411
11412 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
11413 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
11414 @end table
11415 @end deftp
11416
11417 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
11418 variables.
11419
11420 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
11421 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
11422 such as @var{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @var{%immutable-store} (see
11423 below.) Operating system declarations should always contain at least
11424 these.
11425 @end defvr
11426
11427 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
11428 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
11429 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
11430 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
11431 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
11432 @command{xterm}.
11433 @end defvr
11434
11435 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
11436 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
11437 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
11438 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
11439 @end defvr
11440
11441 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
11442 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
11443 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
11444 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
11445 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
11446
11447 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
11448 read-write in its own ``name space.''
11449 @end defvr
11450
11451 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
11452 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
11453 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
11454 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
11455 @end defvr
11456
11457 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
11458 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
11459 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
11460 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
11461 @end defvr
11462
11463 @node Mapped Devices
11464 @section Mapped Devices
11465
11466 @cindex device mapping
11467 @cindex mapped devices
11468 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
11469 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
11470 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
11471 with additional processing over the data that flows through
11472 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
11473 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
11474 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
11475 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
11476 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
11477 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
11478 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
11479 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
11480 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
11481 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
11482 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
11483 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
11484 Other examples, not yet implemented, are LVM logical volumes.
11485
11486 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
11487 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
11488
11489 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
11490 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
11491 the system boots up.
11492
11493 @table @code
11494 @item source
11495 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
11496 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
11497 need to be assembled for creating a new one.
11498
11499 @item target
11500 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
11501 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
11502 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
11503 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
11504 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
11505 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
11506
11507 @item type
11508 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
11509 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
11510 @end table
11511 @end deftp
11512
11513 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
11514 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
11515 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
11516 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
11517 @end defvr
11518
11519 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
11520 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
11521 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
11522 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
11523 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
11524 @end defvr
11525
11526 @cindex disk encryption
11527 @cindex LUKS
11528 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
11529 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
11530 @url{https://gitlab.com/cryptsetup/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
11531 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
11532 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
11533 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
11534 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
11535
11536 @lisp
11537 (mapped-device
11538 (source "/dev/sda3")
11539 (target "home")
11540 (type luks-device-mapping))
11541 @end lisp
11542
11543 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
11544 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
11545 command like:
11546
11547 @example
11548 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
11549 @end example
11550
11551 and use it as follows:
11552
11553 @lisp
11554 (mapped-device
11555 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
11556 (target "home")
11557 (type luks-device-mapping))
11558 @end lisp
11559
11560 @cindex swap encryption
11561 It is also desirable to encrypt swap space, since swap space may contain
11562 sensitive data. One way to accomplish that is to use a swap file in a
11563 file system on a device mapped via LUKS encryption. In this way, the
11564 swap file is encrypted because the entire device is encrypted.
11565 @xref{Preparing for Installation,,Disk Partitioning}, for an example.
11566
11567 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
11568 may be declared as follows:
11569
11570 @lisp
11571 (mapped-device
11572 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
11573 (target "/dev/md0")
11574 (type raid-device-mapping))
11575 @end lisp
11576
11577 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
11578 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
11579 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
11580 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
11581 automatically later.
11582
11583
11584 @node User Accounts
11585 @section User Accounts
11586
11587 @cindex users
11588 @cindex accounts
11589 @cindex user accounts
11590 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
11591 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
11592 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
11593
11594 @lisp
11595 (user-account
11596 (name "alice")
11597 (group "users")
11598 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
11599 "audio" ;sound card
11600 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
11601 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
11602 (comment "Bob's sister")
11603 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
11604 @end lisp
11605
11606 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
11607 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
11608 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
11609 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
11610 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
11611 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
11612 as declared.
11613
11614 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
11615 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
11616 be specified:
11617
11618 @table @asis
11619 @item @code{name}
11620 The name of the user account.
11621
11622 @item @code{group}
11623 @cindex groups
11624 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
11625 this account belongs to.
11626
11627 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
11628 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
11629 account belongs to.
11630
11631 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
11632 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
11633 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
11634 account is created.
11635
11636 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
11637 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
11638
11639 @item @code{home-directory}
11640 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
11641
11642 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
11643 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
11644 if it does not exist yet.
11645
11646 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
11647 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
11648 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
11649
11650 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
11651 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
11652 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
11653 graphical login managers do not list them.
11654
11655 @anchor{user-account-password}
11656 @cindex password, for user accounts
11657 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
11658 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
11659 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
11660 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
11661 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
11662 reconfiguration.
11663
11664 If you @emph{do} want to set an initial password for an account, then
11665 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string. You can use the
11666 @code{crypt} procedure for this purpose:
11667
11668 @lisp
11669 (user-account
11670 (name "charlie")
11671 (group "users")
11672
11673 ;; Specify a SHA-512-hashed initial password.
11674 (password (crypt "InitialPassword!" "$6$abc")))
11675 @end lisp
11676
11677 @quotation Note
11678 The hash of this initial password will be available in a file in
11679 @file{/gnu/store}, readable by all the users, so this method must be used with
11680 care.
11681 @end quotation
11682
11683 @xref{Passphrase Storage,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for
11684 more information on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU
11685 Guile Reference Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
11686
11687 @end table
11688 @end deftp
11689
11690 @cindex groups
11691 User group declarations are even simpler:
11692
11693 @lisp
11694 (user-group (name "students"))
11695 @end lisp
11696
11697 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
11698 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
11699
11700 @table @asis
11701 @item @code{name}
11702 The name of the group.
11703
11704 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
11705 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
11706 automatically allocated when the group is created.
11707
11708 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
11709 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
11710 System groups have low numerical IDs.
11711
11712 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
11713 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
11714 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
11715
11716 @end table
11717 @end deftp
11718
11719 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
11720 expect:
11721
11722 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
11723 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
11724 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
11725 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
11726 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
11727 @end defvr
11728
11729 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
11730 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
11731 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
11732
11733 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
11734 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
11735 @end defvr
11736
11737 @node Keyboard Layout
11738 @section Keyboard Layout
11739
11740 @cindex keyboard layout
11741 @cindex keymap
11742 To specify what each key of your keyboard does, you need to tell the operating
11743 system what @dfn{keyboard layout} you want to use. The default, when nothing
11744 is specified, is the US English QWERTY layout for 105-key PC keyboards.
11745 However, German speakers will usually prefer the German QWERTZ layout, French
11746 speakers will want the AZERTY layout, and so on; hackers might prefer Dvorak
11747 or bépo, and they might even want to further customize the effect of some of
11748 the keys. This section explains how to get that done.
11749
11750 @cindex keyboard layout, definition
11751 There are three components that will want to know about your keyboard layout:
11752
11753 @itemize
11754 @item
11755 The @emph{bootloader} may want to know what keyboard layout you want to use
11756 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{keyboard-layout}}). This is useful if
11757 you want, for instance, to make sure that you can type the passphrase of your
11758 encrypted root partition using the right layout.
11759
11760 @item
11761 The @emph{operating system kernel}, Linux, will need that so that the console
11762 is properly configured (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
11763 @code{keyboard-layout}}).
11764
11765 @item
11766 The @emph{graphical display server}, usually Xorg, also has its own idea of
11767 the keyboard layout (@pxref{X Window, @code{keyboard-layout}}).
11768 @end itemize
11769
11770 Guix allows you to configure all three separately but, fortunately, it allows
11771 you to share the same keyboard layout for all three components.
11772
11773 @cindex XKB, keyboard layouts
11774 Keyboard layouts are represented by records created by the
11775 @code{keyboard-layout} procedure of @code{(gnu system keyboard)}. Following
11776 the X Keyboard extension (XKB), each layout has four attributes: a name (often
11777 a language code such as ``fi'' for Finnish or ``jp'' for Japanese), an
11778 optional variant name, an optional keyboard model name, and a possibly empty
11779 list of additional options. In most cases the layout name is all you care
11780 about. Here are a few example:
11781
11782 @lisp
11783 ;; The German QWERTZ layout. Here we assume a standard
11784 ;; "pc105" keyboard model.
11785 (keyboard-layout "de")
11786
11787 ;; The bépo variant of the French layout.
11788 (keyboard-layout "fr" "bepo")
11789
11790 ;; The Catalan layout.
11791 (keyboard-layout "es" "cat")
11792
11793 ;; The Latin American Spanish layout. In addition, the
11794 ;; "Caps Lock" key is used as an additional "Ctrl" key,
11795 ;; and the "Menu" key is used as a "Compose" key to enter
11796 ;; accented letters.
11797 (keyboard-layout "latam"
11798 #:options '("ctrl:nocaps" "compose:menu"))
11799
11800 ;; The Russian layout for a ThinkPad keyboard.
11801 (keyboard-layout "ru" #:model "thinkpad")
11802
11803 ;; The "US international" layout, which is the US layout plus
11804 ;; dead keys to enter accented characters. This is for an
11805 ;; Apple MacBook keyboard.
11806 (keyboard-layout "us" "intl" #:model "macbook78")
11807 @end lisp
11808
11809 See the @file{share/X11/xkb} directory of the @code{xkeyboard-config} package
11810 for a complete list of supported layouts, variants, and models.
11811
11812 @cindex keyboard layout, configuration
11813 Let's say you want your system to use the Turkish keyboard layout throughout
11814 your system---bootloader, console, and Xorg. Here's what your system
11815 configuration would look like:
11816
11817 @findex set-xorg-configuration
11818 @lisp
11819 ;; Using the Turkish layout for the bootloader, the console,
11820 ;; and for Xorg.
11821
11822 (operating-system
11823 ;; ...
11824 (keyboard-layout (keyboard-layout "tr")) ;for the console
11825 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
11826 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
11827 (target "/boot/efi")
11828 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout))) ;for GRUB
11829 (services (cons (set-xorg-configuration
11830 (xorg-configuration ;for Xorg
11831 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout)))
11832 %desktop-services)))
11833 @end lisp
11834
11835 In the example above, for GRUB and for Xorg, we just refer to the
11836 @code{keyboard-layout} field defined above, but we could just as well refer to
11837 a different layout. The @code{set-xorg-configuration} procedure communicates
11838 the desired Xorg configuration to the graphical log-in manager, by default
11839 GDM.
11840
11841 We've discussed how to specify the @emph{default} keyboard layout of your
11842 system when it starts, but you can also adjust it at run time:
11843
11844 @itemize
11845 @item
11846 If you're using GNOME, its settings panel has a ``Region & Language'' entry
11847 where you can select one or more keyboard layouts.
11848
11849 @item
11850 Under Xorg, the @command{setxkbmap} command (from the same-named package)
11851 allows you to change the current layout. For example, this is how you would
11852 change the layout to US Dvorak:
11853
11854 @example
11855 setxkbmap us dvorak
11856 @end example
11857
11858 @item
11859 The @code{loadkeys} command changes the keyboard layout in effect in the Linux
11860 console. However, note that @code{loadkeys} does @emph{not} use the XKB
11861 keyboard layout categorization described above. The command below loads the
11862 French bépo layout:
11863
11864 @example
11865 loadkeys fr-bepo
11866 @end example
11867 @end itemize
11868
11869 @node Locales
11870 @section Locales
11871
11872 @cindex locale
11873 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
11874 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11875 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
11876 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
11877 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
11878 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
11879
11880 @cindex locale definition
11881 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
11882 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
11883 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
11884
11885 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
11886 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
11887 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
11888 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
11889 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
11890 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
11891 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
11892 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
11893
11894 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
11895 that field may be:
11896
11897 @lisp
11898 (cons (locale-definition
11899 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
11900 %default-locale-definitions)
11901 @end lisp
11902
11903 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
11904 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
11905
11906 @lisp
11907 (list (locale-definition
11908 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
11909 (charset "EUC-JP")))
11910 @end lisp
11911
11912 @vindex LOCPATH
11913 The compiled locale definitions are available at
11914 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
11915 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
11916 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
11917 @code{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
11918 @code{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
11919
11920 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
11921 locale)} module. Details are given below.
11922
11923 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
11924 This is the data type of a locale definition.
11925
11926 @table @asis
11927
11928 @item @code{name}
11929 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11930 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
11931
11932 @item @code{source}
11933 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
11934 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
11935
11936 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
11937 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
11938 @uref{https://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
11939 IANA}.
11940
11941 @end table
11942 @end deftp
11943
11944 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
11945 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
11946 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
11947 declarations.
11948
11949 @cindex locale name
11950 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
11951 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
11952 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
11953 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
11954 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
11955 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
11956 @end defvr
11957
11958 @subsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
11959
11960 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
11961 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
11962 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
11963 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
11964 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
11965 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
11966 another.
11967
11968 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
11969 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
11970 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
11971 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
11972 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
11973 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
11974 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
11975 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
11976 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @code{LC_COLLATE}
11977 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
11978 programs will not abort.
11979
11980 The ``problem'' with Guix is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
11981 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
11982 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
11983 used to build the system-wide locale data.
11984
11985 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
11986 and define @var{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
11987 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
11988
11989 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
11990 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
11991 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
11992 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
11993 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
11994 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
11995
11996 @lisp
11997 (use-package-modules base)
11998
11999 (operating-system
12000 ;; @dots{}
12001 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
12002 @end lisp
12003
12004 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
12005 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
12006 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
12007
12008
12009 @node Services
12010 @section Services
12011
12012 @cindex system services
12013 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
12014 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
12015 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
12016 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
12017 configuring network access.
12018
12019 Guix has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
12020 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
12021 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
12022 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
12023 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
12024 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
12025
12026 @example
12027 # herd status
12028 @end example
12029
12030 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
12031 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
12032 service and its associated actions:
12033
12034 @example
12035 # herd doc nscd
12036 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
12037
12038 # herd doc nscd action invalidate
12039 invalidate: Invalidate the given cache--e.g., 'hosts' for host name lookups.
12040 @end example
12041
12042 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
12043 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
12044 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
12045
12046 @example
12047 # herd stop nscd
12048 Service nscd has been stopped.
12049 # herd restart xorg-server
12050 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
12051 Service xorg-server has been started.
12052 @end example
12053
12054 The following sections document the available services, starting with
12055 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
12056 declaration.
12057
12058 @menu
12059 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
12060 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
12061 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
12062 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
12063 * X Window:: Graphical display.
12064 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
12065 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
12066 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
12067 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
12068 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
12069 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
12070 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
12071 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
12072 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
12073 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
12074 * Web Services:: Web servers.
12075 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
12076 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
12077 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
12078 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
12079 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
12080 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
12081 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
12082 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
12083 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
12084 * Game Services:: Game servers.
12085 * PAM Mount Service:: Service to mount volumes when logging in.
12086 * Guix Services:: Services relating specifically to Guix.
12087 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
12088 @end menu
12089
12090 @node Base Services
12091 @subsection Base Services
12092
12093 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
12094 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
12095 this module are listed below.
12096
12097 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
12098 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
12099 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
12100 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
12101 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
12102 more.
12103
12104 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
12105 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
12106 system, you will want to append services to @code{%base-services}, like
12107 this:
12108
12109 @lisp
12110 (append (list (service avahi-service-type)
12111 (service openssh-service-type))
12112 %base-services)
12113 @end lisp
12114 @end defvr
12115
12116 @defvr {Scheme Variable} special-files-service-type
12117 This is the service that sets up ``special files'' such as
12118 @file{/bin/sh}; an instance of it is part of @code{%base-services}.
12119
12120 The value associated with @code{special-files-service-type} services
12121 must be a list of tuples where the first element is the ``special file''
12122 and the second element is its target. By default it is:
12123
12124 @cindex @file{/bin/sh}
12125 @cindex @file{sh}, in @file{/bin}
12126 @lisp
12127 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh")))
12128 @end lisp
12129
12130 @cindex @file{/usr/bin/env}
12131 @cindex @file{env}, in @file{/usr/bin}
12132 If you want to add, say, @code{/usr/bin/env} to your system, you can
12133 change it to:
12134
12135 @lisp
12136 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh"))
12137 ("/usr/bin/env" ,(file-append coreutils "/bin/env")))
12138 @end lisp
12139
12140 Since this is part of @code{%base-services}, you can use
12141 @code{modify-services} to customize the set of special files
12142 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}). But the simple way
12143 to add a special file is @i{via} the @code{extra-special-file} procedure
12144 (see below.)
12145 @end defvr
12146
12147 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} extra-special-file @var{file} @var{target}
12148 Use @var{target} as the ``special file'' @var{file}.
12149
12150 For example, adding the following lines to the @code{services} field of
12151 your operating system declaration leads to a @file{/usr/bin/env}
12152 symlink:
12153
12154 @lisp
12155 (extra-special-file "/usr/bin/env"
12156 (file-append coreutils "/bin/env"))
12157 @end lisp
12158 @end deffn
12159
12160 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
12161 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
12162 @end deffn
12163
12164 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
12165 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
12166 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
12167 among other things.
12168 @end deffn
12169
12170 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
12171 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
12172
12173 @table @asis
12174
12175 @item @code{motd}
12176 @cindex message of the day
12177 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
12178
12179 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
12180 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
12181 the 'root' account has just been created.
12182
12183 @end table
12184 @end deftp
12185
12186 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
12187 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
12188 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
12189 other things.
12190 @end deffn
12191
12192 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
12193 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
12194 provides the default implementation of virtual console log-in.
12195
12196 @table @asis
12197
12198 @item @code{tty}
12199 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
12200
12201 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
12202 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
12203 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
12204 user name and password must be entered to log in.
12205
12206 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
12207 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
12208 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
12209 the name of the log-in program.
12210
12211 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
12212 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
12213 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
12214
12215 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
12216 The Mingetty package to use.
12217
12218 @end table
12219 @end deftp
12220
12221 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} agetty-service @var{config}
12222 Return a service to run agetty according to @var{config}, an
12223 @code{<agetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run,
12224 among other things.
12225 @end deffn
12226
12227 @deftp {Data Type} agetty-configuration
12228 This is the data type representing the configuration of agetty, which
12229 implements virtual and serial console log-in. See the @code{agetty(8)}
12230 man page for more information.
12231
12232 @table @asis
12233
12234 @item @code{tty}
12235 The name of the console this agetty runs on, as a string---e.g.,
12236 @code{"ttyS0"}. This argument is optional, it will default to
12237 a reasonable default serial port used by the kernel Linux.
12238
12239 For this, if there is a value for an option @code{agetty.tty} in the kernel
12240 command line, agetty will extract the device name of the serial port
12241 from it and use that.
12242
12243 If not and if there is a value for an option @code{console} with a tty in
12244 the Linux command line, agetty will extract the device name of the
12245 serial port from it and use that.
12246
12247 In both cases, agetty will leave the other serial device settings
12248 (baud rate etc.)@: alone---in the hope that Linux pinned them to the
12249 correct values.
12250
12251 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
12252 A string containing a comma-separated list of one or more baud rates, in
12253 descending order.
12254
12255 @item @code{term} (default: @code{#f})
12256 A string containing the value used for the @code{TERM} environment
12257 variable.
12258
12259 @item @code{eight-bits?} (default: @code{#f})
12260 When @code{#t}, the tty is assumed to be 8-bit clean, and parity detection is
12261 disabled.
12262
12263 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
12264 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
12265 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
12266
12267 @item @code{no-reset?} (default: @code{#f})
12268 When @code{#t}, don't reset terminal cflags (control modes).
12269
12270 @item @code{host} (default: @code{#f})
12271 This accepts a string containing the "login_host", which will be written
12272 into the @file{/var/run/utmpx} file.
12273
12274 @item @code{remote?} (default: @code{#f})
12275 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{host}, this will add an
12276 @code{-r} fakehost option to the command line of the login program
12277 specified in @var{login-program}.
12278
12279 @item @code{flow-control?} (default: @code{#f})
12280 When set to @code{#t}, enable hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control.
12281
12282 @item @code{no-issue?} (default: @code{#f})
12283 When set to @code{#t}, the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file will
12284 not be displayed before presenting the login prompt.
12285
12286 @item @code{init-string} (default: @code{#f})
12287 This accepts a string that will be sent to the tty or modem before
12288 sending anything else. It can be used to initialize a modem.
12289
12290 @item @code{no-clear?} (default: @code{#f})
12291 When set to @code{#t}, agetty will not clear the screen before showing
12292 the login prompt.
12293
12294 @item @code{login-program} (default: (file-append shadow "/bin/login"))
12295 This must be either a gexp denoting the name of a log-in program, or
12296 unset, in which case the default value is the @command{login} from the
12297 Shadow tool suite.
12298
12299 @item @code{local-line} (default: @code{#f})
12300 Control the CLOCAL line flag. This accepts one of three symbols as
12301 arguments, @code{'auto}, @code{'always}, or @code{'never}. If @code{#f},
12302 the default value chosen by agetty is @code{'auto}.
12303
12304 @item @code{extract-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
12305 When set to @code{#t}, instruct agetty to try to extract the baud rate
12306 from the status messages produced by certain types of modems.
12307
12308 @item @code{skip-login?} (default: @code{#f})
12309 When set to @code{#t}, do not prompt the user for a login name. This
12310 can be used with @var{login-program} field to use non-standard login
12311 systems.
12312
12313 @item @code{no-newline?} (default: @code{#f})
12314 When set to @code{#t}, do not print a newline before printing the
12315 @file{/etc/issue} file.
12316
12317 @c Is this dangerous only when used with login-program, or always?
12318 @item @code{login-options} (default: @code{#f})
12319 This option accepts a string containing options that are passed to the
12320 login program. When used with the @var{login-program}, be aware that a
12321 malicious user could try to enter a login name containing embedded
12322 options that could be parsed by the login program.
12323
12324 @item @code{login-pause} (default: @code{#f})
12325 When set to @code{#t}, wait for any key before showing the login prompt.
12326 This can be used in conjunction with @var{auto-login} to save memory by
12327 lazily spawning shells.
12328
12329 @item @code{chroot} (default: @code{#f})
12330 Change root to the specified directory. This option accepts a directory
12331 path as a string.
12332
12333 @item @code{hangup?} (default: @code{#f})
12334 Use the Linux system call @code{vhangup} to do a virtual hangup of the
12335 specified terminal.
12336
12337 @item @code{keep-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
12338 When set to @code{#t}, try to keep the existing baud rate. The baud
12339 rates from @var{baud-rate} are used when agetty receives a @key{BREAK}
12340 character.
12341
12342 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{#f})
12343 When set to an integer value, terminate if no user name could be read
12344 within @var{timeout} seconds.
12345
12346 @item @code{detect-case?} (default: @code{#f})
12347 When set to @code{#t}, turn on support for detecting an uppercase-only
12348 terminal. This setting will detect a login name containing only
12349 uppercase letters as indicating an uppercase-only terminal and turn on
12350 some upper-to-lower case conversions. Note that this will not support
12351 Unicode characters.
12352
12353 @item @code{wait-cr?} (default: @code{#f})
12354 When set to @code{#t}, wait for the user or modem to send a
12355 carriage-return or linefeed character before displaying
12356 @file{/etc/issue} or login prompt. This is typically used with the
12357 @var{init-string} option.
12358
12359 @item @code{no-hints?} (default: @code{#f})
12360 When set to @code{#t}, do not print hints about Num, Caps, and Scroll
12361 locks.
12362
12363 @item @code{no-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
12364 By default, the hostname is printed. When this option is set to
12365 @code{#t}, no hostname will be shown at all.
12366
12367 @item @code{long-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
12368 By default, the hostname is only printed until the first dot. When this
12369 option is set to @code{#t}, the fully qualified hostname by
12370 @code{gethostname} or @code{getaddrinfo} is shown.
12371
12372 @item @code{erase-characters} (default: @code{#f})
12373 This option accepts a string of additional characters that should be
12374 interpreted as backspace when the user types their login name.
12375
12376 @item @code{kill-characters} (default: @code{#f})
12377 This option accepts a string that should be interpreted to mean "ignore
12378 all previous characters" (also called a "kill" character) when the user
12379 types their login name.
12380
12381 @item @code{chdir} (default: @code{#f})
12382 This option accepts, as a string, a directory path that will be changed
12383 to before login.
12384
12385 @item @code{delay} (default: @code{#f})
12386 This options accepts, as an integer, the number of seconds to sleep
12387 before opening the tty and displaying the login prompt.
12388
12389 @item @code{nice} (default: @code{#f})
12390 This option accepts, as an integer, the nice value with which to run the
12391 @command{login} program.
12392
12393 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
12394 This option provides an "escape hatch" for the user to provide arbitrary
12395 command-line arguments to @command{agetty} as a list of strings.
12396
12397 @end table
12398 @end deftp
12399
12400 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
12401 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
12402 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
12403 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
12404 @end deffn
12405
12406 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
12407 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
12408 implements virtual console log-in.
12409
12410 @table @asis
12411
12412 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
12413 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
12414
12415 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
12416 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
12417 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
12418
12419 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
12420 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
12421
12422 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
12423 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
12424 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
12425
12426 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
12427 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
12428
12429 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
12430 The Kmscon package to use.
12431
12432 @end table
12433 @end deftp
12434
12435 @cindex name service cache daemon
12436 @cindex nscd
12437 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
12438 [#:name-services '()]
12439 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
12440 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
12441 Service Switch}, for an example.
12442
12443 For convenience, the Shepherd service for nscd provides the following actions:
12444
12445 @table @code
12446 @item invalidate
12447 @cindex cache invalidation, nscd
12448 @cindex nscd, cache invalidation
12449 This invalidate the given cache. For instance, running:
12450
12451 @example
12452 herd invalidate nscd hosts
12453 @end example
12454
12455 @noindent
12456 invalidates the host name lookup cache of nscd.
12457
12458 @item statistics
12459 Running @command{herd statistics nscd} displays information about nscd usage
12460 and caches.
12461 @end table
12462
12463 @end deffn
12464
12465 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
12466 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
12467 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
12468 @var{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
12469 @end defvr
12470
12471 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
12472 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
12473 configuration.
12474
12475 @table @asis
12476
12477 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
12478 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
12479 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
12480
12481 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
12482 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
12483 command.
12484
12485 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
12486 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
12487 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
12488
12489 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
12490 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
12491 debugging output is logged.
12492
12493 @item @code{caches} (default: @var{%nscd-default-caches})
12494 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
12495 below.
12496
12497 @end table
12498 @end deftp
12499
12500 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
12501 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
12502
12503 @table @asis
12504
12505 @item @code{database}
12506 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
12507 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
12508 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
12509 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
12510
12511 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
12512 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
12513 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
12514 negative lookup result remains in cache.
12515
12516 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
12517 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
12518 @var{database}.
12519
12520 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
12521 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
12522 them into account.
12523
12524 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
12525 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
12526
12527 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
12528 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
12529
12530 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
12531 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
12532
12533 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
12534 @c settings, so leave them out.
12535
12536 @end table
12537 @end deftp
12538
12539 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
12540 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
12541 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
12542
12543 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
12544 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
12545 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
12546 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
12547 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
12548 @end defvr
12549
12550 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
12551 @cindex syslog
12552 @cindex logging
12553 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
12554 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
12555
12556 @table @asis
12557 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
12558 The syslog daemon to use.
12559
12560 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
12561 The syslog configuration file to use.
12562
12563 @end table
12564 @end deftp
12565
12566 @anchor{syslog-service}
12567 @cindex syslog
12568 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
12569 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
12570
12571 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
12572 information on the configuration file syntax.
12573 @end deffn
12574
12575 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guix-service-type
12576 This is the type of the service that runs the build daemon,
12577 @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). Its value must be a
12578 @code{guix-configuration} record as described below.
12579 @end defvr
12580
12581 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
12582 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
12583 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
12584 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
12585
12586 @table @asis
12587 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
12588 The Guix package to use.
12589
12590 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
12591 Name of the group for build user accounts.
12592
12593 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
12594 Number of build user accounts to create.
12595
12596 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
12597 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
12598 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
12599 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
12600 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12601
12602 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
12603 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
12604 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
12605 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
12606 contains that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12607
12608 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
12609 Whether to use substitutes.
12610
12611 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @code{%default-substitute-urls})
12612 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
12613
12614 @item @code{max-silent-time} (default: @code{0})
12615 @itemx @code{timeout} (default: @code{0})
12616 The number of seconds of silence and the number of seconds of activity,
12617 respectively, after which a build process times out. A value of zero
12618 disables the timeout.
12619
12620 @item @code{log-compression} (default: @code{'bzip2})
12621 The type of compression used for build logs---one of @code{gzip},
12622 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
12623
12624 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
12625 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
12626
12627 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/guix-daemon.log"})
12628 File where @command{guix-daemon}'s standard output and standard error
12629 are written.
12630
12631 @item @code{http-proxy} (default: @code{#f})
12632 The HTTP proxy used for downloading fixed-output derivations and
12633 substitutes.
12634
12635 @item @code{tmpdir} (default: @code{#f})
12636 A directory path where the @command{guix-daemon} will perform builds.
12637
12638 @end table
12639 @end deftp
12640
12641 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev @var{eudev} #:rules @code{'()}]
12642 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
12643 udev rules can be provided as a list of files through the @var{rules}
12644 variable. The procedures @code{udev-rule} and @code{file->udev-rule} from
12645 @code{(gnu services base)} simplify the creation of such rule files.
12646 @end deffn
12647
12648 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{contents}]
12649 Return a udev-rule file named @var{file-name} containing the rules
12650 defined by the @var{contents} literal.
12651
12652 In the following example, a rule for a USB device is defined to be
12653 stored in the file @file{90-usb-thing.rules}. The rule runs a script
12654 upon detecting a USB device with a given product identifier.
12655
12656 @lisp
12657 (define %example-udev-rule
12658 (udev-rule
12659 "90-usb-thing.rules"
12660 (string-append "ACTION==\"add\", SUBSYSTEM==\"usb\", "
12661 "ATTR@{product@}==\"Example\", "
12662 "RUN+=\"/path/to/script\"")))
12663 @end lisp
12664
12665 The @command{herd rules udev} command, as root, returns the name of the
12666 directory containing all the active udev rules.
12667 @end deffn
12668
12669 Here we show how the default @var{udev-service} can be extended with it.
12670
12671 @lisp
12672 (operating-system
12673 ;; @dots{}
12674 (services
12675 (modify-services %desktop-services
12676 (udev-service-type config =>
12677 (udev-configuration (inherit config)
12678 (rules (append (udev-configuration-rules config)
12679 (list %example-udev-rule))))))))
12680 @end lisp
12681
12682 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file->udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{file}]
12683 Return a udev file named @var{file-name} containing the rules defined
12684 within @var{file}, a file-like object.
12685
12686 The following example showcases how we can use an existing rule file.
12687
12688 @lisp
12689 (use-modules (guix download) ;for url-fetch
12690 (guix packages) ;for origin
12691 @dots{})
12692
12693 (define %android-udev-rules
12694 (file->udev-rule
12695 "51-android-udev.rules"
12696 (let ((version "20170910"))
12697 (origin
12698 (method url-fetch)
12699 (uri (string-append "https://raw.githubusercontent.com/M0Rf30/"
12700 "android-udev-rules/" version "/51-android.rules"))
12701 (sha256
12702 (base32 "0lmmagpyb6xsq6zcr2w1cyx9qmjqmajkvrdbhjx32gqf1d9is003"))))))
12703 @end lisp
12704 @end deffn
12705
12706 Additionally, Guix package definitions can be included in @var{rules} in
12707 order to extend the udev rules with the definitions found under their
12708 @file{lib/udev/rules.d} sub-directory. In lieu of the previous
12709 @var{file->udev-rule} example, we could have used the
12710 @var{android-udev-rules} package which exists in Guix in the @code{(gnu
12711 packages android)} module.
12712
12713 The following example shows how to use the @var{android-udev-rules}
12714 package so that the Android tool @command{adb} can detect devices
12715 without root privileges. It also details how to create the
12716 @code{adbusers} group, which is required for the proper functioning of
12717 the rules defined within the @var{android-udev-rules} package. To
12718 create such a group, we must define it both as part of the
12719 @var{supplementary-groups} of our @var{user-account} declaration, as
12720 well as in the @var{groups} field of the @var{operating-system} record.
12721
12722 @lisp
12723 (use-modules (gnu packages android) ;for android-udev-rules
12724 (gnu system shadow) ;for user-group
12725 @dots{})
12726
12727 (operating-system
12728 ;; @dots{}
12729 (users (cons (user-acount
12730 ;; @dots{}
12731 (supplementary-groups
12732 '("adbusers" ;for adb
12733 "wheel" "netdev" "audio" "video")))))
12734
12735 (groups (cons (user-group (system? #t) (name "adbusers"))
12736 %base-groups))
12737
12738 ;; @dots{}
12739
12740 (services
12741 (modify-services %desktop-services
12742 (udev-service-type
12743 config =>
12744 (udev-configuration (inherit config)
12745 (rules (cons android-udev-rules
12746 (udev-configuration-rules config))))))))
12747 @end lisp
12748
12749 @defvr {Scheme Variable} urandom-seed-service-type
12750 Save some entropy in @var{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
12751 when rebooting. It also tries to seed @file{/dev/urandom} from
12752 @file{/dev/hwrng} while booting, if @file{/dev/hwrng} exists and is
12753 readable.
12754 @end defvr
12755
12756 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
12757 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
12758 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
12759 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
12760 @end defvr
12761
12762 @cindex mouse
12763 @cindex gpm
12764 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gpm-service-type
12765 This is the type of the service that runs GPM, the @dfn{general-purpose
12766 mouse daemon}, which provides mouse support to the Linux console. GPM
12767 allows users to use the mouse in the console, notably to select, copy,
12768 and paste text.
12769
12770 The value for services of this type must be a @code{gpm-configuration}
12771 (see below). This service is not part of @code{%base-services}.
12772 @end defvr
12773
12774 @deftp {Data Type} gpm-configuration
12775 Data type representing the configuration of GPM.
12776
12777 @table @asis
12778 @item @code{options} (default: @code{%default-gpm-options})
12779 Command-line options passed to @command{gpm}. The default set of
12780 options instruct @command{gpm} to listen to mouse events on
12781 @file{/dev/input/mice}. @xref{Command Line,,, gpm, gpm manual}, for
12782 more information.
12783
12784 @item @code{gpm} (default: @code{gpm})
12785 The GPM package to use.
12786
12787 @end table
12788 @end deftp
12789
12790 @anchor{guix-publish-service-type}
12791 @deffn {Scheme Variable} guix-publish-service-type
12792 This is the service type for @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking
12793 guix publish}). Its value must be a @code{guix-publish-configuration}
12794 object, as described below.
12795
12796 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
12797 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
12798 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
12799 @end deffn
12800
12801 @deftp {Data Type} guix-publish-configuration
12802 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{guix publish}
12803 service.
12804
12805 @table @asis
12806 @item @code{guix} (default: @code{guix})
12807 The Guix package to use.
12808
12809 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
12810 The TCP port to listen for connections.
12811
12812 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
12813 The host (and thus, network interface) to listen to. Use
12814 @code{"0.0.0.0"} to listen on all the network interfaces.
12815
12816 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{'(("gzip" 3))})
12817 This is a list of compression method/level tuple used when compressing
12818 substitutes. For example, to compress all substitutes with @emph{both} lzip
12819 at level 7 and gzip at level 9, write:
12820
12821 @lisp
12822 '(("lzip" 7) ("gzip" 9))
12823 @end lisp
12824
12825 Level 9 achieves the best compression ratio at the expense of increased CPU
12826 usage, whereas level 1 achieves fast compression.
12827
12828 An empty list disables compression altogether.
12829
12830 @item @code{nar-path} (default: @code{"nar"})
12831 The URL path at which ``nars'' can be fetched. @xref{Invoking guix
12832 publish, @code{--nar-path}}, for details.
12833
12834 @item @code{cache} (default: @code{#f})
12835 When it is @code{#f}, disable caching and instead generate archives on
12836 demand. Otherwise, this should be the name of a directory---e.g.,
12837 @code{"/var/cache/guix/publish"}---where @command{guix publish} caches
12838 archives and meta-data ready to be sent. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
12839 @option{--cache}}, for more information on the tradeoffs involved.
12840
12841 @item @code{workers} (default: @code{#f})
12842 When it is an integer, this is the number of worker threads used for
12843 caching; when @code{#f}, the number of processors is used.
12844 @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--workers}}, for more information.
12845
12846 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{#f})
12847 When it is an integer, this denotes the @dfn{time-to-live} in seconds
12848 of the published archives. @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--ttl}},
12849 for more information.
12850 @end table
12851 @end deftp
12852
12853 @anchor{rngd-service}
12854 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
12855 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
12856 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
12857 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
12858 @var{device} does not exist.
12859 @end deffn
12860
12861 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
12862 @cindex session limits
12863 @cindex ulimit
12864 @cindex priority
12865 @cindex realtime
12866 @cindex jackd
12867 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @code{'()}]
12868
12869 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
12870 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
12871 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
12872 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
12873 @code{ulimit} limits and nice priority limits to user sessions.
12874
12875 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
12876 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
12877
12878 @lisp
12879 (pam-limits-service
12880 (list
12881 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
12882 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
12883 @end lisp
12884
12885 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
12886 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
12887 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
12888 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
12889 @end deffn
12890
12891 @node Scheduled Job Execution
12892 @subsection Scheduled Job Execution
12893
12894 @cindex cron
12895 @cindex mcron
12896 @cindex scheduling jobs
12897 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
12898 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
12899 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
12900 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
12901 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
12902 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
12903
12904 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
12905 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
12906 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
12907 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
12908 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
12909 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
12910 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
12911
12912 @lisp
12913 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
12914 (use-package-modules base idutils)
12915
12916 (define updatedb-job
12917 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
12918 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
12919 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
12920 (lambda ()
12921 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
12922 "updatedb"
12923 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
12924
12925 (define garbage-collector-job
12926 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
12927 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
12928 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
12929 "guix gc -F 1G"))
12930
12931 (define idutils-job
12932 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
12933 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
12934 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
12935 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
12936 #:user "charlie"))
12937
12938 (operating-system
12939 ;; @dots{}
12940 (services (cons (service mcron-service-type
12941 (mcron-configuration
12942 (jobs (list garbage-collector-job
12943 updatedb-job
12944 idutils-job))))
12945 %base-services)))
12946 @end lisp
12947
12948 For more complex jobs defined in Scheme where you need control over the top
12949 level, for instance to introduce a @code{use-modules} form, you can move your
12950 code to a separate program using the @code{program-file} procedure of the
12951 @code{(guix gexp)} module (@pxref{G-Expressions}). The example below
12952 illustrates that.
12953
12954 @lisp
12955 (define %battery-alert-job
12956 ;; Beep when the battery percentage falls below %MIN-LEVEL.
12957 #~(job
12958 '(next-minute (range 0 60 1))
12959 #$(program-file
12960 "battery-alert.scm"
12961 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
12962 '((guix build utils)))
12963 #~(begin
12964 (define %min-level 20)
12965 (use-modules (guix build utils)
12966 (ice-9 popen)
12967 (ice-9 regex)
12968 (ice-9 textual-ports)
12969 (srfi srfi-2))
12970 (setenv "LC_ALL" "C") ;ensure English output
12971 (and-let* ((input-pipe (open-pipe*
12972 OPEN_READ
12973 #$(file-append acpi "/bin/acpi")))
12974 (output (get-string-all input-pipe))
12975 (m (string-match "Discharging, ([0-9]+)%" output))
12976 (level (string->number (match:substring m 1)))
12977 ((< level %min-level)))
12978 (format #t "warning: Battery level is low (~a%)~%" level)
12979 (invoke #$(file-append beep "/bin/beep") "-r5")))))))
12980 @end lisp
12981
12982 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
12983 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
12984 reference of the mcron service.
12985
12986 On a running system, you can use the @code{schedule} action of the service to
12987 visualize the mcron jobs that will be executed next:
12988
12989 @example
12990 # herd schedule mcron
12991 @end example
12992
12993 @noindent
12994 The example above lists the next five tasks that will be executed, but you can
12995 also specify the number of tasks to display:
12996
12997 @example
12998 # herd schedule mcron 10
12999 @end example
13000
13001 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
13002 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
13003 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
13004
13005 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
13006 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
13007 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
13008 mcron jobs to run.
13009 @end defvr
13010
13011 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
13012 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
13013
13014 @table @asis
13015 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron})
13016 The mcron package to use.
13017
13018 @item @code{jobs}
13019 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
13020 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
13021 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
13022 @end table
13023 @end deftp
13024
13025
13026 @node Log Rotation
13027 @subsection Log Rotation
13028
13029 @cindex rottlog
13030 @cindex log rotation
13031 @cindex logging
13032 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
13033 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
13034 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
13035 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
13036 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
13037
13038 The example below defines an operating system that provides log rotation
13039 with the default settings, for commonly encountered log files.
13040
13041 @lisp
13042 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
13043 (use-service-modules admin mcron)
13044 (use-package-modules base idutils)
13045
13046 (operating-system
13047 ;; @dots{}
13048 (services (cons (service rottlog-service-type)
13049 %base-services)))
13050 @end lisp
13051
13052 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
13053 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
13054 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
13055
13056 Other services can extend this one with new @code{log-rotation} objects
13057 (see below), thereby augmenting the set of files to be rotated.
13058
13059 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
13060 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
13061 @end defvr
13062
13063 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
13064 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
13065
13066 @table @asis
13067 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
13068 The Rottlog package to use.
13069
13070 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
13071 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
13072 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
13073
13074 @item @code{rotations} (default: @code{%default-rotations})
13075 A list of @code{log-rotation} objects as defined below.
13076
13077 @item @code{jobs}
13078 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
13079 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
13080 @end table
13081 @end deftp
13082
13083 @deftp {Data Type} log-rotation
13084 Data type representing the rotation of a group of log files.
13085
13086 Taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period Related File
13087 Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a log rotation might be
13088 defined like this:
13089
13090 @lisp
13091 (log-rotation
13092 (frequency 'daily)
13093 (files '("/var/log/apache/*"))
13094 (options '("storedir apache-archives"
13095 "rotate 6"
13096 "notifempty"
13097 "nocompress")))
13098 @end lisp
13099
13100 The list of fields is as follows:
13101
13102 @table @asis
13103 @item @code{frequency} (default: @code{'weekly})
13104 The log rotation frequency, a symbol.
13105
13106 @item @code{files}
13107 The list of files or file glob patterns to rotate.
13108
13109 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'()})
13110 The list of rottlog options for this rotation (@pxref{Configuration
13111 parameters,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]lg Manual}).
13112
13113 @item @code{post-rotate} (default: @code{#f})
13114 Either @code{#f} or a gexp to execute once the rotation has completed.
13115 @end table
13116 @end deftp
13117
13118 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
13119 Specifies weekly rotation of @var{%rotated-files} and of
13120 @file{/var/log/guix-daemon.log}.
13121 @end defvr
13122
13123 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
13124 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
13125 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure" "/var/log/debug" \
13126 "/var/log/maillog")}.
13127 @end defvr
13128
13129 @node Networking Services
13130 @subsection Networking Services
13131
13132 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
13133 the network interface.
13134
13135 @cindex DHCP, networking service
13136 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dhcp-client-service-type
13137 This is the type of services that run @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
13138 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces. Its value
13139 is the DHCP client package to use, @code{isc-dhcp} by default.
13140 @end defvr
13141
13142 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcpd-service-type
13143 This type defines a service that runs a DHCP daemon. To create a
13144 service of this type, you must supply a @code{<dhcpd-configuration>}.
13145 For example:
13146
13147 @lisp
13148 (service dhcpd-service-type
13149 (dhcpd-configuration
13150 (config-file (local-file "my-dhcpd.conf"))
13151 (interfaces '("enp0s25"))))
13152 @end lisp
13153 @end deffn
13154
13155 @deftp {Data Type} dhcpd-configuration
13156 @table @asis
13157 @item @code{package} (default: @code{isc-dhcp})
13158 The package that provides the DHCP daemon. This package is expected to
13159 provide the daemon at @file{sbin/dhcpd} relative to its output
13160 directory. The default package is the
13161 @uref{https://www.isc.org/products/DHCP, ISC's DHCP server}.
13162 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
13163 The configuration file to use. This is required. It will be passed to
13164 @code{dhcpd} via its @code{-cf} option. This may be any ``file-like''
13165 object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}). See @code{man
13166 dhcpd.conf} for details on the configuration file syntax.
13167 @item @code{version} (default: @code{"4"})
13168 The DHCP version to use. The ISC DHCP server supports the values ``4'',
13169 ``6'', and ``4o6''. These correspond to the @code{dhcpd} program
13170 options @code{-4}, @code{-6}, and @code{-4o6}. See @code{man dhcpd} for
13171 details.
13172 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd"})
13173 The run directory to use. At service activation time, this directory
13174 will be created if it does not exist.
13175 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd/dhcpd.pid"})
13176 The PID file to use. This corresponds to the @code{-pf} option of
13177 @code{dhcpd}. See @code{man dhcpd} for details.
13178 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'()})
13179 The names of the network interfaces on which dhcpd should listen for
13180 broadcasts. If this list is not empty, then its elements (which must be
13181 strings) will be appended to the @code{dhcpd} invocation when starting
13182 the daemon. It may not be necessary to explicitly specify any
13183 interfaces here; see @code{man dhcpd} for details.
13184 @end table
13185 @end deftp
13186
13187 @defvr {Scheme Variable} static-networking-service-type
13188 This is the type for statically-configured network interfaces.
13189 @c TODO Document <static-networking> data structures.
13190 @end defvr
13191
13192 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
13193 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}] @
13194 [#:requirement @code{'(udev)}]
13195 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
13196 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
13197 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway. @var{requirement}
13198 can be used to declare a dependency on another service before configuring the
13199 interface.
13200
13201 This procedure can be called several times, one for each network
13202 interface of interest. Behind the scenes what it does is extend
13203 @code{static-networking-service-type} with additional network interfaces
13204 to handle.
13205
13206 For example:
13207
13208 @lisp
13209 (static-networking-service "eno1" "192.168.1.82"
13210 #:gateway "192.168.1.2"
13211 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.2"))
13212 @end lisp
13213 @end deffn
13214
13215 @cindex wicd
13216 @cindex wireless
13217 @cindex WiFi
13218 @cindex network management
13219 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
13220 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
13221 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
13222
13223 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
13224 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
13225 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
13226 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
13227 @end deffn
13228
13229 @cindex ModemManager
13230
13231 @defvr {Scheme Variable} modem-manager-service-type
13232 This is the service type for the
13233 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/ModemManager, ModemManager}
13234 service. The value for this service type is a
13235 @code{modem-manager-configuration} record.
13236
13237 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
13238 Services}).
13239 @end defvr
13240
13241 @deftp {Data Type} modem-manager-configuration
13242 Data type representing the configuration of ModemManager.
13243
13244 @table @asis
13245 @item @code{modem-manager} (default: @code{modem-manager})
13246 The ModemManager package to use.
13247
13248 @end table
13249 @end deftp
13250
13251 @cindex USB_ModeSwitch
13252 @cindex Modeswitching
13253
13254 @defvr {Scheme Variable} usb-modeswitch-service-type
13255 This is the service type for the
13256 @uref{http://www.draisberghof.de/usb_modeswitch/, USB_ModeSwitch} service. The
13257 value for this service type is a @code{usb-modeswitch-configuration} record.
13258
13259 When plugged in, some USB modems (and other USB devices) initially present
13260 themselves as a read-only storage medium and not as a modem. They need to be
13261 @dfn{modeswitched} before they are usable. The USB_ModeSwitch service type
13262 installs udev rules to automatically modeswitch these devices when they are
13263 plugged in.
13264
13265 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
13266 Services}).
13267 @end defvr
13268
13269 @deftp {Data Type} usb-modeswitch-configuration
13270 Data type representing the configuration of USB_ModeSwitch.
13271
13272 @table @asis
13273 @item @code{usb-modeswitch} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch})
13274 The USB_ModeSwitch package providing the binaries for modeswitching.
13275
13276 @item @code{usb-modeswitch-data} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch-data})
13277 The package providing the device data and udev rules file used by
13278 USB_ModeSwitch.
13279
13280 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$usb-modeswitch:dispatcher "/etc/usb_modeswitch.conf")})
13281 Which config file to use for the USB_ModeSwitch dispatcher. By default the
13282 config file shipped with USB_ModeSwitch is used which disables logging to
13283 @file{/var/log} among other default settings. If set to @code{#f}, no config
13284 file is used.
13285
13286 @end table
13287 @end deftp
13288
13289 @cindex NetworkManager
13290
13291 @defvr {Scheme Variable} network-manager-service-type
13292 This is the service type for the
13293 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/NetworkManager, NetworkManager}
13294 service. The value for this service type is a
13295 @code{network-manager-configuration} record.
13296
13297 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
13298 Services}).
13299 @end defvr
13300
13301 @deftp {Data Type} network-manager-configuration
13302 Data type representing the configuration of NetworkManager.
13303
13304 @table @asis
13305 @item @code{network-manager} (default: @code{network-manager})
13306 The NetworkManager package to use.
13307
13308 @item @code{dns} (default: @code{"default"})
13309 Processing mode for DNS, which affects how NetworkManager uses the
13310 @code{resolv.conf} configuration file.
13311
13312 @table @samp
13313 @item default
13314 NetworkManager will update @code{resolv.conf} to reflect the nameservers
13315 provided by currently active connections.
13316
13317 @item dnsmasq
13318 NetworkManager will run @code{dnsmasq} as a local caching nameserver, using a
13319 @dfn{conditional forwarding} configuration if you are connected to a VPN, and
13320 then update @code{resolv.conf} to point to the local nameserver.
13321
13322 With this setting, you can share your network connection. For example when
13323 you want to share your network connection to another laptop @i{via} an
13324 Ethernet cable, you can open @command{nm-connection-editor} and configure the
13325 Wired connection's method for IPv4 and IPv6 to be ``Shared to other computers''
13326 and reestablish the connection (or reboot).
13327
13328 You can also set up a @dfn{host-to-guest connection} to QEMU VMs
13329 (@pxref{Installing Guix in a VM}). With a host-to-guest connection, you can
13330 e.g.@: access a Web server running on the VM (@pxref{Web Services}) from a Web
13331 browser on your host system, or connect to the VM @i{via} SSH
13332 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}). To set up a
13333 host-to-guest connection, run this command once:
13334
13335 @example
13336 nmcli connection add type tun \
13337 connection.interface-name tap0 \
13338 tun.mode tap tun.owner $(id -u) \
13339 ipv4.method shared \
13340 ipv4.addresses 172.28.112.1/24
13341 @end example
13342
13343 Then each time you launch your QEMU VM (@pxref{Running Guix in a VM}), pass
13344 @option{-nic tap,ifname=tap0,script=no,downscript=no} to
13345 @command{qemu-system-...}.
13346
13347 @item none
13348 NetworkManager will not modify @code{resolv.conf}.
13349 @end table
13350
13351 @item @code{vpn-plugins} (default: @code{'()})
13352 This is the list of available plugins for virtual private networks
13353 (VPNs). An example of this is the @code{network-manager-openvpn}
13354 package, which allows NetworkManager to manage VPNs @i{via} OpenVPN.
13355
13356 @end table
13357 @end deftp
13358
13359 @cindex Connman
13360 @deffn {Scheme Variable} connman-service-type
13361 This is the service type to run @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman},
13362 a network connection manager.
13363
13364 Its value must be an
13365 @code{connman-configuration} record as in this example:
13366
13367 @lisp
13368 (service connman-service-type
13369 (connman-configuration
13370 (disable-vpn? #t)))
13371 @end lisp
13372
13373 See below for details about @code{connman-configuration}.
13374 @end deffn
13375
13376 @deftp {Data Type} connman-configuration
13377 Data Type representing the configuration of connman.
13378
13379 @table @asis
13380 @item @code{connman} (default: @var{connman})
13381 The connman package to use.
13382
13383 @item @code{disable-vpn?} (default: @code{#f})
13384 When true, disable connman's vpn plugin.
13385 @end table
13386 @end deftp
13387
13388 @cindex WPA Supplicant
13389 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
13390 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
13391 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
13392 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks.
13393 @end defvr
13394
13395 @deftp {Data Type} wpa-supplicant-configuration
13396 Data type representing the configuration of WPA Supplicant.
13397
13398 It takes the following parameters:
13399
13400 @table @asis
13401 @item @code{wpa-supplicant} (default: @code{wpa-supplicant})
13402 The WPA Supplicant package to use.
13403
13404 @item @code{dbus?} (default: @code{#t})
13405 Whether to listen for requests on D-Bus.
13406
13407 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/wpa_supplicant.pid"})
13408 Where to store the PID file.
13409
13410 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
13411 If this is set, it must specify the name of a network interface that
13412 WPA supplicant will control.
13413
13414 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
13415 Optional configuration file to use.
13416
13417 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
13418 List of additional command-line arguments to pass to the daemon.
13419 @end table
13420 @end deftp
13421
13422 @cindex iptables
13423 @defvr {Scheme Variable} iptables-service-type
13424 This is the service type to set up an iptables configuration. iptables is a
13425 packet filtering framework supported by the Linux kernel. This service
13426 supports configuring iptables for both IPv4 and IPv6. A simple example
13427 configuration rejecting all incoming connections except those to the ssh port
13428 22 is shown below.
13429
13430 @lisp
13431 (service iptables-service-type
13432 (iptables-configuration
13433 (ipv4-rules (plain-file "iptables.rules" "*filter
13434 :INPUT ACCEPT
13435 :FORWARD ACCEPT
13436 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
13437 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
13438 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp-port-unreachable
13439 COMMIT
13440 "))
13441 (ipv6-rules (plain-file "ip6tables.rules" "*filter
13442 :INPUT ACCEPT
13443 :FORWARD ACCEPT
13444 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
13445 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
13446 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp6-port-unreachable
13447 COMMIT
13448 "))))
13449 @end lisp
13450 @end defvr
13451
13452 @deftp {Data Type} iptables-configuration
13453 The data type representing the configuration of iptables.
13454
13455 @table @asis
13456 @item @code{iptables} (default: @code{iptables})
13457 The iptables package that provides @code{iptables-restore} and
13458 @code{ip6tables-restore}.
13459 @item @code{ipv4-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
13460 The iptables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{iptables-restore}.
13461 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
13462 objects}).
13463 @item @code{ipv6-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
13464 The ip6tables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{ip6tables-restore}.
13465 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
13466 objects}).
13467 @end table
13468 @end deftp
13469
13470 @cindex nftables
13471 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nftables-service-type
13472 This is the service type to set up a nftables configuration. nftables is a
13473 netfilter project that aims to replace the existing iptables, ip6tables,
13474 arptables and ebtables framework. It provides a new packet filtering
13475 framework, a new user-space utility @command{nft}, and a compatibility layer
13476 for iptables. This service comes with a default ruleset
13477 @code{%default-nftables-ruleset} that rejecting all incomming connections
13478 except those to the ssh port 22. To use it, simply write:
13479
13480 @lisp
13481 (service nftables-service-type)
13482 @end lisp
13483 @end defvr
13484
13485 @deftp {Data Type} nftables-configuration
13486 The data type representing the configuration of nftables.
13487
13488 @table @asis
13489 @item @code{package} (default: @code{nftables})
13490 The nftables package that provides @command{nft}.
13491 @item @code{ruleset} (default: @code{%default-nftables-ruleset})
13492 The nftables ruleset to use. This may be any ``file-like'' object
13493 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
13494 @end table
13495 @end deftp
13496
13497 @cindex NTP (Network Time Protocol), service
13498 @cindex ntpd, service for the Network Time Protocol daemon
13499 @cindex real time clock
13500 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ntp-service-type
13501 This is the type of the service running the @uref{http://www.ntp.org,
13502 Network Time Protocol (NTP)} daemon, @command{ntpd}. The daemon will keep the
13503 system clock synchronized with that of the specified NTP servers.
13504
13505 The value of this service is an @code{ntpd-configuration} object, as described
13506 below.
13507 @end defvr
13508
13509 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-configuration
13510 This is the data type for the NTP service configuration.
13511
13512 @table @asis
13513 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%ntp-servers})
13514 This is the list of servers (@code{<ntp-server>} records) with which
13515 @command{ntpd} will be synchronized. See the @code{ntp-server} data type
13516 definition below.
13517
13518 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#t})
13519 This determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial
13520 adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
13521
13522 @item @code{ntp} (default: @code{ntp})
13523 The NTP package to use.
13524 @end table
13525 @end deftp
13526
13527 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
13528 List of host names used as the default NTP servers. These are servers of the
13529 @uref{https://www.ntppool.org/en/, NTP Pool Project}.
13530 @end defvr
13531
13532 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-server
13533 The data type representing the configuration of a NTP server.
13534
13535 @table @asis
13536 @item @code{type} (default: @code{'server})
13537 The type of the NTP server, given as a symbol. One of @code{'pool},
13538 @code{'server}, @code{'peer}, @code{'broadcast} or @code{'manycastclient}.
13539
13540 @item @code{address}
13541 The address of the server, as a string.
13542
13543 @item @code{options}
13544 NTPD options to use with that specific server, given as a list of option names
13545 and/or of option names and values tuples. The following example define a server
13546 to use with the options @option{iburst} and @option{prefer}, as well as
13547 @option{version} 3 and a @option{maxpoll} time of 16 seconds.
13548
13549 @example
13550 (ntp-server
13551 (type 'server)
13552 (address "some.ntp.server.org")
13553 (options `(iburst (version 3) (maxpoll 16) prefer))))
13554 @end example
13555 @end table
13556 @end deftp
13557
13558 @cindex OpenNTPD
13559 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openntpd-service-type
13560 Run the @command{ntpd}, the Network Time Protocol (NTP) daemon, as implemented
13561 by @uref{http://www.openntpd.org, OpenNTPD}. The daemon will keep the system
13562 clock synchronized with that of the given servers.
13563
13564 @lisp
13565 (service
13566 openntpd-service-type
13567 (openntpd-configuration
13568 (listen-on '("127.0.0.1" "::1"))
13569 (sensor '("udcf0 correction 70000"))
13570 (constraint-from '("www.gnu.org"))
13571 (constraints-from '("https://www.google.com/"))
13572 (allow-large-adjustment? #t)))
13573
13574 @end lisp
13575 @end deffn
13576
13577 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %openntpd-servers
13578 This variable is a list of the server addresses defined in
13579 @var{%ntp-servers}.
13580 @end defvr
13581
13582 @deftp {Data Type} openntpd-configuration
13583 @table @asis
13584 @item @code{openntpd} (default: @code{(file-append openntpd "/sbin/ntpd")})
13585 The openntpd executable to use.
13586 @item @code{listen-on} (default: @code{'("127.0.0.1" "::1")})
13587 A list of local IP addresses or hostnames the ntpd daemon should listen on.
13588 @item @code{query-from} (default: @code{'()})
13589 A list of local IP address the ntpd daemon should use for outgoing queries.
13590 @item @code{sensor} (default: @code{'()})
13591 Specify a list of timedelta sensor devices ntpd should use. @code{ntpd}
13592 will listen to each sensor that actually exists and ignore non-existent ones.
13593 See @uref{https://man.openbsd.org/ntpd.conf, upstream documentation} for more
13594 information.
13595 @item @code{server} (default: @code{'()})
13596 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP servers to synchronize to.
13597 @item @code{servers} (default: @var{%openntp-servers})
13598 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP pools to synchronize to.
13599 @item @code{constraint-from} (default: @code{'()})
13600 @code{ntpd} can be configured to query the ‘Date’ from trusted HTTPS servers via TLS.
13601 This time information is not used for precision but acts as an authenticated
13602 constraint, thereby reducing the impact of unauthenticated NTP
13603 man-in-the-middle attacks.
13604 Specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of HTTPS servers to provide
13605 a constraint.
13606 @item @code{constraints-from} (default: @code{'()})
13607 As with constraint from, specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of
13608 HTTPS servers to provide a constraint. Should the hostname resolve to multiple
13609 IP addresses, @code{ntpd} will calculate a median constraint from all of them.
13610 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#f})
13611 Determines if @code{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial adjustment of more
13612 than 180 seconds.
13613 @end table
13614 @end deftp
13615
13616 @cindex inetd
13617 @deffn {Scheme variable} inetd-service-type
13618 This service runs the @command{inetd} (@pxref{inetd invocation,,,
13619 inetutils, GNU Inetutils}) daemon. @command{inetd} listens for
13620 connections on internet sockets, and lazily starts the specified server
13621 program when a connection is made on one of these sockets.
13622
13623 The value of this service is an @code{inetd-configuration} object. The
13624 following example configures the @command{inetd} daemon to provide the
13625 built-in @command{echo} service, as well as an smtp service which
13626 forwards smtp traffic over ssh to a server @code{smtp-server} behind a
13627 gateway @code{hostname}:
13628
13629 @lisp
13630 (service
13631 inetd-service-type
13632 (inetd-configuration
13633 (entries (list
13634 (inetd-entry
13635 (name "echo")
13636 (socket-type 'stream)
13637 (protocol "tcp")
13638 (wait? #f)
13639 (user "root"))
13640 (inetd-entry
13641 (node "127.0.0.1")
13642 (name "smtp")
13643 (socket-type 'stream)
13644 (protocol "tcp")
13645 (wait? #f)
13646 (user "root")
13647 (program (file-append openssh "/bin/ssh"))
13648 (arguments
13649 '("ssh" "-qT" "-i" "/path/to/ssh_key"
13650 "-W" "smtp-server:25" "user@@hostname")))))))
13651 @end lisp
13652
13653 See below for more details about @code{inetd-configuration}.
13654 @end deffn
13655
13656 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-configuration
13657 Data type representing the configuration of @command{inetd}.
13658
13659 @table @asis
13660 @item @code{program} (default: @code{(file-append inetutils "/libexec/inetd")})
13661 The @command{inetd} executable to use.
13662
13663 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
13664 A list of @command{inetd} service entries. Each entry should be created
13665 by the @code{inetd-entry} constructor.
13666 @end table
13667 @end deftp
13668
13669 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-entry
13670 Data type representing an entry in the @command{inetd} configuration.
13671 Each entry corresponds to a socket where @command{inetd} will listen for
13672 requests.
13673
13674 @table @asis
13675 @item @code{node} (default: @code{#f})
13676 Optional string, a comma-separated list of local addresses
13677 @command{inetd} should use when listening for this service.
13678 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a complete
13679 description of all options.
13680 @item @code{name}
13681 A string, the name must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/services}.
13682 @item @code{socket-type}
13683 One of @code{'stream}, @code{'dgram}, @code{'raw}, @code{'rdm} or
13684 @code{'seqpacket}.
13685 @item @code{protocol}
13686 A string, must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/protocols}.
13687 @item @code{wait?} (default: @code{#t})
13688 Whether @command{inetd} should wait for the server to exit before
13689 listening to new service requests.
13690 @item @code{user}
13691 A string containing the user (and, optionally, group) name of the user
13692 as whom the server should run. The group name can be specified in a
13693 suffix, separated by a colon or period, i.e.@: @code{"user"},
13694 @code{"user:group"} or @code{"user.group"}.
13695 @item @code{program} (default: @code{"internal"})
13696 The server program which will serve the requests, or @code{"internal"}
13697 if @command{inetd} should use a built-in service.
13698 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
13699 A list strings or file-like objects, which are the server program's
13700 arguments, starting with the zeroth argument, i.e.@: the name of the
13701 program itself. For @command{inetd}'s internal services, this entry
13702 must be @code{'()} or @code{'("internal")}.
13703 @end table
13704
13705 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a more
13706 detailed discussion of each configuration field.
13707 @end deftp
13708
13709 @cindex Tor
13710 @defvr {Scheme Variable} tor-service-type
13711 This is the type for a service that runs the @uref{https://torproject.org,
13712 Tor} anonymous networking daemon. The service is configured using a
13713 @code{<tor-configuration>} record. By default, the Tor daemon runs as the
13714 @code{tor} unprivileged user, which is a member of the @code{tor} group.
13715
13716 @end defvr
13717
13718 @deftp {Data Type} tor-configuration
13719 @table @asis
13720 @item @code{tor} (default: @code{tor})
13721 The package that provides the Tor daemon. This package is expected to provide
13722 the daemon at @file{bin/tor} relative to its output directory. The default
13723 package is the @uref{https://www.torproject.org, Tor Project's}
13724 implementation.
13725
13726 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(plain-file "empty" "")})
13727 The configuration file to use. It will be appended to a default configuration
13728 file, and the final configuration file will be passed to @code{tor} via its
13729 @code{-f} option. This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions,
13730 file-like objects}). See @code{man tor} for details on the configuration file
13731 syntax.
13732
13733 @item @code{hidden-services} (default: @code{'()})
13734 The list of @code{<hidden-service>} records to use. For any hidden service
13735 you include in this list, appropriate configuration to enable the hidden
13736 service will be automatically added to the default configuration file. You
13737 may conveniently create @code{<hidden-service>} records using the
13738 @code{tor-hidden-service} procedure described below.
13739
13740 @item @code{socks-socket-type} (default: @code{'tcp})
13741 The default socket type that Tor should use for its SOCKS socket. This must
13742 be either @code{'tcp} or @code{'unix}. If it is @code{'tcp}, then by default
13743 Tor will listen on TCP port 9050 on the loopback interface (i.e., localhost).
13744 If it is @code{'unix}, then Tor will listen on the UNIX domain socket
13745 @file{/var/run/tor/socks-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
13746 @code{tor} group.
13747
13748 If you want to customize the SOCKS socket in more detail, leave
13749 @code{socks-socket-type} at its default value of @code{'tcp} and use
13750 @code{config-file} to override the default by providing your own
13751 @code{SocksPort} option.
13752 @end table
13753 @end deftp
13754
13755 @cindex hidden service
13756 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
13757 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
13758 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
13759
13760 @example
13761 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
13762 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
13763 @end example
13764
13765 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
13766 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
13767
13768 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
13769 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
13770 service.
13771
13772 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
13773 project's documentation} for more information.
13774 @end deffn
13775
13776 The @code{(gnu services rsync)} module provides the following services:
13777
13778 You might want an rsync daemon if you have files that you want available
13779 so anyone (or just yourself) can download existing files or upload new
13780 files.
13781
13782 @deffn {Scheme Variable} rsync-service-type
13783 This is the service type for the @uref{https://rsync.samba.org, rsync} daemon,
13784 The value for this service type is a
13785 @command{rsync-configuration} record as in this example:
13786
13787 @lisp
13788 (service rsync-service-type)
13789 @end lisp
13790
13791 See below for details about @code{rsync-configuration}.
13792 @end deffn
13793
13794 @deftp {Data Type} rsync-configuration
13795 Data type representing the configuration for @code{rsync-service}.
13796
13797 @table @asis
13798 @item @code{package} (default: @var{rsync})
13799 @code{rsync} package to use.
13800
13801 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{873})
13802 TCP port on which @command{rsync} listens for incoming connections. If port
13803 is less than @code{1024} @command{rsync} needs to be started as the
13804 @code{root} user and group.
13805
13806 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.pid"})
13807 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its PID.
13808
13809 @item @code{lock-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.lock"})
13810 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its lock file.
13811
13812 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/rsyncd.log"})
13813 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its log file.
13814
13815 @item @code{use-chroot?} (default: @var{#t})
13816 Whether to use chroot for @command{rsync} shared directory.
13817
13818 @item @code{share-path} (default: @file{/srv/rsync})
13819 Location of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
13820
13821 @item @code{share-comment} (default: @code{"Rsync share"})
13822 Comment of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
13823
13824 @item @code{read-only?} (default: @var{#f})
13825 Read-write permissions to shared directory.
13826
13827 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{300})
13828 I/O timeout in seconds.
13829
13830 @item @code{user} (default: @var{"root"})
13831 Owner of the @code{rsync} process.
13832
13833 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"root"})
13834 Group of the @code{rsync} process.
13835
13836 @item @code{uid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
13837 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
13838 place as when the daemon was run as @code{root}.
13839
13840 @item @code{gid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
13841 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
13842
13843 @end table
13844 @end deftp
13845
13846 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
13847 @cindex SSH
13848 @cindex SSH server
13849
13850 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
13851 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
13852 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
13853 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
13854 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
13855 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
13856 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
13857 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
13858 only by root.
13859
13860 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
13861 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
13862 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
13863 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
13864 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
13865
13866 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
13867 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
13868 require interaction.
13869
13870 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
13871 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
13872 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
13873 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
13874
13875 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
13876 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
13877 or addresses.
13878
13879 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
13880 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
13881 root.
13882
13883 The other options should be self-descriptive.
13884 @end deffn
13885
13886 @cindex SSH
13887 @cindex SSH server
13888 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
13889 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
13890 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
13891 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
13892
13893 @lisp
13894 (service openssh-service-type
13895 (openssh-configuration
13896 (x11-forwarding? #t)
13897 (permit-root-login 'without-password)
13898 (authorized-keys
13899 `(("alice" ,(local-file "alice.pub"))
13900 ("bob" ,(local-file "bob.pub"))))))
13901 @end lisp
13902
13903 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
13904
13905 This service can be extended with extra authorized keys, as in this
13906 example:
13907
13908 @lisp
13909 (service-extension openssh-service-type
13910 (const `(("charlie"
13911 ,(local-file "charlie.pub")))))
13912 @end lisp
13913 @end deffn
13914
13915 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
13916 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
13917
13918 @table @asis
13919 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
13920 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
13921
13922 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
13923 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
13924
13925 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
13926 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
13927 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
13928 If it's the symbol @code{'without-password}, then root logins are
13929 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
13930
13931 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
13932 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
13933 not.
13934
13935 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
13936 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
13937 other authentication methods.
13938
13939 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
13940 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
13941 false, users have to use other authentication method.
13942
13943 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
13944 This is used only by protocol version 2.
13945
13946 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
13947 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
13948 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
13949 @option{-Y} will work.
13950
13951 @item @code{allow-agent-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
13952 Whether to allow agent forwarding.
13953
13954 @item @code{allow-tcp-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
13955 Whether to allow TCP forwarding.
13956
13957 @item @code{gateway-ports?} (default: @code{#f})
13958 Whether to allow gateway ports.
13959
13960 @item @code{challenge-response-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
13961 Specifies whether challenge response authentication is allowed (e.g.@: via
13962 PAM).
13963
13964 @item @code{use-pam?} (default: @code{#t})
13965 Enables the Pluggable Authentication Module interface. If set to
13966 @code{#t}, this will enable PAM authentication using
13967 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} and
13968 @code{password-authentication?}, in addition to PAM account and session
13969 module processing for all authentication types.
13970
13971 Because PAM challenge response authentication usually serves an
13972 equivalent role to password authentication, you should disable either
13973 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} or
13974 @code{password-authentication?}.
13975
13976 @item @code{print-last-log?} (default: @code{#t})
13977 Specifies whether @command{sshd} should print the date and time of the
13978 last user login when a user logs in interactively.
13979
13980 @item @code{subsystems} (default: @code{'(("sftp" "internal-sftp"))})
13981 Configures external subsystems (e.g.@: file transfer daemon).
13982
13983 This is a list of two-element lists, each of which containing the
13984 subsystem name and a command (with optional arguments) to execute upon
13985 subsystem request.
13986
13987 The command @command{internal-sftp} implements an in-process SFTP
13988 server. Alternately, one can specify the @command{sftp-server} command:
13989 @lisp
13990 (service openssh-service-type
13991 (openssh-configuration
13992 (subsystems
13993 `(("sftp" ,(file-append openssh "/libexec/sftp-server"))))))
13994 @end lisp
13995
13996 @item @code{accepted-environment} (default: @code{'()})
13997 List of strings describing which environment variables may be exported.
13998
13999 Each string gets on its own line. See the @code{AcceptEnv} option in
14000 @code{man sshd_config}.
14001
14002 This example allows ssh-clients to export the @code{COLORTERM} variable.
14003 It is set by terminal emulators, which support colors. You can use it in
14004 your shell's ressource file to enable colors for the prompt and commands
14005 if this variable is set.
14006
14007 @lisp
14008 (service openssh-service-type
14009 (openssh-configuration
14010 (accepted-environment '("COLORTERM"))))
14011 @end lisp
14012
14013 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{'()})
14014 @cindex authorized keys, SSH
14015 @cindex SSH authorized keys
14016 This is the list of authorized keys. Each element of the list is a user
14017 name followed by one or more file-like objects that represent SSH public
14018 keys. For example:
14019
14020 @lisp
14021 (openssh-configuration
14022 (authorized-keys
14023 `(("rekado" ,(local-file "rekado.pub"))
14024 ("chris" ,(local-file "chris.pub"))
14025 ("root" ,(local-file "rekado.pub") ,(local-file "chris.pub")))))
14026 @end lisp
14027
14028 @noindent
14029 registers the specified public keys for user accounts @code{rekado},
14030 @code{chris}, and @code{root}.
14031
14032 Additional authorized keys can be specified @i{via}
14033 @code{service-extension}.
14034
14035 Note that this does @emph{not} interfere with the use of
14036 @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
14037
14038 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
14039 This is a symbol specifying the logging level: @code{quiet}, @code{fatal},
14040 @code{error}, @code{info}, @code{verbose}, @code{debug}, etc. See the man
14041 page for @file{sshd_config} for the full list of level names.
14042
14043 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
14044 This field can be used to append arbitrary text to the configuration file. It
14045 is especially useful for elaborate configurations that cannot be expressed
14046 otherwise. This configuration, for example, would generally disable root
14047 logins, but permit them from one specific IP address:
14048
14049 @lisp
14050 (openssh-configuration
14051 (extra-content "\
14052 Match Address 192.168.0.1
14053 PermitRootLogin yes"))
14054 @end lisp
14055
14056 @end table
14057 @end deftp
14058
14059 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
14060 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
14061 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
14062 object.
14063
14064 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
14065 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
14066
14067 @lisp
14068 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
14069 (port-number 1234)))
14070 @end lisp
14071 @end deffn
14072
14073 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
14074 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
14075
14076 @table @asis
14077 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
14078 The Dropbear package to use.
14079
14080 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
14081 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
14082
14083 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
14084 Whether to enable syslog output.
14085
14086 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
14087 File name of the daemon's PID file.
14088
14089 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
14090 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
14091
14092 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
14093 Whether to allow empty passwords.
14094
14095 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
14096 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
14097 @end table
14098 @end deftp
14099
14100 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
14101 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
14102 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
14103 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
14104 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
14105 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
14106
14107 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
14108 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
14109 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
14110
14111 @lisp
14112 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
14113
14114 (operating-system
14115 (host-name "mymachine")
14116 ;; ...
14117 (hosts-file
14118 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
14119 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
14120 (plain-file "hosts"
14121 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
14122 %facebook-host-aliases))))
14123 @end lisp
14124
14125 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
14126 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
14127 @end defvr
14128
14129 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
14130
14131 @defvr {Scheme Variable} avahi-service-type
14132 This is the service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
14133 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
14134 ``zero-configuration'' host name lookups (see @uref{https://avahi.org/}).
14135 Its value must be a @code{zero-configuration} record---see below.
14136
14137 This service extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can
14138 resolve @code{.local} host names using
14139 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. @xref{Name
14140 Service Switch}, for information on host name resolution.
14141
14142 Additionally, add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that
14143 commands such as @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
14144 @end defvr
14145
14146 @deftp {Data Type} avahi-configuration
14147 Data type representation the configuration for Avahi.
14148
14149 @table @asis
14150
14151 @item @code{host-name} (default: @code{#f})
14152 If different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
14153 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
14154
14155 @item @code{publish?} (default: @code{#t})
14156 When true, allow host names and services to be published (broadcast) over the
14157 network.
14158
14159 @item @code{publish-workstation?} (default: @code{#t})
14160 When true, @command{avahi-daemon} publishes the machine's host name and IP
14161 address via mDNS on the local network. To view the host names published on
14162 your local network, you can run:
14163
14164 @example
14165 avahi-browse _workstation._tcp
14166 @end example
14167
14168 @item @code{wide-area?} (default: @code{#f})
14169 When true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
14170
14171 @item @code{ipv4?} (default: @code{#t})
14172 @itemx @code{ipv6?} (default: @code{#t})
14173 These fields determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6 sockets.
14174
14175 @item @code{domains-to-browse} (default: @code{'()})
14176 This is a list of domains to browse.
14177 @end table
14178 @end deftp
14179
14180 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openvswitch-service-type
14181 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.openvswitch.org, Open vSwitch}
14182 service, whose value should be an @code{openvswitch-configuration}
14183 object.
14184 @end deffn
14185
14186 @deftp {Data Type} openvswitch-configuration
14187 Data type representing the configuration of Open vSwitch, a multilayer
14188 virtual switch which is designed to enable massive network automation
14189 through programmatic extension.
14190
14191 @table @asis
14192 @item @code{package} (default: @var{openvswitch})
14193 Package object of the Open vSwitch.
14194
14195 @end table
14196 @end deftp
14197
14198 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pagekite-service-type
14199 This is the service type for the @uref{https://pagekite.net, PageKite} service,
14200 a tunneling solution for making localhost servers publicly visible, even from
14201 behind restrictive firewalls or NAT without forwarded ports. The value for
14202 this service type is a @code{pagekite-configuration} record.
14203
14204 Here's an example exposing the local HTTP and SSH daemons:
14205
14206 @lisp
14207 (service pagekite-service-type
14208 (pagekite-configuration
14209 (kites '("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret"
14210 "raw/22:@@kitename:localhost:22:@@kitesecret"))
14211 (extra-file "/etc/pagekite.rc")))
14212 @end lisp
14213 @end defvr
14214
14215 @deftp {Data Type} pagekite-configuration
14216 Data type representing the configuration of PageKite.
14217
14218 @table @asis
14219 @item @code{package} (default: @var{pagekite})
14220 Package object of PageKite.
14221
14222 @item @code{kitename} (default: @code{#f})
14223 PageKite name for authenticating to the frontend server.
14224
14225 @item @code{kitesecret} (default: @code{#f})
14226 Shared secret for authenticating to the frontend server. You should probably
14227 put this inside @code{extra-file} instead.
14228
14229 @item @code{frontend} (default: @code{#f})
14230 Connect to the named PageKite frontend server instead of the
14231 @uref{https://pagekite.net,,pagekite.net} service.
14232
14233 @item @code{kites} (default: @code{'("http:@@kitename:localhost:80:@@kitesecret")})
14234 List of service kites to use. Exposes HTTP on port 80 by default. The format
14235 is @code{proto:kitename:host:port:secret}.
14236
14237 @item @code{extra-file} (default: @code{#f})
14238 Extra configuration file to read, which you are expected to create manually.
14239 Use this to add additional options and manage shared secrets out-of-band.
14240
14241 @end table
14242 @end deftp
14243
14244 @node X Window
14245 @subsection X Window
14246
14247 @cindex X11
14248 @cindex X Window System
14249 @cindex login manager
14250 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
14251 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
14252 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
14253 started by the @dfn{login manager}, by default the GNOME Display Manager (GDM).
14254
14255 @cindex GDM
14256 @cindex GNOME, login manager
14257 GDM of course allows users to log in into window managers and desktop
14258 environments other than GNOME; for those using GNOME, GDM is required for
14259 features such as automatic screen locking.
14260
14261 @cindex window manager
14262 To use X11, you must install at least one @dfn{window manager}---for
14263 example the @code{windowmaker} or @code{openbox} packages---preferably
14264 by adding it to the @code{packages} field of your operating system
14265 definition (@pxref{operating-system Reference, system-wide packages}).
14266
14267 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gdm-service-type
14268 This is the type for the @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GDM/, GNOME
14269 Desktop Manager} (GDM), a program that manages graphical display servers and
14270 handles graphical user logins. Its value must be a @code{gdm-configuration}
14271 (see below.)
14272
14273 @cindex session types (X11)
14274 @cindex X11 session types
14275 GDM looks for @dfn{session types} described by the @file{.desktop} files in
14276 @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users to choose
14277 a session from the log-in screen. Packages such as @code{gnome}, @code{xfce},
14278 and @code{i3} provide @file{.desktop} files; adding them to the system-wide
14279 set of packages automatically makes them available at the log-in screen.
14280
14281 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
14282 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
14283 and/or other X clients.
14284 @end defvr
14285
14286 @deftp {Data Type} gdm-configuration
14287 @table @asis
14288 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
14289 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{#f})
14290 When @code{auto-login?} is false, GDM presents a log-in screen.
14291
14292 When @code{auto-login?} is true, GDM logs in directly as
14293 @code{default-user}.
14294
14295 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
14296 When true, GDM writes debug messages to its log.
14297
14298 @item @code{gnome-shell-assets} (default: ...)
14299 List of GNOME Shell assets needed by GDM: icon theme, fonts, etc.
14300
14301 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default: @code{(xorg-configuration)})
14302 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
14303
14304 @item @code{xsession} (default: @code{(xinitrc)})
14305 Script to run before starting a X session.
14306
14307 @item @code{dbus-daemon} (default: @code{dbus-daemon-wrapper})
14308 File name of the @code{dbus-daemon} executable.
14309
14310 @item @code{gdm} (default: @code{gdm})
14311 The GDM package to use.
14312 @end table
14313 @end deftp
14314
14315 @defvr {Scheme Variable} slim-service-type
14316 This is the type for the SLiM graphical login manager for X11.
14317
14318 Like GDM, SLiM looks for session types described by @file{.desktop} files and
14319 allows users to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. It
14320 also honors @file{~/.xsession} files.
14321
14322 Unlike GDM, SLiM does not spawn the user session on a different VT after
14323 logging in, which means that you can only start one graphical session. If you
14324 want to be able to run multiple graphical sessions at the same time you have
14325 to add multiple SLiM services to your system services. The following example
14326 shows how to replace the default GDM service with two SLiM services on tty7
14327 and tty8.
14328
14329 @lisp
14330 (use-modules (gnu services)
14331 (gnu services desktop)
14332 (gnu services xorg)
14333 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'remove'
14334
14335 (operating-system
14336 ;; ...
14337 (services (cons* (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
14338 (display ":0")
14339 (vt "vt7")))
14340 (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
14341 (display ":1")
14342 (vt "vt8")))
14343 (remove (lambda (service)
14344 (eq? (service-kind service) gdm-service-type))
14345 %desktop-services))))
14346 @end lisp
14347
14348 @end defvr
14349
14350 @deftp {Data Type} slim-configuration
14351 Data type representing the configuration of @code{slim-service-type}.
14352
14353 @table @asis
14354 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
14355 Whether to allow logins with empty passwords.
14356
14357 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
14358 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{""})
14359 When @code{auto-login?} is false, SLiM presents a log-in screen.
14360
14361 When @code{auto-login?} is true, SLiM logs in directly as
14362 @code{default-user}.
14363
14364 @item @code{theme} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme})
14365 @itemx @code{theme-name} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme-name})
14366 The graphical theme to use and its name.
14367
14368 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{#f})
14369 If true, this must be the name of the executable to start as the default
14370 session---e.g., @code{(file-append windowmaker "/bin/windowmaker")}.
14371
14372 If false, a session described by one of the available @file{.desktop}
14373 files in @code{/run/current-system/profile} and @code{~/.guix-profile}
14374 will be used.
14375
14376 @quotation Note
14377 You must install at least one window manager in the system profile or in
14378 your user profile. Failing to do that, if @code{auto-login-session} is
14379 false, you will be unable to log in.
14380 @end quotation
14381
14382 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
14383 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
14384
14385 @item @code{display} (default @code{":0"})
14386 The display on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
14387
14388 @item @code{vt} (default @code{"vt7"})
14389 The VT on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
14390
14391 @item @code{xauth} (default: @code{xauth})
14392 The XAuth package to use.
14393
14394 @item @code{shepherd} (default: @code{shepherd})
14395 The Shepherd package used when invoking @command{halt} and
14396 @command{reboot}.
14397
14398 @item @code{sessreg} (default: @code{sessreg})
14399 The sessreg package used in order to register the session.
14400
14401 @item @code{slim} (default: @code{slim})
14402 The SLiM package to use.
14403 @end table
14404 @end deftp
14405
14406 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
14407 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
14408 The default SLiM theme and its name.
14409 @end defvr
14410
14411
14412 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
14413 This is the data type representing the sddm service configuration.
14414
14415 @table @asis
14416 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
14417 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are "x11"
14418 or "wayland".
14419
14420 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
14421 Valid values are "on", "off" or "none".
14422
14423 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
14424 Command to run when halting.
14425
14426 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
14427 Command to run when rebooting.
14428
14429 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
14430 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are "elarun" or "maldives".
14431
14432 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
14433 Directory to look for themes.
14434
14435 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
14436 Directory to look for faces.
14437
14438 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
14439 Default PATH to use.
14440
14441 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: 1000)
14442 Minimum UID displayed in SDDM and allowed for log-in.
14443
14444 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default: 2000)
14445 Maximum UID to display in SDDM.
14446
14447 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
14448 Remember last user.
14449
14450 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
14451 Remember last session.
14452
14453 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
14454 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
14455
14456 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
14457 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
14458
14459 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
14460 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
14461
14462 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
14463 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
14464
14465 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
14466 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
14467
14468 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
14469 Path to xauth.
14470
14471 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
14472 Path to Xephyr.
14473
14474 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
14475 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
14476
14477 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
14478 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
14479
14480 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitrc})
14481 Script to run before starting a X session.
14482
14483 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
14484 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
14485
14486 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
14487 Minimum VT to use.
14488
14489 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
14490 User to use for auto-login.
14491
14492 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
14493 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
14494
14495 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
14496 Relogin after logout.
14497
14498 @end table
14499 @end deftp
14500
14501 @cindex login manager
14502 @cindex X11 login
14503 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sddm-service-type
14504 This is the type of the service to run the
14505 @uref{https://github.com/sddm/sddm,SSDM display manager}. Its value
14506 must be a @code{sddm-configuration} record (see below).
14507
14508 Here's an example use:
14509
14510 @lisp
14511 (service sddm-service-type
14512 (sddm-configuration
14513 (auto-login-user "alice")
14514 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
14515 @end lisp
14516 @end defvr
14517
14518 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
14519 This data type represents the configuration of the SDDM login manager.
14520 The available fields are:
14521
14522 @table @asis
14523 @item @code{sddm} (default: @code{sddm})
14524 The SDDM package to use.
14525
14526 @item @code{display-server} (default: @code{"x11"})
14527 This must be either @code{"x11"} or @code{"wayland"}.
14528
14529 @c FIXME: Add more fields.
14530
14531 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default: @code{""})
14532 If non-empty, this is the user account under which to log in
14533 automatically.
14534
14535 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{""})
14536 If non-empty, this is the @file{.desktop} file name to use as the
14537 auto-login session.
14538 @end table
14539 @end deftp
14540
14541 @cindex Xorg, configuration
14542 @deftp {Data Type} xorg-configuration
14543 This data type represents the configuration of the Xorg graphical display
14544 server. Note that there is not Xorg service; instead, the X server is started
14545 by a ``display manager'' such as GDM, SDDM, and SLiM. Thus, the configuration
14546 of these display managers aggregates an @code{xorg-configuration} record.
14547
14548 @table @asis
14549 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-xorg-modules})
14550 This is a list of @dfn{module packages} loaded by the Xorg
14551 server---e.g., @code{xf86-video-vesa}, @code{xf86-input-keyboard}, and so on.
14552
14553 @item @code{fonts} (default: @code{%default-xorg-fonts})
14554 This is a list of font directories to add to the server's @dfn{font path}.
14555
14556 @item @code{drivers} (default: @code{'()})
14557 This must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a graphics
14558 driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in this
14559 order---e.g., @code{("modesetting" "vesa")}.
14560
14561 @item @code{resolutions} (default: @code{'()})
14562 When @code{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an appropriate screen
14563 resolution. Otherwise, it must be a list of resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024
14564 768) (640 480))}.
14565
14566 @cindex keyboard layout, for Xorg
14567 @cindex keymap, for Xorg
14568 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
14569 If this is @code{#f}, Xorg uses the default keyboard layout---usually US
14570 English (``qwerty'') for a 105-key PC keyboard.
14571
14572 Otherwise this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object specifying the keyboard
14573 layout in use when Xorg is running. @xref{Keyboard Layout}, for more
14574 information on how to specify the keyboard layout.
14575
14576 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
14577 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file. It
14578 is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration file.
14579
14580 @item @code{server} (default: @code{xorg-server})
14581 This is the package providing the Xorg server.
14582
14583 @item @code{server-arguments} (default: @code{%default-xorg-server-arguments})
14584 This is the list of command-line arguments to pass to the X server. The
14585 default is @code{-nolisten tcp}.
14586 @end table
14587 @end deftp
14588
14589 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} set-xorg-configuration @var{config} @
14590 [@var{login-manager-service-type}]
14591 Tell the log-in manager (of type @var{login-manager-service-type}) to use
14592 @var{config}, an @code{<xorg-configuration>} record.
14593
14594 Since the Xorg configuration is embedded in the log-in manager's
14595 configuration---e.g., @code{gdm-configuration}---this procedure provides a
14596 shorthand to set the Xorg configuration.
14597 @end deffn
14598
14599 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [@var{config}]
14600 Return a @code{startx} script in which the modules, fonts, etc. specified
14601 in @var{config}, are available. The result should be used in place of
14602 @code{startx}.
14603
14604 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
14605 @end deffn
14606
14607
14608 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{program}]
14609 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen locker or screen saver whose
14610 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
14611 for it. For example:
14612
14613 @lisp
14614 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
14615 @end lisp
14616
14617 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
14618 @end deffn
14619
14620
14621 @node Printing Services
14622 @subsection Printing Services
14623
14624 @cindex printer support with CUPS
14625 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
14626 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a Guix
14627 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
14628
14629 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
14630 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
14631 CUPS configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
14632 write:
14633 @lisp
14634 (service cups-service-type)
14635 @end lisp
14636 @end deffn
14637
14638 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
14639 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
14640 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
14641 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
14642 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
14643 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
14644 secure connections to the print server.
14645
14646 Suppose you want to enable the Web interface of CUPS and also add
14647 support for Epson printers @i{via} the @code{escpr} package and for HP
14648 printers @i{via} the @code{hplip-minimal} package. You can do that directly,
14649 like this (you need to use the @code{(gnu packages cups)} module):
14650
14651 @lisp
14652 (service cups-service-type
14653 (cups-configuration
14654 (web-interface? #t)
14655 (extensions
14656 (list cups-filters escpr hplip-minimal))))
14657 @end lisp
14658
14659 Note: If you wish to use the Qt5 based GUI which comes with the hplip
14660 package then it is suggested that you install the @code{hplip} package,
14661 either in your OS configuration file or as your user.
14662
14663 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
14664 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
14665 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
14666 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
14667 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
14668 from some other system; see the end for more details.
14669
14670 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
14671 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
14672 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
14673 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
14674 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
14675 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
14676 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
14677
14678
14679 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
14680
14681 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
14682 The CUPS package.
14683 @end deftypevr
14684
14685 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions
14686 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
14687 @end deftypevr
14688
14689 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
14690 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
14691 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
14692
14693 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
14694
14695 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
14696 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
14697 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
14698 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
14699 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
14700 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
14701 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
14702 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
14703
14704 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
14705 @end deftypevr
14706
14707 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
14708 Where CUPS should cache data.
14709
14710 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
14711 @end deftypevr
14712
14713 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
14714 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
14715 writes.
14716
14717 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
14718 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
14719 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
14720 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
14721 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
14722
14723 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
14724 @end deftypevr
14725
14726 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
14727 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
14728 error log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
14729 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
14730 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
14731 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
14732 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
14733 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
14734
14735 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
14736 @end deftypevr
14737
14738 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
14739 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
14740 kind strings are:
14741
14742 @table @code
14743 @item none
14744 No errors are fatal.
14745
14746 @item all
14747 All of the errors below are fatal.
14748
14749 @item browse
14750 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
14751 to the DNS-SD daemon.
14752
14753 @item config
14754 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
14755
14756 @item listen
14757 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
14758 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
14759
14760 @item log
14761 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
14762
14763 @item permissions
14764 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
14765 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
14766 @end table
14767
14768 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
14769 @end deftypevr
14770
14771 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
14772 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
14773 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
14774
14775 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14776 @end deftypevr
14777
14778 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
14779 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
14780 programs.
14781
14782 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
14783 @end deftypevr
14784
14785 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
14786 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
14787
14788 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
14789 @end deftypevr
14790
14791 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
14792 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
14793 page log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
14794 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
14795 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
14796 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
14797 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
14798 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
14799
14800 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
14801 @end deftypevr
14802
14803 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
14804 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
14805 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
14806
14807 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
14808 @end deftypevr
14809
14810 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
14811 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
14812 data.
14813
14814 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
14815 @end deftypevr
14816
14817 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
14818 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
14819 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
14820 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
14821 used/supported on macOS.
14822
14823 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
14824 @end deftypevr
14825
14826 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
14827 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
14828 look for public and private keys in this directory: a @code{.crt} files
14829 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @code{.key} files for
14830 PEM-encoded private keys.
14831
14832 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
14833 @end deftypevr
14834
14835 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
14836 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
14837
14838 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
14839 @end deftypevr
14840
14841 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
14842 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
14843 configuration or state files.
14844
14845 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14846 @end deftypevr
14847
14848 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
14849 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
14850 @end deftypevr
14851
14852 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
14853 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
14854
14855 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
14856 @end deftypevr
14857
14858 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
14859 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
14860 programs.
14861
14862 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
14863 @end deftypevr
14864
14865 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string set-env
14866 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
14867
14868 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
14869 @end deftypevr
14870 @end deftypevr
14871
14872 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
14873 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
14874 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
14875 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
14876 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
14877 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
14878 level logs all requests.
14879
14880 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
14881 @end deftypevr
14882
14883 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
14884 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
14885 longer required for quotas.
14886
14887 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14888 @end deftypevr
14889
14890 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list browse-dns-sd-sub-types
14891 Specifies a list of DNS-SD sub-types to advertise for each shared printer.
14892 For example, @samp{"_cups" "_print"} will tell network clients that both
14893 CUPS sharing and IPP Everywhere are supported.
14894
14895 Defaults to @samp{"_cups"}.
14896 @end deftypevr
14897
14898 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
14899 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
14900
14901 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
14902 @end deftypevr
14903
14904 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
14905 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
14906
14907 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14908 @end deftypevr
14909
14910 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
14911 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
14912
14913 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14914 @end deftypevr
14915
14916 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
14917 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
14918 name can be used, including "classified", "confidential", "secret",
14919 "topsecret", and "unclassified", or the banner can be omitted to disable
14920 secure printing functions.
14921
14922 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14923 @end deftypevr
14924
14925 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
14926 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
14927 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
14928
14929 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14930 @end deftypevr
14931
14932 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
14933 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
14934
14935 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
14936 @end deftypevr
14937
14938 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
14939 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
14940
14941 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
14942 @end deftypevr
14943
14944 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
14945 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
14946
14947 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
14948 @end deftypevr
14949
14950 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
14951 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
14952 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
14953 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
14954 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
14955
14956 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
14957 @end deftypevr
14958
14959 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
14960 Specifies the default access policy to use.
14961
14962 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
14963 @end deftypevr
14964
14965 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
14966 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
14967
14968 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
14969 @end deftypevr
14970
14971 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
14972 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
14973 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
14974 typically within a few milliseconds.
14975
14976 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14977 @end deftypevr
14978
14979 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
14980 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
14981 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
14982 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
14983 @code{retry-current-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
14984 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
14985
14986 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
14987 @end deftypevr
14988
14989 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
14990 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
14991 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
14992 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
14993 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
14994 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
14995 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
14996 at any time.
14997
14998 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14999 @end deftypevr
15000
15001 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
15002 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
15003 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
15004 lowest priority.
15005
15006 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15007 @end deftypevr
15008
15009 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
15010 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
15011 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
15012 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
15013 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
15014 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
15015 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
15016
15017 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15018 @end deftypevr
15019
15020 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
15021 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
15022 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
15023
15024 Defaults to @samp{30}.
15025 @end deftypevr
15026
15027 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
15028 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
15029 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
15030 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
15031 @code{retry-current-job}.
15032
15033 Defaults to @samp{30}.
15034 @end deftypevr
15035
15036 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
15037 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
15038 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
15039 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
15040 @code{retry-current-job}.
15041
15042 Defaults to @samp{5}.
15043 @end deftypevr
15044
15045 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
15046 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
15047
15048 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15049 @end deftypevr
15050
15051 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer keep-alive-timeout
15052 Specifies how long an idle client connection remains open, in seconds.
15053
15054 Defaults to @samp{30}.
15055 @end deftypevr
15056
15057 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
15058 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
15059 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
15060
15061 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15062 @end deftypevr
15063
15064 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
15065 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
15066 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
15067 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
15068 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
15069 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
15070 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
15071 @end deftypevr
15072
15073 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
15074 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
15075 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
15076 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
15077 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
15078 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
15079 ones.
15080
15081 Defaults to @samp{128}.
15082 @end deftypevr
15083
15084 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
15085 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
15086
15087 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
15088
15089 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
15090 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
15091 @end deftypevr
15092
15093 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
15094 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
15095 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
15096
15097 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15098 @end deftypevr
15099
15100 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
15101 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
15102
15103 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15104
15105 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
15106
15107 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
15108 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
15109 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
15110
15111 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15112 @end deftypevr
15113
15114 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
15115 Methods to which this access control applies.
15116
15117 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15118 @end deftypevr
15119
15120 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
15121 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
15122 one directive, such as "Order allow,deny".
15123
15124 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15125 @end deftypevr
15126 @end deftypevr
15127 @end deftypevr
15128
15129 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
15130 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
15131 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
15132 of the LogLevel setting.
15133
15134 Defaults to @samp{100}.
15135 @end deftypevr
15136
15137 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
15138 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
15139 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
15140
15141 Defaults to @samp{info}.
15142 @end deftypevr
15143
15144 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
15145 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
15146 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
15147
15148 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
15149 @end deftypevr
15150
15151 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
15152 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
15153 the scheduler.
15154
15155 Defaults to @samp{100}.
15156 @end deftypevr
15157
15158 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
15159 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
15160 from a single address.
15161
15162 Defaults to @samp{100}.
15163 @end deftypevr
15164
15165 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
15166 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
15167 job.
15168
15169 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
15170 @end deftypevr
15171
15172 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
15173 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
15174 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
15175 held jobs.
15176
15177 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15178 @end deftypevr
15179
15180 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
15181 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
15182 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
15183
15184 Defaults to @samp{500}.
15185 @end deftypevr
15186
15187 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
15188 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
15189 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
15190
15191 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15192 @end deftypevr
15193
15194 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
15195 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
15196 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
15197
15198 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15199 @end deftypevr
15200
15201 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
15202 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
15203 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of "stuck" jobs.
15204
15205 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
15206 @end deftypevr
15207
15208 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
15209 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
15210 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
15211
15212 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
15213 @end deftypevr
15214
15215 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
15216 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
15217 multiple file print job, in seconds.
15218
15219 Defaults to @samp{300}.
15220 @end deftypevr
15221
15222 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
15223 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
15224 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
15225 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
15226 sequences are recognized:
15227
15228 @table @samp
15229 @item %%
15230 insert a single percent character
15231
15232 @item %@{name@}
15233 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
15234
15235 @item %C
15236 insert the number of copies for the current page
15237
15238 @item %P
15239 insert the current page number
15240
15241 @item %T
15242 insert the current date and time in common log format
15243
15244 @item %j
15245 insert the job ID
15246
15247 @item %p
15248 insert the printer name
15249
15250 @item %u
15251 insert the username
15252 @end table
15253
15254 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
15255 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
15256 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
15257 standard items.
15258
15259 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15260 @end deftypevr
15261
15262 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
15263 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
15264 of strings.
15265
15266 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15267 @end deftypevr
15268
15269 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
15270 Specifies named access control policies.
15271
15272 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
15273
15274 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
15275 Name of the policy.
15276 @end deftypevr
15277
15278 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
15279 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
15280 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
15281 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
15282 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
15283 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
15284 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
15285 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
15286 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
15287 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
15288
15289 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
15290 @end deftypevr
15291
15292 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
15293 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
15294 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
15295
15296 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
15297 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
15298 @end deftypevr
15299
15300 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
15301 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
15302 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
15303 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
15304 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
15305 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
15306 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
15307 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
15308 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
15309 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
15310
15311 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
15312 @end deftypevr
15313
15314 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
15315 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
15316 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
15317
15318 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
15319 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
15320 @end deftypevr
15321
15322 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
15323 Access control by IPP operation.
15324
15325 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15326 @end deftypevr
15327 @end deftypevr
15328
15329 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
15330 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
15331 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
15332 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
15333 value applies indefinitely.
15334
15335 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
15336 @end deftypevr
15337
15338 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
15339 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
15340 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
15341 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
15342 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
15343
15344 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15345 @end deftypevr
15346
15347 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
15348 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
15349 restarting the scheduler.
15350
15351 Defaults to @samp{30}.
15352 @end deftypevr
15353
15354 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
15355 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
15356 into bitmaps for a printer.
15357
15358 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
15359 @end deftypevr
15360
15361 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
15362 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
15363
15364 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
15365 @end deftypevr
15366
15367 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
15368 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
15369 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
15370 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
15371 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
15372 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
15373 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
15374 @code{*}.
15375
15376 Defaults to @samp{*}.
15377 @end deftypevr
15378
15379 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
15380 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
15381
15382 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
15383 @end deftypevr
15384
15385 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
15386 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
15387 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
15388 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
15389 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
15390 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
15391 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
15392 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
15393
15394 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
15395 @end deftypevr
15396
15397 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
15398 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
15399 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
15400 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
15401 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
15402
15403 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15404 @end deftypevr
15405
15406 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
15407 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
15408 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. Security is
15409 reduced when @code{Allow} options are used, and enhanced when @code{Deny}
15410 options are used. The @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher
15411 suites, which are required for some older clients. The @code{AllowSSL3} option
15412 enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some older clients that do not support
15413 TLS v1.0. The @code{DenyCBC} option disables all CBC cipher suites. The
15414 @code{DenyTLS1.0} option disables TLS v1.0 support - this sets the minimum
15415 protocol version to TLS v1.1.
15416
15417 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15418 @end deftypevr
15419
15420 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
15421 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
15422 the IPP specifications.
15423
15424 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15425 @end deftypevr
15426
15427 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
15428 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
15429
15430 Defaults to @samp{300}.
15431
15432 @end deftypevr
15433
15434 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
15435 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
15436
15437 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15438 @end deftypevr
15439
15440 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
15441 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
15442 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
15443 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
15444 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
15445 @code{cups-service-type}.
15446
15447 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
15448
15449 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
15450 The CUPS package.
15451 @end deftypevr
15452
15453 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
15454 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
15455 @end deftypevr
15456
15457 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
15458 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
15459 @end deftypevr
15460
15461 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
15462 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
15463 this:
15464
15465 @lisp
15466 (service cups-service-type
15467 (opaque-cups-configuration
15468 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
15469 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
15470 @end lisp
15471
15472
15473 @node Desktop Services
15474 @subsection Desktop Services
15475
15476 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
15477 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
15478 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
15479 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
15480 environments like GNOME, Xfce or MATE.
15481
15482 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
15483 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
15484 environment and networking:
15485
15486 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
15487 This is a list of services that builds upon @code{%base-services} and
15488 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
15489
15490 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
15491 @code{gdm-service-type}}), screen lockers, a network management tool
15492 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{network-manager-service-type}}) with modem
15493 support (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{modem-manager-service-type}}),
15494 energy and color management services, the @code{elogind} login and seat
15495 manager, the Polkit privilege service, the GeoClue location service, the
15496 AccountsService daemon that allows authorized users change system passwords,
15497 an NTP client (@pxref{Networking Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the
15498 name service switch service configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns}
15499 (@pxref{Name Service Switch, mDNS}).
15500 @end defvr
15501
15502 The @code{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
15503 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
15504 Reference, @code{services}}).
15505
15506 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service-type},
15507 @code{xfce-desktop-service}, @code{mate-desktop-service-type} and
15508 @code{enlightenment-desktop-service-type} procedures can add GNOME, Xfce, MATE
15509 and/or Enlightenment to a system. To ``add GNOME'' means that system-level
15510 services like the backlight adjustment helpers and the power management
15511 utilities are added to the system, extending @code{polkit} and @code{dbus}
15512 appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with elevated privileges on a
15513 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
15514 adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service-type} adds the GNOME
15515 metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the Xfce service
15516 not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but it
15517 also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode''
15518 file management window, if the user authenticates using the
15519 administrator's password via the standard polkit graphical interface.
15520 To ``add MATE'' means that @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} are extended
15521 appropriately, allowing MATE to operate with elevated privileges on a
15522 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
15523 adding a service of type @code{mate-desktop-service-type} adds the MATE
15524 metapackage to the system profile. ``Adding Enlightenment'' means that
15525 @code{dbus} is extended appropriately, and several of Enlightenment's binaries
15526 are set as setuid, allowing Enlightenment's screen locker and other
15527 functionality to work as expetected.
15528
15529 The desktop environments in Guix use the Xorg display server by
15530 default. If you'd like to use the newer display server protocol
15531 called Wayland, you need to use the @code{sddm-service} instead of
15532 GDM as the graphical login manager. You should then
15533 select the ``GNOME (Wayland)'' session in SDDM. Alternatively you can
15534 also try starting GNOME on Wayland manually from a TTY with the
15535 command ``XDG_SESSION_TYPE=wayland exec dbus-run-session
15536 gnome-session``. Currently only GNOME has support for Wayland.
15537
15538 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-desktop-service-type
15539 This is the type of the service that adds the @uref{https://www.gnome.org,
15540 GNOME} desktop environment. Its value is a @code{gnome-desktop-configuration}
15541 object (see below.)
15542
15543 This service adds the @code{gnome} package to the system profile, and extends
15544 polkit with the actions from @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
15545 @end defvr
15546
15547 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-desktop-configuration
15548 Configuration record for the GNOME desktop environment.
15549
15550 @table @asis
15551 @item @code{gnome} (default: @code{gnome})
15552 The GNOME package to use.
15553 @end table
15554 @end deftp
15555
15556 @defvr {Scheme Variable} xfce-desktop-service-type
15557 This is the type of a service to run the @uref{Xfce, https://xfce.org/}
15558 desktop environment. Its value is an @code{xfce-desktop-configuration} object
15559 (see below.)
15560
15561 This service adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile, and
15562 extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the file
15563 system as root from within a user session, after the user has authenticated
15564 with the administrator's password.
15565 @end defvr
15566
15567 @deftp {Data Type} xfce-desktop-configuration
15568 Configuration record for the Xfce desktop environment.
15569
15570 @table @asis
15571 @item @code{xfce} (default: @code{xfce})
15572 The Xfce package to use.
15573 @end table
15574 @end deftp
15575
15576 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mate-desktop-service-type
15577 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://mate-desktop.org/,
15578 MATE desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{mate-desktop-configuration}
15579 object (see below.)
15580
15581 This service adds the @code{mate} package to the system
15582 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
15583 @code{mate-settings-daemon}.
15584 @end deffn
15585
15586 @deftp {Data Type} mate-desktop-configuration
15587 Configuration record for the MATE desktop environment.
15588
15589 @table @asis
15590 @item @code{mate} (default: @code{mate})
15591 The MATE package to use.
15592 @end table
15593 @end deftp
15594
15595 @deffn {Scheme Variable} enlightenment-desktop-service-type
15596 Return a service that adds the @code{enlightenment} package to the system
15597 profile, and extends dbus with actions from @code{efl}.
15598 @end deffn
15599
15600 @deftp {Data Type} enlightenment-desktop-service-configuration
15601 @table @asis
15602 @item @code{enlightenment} (default: @code{enlightenment})
15603 The enlightenment package to use.
15604 @end table
15605 @end deftp
15606
15607 Because the GNOME, Xfce and MATE desktop services pull in so many packages,
15608 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include any of
15609 them by default. To add GNOME, Xfce or MATE, just @code{cons} them onto
15610 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
15611 @code{operating-system}:
15612
15613 @lisp
15614 (use-modules (gnu))
15615 (use-service-modules desktop)
15616 (operating-system
15617 ...
15618 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
15619 (services (cons* (service gnome-desktop-service-type)
15620 (service xfce-desktop-service)
15621 %desktop-services))
15622 ...)
15623 @end lisp
15624
15625 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
15626 graphical login window.
15627
15628 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
15629 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
15630 are described below.
15631
15632 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
15633 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
15634 support for @var{services}.
15635
15636 @uref{https://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
15637 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
15638 and to be notified of system-wide events.
15639
15640 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
15641 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
15642 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
15643 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
15644 @end deffn
15645
15646 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
15647 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
15648 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/elogind/elogind,
15649 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
15650 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
15651 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
15652
15653 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
15654 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
15655 when the power button is pressed.
15656
15657 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
15658 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
15659 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
15660 their default values are:
15661
15662 @table @code
15663 @item kill-user-processes?
15664 @code{#f}
15665 @item kill-only-users
15666 @code{()}
15667 @item kill-exclude-users
15668 @code{("root")}
15669 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
15670 @code{5}
15671 @item handle-power-key
15672 @code{poweroff}
15673 @item handle-suspend-key
15674 @code{suspend}
15675 @item handle-hibernate-key
15676 @code{hibernate}
15677 @item handle-lid-switch
15678 @code{suspend}
15679 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
15680 @code{ignore}
15681 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
15682 @code{#f}
15683 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
15684 @code{#f}
15685 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
15686 @code{#f}
15687 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
15688 @code{#t}
15689 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
15690 @code{30}
15691 @item idle-action
15692 @code{ignore}
15693 @item idle-action-seconds
15694 @code{(* 30 60)}
15695 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
15696 @code{10}
15697 @item runtime-directory-size
15698 @code{#f}
15699 @item remove-ipc?
15700 @code{#t}
15701 @item suspend-state
15702 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
15703 @item suspend-mode
15704 @code{()}
15705 @item hibernate-state
15706 @code{("disk")}
15707 @item hibernate-mode
15708 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
15709 @item hybrid-sleep-state
15710 @code{("disk")}
15711 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
15712 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
15713 @end table
15714 @end deffn
15715
15716 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} accountsservice-service @
15717 [#:accountsservice @var{accountsservice}]
15718 Return a service that runs AccountsService, a system service that can
15719 list available accounts, change their passwords, and so on.
15720 AccountsService integrates with PolicyKit to enable unprivileged users
15721 to acquire the capability to modify their system configuration.
15722 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/AccountsService/, the
15723 accountsservice web site} for more information.
15724
15725 The @var{accountsservice} keyword argument is the @code{accountsservice}
15726 package to expose as a service.
15727 @end deffn
15728
15729 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
15730 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
15731 Return a service that runs the
15732 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
15733 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
15734 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
15735 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
15736 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
15737 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
15738 @end deffn
15739
15740 @defvr {Scheme Variable} polkit-wheel-service
15741 Service that adds the @code{wheel} group as admins to the Polkit
15742 service. This makes it so that users in the @code{wheel} group are queried
15743 for their own passwords when performing administrative actions instead of
15744 @code{root}'s, similar to the behaviour used by @code{sudo}.
15745 @end defvr
15746
15747 @defvr {Scheme Variable} upower-service-type
15748 Service that runs @uref{https://upower.freedesktop.org/, @command{upowerd}}, a
15749 system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery levels, with the given
15750 configuration settings.
15751
15752 It implements the @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is
15753 notably used by GNOME.
15754 @end defvr
15755
15756 @deftp {Data Type} upower-configuration
15757 Data type representation the configuration for UPower.
15758
15759 @table @asis
15760
15761 @item @code{upower} (default: @var{upower})
15762 Package to use for @code{upower}.
15763
15764 @item @code{watts-up-pro?} (default: @code{#f})
15765 Enable the Watts Up Pro device.
15766
15767 @item @code{poll-batteries?} (default: @code{#t})
15768 Enable polling the kernel for battery level changes.
15769
15770 @item @code{ignore-lid?} (default: @code{#f})
15771 Ignore the lid state, this can be useful if it's incorrect on a device.
15772
15773 @item @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} (default: @code{#f})
15774 Whether battery percentage based policy should be used. The default is to use
15775 the time left, change to @code{#t} to use the percentage.
15776
15777 @item @code{percentage-low} (default: @code{10})
15778 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15779 at which the battery is considered low.
15780
15781 @item @code{percentage-critical} (default: @code{3})
15782 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15783 at which the battery is considered critical.
15784
15785 @item @code{percentage-action} (default: @code{2})
15786 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15787 at which action will be taken.
15788
15789 @item @code{time-low} (default: @code{1200})
15790 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15791 seconds at which the battery is considered low.
15792
15793 @item @code{time-critical} (default: @code{300})
15794 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15795 seconds at which the battery is considered critical.
15796
15797 @item @code{time-action} (default: @code{120})
15798 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15799 seconds at which action will be taken.
15800
15801 @item @code{critical-power-action} (default: @code{'hybrid-sleep})
15802 The action taken when @code{percentage-action} or @code{time-action} is
15803 reached (depending on the configuration of @code{use-percentage-for-policy?}).
15804
15805 Possible values are:
15806
15807 @itemize @bullet
15808 @item
15809 @code{'power-off}
15810
15811 @item
15812 @code{'hibernate}
15813
15814 @item
15815 @code{'hybrid-sleep}.
15816 @end itemize
15817
15818 @end table
15819 @end deftp
15820
15821 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
15822 Return a service for @uref{https://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
15823 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces with
15824 notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk to UDisks
15825 include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and GNOME Disks.
15826 @end deffn
15827
15828 @deffn {Scheme Variable} colord-service-type
15829 This is the type of the service that runs @command{colord}, a system
15830 service with a D-Bus
15831 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
15832 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
15833 tool. See @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
15834 site} for more information.
15835 @end deffn
15836
15837 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
15838 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
15839 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
15840 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
15841 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
15842 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
15843 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
15844 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
15845 means that all users are allowed.
15846 @end deffn
15847
15848 @cindex scanner access
15849 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} sane-service-type
15850 This service provides access to scanners @i{via}
15851 @uref{http://www.sane-project.org, SANE} by installing the necessary udev
15852 rules.
15853 @end deffn
15854
15855 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
15856 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
15857 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
15858 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
15859 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
15860 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
15861 know the user's location.
15862 @end defvr
15863
15864 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
15865 [#:whitelist '()] @
15866 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
15867 [#:submit-data? #f]
15868 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
15869 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
15870 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
15871 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
15872 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
15873 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
15874 location databases. See
15875 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
15876 web site} for more information.
15877 @end deffn
15878
15879 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}] @
15880 [@w{#:auto-enable? #f}]
15881 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which
15882 manages all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus
15883 interfaces. When AUTO-ENABLE? is true, the bluetooth controller is
15884 powered automatically at boot, which can be useful when using a
15885 bluetooth keyboard or mouse.
15886
15887 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
15888 @end deffn
15889
15890 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-keyring-service-type
15891 This is the type of the service that adds the
15892 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GnomeKeyring, GNOME Keyring}. Its
15893 value is a @code{gnome-keyring-configuration} object (see below.)
15894
15895 This service adds the @code{gnome-keyring} package to the system profile
15896 and extends PAM with entries using @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so}, unlocking
15897 a user's login keyring when they log in or setting its password with passwd.
15898 @end defvr
15899
15900 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-keyring-configuration
15901 Configuration record for the GNOME Keyring service.
15902
15903 @table @asis
15904 @item @code{keyring} (default: @code{gnome-keyring})
15905 The GNOME keyring package to use.
15906
15907 @item @code{pam-services}
15908 A list of @code{(@var{service} . @var{kind})} pairs denoting PAM
15909 services to extend, where @var{service} is the name of an existing
15910 service to extend and @var{kind} is one of @code{login} or
15911 @code{passwd}.
15912
15913 If @code{login} is given, it adds an optional
15914 @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the auth block without arguments and to
15915 the session block with @code{auto_start}. If @code{passwd} is given, it
15916 adds an optional @code{pam_gnome_keyring.so} to the password block
15917 without arguments.
15918
15919 By default, this field contains ``gdm-password'' with the value @code{login}
15920 and ``passwd'' is with the value @code{passwd}.
15921 @end table
15922 @end deftp
15923
15924
15925 @node Sound Services
15926 @subsection Sound Services
15927
15928 @cindex sound support
15929 @cindex ALSA
15930 @cindex PulseAudio, sound support
15931
15932 The @code{(gnu services sound)} module provides a service to configure the
15933 Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) system, which makes PulseAudio the
15934 preferred ALSA output driver.
15935
15936 @deffn {Scheme Variable} alsa-service-type
15937 This is the type for the @uref{https://alsa-project.org/, Advanced Linux Sound
15938 Architecture} (ALSA) system, which generates the @file{/etc/asound.conf}
15939 configuration file. The value for this type is a @command{alsa-configuration}
15940 record as in this example:
15941
15942 @lisp
15943 (service alsa-service-type)
15944 @end lisp
15945
15946 See below for details about @code{alsa-configuration}.
15947 @end deffn
15948
15949 @deftp {Data Type} alsa-configuration
15950 Data type representing the configuration for @code{alsa-service}.
15951
15952 @table @asis
15953 @item @code{alsa-plugins} (default: @var{alsa-plugins})
15954 @code{alsa-plugins} package to use.
15955
15956 @item @code{pulseaudio?} (default: @var{#t})
15957 Whether ALSA applications should transparently be made to use the
15958 @uref{http://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio} sound server.
15959
15960 Using PulseAudio allows you to run several sound-producing applications
15961 at the same time and to individual control them @i{via}
15962 @command{pavucontrol}, among other things.
15963
15964 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{""})
15965 String to append to the @file{/etc/asound.conf} file.
15966
15967 @end table
15968 @end deftp
15969
15970 Individual users who want to override the system configuration of ALSA can do
15971 it with the @file{~/.asoundrc} file:
15972
15973 @example
15974 # In guix, we have to specify the absolute path for plugins.
15975 pcm_type.jack @{
15976 lib "/home/alice/.guix-profile/lib/alsa-lib/libasound_module_pcm_jack.so"
15977 @}
15978
15979 # Routing ALSA to jack:
15980 # <http://jackaudio.org/faq/routing_alsa.html>.
15981 pcm.rawjack @{
15982 type jack
15983 playback_ports @{
15984 0 system:playback_1
15985 1 system:playback_2
15986 @}
15987
15988 capture_ports @{
15989 0 system:capture_1
15990 1 system:capture_2
15991 @}
15992 @}
15993
15994 pcm.!default @{
15995 type plug
15996 slave @{
15997 pcm "rawjack"
15998 @}
15999 @}
16000 @end example
16001
16002 See @uref{https://www.alsa-project.org/main/index.php/Asoundrc} for the
16003 details.
16004
16005 @deffn {Scheme Variable} pulseaudio-service-type
16006 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio}
16007 sound server. It exists to allow system overrides of the default settings
16008 via @code{pulseaudio-configuration}, see below.
16009
16010 @quotation Warning
16011 This service on its own does not ensure, that the @code{pulseaudio} package
16012 exists on your machine. It merely adds configuration files for it, as
16013 detailed below. In the (admittedly unlikely) case, that you find yourself
16014 without a @code{pulseaudio} package, consider enabling it through the
16015 @code{alsa-service-type} above.
16016 @end quotation
16017 @end deffn
16018
16019 @deftp {Data Type} pulseaudio-configuration
16020 Data type representing the configuration for @code{pulseaudio-service}.
16021
16022 @table @asis
16023 @item @var{client-conf} (default: @code{'()})
16024 List of settings to set in @file{client.conf}.
16025 Accepts a list of strings or a symbol-value pairs. A string will be
16026 inserted as-is with a newline added. A pair will be formatted as
16027 ``key = value'', again with a newline added.
16028
16029 @item @var{daemon-conf} (default: @code{'((flat-volumes . no))})
16030 List of settings to set in @file{daemon.conf}, formatted just like
16031 @var{client-conf}.
16032
16033 @item @var{script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/default.pa")})
16034 Script file to use as as @file{default.pa}.
16035
16036 @item @var{system-script-file} (default: @code{(file-append pulseaudio "/etc/pulse/system.pa")})
16037 Script file to use as as @file{system.pa}.
16038 @end table
16039 @end deftp
16040
16041 @deffn {Scheme Variable} ladspa-service-type
16042 This service sets the @var{LADSPA_PATH} variable, so that programs, which
16043 respect it, e.g. PulseAudio, can load LADSPA plugins.
16044
16045 The following example will setup the service to enable modules from the
16046 @code{swh-plugins} package:
16047
16048 @lisp
16049 (service ladspa-service-type
16050 (ladspa-configuration (plugins (list swh-plugins))))
16051 @end lisp
16052
16053 See @uref{http://plugin.org.uk/ladspa-swh/docs/ladspa-swh.html} for the
16054 details.
16055
16056 @end deffn
16057
16058 @node Database Services
16059 @subsection Database Services
16060
16061 @cindex database
16062 @cindex SQL
16063 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
16064
16065 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
16066 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data''] @
16067 [#:port 5432] [#:locale ``en_US.utf8''] [#:extension-packages '()]
16068 Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
16069 server.
16070
16071 The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file},
16072 creates a database cluster with @var{locale} as the default
16073 locale, stored in @var{data-directory}. It then listens on @var{port}.
16074
16075 @cindex postgresql extension-packages
16076 Additional extensions are loaded from packages listed in
16077 @var{extension-packages}. Extensions are available at runtime. For instance,
16078 to create a geographic database using the @code{postgis} extension, a user can
16079 configure the postgresql-service as in this example:
16080
16081 @cindex postgis
16082 @lisp
16083 (use-package-modules databases geo)
16084
16085 (operating-system
16086 ...
16087 ;; postgresql is required to run `psql' but postgis is not required for
16088 ;; proper operation.
16089 (packages (cons* postgresql %base-packages))
16090 (services
16091 (cons*
16092 (postgresql-service #:extension-packages (list postgis))
16093 %base-services)))
16094 @end lisp
16095
16096 Then the extension becomes visible and you can initialise an empty geographic
16097 database in this way:
16098
16099 @example
16100 psql -U postgres
16101 > create database postgistest;
16102 > \connect postgistest;
16103 > create extension postgis;
16104 > create extension postgis_topology;
16105 @end example
16106
16107 There is no need to add this field for contrib extensions such as hstore or
16108 dblink as they are already loadable by postgresql. This field is only
16109 required to add extensions provided by other packages.
16110 @end deffn
16111
16112 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mysql-service [#:config (mysql-configuration)]
16113 Return a service that runs @command{mysqld}, the MySQL or MariaDB
16114 database server.
16115
16116 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
16117 @command{mysqld}, which should be a @code{<mysql-configuration>} object.
16118 @end deffn
16119
16120 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
16121 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service}.
16122
16123 @table @asis
16124 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
16125 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
16126 or @var{mysql}.
16127
16128 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
16129 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
16130
16131 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
16132 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
16133 @end table
16134 @end deftp
16135
16136 @defvr {Scheme Variable} memcached-service-type
16137 This is the service type for the @uref{https://memcached.org/,
16138 Memcached} service, which provides a distributed in memory cache. The
16139 value for the service type is a @code{memcached-configuration} object.
16140 @end defvr
16141
16142 @lisp
16143 (service memcached-service-type)
16144 @end lisp
16145
16146 @deftp {Data Type} memcached-configuration
16147 Data type representing the configuration of memcached.
16148
16149 @table @asis
16150 @item @code{memcached} (default: @code{memcached})
16151 The Memcached package to use.
16152
16153 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0")})
16154 Network interfaces on which to listen.
16155
16156 @item @code{tcp-port} (default: @code{11211})
16157 Port on which to accept connections on,
16158
16159 @item @code{udp-port} (default: @code{11211})
16160 Port on which to accept UDP connections on, a value of 0 will disable
16161 listening on a UDP socket.
16162
16163 @item @code{additional-options} (default: @code{'()})
16164 Additional command line options to pass to @code{memcached}.
16165 @end table
16166 @end deftp
16167
16168 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mongodb-service-type
16169 This is the service type for @uref{https://www.mongodb.com/, MongoDB}.
16170 The value for the service type is a @code{mongodb-configuration} object.
16171 @end defvr
16172
16173 @lisp
16174 (service mongodb-service-type)
16175 @end lisp
16176
16177 @deftp {Data Type} mongodb-configuration
16178 Data type representing the configuration of mongodb.
16179
16180 @table @asis
16181 @item @code{mongodb} (default: @code{mongodb})
16182 The MongoDB package to use.
16183
16184 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-mongodb-configuration-file})
16185 The configuration file for MongoDB.
16186
16187 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/mongodb"})
16188 This value is used to create the directory, so that it exists and is
16189 owned by the mongodb user. It should match the data-directory which
16190 MongoDB is configured to use through the configuration file.
16191 @end table
16192 @end deftp
16193
16194 @defvr {Scheme Variable} redis-service-type
16195 This is the service type for the @uref{https://redis.io/, Redis}
16196 key/value store, whose value is a @code{redis-configuration} object.
16197 @end defvr
16198
16199 @deftp {Data Type} redis-configuration
16200 Data type representing the configuration of redis.
16201
16202 @table @asis
16203 @item @code{redis} (default: @code{redis})
16204 The Redis package to use.
16205
16206 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
16207 Network interface on which to listen.
16208
16209 @item @code{port} (default: @code{6379})
16210 Port on which to accept connections on, a value of 0 will disable
16211 listening on a TCP socket.
16212
16213 @item @code{working-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/redis"})
16214 Directory in which to store the database and related files.
16215 @end table
16216 @end deftp
16217
16218 @node Mail Services
16219 @subsection Mail Services
16220
16221 @cindex mail
16222 @cindex email
16223 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
16224 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
16225 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
16226 in the subsections below.
16227
16228 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
16229
16230 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
16231 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
16232 @end deffn
16233
16234 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
16235 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
16236 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
16237 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
16238 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
16239 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
16240 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
16241 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
16242
16243 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
16244 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
16245
16246 @lisp
16247 (dovecot-service #:config
16248 (dovecot-configuration
16249 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
16250 @end lisp
16251
16252 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
16253 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
16254 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
16255 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
16256 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
16257 from some other system; see the end for more details.
16258
16259 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
16260 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
16261 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
16262 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
16263 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
16264 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
16265 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
16266
16267 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
16268
16269 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
16270 The dovecot package.
16271 @end deftypevr
16272
16273 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
16274 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
16275 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
16276 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
16277 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
16278 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
16279 @end deftypevr
16280
16281 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
16282 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
16283 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
16284
16285 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
16286
16287 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
16288 The name of the protocol.
16289 @end deftypevr
16290
16291 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
16292 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
16293 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
16294 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
16295 @end deftypevr
16296
16297 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
16298 Space separated list of plugins to load.
16299 @end deftypevr
16300
16301 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
16302 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
16303 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
16304 Defaults to @samp{10}.
16305 @end deftypevr
16306
16307 @end deftypevr
16308
16309 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
16310 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
16311 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
16312 @samp{lmtp}.
16313
16314 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
16315
16316 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
16317 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
16318 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
16319 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
16320 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
16321 @end deftypevr
16322
16323 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
16324 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
16325 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
16326 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
16327 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16328
16329 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
16330
16331 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
16332 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
16333 the section name.
16334 @end deftypevr
16335
16336 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
16337 The access mode for the socket.
16338 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
16339 @end deftypevr
16340
16341 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
16342 The user to own the socket.
16343 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16344 @end deftypevr
16345
16346 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
16347 The group to own the socket.
16348 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16349 @end deftypevr
16350
16351
16352 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
16353
16354 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
16355 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
16356 the section name.
16357 @end deftypevr
16358
16359 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
16360 The access mode for the socket.
16361 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
16362 @end deftypevr
16363
16364 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
16365 The user to own the socket.
16366 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16367 @end deftypevr
16368
16369 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
16370 The group to own the socket.
16371 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16372 @end deftypevr
16373
16374
16375 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
16376
16377 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
16378 The protocol to listen for.
16379 @end deftypevr
16380
16381 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
16382 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
16383 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16384 @end deftypevr
16385
16386 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
16387 The port on which to listen.
16388 @end deftypevr
16389
16390 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
16391 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
16392 @samp{required}.
16393 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16394 @end deftypevr
16395
16396 @end deftypevr
16397
16398 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer client-limit
16399 Maximum number of simultaneous client connections per process. Once
16400 this number of connections is received, the next incoming connection
16401 will prompt Dovecot to spawn another process. If set to 0,
16402 @code{default-client-limit} is used instead.
16403
16404 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16405
16406 @end deftypevr
16407
16408 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
16409 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
16410 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
16411 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
16412 Defaults to @samp{1}.
16413
16414 @end deftypevr
16415
16416 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-limit
16417 Maximum number of processes that can exist for this service. If set to
16418 0, @code{default-process-limit} is used instead.
16419
16420 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16421
16422 @end deftypevr
16423
16424 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
16425 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
16426 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16427 @end deftypevr
16428
16429 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
16430 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
16431 this.
16432 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
16433 @end deftypevr
16434
16435 @end deftypevr
16436
16437 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
16438 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
16439 constructor.
16440
16441 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
16442
16443 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
16444 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
16445 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16446 @end deftypevr
16447
16448 @end deftypevr
16449
16450 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
16451 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
16452 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
16453
16454 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
16455
16456 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
16457 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
16458 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
16459 @samp{static}.
16460 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
16461 @end deftypevr
16462
16463 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
16464 Space separated list of arguments to the passdb driver.
16465 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16466 @end deftypevr
16467
16468 @end deftypevr
16469
16470 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
16471 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
16472 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
16473
16474 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
16475
16476 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
16477 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
16478 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
16479 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
16480 @end deftypevr
16481
16482 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
16483 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
16484 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16485 @end deftypevr
16486
16487 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
16488 Override fields from passwd.
16489 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16490 @end deftypevr
16491
16492 @end deftypevr
16493
16494 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
16495 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
16496 constructor.
16497 @end deftypevr
16498
16499 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
16500 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
16501 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
16502
16503 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
16504
16505 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
16506 Name for this namespace.
16507 @end deftypevr
16508
16509 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
16510 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
16511 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
16512 @end deftypevr
16513
16514 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
16515 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
16516 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
16517 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
16518 format.
16519 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16520 @end deftypevr
16521
16522 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
16523 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
16524 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
16525 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16526 @end deftypevr
16527
16528 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
16529 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
16530 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
16531 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16532 @end deftypevr
16533
16534 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
16535 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
16536 namespace has it.
16537 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16538 @end deftypevr
16539
16540 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
16541 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
16542 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
16543 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
16544 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
16545 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
16546 and @samp{mail/}.
16547 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16548 @end deftypevr
16549
16550 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
16551 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
16552 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
16553 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
16554 hides the namespace prefix.
16555 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16556 @end deftypevr
16557
16558 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
16559 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
16560 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
16561 as @code{#t}).
16562 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16563 @end deftypevr
16564
16565 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
16566 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
16567 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16568
16569 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
16570
16571 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
16572 Name for this mailbox.
16573 @end deftypevr
16574
16575 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
16576 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
16577 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
16578 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
16579 @end deftypevr
16580
16581 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
16582 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
16583 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
16584 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
16585 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16586 @end deftypevr
16587
16588 @end deftypevr
16589
16590 @end deftypevr
16591
16592 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
16593 Base directory where to store runtime data.
16594 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
16595 @end deftypevr
16596
16597 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
16598 Greeting message for clients.
16599 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
16600 @end deftypevr
16601
16602 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
16603 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
16604 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
16605 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
16606 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
16607 here.
16608 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16609 @end deftypevr
16610
16611 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
16612 List of login access check sockets (e.g.@: tcpwrap).
16613 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16614 @end deftypevr
16615
16616 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
16617 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
16618 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
16619 processes (e.g.@: shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
16620 accounts).
16621 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16622 @end deftypevr
16623
16624 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
16625 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
16626 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
16627 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
16628 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g.@: due to a security fix).
16629 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16630 @end deftypevr
16631
16632 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
16633 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
16634 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
16635 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16636 @end deftypevr
16637
16638 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
16639 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
16640 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
16641 @end deftypevr
16642
16643 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
16644 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
16645 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
16646 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
16647 @end deftypevr
16648
16649 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
16650 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
16651 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
16652 matches the local IP (i.e.@: you're connecting from the same computer),
16653 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
16654 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
16655 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16656 @end deftypevr
16657
16658 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
16659 Authentication cache size (e.g.@: @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
16660 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
16661 for caching to be used.
16662 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16663 @end deftypevr
16664
16665 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
16666 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
16667 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
16668 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
16669 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
16670 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
16671 authentication.
16672 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
16673 @end deftypevr
16674
16675 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
16676 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
16677 0 disables caching them completely.
16678 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
16679 @end deftypevr
16680
16681 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
16682 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
16683 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
16684 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
16685 realm first.
16686 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16687 @end deftypevr
16688
16689 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
16690 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
16691 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
16692 logins.
16693 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16694 @end deftypevr
16695
16696 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
16697 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
16698 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
16699 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
16700 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
16701 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
16702 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
16703 @end deftypevr
16704
16705 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
16706 Username character translations before it's looked up from
16707 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
16708 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
16709 translated to @samp{@@}.
16710 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16711 @end deftypevr
16712
16713 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
16714 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
16715 use the standard variables here, e.g.@: %Lu would lowercase the username,
16716 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
16717 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
16718 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
16719 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
16720 @end deftypevr
16721
16722 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
16723 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
16724 username within the normal username string (i.e.@: not using SASL
16725 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
16726 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
16727 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
16728 choice.
16729 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16730 @end deftypevr
16731
16732 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
16733 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
16734 mechanism.
16735 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
16736 @end deftypevr
16737
16738 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
16739 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
16740 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g.@: MySQL and PAM).
16741 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
16742 Defaults to @samp{30}.
16743 @end deftypevr
16744
16745 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
16746 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
16747 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
16748 allow all keytab entries.
16749 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16750 @end deftypevr
16751
16752 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
16753 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
16754 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
16755 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
16756 file.
16757 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16758 @end deftypevr
16759
16760 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
16761 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
16762 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
16763 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
16764 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16765 @end deftypevr
16766
16767 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
16768 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
16769 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
16770 @end deftypevr
16771
16772 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
16773 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
16774 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
16775 @end deftypevr
16776
16777 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
16778 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
16779 fails.
16780 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16781 @end deftypevr
16782
16783 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
16784 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
16785 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
16786 CommonName.
16787 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16788 @end deftypevr
16789
16790 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
16791 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
16792 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
16793 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
16794 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
16795 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
16796 @end deftypevr
16797
16798 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
16799 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
16800 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
16801 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
16802 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16803 @end deftypevr
16804
16805 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
16806 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
16807 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
16808 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16809 @end deftypevr
16810
16811 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
16812 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
16813 has any connections.
16814 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
16815 @end deftypevr
16816
16817 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
16818 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
16819 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
16820 are shared within domain.
16821 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
16822 @end deftypevr
16823
16824 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
16825 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
16826 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
16827 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
16828 @end deftypevr
16829
16830 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
16831 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
16832 @samp{log-path}.
16833 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16834 @end deftypevr
16835
16836 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
16837 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
16838 @samp{info-log-path}.
16839 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16840 @end deftypevr
16841
16842 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
16843 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
16844 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
16845 standard facilities are supported.
16846 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
16847 @end deftypevr
16848
16849 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
16850 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
16851 failed.
16852 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16853 @end deftypevr
16854
16855 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-verbose-passwords
16856 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
16857 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
16858 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
16859 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
16860 ":n" (e.g.@: sha1:6).
16861 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
16862 @end deftypevr
16863
16864 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
16865 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
16866 SQL queries.
16867 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16868 @end deftypevr
16869
16870 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
16871 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
16872 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
16873 @samp{auth-debug}.
16874 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16875 @end deftypevr
16876
16877 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
16878 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
16879 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
16880 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16881 @end deftypevr
16882
16883 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
16884 Show protocol level SSL errors.
16885 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16886 @end deftypevr
16887
16888 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
16889 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
16890 strftime(3) format.
16891 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
16892 @end deftypevr
16893
16894 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
16895 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
16896 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
16897 string.
16898 @end deftypevr
16899
16900 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
16901 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
16902 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
16903 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
16904 @end deftypevr
16905
16906 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
16907 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
16908 of possible variables you can use.
16909 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u)<%@{pid@}><%@{session@}>: \""}.
16910 @end deftypevr
16911
16912 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
16913 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
16914 @table @code
16915 @item %$
16916 Delivery status message (e.g.@: @samp{saved to INBOX})
16917 @item %m
16918 Message-ID
16919 @item %s
16920 Subject
16921 @item %f
16922 From address
16923 @item %p
16924 Physical size
16925 @item %w
16926 Virtual size.
16927 @end table
16928 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
16929 @end deftypevr
16930
16931 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
16932 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
16933 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
16934 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
16935 Dovecot the full location.
16936
16937 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
16938 file (e.g.@: /var/mail/%u) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
16939 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the "root mail
16940 directory", and it must be the first path given in the
16941 @samp{mail-location} setting.
16942
16943 There are a few special variables you can use, eg.:
16944
16945 @table @samp
16946 @item %u
16947 username
16948 @item %n
16949 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
16950 @item %d
16951 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
16952 @item %h
16953 home director
16954 @end table
16955
16956 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
16957 @table @samp
16958 @item maildir:~/Maildir
16959 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
16960 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
16961 @end table
16962 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16963 @end deftypevr
16964
16965 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
16966 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
16967 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
16968 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
16969 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16970 @end deftypevr
16971
16972 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
16973
16974 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16975 @end deftypevr
16976
16977 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
16978 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
16979 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
16980 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to "mail" to give access to
16981 /var/mail.
16982 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16983 @end deftypevr
16984
16985 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
16986 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
16987 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
16988 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create
16989 symlinks (e.g.@: if "mail" group is set here, ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var
16990 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or ln -s
16991 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox would allow reading it).
16992 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16993 @end deftypevr
16994
16995 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
16996 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
16997 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
16998 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
16999 names with e.g.@: /path/ or ~user/.
17000 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17001 @end deftypevr
17002
17003 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
17004 Don't use mmap() at all. This is required if you store indexes to
17005 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
17006 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17007 @end deftypevr
17008
17009 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
17010 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
17011 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
17012 nowadays by default.
17013 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17014 @end deftypevr
17015
17016 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
17017 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
17018 @table @code
17019 @item optimized
17020 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
17021 @item always
17022 Useful with e.g.@: NFS when write()s are delayed
17023 @item never
17024 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
17025 @end table
17026 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
17027 @end deftypevr
17028
17029 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
17030 Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
17031 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
17032 this isn't needed.
17033 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17034 @end deftypevr
17035
17036 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
17037 Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
17038 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
17039 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17040 @end deftypevr
17041
17042 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
17043 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
17044 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
17045 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
17046 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
17047 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
17048 @end deftypevr
17049
17050 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
17051 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
17052 kB.
17053 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
17054 @end deftypevr
17055
17056 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
17057 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
17058 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
17059 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
17060 is set to 0.
17061 Defaults to @samp{500}.
17062 @end deftypevr
17063
17064 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
17065
17066 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17067 @end deftypevr
17068
17069 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
17070 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
17071 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
17072 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
17073 Defaults to @samp{1}.
17074 @end deftypevr
17075
17076 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
17077
17078 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17079 @end deftypevr
17080
17081 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
17082 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
17083 trying to create new keywords.
17084 Defaults to @samp{50}.
17085 @end deftypevr
17086
17087 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
17088 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
17089 processes (i.e.@: /var/mail will allow chrooting to /var/mail/foo/bar
17090 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
17091 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
17092 "/./" in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
17093 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
17094 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
17095 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
17096 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17097 @end deftypevr
17098
17099 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
17100 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
17101 for specific users in user database by giving /./ in user's home
17102 directory (e.g.@: /home/./user chroots into /home). Note that usually
17103 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
17104 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
17105 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append "/."@: to
17106 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
17107 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17108 @end deftypevr
17109
17110 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
17111 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
17112 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
17113 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
17114 @end deftypevr
17115
17116 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
17117 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
17118 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
17119 @end deftypevr
17120
17121 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
17122 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
17123 LDA, etc.@: are added to this list in their own .conf files.
17124 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17125 @end deftypevr
17126
17127 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
17128 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
17129 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
17130 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
17131 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17132 @end deftypevr
17133
17134 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
17135 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
17136 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
17137 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
17138 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
17139 occur.
17140 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
17141 @end deftypevr
17142
17143 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
17144 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
17145 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
17146 FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
17147 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
17148 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
17149 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17150 @end deftypevr
17151
17152 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
17153 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
17154 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
17155 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
17156 causes more disk I/O.
17157 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
17158 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
17159 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17160 @end deftypevr
17161
17162 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
17163 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
17164 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
17165 side effects.
17166 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17167 @end deftypevr
17168
17169 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
17170 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
17171 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
17172 the mail otherwise.
17173 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17174 @end deftypevr
17175
17176 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
17177 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
17178 available:
17179
17180 @table @code
17181 @item dotlock
17182 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
17183 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
17184 need write access to that directory.
17185 @item dotlock-try
17186 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
17187 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
17188 @item fcntl
17189 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
17190 @item flock
17191 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
17192 @item lockf
17193 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
17194 @end table
17195
17196 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
17197 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
17198 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
17199 them simultaneously.
17200 @end deftypevr
17201
17202 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
17203
17204 @end deftypevr
17205
17206 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
17207 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
17208 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
17209 @end deftypevr
17210
17211 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
17212 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
17213 override the lock file after this much time.
17214 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
17215 @end deftypevr
17216
17217 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
17218 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
17219 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
17220 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
17221 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
17222 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
17223 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
17224 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
17225 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
17226 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
17227 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17228 @end deftypevr
17229
17230 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
17231 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
17232 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
17233 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
17234 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17235 @end deftypevr
17236
17237 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
17238 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
17239 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
17240 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
17241 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
17242 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17243 @end deftypevr
17244
17245 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
17246 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g.@: 100k), don't write index
17247 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
17248 updated.
17249 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17250 @end deftypevr
17251
17252 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
17253 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
17254 Defaults to @samp{10000000}.
17255 @end deftypevr
17256
17257 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
17258 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
17259 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
17260 disabled.
17261 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
17262 @end deftypevr
17263
17264 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
17265 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
17266 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
17267 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
17268 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17269 @end deftypevr
17270
17271 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
17272 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
17273 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
17274 don't support this for now.
17275
17276 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
17277
17278 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
17279 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17280 @end deftypevr
17281
17282 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
17283 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
17284 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
17285 externally.
17286 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
17287 @end deftypevr
17288
17289 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
17290 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
17291 @table @code
17292 @item posix
17293 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
17294 @item sis posix
17295 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
17296 @item sis-queue posix
17297 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
17298 @end table
17299 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
17300 @end deftypevr
17301
17302 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
17303 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
17304 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
17305 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
17306 truncated, e.g.@: @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
17307 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
17308 @end deftypevr
17309
17310 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
17311
17312 Defaults to @samp{100}.
17313 @end deftypevr
17314
17315 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
17316
17317 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
17318 @end deftypevr
17319
17320 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
17321 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
17322 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
17323 before they eat up everything.
17324 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
17325 @end deftypevr
17326
17327 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
17328 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
17329 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
17330 at all.
17331 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
17332 @end deftypevr
17333
17334 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
17335 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
17336 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
17337 processes.
17338 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
17339 @end deftypevr
17340
17341 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
17342 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
17343 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
17344 @end deftypevr
17345
17346 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
17347 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
17348 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
17349 @end deftypevr
17350
17351 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
17352 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
17353 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
17354 root.
17355 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
17356 @end deftypevr
17357
17358 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
17359 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
17360 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
17361 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
17362 instead to a different.
17363 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17364 @end deftypevr
17365
17366 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
17367 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
17368 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
17369 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
17370 CRL(s). (e.g.@: @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
17371 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17372 @end deftypevr
17373
17374 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
17375 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
17376 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17377 @end deftypevr
17378
17379 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
17380 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
17381 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
17382 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17383 @end deftypevr
17384
17385 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
17386 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
17387 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
17388 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
17389 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
17390 @end deftypevr
17391
17392 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-min-protocol
17393 Minimum SSL protocol version to accept.
17394 Defaults to @samp{"TLSv1"}.
17395 @end deftypevr
17396
17397 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
17398 SSL ciphers to use.
17399 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!kRSA:!SRP:!kDHd:!DSS:!aNULL:!eNULL:!EXPORT:!DES:!3DES:!MD5:!PSK:!RC4:!ADH:!LOW@@STRENGTH"}.
17400 @end deftypevr
17401
17402 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
17403 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
17404 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17405 @end deftypevr
17406
17407 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
17408 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
17409 %d expands to recipient domain.
17410 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
17411 @end deftypevr
17412
17413 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
17414 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g.@: in Message-Id)
17415 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
17416 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17417 @end deftypevr
17418
17419 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
17420 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
17421 bouncing the mail.
17422 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17423 @end deftypevr
17424
17425 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
17426 Binary to use for sending mails.
17427 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
17428 @end deftypevr
17429
17430 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
17431 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
17432 sendmail.
17433 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17434 @end deftypevr
17435
17436 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
17437 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
17438 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
17439 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
17440 @end deftypevr
17441
17442 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
17443 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
17444 variables:
17445
17446 @table @code
17447 @item %n
17448 CRLF
17449 @item %r
17450 reason
17451 @item %s
17452 original subject
17453 @item %t
17454 recipient
17455 @end table
17456 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
17457 @end deftypevr
17458
17459 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
17460 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
17461 address.
17462 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
17463 @end deftypevr
17464
17465 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
17466 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
17467 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
17468 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
17469 X-Original-To.
17470 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17471 @end deftypevr
17472
17473 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
17474 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
17475 it?.
17476 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17477 @end deftypevr
17478
17479 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
17480 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
17481 subscribed?.
17482 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17483 @end deftypevr
17484
17485 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
17486 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
17487 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
17488 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
17489 often.
17490 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
17491 @end deftypevr
17492
17493 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
17494 IMAP logout format string:
17495 @table @code
17496 @item %i
17497 total number of bytes read from client
17498 @item %o
17499 total number of bytes sent to client.
17500 @end table
17501 See @file{doc/wiki/Variables.txt} for a list of all the variables you can use.
17502 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o deleted=%@{deleted@} expunged=%@{expunged@} trashed=%@{trashed@} hdr_count=%@{fetch_hdr_count@} hdr_bytes=%@{fetch_hdr_bytes@} body_count=%@{fetch_body_count@} body_bytes=%@{fetch_body_bytes@}"}.
17503 @end deftypevr
17504
17505 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
17506 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
17507 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g.@: +XFOO XBAR).
17508 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17509 @end deftypevr
17510
17511 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
17512 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
17513 is IDLEing.
17514 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
17515 @end deftypevr
17516
17517 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
17518 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
17519 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
17520 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
17521 support-email.
17522 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17523 @end deftypevr
17524
17525 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
17526 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
17527 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17528 @end deftypevr
17529
17530 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
17531 Workarounds for various client bugs:
17532
17533 @table @code
17534 @item delay-newmail
17535 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
17536 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
17537 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
17538 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
17539 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
17540 "Headers Only".
17541
17542 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
17543 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
17544 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
17545 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
17546
17547 @item tb-lsub-flags
17548 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g.@: mbox).
17549 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
17550 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
17551 @end table
17552 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17553 @end deftypevr
17554
17555 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
17556 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
17557 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17558 @end deftypevr
17559
17560
17561 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
17562 that Guix has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
17563 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
17564 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
17565 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
17566
17567 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
17568 and running. In that case, you can pass an
17569 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
17570 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
17571 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
17572
17573 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
17574
17575 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
17576 The dovecot package.
17577 @end deftypevr
17578
17579 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
17580 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
17581 @end deftypevr
17582
17583 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
17584 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
17585
17586 @lisp
17587 (dovecot-service #:config
17588 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
17589 (string "")))
17590 @end lisp
17591
17592 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
17593
17594 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
17595 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
17596 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
17597 as in this example:
17598
17599 @lisp
17600 (service opensmtpd-service-type
17601 (opensmtpd-configuration
17602 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
17603 @end lisp
17604 @end deffn
17605
17606 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
17607 Data type representing the configuration of opensmtpd.
17608
17609 @table @asis
17610 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
17611 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
17612
17613 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-opensmtpd-file})
17614 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
17615 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
17616 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
17617 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
17618
17619 @end table
17620 @end deftp
17621
17622 @subsubheading Exim Service
17623
17624 @cindex mail transfer agent (MTA)
17625 @cindex MTA (mail transfer agent)
17626 @cindex SMTP
17627
17628 @deffn {Scheme Variable} exim-service-type
17629 This is the type of the @uref{https://exim.org, Exim} mail transfer
17630 agent (MTA), whose value should be an @code{exim-configuration} object
17631 as in this example:
17632
17633 @lisp
17634 (service exim-service-type
17635 (exim-configuration
17636 (config-file (local-file "./my-exim.conf"))))
17637 @end lisp
17638 @end deffn
17639
17640 In order to use an @code{exim-service-type} service you must also have a
17641 @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service present in your
17642 @code{operating-system} (even if it has no aliases).
17643
17644 @deftp {Data Type} exim-configuration
17645 Data type representing the configuration of exim.
17646
17647 @table @asis
17648 @item @code{package} (default: @var{exim})
17649 Package object of the Exim server.
17650
17651 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
17652 File-like object of the Exim configuration file to use. If its value is
17653 @code{#f} then use the default configuration file from the package
17654 provided in @code{package}. The resulting configuration file is loaded
17655 after setting the @code{exim_user} and @code{exim_group} configuration
17656 variables.
17657
17658 @end table
17659 @end deftp
17660
17661 @subsubheading Getmail service
17662
17663 @cindex IMAP
17664 @cindex POP
17665
17666 @deffn {Scheme Variable} getmail-service-type
17667 This is the type of the @uref{http://pyropus.ca/software/getmail/, Getmail}
17668 mail retriever, whose value should be an @code{getmail-configuration}.
17669 @end deffn
17670
17671 Available @code{getmail-configuration} fields are:
17672
17673 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} symbol name
17674 A symbol to identify the getmail service.
17675
17676 Defaults to @samp{"unset"}.
17677
17678 @end deftypevr
17679
17680 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} package package
17681 The getmail package to use.
17682
17683 @end deftypevr
17684
17685 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string user
17686 The user to run getmail as.
17687
17688 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
17689
17690 @end deftypevr
17691
17692 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string group
17693 The group to run getmail as.
17694
17695 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
17696
17697 @end deftypevr
17698
17699 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string directory
17700 The getmail directory to use.
17701
17702 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/getmail/default"}.
17703
17704 @end deftypevr
17705
17706 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} getmail-configuration-file rcfile
17707 The getmail configuration file to use.
17708
17709 Available @code{getmail-configuration-file} fields are:
17710
17711 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-retriever-configuration retriever
17712 What mail account to retrieve mail from, and how to access that account.
17713
17714 Available @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} fields are:
17715
17716 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string type
17717 The type of mail retriever to use. Valid values include @samp{passwd}
17718 and @samp{static}.
17719
17720 Defaults to @samp{"SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever"}.
17721
17722 @end deftypevr
17723
17724 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string server
17725 Username to login to the mail server with.
17726
17727 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
17728
17729 @end deftypevr
17730
17731 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string username
17732 Username to login to the mail server with.
17733
17734 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
17735
17736 @end deftypevr
17737
17738 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
17739 Port number to connect to.
17740
17741 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17742
17743 @end deftypevr
17744
17745 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string password
17746 Override fields from passwd.
17747
17748 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17749
17750 @end deftypevr
17751
17752 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} list password-command
17753 Override fields from passwd.
17754
17755 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17756
17757 @end deftypevr
17758
17759 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string keyfile
17760 PEM-formatted key file to use for the TLS negotiation.
17761
17762 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17763
17764 @end deftypevr
17765
17766 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string certfile
17767 PEM-formatted certificate file to use for the TLS negotiation.
17768
17769 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17770
17771 @end deftypevr
17772
17773 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string ca-certs
17774 CA certificates to use.
17775
17776 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17777
17778 @end deftypevr
17779
17780 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
17781 Extra retriever parameters.
17782
17783 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17784
17785 @end deftypevr
17786
17787 @end deftypevr
17788
17789 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-destination-configuration destination
17790 What to do with retrieved messages.
17791
17792 Available @code{getmail-destination-configuration} fields are:
17793
17794 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string type
17795 The type of mail destination. Valid values include @samp{Maildir},
17796 @samp{Mboxrd} and @samp{MDA_external}.
17797
17798 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
17799
17800 @end deftypevr
17801
17802 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string-or-filelike path
17803 The path option for the mail destination. The behaviour depends on the
17804 chosen type.
17805
17806 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17807
17808 @end deftypevr
17809
17810 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
17811 Extra destination parameters
17812
17813 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17814
17815 @end deftypevr
17816
17817 @end deftypevr
17818
17819 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-options-configuration options
17820 Configure getmail.
17821
17822 Available @code{getmail-options-configuration} fields are:
17823
17824 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer verbose
17825 If set to @samp{0}, getmail will only print warnings and errors. A
17826 value of @samp{1} means that messages will be printed about retrieving
17827 and deleting messages. If set to @samp{2}, getmail will print messages
17828 about each of it's actions.
17829
17830 Defaults to @samp{1}.
17831
17832 @end deftypevr
17833
17834 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean read-all
17835 If true, getmail will retrieve all available messages. Otherwise it
17836 will only retrieve messages it hasn't seen previously.
17837
17838 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17839
17840 @end deftypevr
17841
17842 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delete
17843 If set to true, messages will be deleted from the server after
17844 retrieving and successfully delivering them. Otherwise, messages will
17845 be left on the server.
17846
17847 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17848
17849 @end deftypevr
17850
17851 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-after
17852 Getmail will delete messages this number of days after seeing them, if
17853 they have been delivered. This means messages will be left on the
17854 server this number of days after delivering them. A value of @samp{0}
17855 disabled this feature.
17856
17857 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17858
17859 @end deftypevr
17860
17861 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-bigger-than
17862 Delete messages larger than this of bytes after retrieving them, even if
17863 the delete and delete-after options are disabled. A value of @samp{0}
17864 disables this feature.
17865
17866 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17867
17868 @end deftypevr
17869
17870 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-bytes-per-session
17871 Retrieve messages totalling up to this number of bytes before closing
17872 the session with the server. A value of @samp{0} disables this feature.
17873
17874 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17875
17876 @end deftypevr
17877
17878 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-message-size
17879 Don't retrieve messages larger than this number of bytes. A value of
17880 @samp{0} disables this feature.
17881
17882 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17883
17884 @end deftypevr
17885
17886 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delivered-to
17887 If true, getmail will add a Delivered-To header to messages.
17888
17889 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17890
17891 @end deftypevr
17892
17893 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean received
17894 If set, getmail adds a Received header to the messages.
17895
17896 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17897
17898 @end deftypevr
17899
17900 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} string message-log
17901 Getmail will record a log of its actions to the named file. A value of
17902 @samp{""} disables this feature.
17903
17904 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17905
17906 @end deftypevr
17907
17908 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-syslog
17909 If true, getmail will record a log of its actions using the system
17910 logger.
17911
17912 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17913
17914 @end deftypevr
17915
17916 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-verbose
17917 If true, getmail will log information about messages not retrieved and
17918 the reason for not retrieving them, as well as starting and ending
17919 information lines.
17920
17921 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17922
17923 @end deftypevr
17924
17925 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
17926 Extra options to include.
17927
17928 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17929
17930 @end deftypevr
17931
17932 @end deftypevr
17933
17934 @end deftypevr
17935
17936 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list idle
17937 A list of mailboxes that getmail should wait on the server for new mail
17938 notifications. This depends on the server supporting the IDLE
17939 extension.
17940
17941 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17942
17943 @end deftypevr
17944
17945 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list environment-variables
17946 Environment variables to set for getmail.
17947
17948 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17949
17950 @end deftypevr
17951
17952 @subsubheading Mail Aliases Service
17953
17954 @cindex email aliases
17955 @cindex aliases, for email addresses
17956
17957 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mail-aliases-service-type
17958 This is the type of the service which provides @code{/etc/aliases},
17959 specifying how to deliver mail to users on this system.
17960
17961 @lisp
17962 (service mail-aliases-service-type
17963 '(("postmaster" "bob")
17964 ("bob" "bob@@example.com" "bob@@example2.com")))
17965 @end lisp
17966 @end deffn
17967
17968 The configuration for a @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service is an
17969 association list denoting how to deliver mail that comes to this
17970 system. Each entry is of the form @code{(alias addresses ...)}, with
17971 @code{alias} specifying the local alias and @code{addresses} specifying
17972 where to deliver this user's mail.
17973
17974 The aliases aren't required to exist as users on the local system. In
17975 the above example, there doesn't need to be a @code{postmaster} entry in
17976 the @code{operating-system}'s @code{user-accounts} in order to deliver
17977 the @code{postmaster} mail to @code{bob} (which subsequently would
17978 deliver mail to @code{bob@@example.com} and @code{bob@@example2.com}).
17979
17980 @subsubheading GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
17981 @cindex GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
17982
17983 @deffn {Scheme Variable} imap4d-service-type
17984 This is the type of the GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon (@pxref{imap4d,,,
17985 mailutils, GNU Mailutils Manual}), whose value should be an
17986 @code{imap4d-configuration} object as in this example:
17987
17988 @lisp
17989 (service imap4d-service-type
17990 (imap4d-configuration
17991 (config-file (local-file "imap4d.conf"))))
17992 @end lisp
17993 @end deffn
17994
17995 @deftp {Data Type} imap4d-configuration
17996 Data type representing the configuration of @command{imap4d}.
17997
17998 @table @asis
17999 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mailutils})
18000 The package that provides @command{imap4d}.
18001
18002 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-imap4d-config-file})
18003 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
18004 on TCP port 143 of @code{localhost}. @xref{Conf-imap4d,,, mailutils, GNU
18005 Mailutils Manual}, for details.
18006
18007 @end table
18008 @end deftp
18009
18010 @node Messaging Services
18011 @subsection Messaging Services
18012
18013 @cindex messaging
18014 @cindex jabber
18015 @cindex XMPP
18016 The @code{(gnu services messaging)} module provides Guix service
18017 definitions for messaging services: currently only Prosody is supported.
18018
18019 @subsubheading Prosody Service
18020
18021 @deffn {Scheme Variable} prosody-service-type
18022 This is the type for the @uref{https://prosody.im, Prosody XMPP
18023 communication server}. Its value must be a @code{prosody-configuration}
18024 record as in this example:
18025
18026 @lisp
18027 (service prosody-service-type
18028 (prosody-configuration
18029 (modules-enabled (cons "groups" "mam" %default-modules-enabled))
18030 (int-components
18031 (list
18032 (int-component-configuration
18033 (hostname "conference.example.net")
18034 (plugin "muc")
18035 (mod-muc (mod-muc-configuration)))))
18036 (virtualhosts
18037 (list
18038 (virtualhost-configuration
18039 (domain "example.net"))))))
18040 @end lisp
18041
18042 See below for details about @code{prosody-configuration}.
18043
18044 @end deffn
18045
18046 By default, Prosody does not need much configuration. Only one
18047 @code{virtualhosts} field is needed: it specifies the domain you wish
18048 Prosody to serve.
18049
18050 You can perform various sanity checks on the generated configuration
18051 with the @code{prosodyctl check} command.
18052
18053 Prosodyctl will also help you to import certificates from the
18054 @code{letsencrypt} directory so that the @code{prosody} user can access
18055 them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/letsencrypt}.
18056
18057 @example
18058 prosodyctl --root cert import /etc/letsencrypt/live
18059 @end example
18060
18061 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
18062 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
18063 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
18064 strings. Types starting with @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't
18065 show up in @code{prosody.cfg.lua} when their value is @code{'disabled}.
18066
18067 There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string, if you
18068 have an old @code{prosody.cfg.lua} file that you want to port over from
18069 some other system; see the end for more details.
18070
18071 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
18072 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a file name.
18073
18074 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
18075 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services messaging). Manually maintained
18076 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
18077 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
18078 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
18079 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
18080 @c the churn as Prosody updates.
18081
18082 Available @code{prosody-configuration} fields are:
18083
18084 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
18085 The Prosody package.
18086 @end deftypevr
18087
18088 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name data-path
18089 Location of the Prosody data storage directory. See
18090 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure}.
18091 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody"}.
18092 @end deftypevr
18093
18094 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object-list plugin-paths
18095 Additional plugin directories. They are searched in all the specified
18096 paths in order. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/plugins_directory}.
18097 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18098 @end deftypevr
18099
18100 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name certificates
18101 Every virtual host and component needs a certificate so that clients and
18102 servers can securely verify its identity. Prosody will automatically load
18103 certificates/keys from the directory specified here.
18104 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/prosody/certs"}.
18105 @end deftypevr
18106
18107 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list admins
18108 This is a list of accounts that are admins for the server. Note that you
18109 must create the accounts separately. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/admins} and
18110 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
18111 Example: @code{(admins '("user1@@example.com" "user2@@example.net"))}
18112 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18113 @end deftypevr
18114
18115 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean use-libevent?
18116 Enable use of libevent for better performance under high load. See
18117 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/libevent}.
18118 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18119 @end deftypevr
18120
18121 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} module-list modules-enabled
18122 This is the list of modules Prosody will load on startup. It looks for
18123 @code{mod_modulename.lua} in the plugins folder, so make sure that exists too.
18124 Documentation on modules can be found at:
18125 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules}.
18126 Defaults to @samp{("roster" "saslauth" "tls" "dialback" "disco" "carbons" "private" "blocklist" "vcard" "version" "uptime" "time" "ping" "pep" "register" "admin_adhoc")}.
18127 @end deftypevr
18128
18129 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list modules-disabled
18130 @samp{"offline"}, @samp{"c2s"} and @samp{"s2s"} are auto-loaded, but
18131 should you want to disable them then add them to this list.
18132 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18133 @end deftypevr
18134
18135 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object groups-file
18136 Path to a text file where the shared groups are defined. If this path is
18137 empty then @samp{mod_groups} does nothing. See
18138 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_groups}.
18139 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody/sharedgroups.txt"}.
18140 @end deftypevr
18141
18142 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean allow-registration?
18143 Disable account creation by default, for security. See
18144 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
18145 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18146 @end deftypevr
18147
18148 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-configuration ssl
18149 These are the SSL/TLS-related settings. Most of them are disabled so to
18150 use Prosody's defaults. If you do not completely understand these options, do
18151 not add them to your config, it is easy to lower the security of your server
18152 using them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/advanced_ssl_config}.
18153
18154 Available @code{ssl-configuration} fields are:
18155
18156 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string protocol
18157 This determines what handshake to use.
18158 @end deftypevr
18159
18160 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name key
18161 Path to your private key file.
18162 @end deftypevr
18163
18164 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name certificate
18165 Path to your certificate file.
18166 @end deftypevr
18167
18168 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} file-object capath
18169 Path to directory containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to
18170 trust when verifying the certificates of remote servers.
18171 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
18172 @end deftypevr
18173
18174 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object cafile
18175 Path to a file containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to trust.
18176 Similar to @code{capath} but with all certificates concatenated together.
18177 @end deftypevr
18178
18179 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verify
18180 A list of verification options (these mostly map to OpenSSL's
18181 @code{set_verify()} flags).
18182 @end deftypevr
18183
18184 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list options
18185 A list of general options relating to SSL/TLS. These map to OpenSSL's
18186 @code{set_options()}. For a full list of options available in LuaSec, see the
18187 LuaSec source.
18188 @end deftypevr
18189
18190 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer depth
18191 How long a chain of certificate authorities to check when looking for a
18192 trusted root certificate.
18193 @end deftypevr
18194
18195 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ciphers
18196 An OpenSSL cipher string. This selects what ciphers Prosody will offer to
18197 clients, and in what order.
18198 @end deftypevr
18199
18200 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name dhparam
18201 A path to a file containing parameters for Diffie-Hellman key exchange. You
18202 can create such a file with:
18203 @code{openssl dhparam -out /etc/prosody/certs/dh-2048.pem 2048}
18204 @end deftypevr
18205
18206 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string curve
18207 Curve for Elliptic curve Diffie-Hellman. Prosody's default is
18208 @samp{"secp384r1"}.
18209 @end deftypevr
18210
18211 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verifyext
18212 A list of "extra" verification options.
18213 @end deftypevr
18214
18215 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string password
18216 Password for encrypted private keys.
18217 @end deftypevr
18218
18219 @end deftypevr
18220
18221 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean c2s-require-encryption?
18222 Whether to force all client-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
18223 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
18224 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18225 @end deftypevr
18226
18227 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list disable-sasl-mechanisms
18228 Set of mechanisms that will never be offered. See
18229 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_saslauth}.
18230 Defaults to @samp{("DIGEST-MD5")}.
18231 @end deftypevr
18232
18233 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-require-encryption?
18234 Whether to force all server-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
18235 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
18236 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18237 @end deftypevr
18238
18239 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-secure-auth?
18240 Whether to require encryption and certificate authentication. This
18241 provides ideal security, but requires servers you communicate with to support
18242 encryption AND present valid, trusted certificates. See
18243 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
18244 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18245 @end deftypevr
18246
18247 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-insecure-domains
18248 Many servers don't support encryption or have invalid or self-signed
18249 certificates. You can list domains here that will not be required to
18250 authenticate using certificates. They will be authenticated using DNS. See
18251 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
18252 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18253 @end deftypevr
18254
18255 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-secure-domains
18256 Even if you leave @code{s2s-secure-auth?} disabled, you can still require
18257 valid certificates for some domains by specifying a list here. See
18258 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
18259 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18260 @end deftypevr
18261
18262 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string authentication
18263 Select the authentication backend to use. The default provider stores
18264 passwords in plaintext and uses Prosody's configured data storage to store the
18265 authentication data. If you do not trust your server please see
18266 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_auth_internal_hashed} for information
18267 about using the hashed backend. See also
18268 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/authentication}
18269 Defaults to @samp{"internal_plain"}.
18270 @end deftypevr
18271
18272 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string log
18273 Set logging options. Advanced logging configuration is not yet supported
18274 by the Prosody service. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/logging}.
18275 Defaults to @samp{"*syslog"}.
18276 @end deftypevr
18277
18278 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name pidfile
18279 File to write pid in. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_posix}.
18280 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/prosody/prosody.pid"}.
18281 @end deftypevr
18282
18283 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer http-max-content-size
18284 Maximum allowed size of the HTTP body (in bytes).
18285 @end deftypevr
18286
18287 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string http-external-url
18288 Some modules expose their own URL in various ways. This URL is built
18289 from the protocol, host and port used. If Prosody sits behind a proxy, the
18290 public URL will be @code{http-external-url} instead. See
18291 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/http#external_url}.
18292 @end deftypevr
18293
18294 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} virtualhost-configuration-list virtualhosts
18295 A host in Prosody is a domain on which user accounts can be created. For
18296 example if you want your users to have addresses like
18297 @samp{"john.smith@@example.com"} then you need to add a host
18298 @samp{"example.com"}. All options in this list will apply only to this host.
18299
18300 Note: the name "virtual" host is used in configuration to avoid confusion with
18301 the actual physical host that Prosody is installed on. A single Prosody
18302 instance can serve many domains, each one defined as a VirtualHost entry in
18303 Prosody's configuration. Conversely a server that hosts a single domain would
18304 have just one VirtualHost entry.
18305
18306 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure#virtual_host_settings}.
18307
18308 Available @code{virtualhost-configuration} fields are:
18309
18310 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
18311 @deftypevr {@code{virtualhost-configuration} parameter} string domain
18312 Domain you wish Prosody to serve.
18313 @end deftypevr
18314
18315 @end deftypevr
18316
18317 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} int-component-configuration-list int-components
18318 Components are extra services on a server which are available to clients,
18319 usually on a subdomain of the main server (such as
18320 @samp{"mycomponent.example.com"}). Example components might be chatroom
18321 servers, user directories, or gateways to other protocols.
18322
18323 Internal components are implemented with Prosody-specific plugins. To add an
18324 internal component, you simply fill the hostname field, and the plugin you wish
18325 to use for the component.
18326
18327 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
18328 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18329
18330 Available @code{int-component-configuration} fields are:
18331
18332 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
18333 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
18334 Hostname of the component.
18335 @end deftypevr
18336
18337 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string plugin
18338 Plugin you wish to use for the component.
18339 @end deftypevr
18340
18341 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} maybe-mod-muc-configuration mod-muc
18342 Multi-user chat (MUC) is Prosody's module for allowing you to create
18343 hosted chatrooms/conferences for XMPP users.
18344
18345 General information on setting up and using multi-user chatrooms can be found
18346 in the "Chatrooms" documentation (@url{https://prosody.im/doc/chatrooms}),
18347 which you should read if you are new to XMPP chatrooms.
18348
18349 See also @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_muc}.
18350
18351 Available @code{mod-muc-configuration} fields are:
18352
18353 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string name
18354 The name to return in service discovery responses.
18355 Defaults to @samp{"Prosody Chatrooms"}.
18356 @end deftypevr
18357
18358 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string-or-boolean restrict-room-creation
18359 If @samp{#t}, this will only allow admins to create new chatrooms.
18360 Otherwise anyone can create a room. The value @samp{"local"} restricts room
18361 creation to users on the service's parent domain. E.g.@: @samp{user@@example.com}
18362 can create rooms on @samp{rooms.example.com}. The value @samp{"admin"}
18363 restricts to service administrators only.
18364 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
18365 @end deftypevr
18366
18367 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-history-messages
18368 Maximum number of history messages that will be sent to the member that has
18369 just joined the room.
18370 Defaults to @samp{20}.
18371 @end deftypevr
18372
18373 @end deftypevr
18374
18375 @end deftypevr
18376
18377 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} ext-component-configuration-list ext-components
18378 External components use XEP-0114, which most standalone components
18379 support. To add an external component, you simply fill the hostname field. See
18380 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
18381 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18382
18383 Available @code{ext-component-configuration} fields are:
18384
18385 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
18386 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string component-secret
18387 Password which the component will use to log in.
18388 @end deftypevr
18389
18390 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
18391 Hostname of the component.
18392 @end deftypevr
18393
18394 @end deftypevr
18395
18396 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer-list component-ports
18397 Port(s) Prosody listens on for component connections.
18398 Defaults to @samp{(5347)}.
18399 @end deftypevr
18400
18401 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string component-interface
18402 Interface Prosody listens on for component connections.
18403 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
18404 @end deftypevr
18405
18406 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-raw-content raw-content
18407 Raw content that will be added to the configuration file.
18408 @end deftypevr
18409
18410 It could be that you just want to get a @code{prosody.cfg.lua}
18411 up and running. In that case, you can pass an
18412 @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} record as the value of
18413 @code{prosody-service-type}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
18414 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
18415 Available @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} fields are:
18416
18417 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
18418 The prosody package.
18419 @end deftypevr
18420
18421 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} string prosody.cfg.lua
18422 The contents of the @code{prosody.cfg.lua} to use.
18423 @end deftypevr
18424
18425 For example, if your @code{prosody.cfg.lua} is just the empty
18426 string, you could instantiate a prosody service like this:
18427
18428 @lisp
18429 (service prosody-service-type
18430 (opaque-prosody-configuration
18431 (prosody.cfg.lua "")))
18432 @end lisp
18433
18434 @c end of Prosody auto-generated documentation
18435
18436 @subsubheading BitlBee Service
18437
18438 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
18439 @cindex IRC gateway
18440 @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} is a gateway that provides an IRC
18441 interface to a variety of messaging protocols such as XMPP.
18442
18443 @defvr {Scheme Variable} bitlbee-service-type
18444 This is the service type for the @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} IRC
18445 gateway daemon. Its value is a @code{bitlbee-configuration} (see
18446 below).
18447
18448 To have BitlBee listen on port 6667 on localhost, add this line to your
18449 services:
18450
18451 @lisp
18452 (service bitlbee-service-type)
18453 @end lisp
18454 @end defvr
18455
18456 @deftp {Data Type} bitlbee-configuration
18457 This is the configuration for BitlBee, with the following fields:
18458
18459 @table @asis
18460 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
18461 @itemx @code{port} (default: @code{6667})
18462 Listen on the network interface corresponding to the IP address
18463 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}.
18464
18465 When @var{interface} is @code{127.0.0.1}, only local clients can
18466 connect; when it is @code{0.0.0.0}, connections can come from any
18467 networking interface.
18468
18469 @item @code{bitlbee} (default: @code{bitlbee})
18470 The BitlBee package to use.
18471
18472 @item @code{plugins} (default: @code{'()})
18473 List of plugin packages to use---e.g., @code{bitlbee-discord}.
18474
18475 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
18476 Configuration snippet added as-is to the BitlBee configuration file.
18477 @end table
18478 @end deftp
18479
18480 @subsubheading Quassel Service
18481
18482 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
18483 @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel} is a distributed IRC client,
18484 meaning that one or more clients can attach to and detach from the
18485 central core.
18486
18487 @defvr {Scheme Variable} quassel-service-type
18488 This is the service type for the @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel}
18489 IRC backend daemon. Its value is a @code{quassel-configuration}
18490 (see below).
18491 @end defvr
18492
18493 @deftp {Data Type} quassel-configuration
18494 This is the configuration for Quassel, with the following fields:
18495
18496 @table @asis
18497 @item @code{quassel} (default: @code{quassel})
18498 The Quassel package to use.
18499
18500 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"::,0.0.0.0"})
18501 @item @code{port} (default: @code{4242})
18502 Listen on the network interface(s) corresponding to the IPv4 or IPv6
18503 interfaces specified in the comma delimited @var{interface}, on
18504 @var{port}.
18505
18506 @item @code{loglevel} (default: @code{"Info"})
18507 The level of logging desired. Accepted values are Debug, Info, Warning
18508 and Error.
18509 @end table
18510 @end deftp
18511
18512 @node Telephony Services
18513 @subsection Telephony Services
18514
18515 @cindex Murmur (VoIP server)
18516 @cindex VoIP server
18517 This section describes how to set up and run a Murmur server. Murmur is
18518 the server of the @uref{https://mumble.info, Mumble} voice-over-IP
18519 (VoIP) suite.
18520
18521 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-configuration
18522 The service type for the Murmur server. An example configuration can
18523 look like this:
18524
18525 @lisp
18526 (service murmur-service-type
18527 (murmur-configuration
18528 (welcome-text
18529 "Welcome to this Mumble server running on Guix!")
18530 (cert-required? #t) ;disallow text password logins
18531 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/fullchain.pem")
18532 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/privkey.pem")))
18533 @end lisp
18534
18535 After reconfiguring your system, you can manually set the murmur @code{SuperUser}
18536 password with the command that is printed during the activation phase.
18537
18538 It is recommended to register a normal Mumble user account
18539 and grant it admin or moderator rights.
18540 You can use the @code{mumble} client to
18541 login as new normal user, register yourself, and log out.
18542 For the next step login with the name @code{SuperUser} use
18543 the @code{SuperUser} password that you set previously,
18544 and grant your newly registered mumble user administrator or moderator
18545 rights and create some channels.
18546
18547 Available @code{murmur-configuration} fields are:
18548
18549 @table @asis
18550 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mumble})
18551 Package that contains @code{bin/murmurd}.
18552
18553 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"murmur"})
18554 User who will run the Murmur server.
18555
18556 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"murmur"})
18557 Group of the user who will run the murmur server.
18558
18559 @item @code{port} (default: @code{64738})
18560 Port on which the server will listen.
18561
18562 @item @code{welcome-text} (default: @code{""})
18563 Welcome text sent to clients when they connect.
18564
18565 @item @code{server-password} (default: @code{""})
18566 Password the clients have to enter in order to connect.
18567
18568 @item @code{max-users} (default: @code{100})
18569 Maximum of users that can be connected to the server at once.
18570
18571 @item @code{max-user-bandwidth} (default: @code{#f})
18572 Maximum voice traffic a user can send per second.
18573
18574 @item @code{database-file} (default: @code{"/var/lib/murmur/db.sqlite"})
18575 File name of the sqlite database.
18576 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
18577
18578 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/murmur/murmur.log"})
18579 File name of the log file.
18580 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
18581
18582 @item @code{autoban-attempts} (default: @code{10})
18583 Maximum number of logins a user can make in @code{autoban-timeframe}
18584 without getting auto banned for @code{autoban-time}.
18585
18586 @item @code{autoban-timeframe} (default: @code{120})
18587 Timeframe for autoban in seconds.
18588
18589 @item @code{autoban-time} (default: @code{300})
18590 Amount of time in seconds for which a client gets banned
18591 when violating the autoban limits.
18592
18593 @item @code{opus-threshold} (default: @code{100})
18594 Percentage of clients that need to support opus
18595 before switching over to opus audio codec.
18596
18597 @item @code{channel-nesting-limit} (default: @code{10})
18598 How deep channels can be nested at maximum.
18599
18600 @item @code{channelname-regex} (default: @code{#f})
18601 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that channel names must conform to.
18602
18603 @item @code{username-regex} (default: @code{#f})
18604 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that user names must conform to.
18605
18606 @item @code{text-message-length} (default: @code{5000})
18607 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one text chat message.
18608
18609 @item @code{image-message-length} (default: @code{(* 128 1024)})
18610 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one image message.
18611
18612 @item @code{cert-required?} (default: @code{#f})
18613 If it is set to @code{#t} clients that use weak password authentication
18614 will not be accepted. Users must have completed the certificate wizard to join.
18615
18616 @item @code{remember-channel?} (default: @code{#f})
18617 Should murmur remember the last channel each user was in when they disconnected
18618 and put them into the remembered channel when they rejoin.
18619
18620 @item @code{allow-html?} (default: @code{#f})
18621 Should html be allowed in text messages, user comments, and channel descriptions.
18622
18623 @item @code{allow-ping?} (default: @code{#f})
18624 Setting to true exposes the current user count, the maximum user count, and
18625 the server's maximum bandwidth per client to unauthenticated users. In the
18626 Mumble client, this information is shown in the Connect dialog.
18627
18628 Disabling this setting will prevent public listing of the server.
18629
18630 @item @code{bonjour?} (default: @code{#f})
18631 Should the server advertise itself in the local network through the bonjour protocol.
18632
18633 @item @code{send-version?} (default: @code{#f})
18634 Should the murmur server version be exposed in ping requests.
18635
18636 @item @code{log-days} (default: @code{31})
18637 Murmur also stores logs in the database, which are accessible via RPC.
18638 The default is 31 days of months, but you can set this setting to 0 to keep logs forever,
18639 or -1 to disable logging to the database.
18640
18641 @item @code{obfuscate-ips?} (default: @code{#t})
18642 Should logged ips be obfuscated to protect the privacy of users.
18643
18644 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @code{#f})
18645 File name of the SSL/TLS certificate used for encrypted connections.
18646
18647 @lisp
18648 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/fullchain.pem")
18649 @end lisp
18650 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @code{#f})
18651 Filepath to the ssl private key used for encrypted connections.
18652 @lisp
18653 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/privkey.pem")
18654 @end lisp
18655
18656 @item @code{ssl-dh-params} (default: @code{#f})
18657 File name of a PEM-encoded file with Diffie-Hellman parameters
18658 for the SSL/TLS encryption. Alternatively you set it to
18659 @code{"@@ffdhe2048"}, @code{"@@ffdhe3072"}, @code{"@@ffdhe4096"}, @code{"@@ffdhe6144"}
18660 or @code{"@@ffdhe8192"} to use bundled parameters from RFC 7919.
18661
18662 @item @code{ssl-ciphers} (default: @code{#f})
18663 The @code{ssl-ciphers} option chooses the cipher suites to make available for use
18664 in SSL/TLS.
18665
18666 This option is specified using
18667 @uref{https://www.openssl.org/docs/apps/ciphers.html#CIPHER-LIST-FORMAT,
18668 OpenSSL cipher list notation}.
18669
18670 It is recommended that you try your cipher string using 'openssl ciphers <string>'
18671 before setting it here, to get a feel for which cipher suites you will get.
18672 After setting this option, it is recommend that you inspect your Murmur log
18673 to ensure that Murmur is using the cipher suites that you expected it to.
18674
18675 Note: Changing this option may impact the backwards compatibility of your
18676 Murmur server, and can remove the ability for older Mumble clients to be able
18677 to connect to it.
18678
18679 @item @code{public-registration} (default: @code{#f})
18680 Must be a @code{<murmur-public-registration-configuration>} record or @code{#f}.
18681
18682 You can optionally register your server in the public server list that the
18683 @code{mumble} client shows on startup.
18684 You cannot register your server if you have set a @code{server-password},
18685 or set @code{allow-ping} to @code{#f}.
18686
18687 It might take a few hours until it shows up in the public list.
18688
18689 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
18690 Optional alternative override for this configuration.
18691 @end table
18692 @end deftp
18693
18694 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-public-registration-configuration
18695 Configuration for public registration of a murmur service.
18696
18697 @table @asis
18698 @item @code{name}
18699 This is a display name for your server. Not to be confused with the hostname.
18700
18701 @item @code{password}
18702 A password to identify your registration.
18703 Subsequent updates will need the same password. Don't lose your password.
18704
18705 @item @code{url}
18706 This should be a @code{http://} or @code{https://} link to your web
18707 site.
18708
18709 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
18710 By default your server will be listed by its IP address.
18711 If it is set your server will be linked by this host name instead.
18712 @end table
18713 @end deftp
18714
18715
18716
18717 @node Monitoring Services
18718 @subsection Monitoring Services
18719
18720 @subsubheading Tailon Service
18721
18722 @uref{https://tailon.readthedocs.io/, Tailon} is a web application for
18723 viewing and searching log files.
18724
18725 The following example will configure the service with default values.
18726 By default, Tailon can be accessed on port 8080 (@code{http://localhost:8080}).
18727
18728 @lisp
18729 (service tailon-service-type)
18730 @end lisp
18731
18732 The following example customises more of the Tailon configuration,
18733 adding @command{sed} to the list of allowed commands.
18734
18735 @lisp
18736 (service tailon-service-type
18737 (tailon-configuration
18738 (config-file
18739 (tailon-configuration-file
18740 (allowed-commands '("tail" "grep" "awk" "sed"))))))
18741 @end lisp
18742
18743
18744 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration
18745 Data type representing the configuration of Tailon.
18746 This type has the following parameters:
18747
18748 @table @asis
18749 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(tailon-configuration-file)})
18750 The configuration file to use for Tailon. This can be set to a
18751 @dfn{tailon-configuration-file} record value, or any gexp
18752 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
18753
18754 For example, to instead use a local file, the @code{local-file} function
18755 can be used:
18756
18757 @lisp
18758 (service tailon-service-type
18759 (tailon-configuration
18760 (config-file (local-file "./my-tailon.conf"))))
18761 @end lisp
18762
18763 @item @code{package} (default: @code{tailon})
18764 The tailon package to use.
18765
18766 @end table
18767 @end deftp
18768
18769 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration-file
18770 Data type representing the configuration options for Tailon.
18771 This type has the following parameters:
18772
18773 @table @asis
18774 @item @code{files} (default: @code{(list "/var/log")})
18775 List of files to display. The list can include strings for a single file
18776 or directory, or a list, where the first item is the name of a
18777 subsection, and the remaining items are the files or directories in that
18778 subsection.
18779
18780 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
18781 Address and port to which Tailon should bind on.
18782
18783 @item @code{relative-root} (default: @code{#f})
18784 URL path to use for Tailon, set to @code{#f} to not use a path.
18785
18786 @item @code{allow-transfers?} (default: @code{#t})
18787 Allow downloading the log files in the web interface.
18788
18789 @item @code{follow-names?} (default: @code{#t})
18790 Allow tailing of not-yet existent files.
18791
18792 @item @code{tail-lines} (default: @code{200})
18793 Number of lines to read initially from each file.
18794
18795 @item @code{allowed-commands} (default: @code{(list "tail" "grep" "awk")})
18796 Commands to allow running. By default, @code{sed} is disabled.
18797
18798 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
18799 Set @code{debug?} to @code{#t} to show debug messages.
18800
18801 @item @code{wrap-lines} (default: @code{#t})
18802 Initial line wrapping state in the web interface. Set to @code{#t} to
18803 initially wrap lines (the default), or to @code{#f} to initially not
18804 wrap lines.
18805
18806 @item @code{http-auth} (default: @code{#f})
18807 HTTP authentication type to use. Set to @code{#f} to disable
18808 authentication (the default). Supported values are @code{"digest"} or
18809 @code{"basic"}.
18810
18811 @item @code{users} (default: @code{#f})
18812 If HTTP authentication is enabled (see @code{http-auth}), access will be
18813 restricted to the credentials provided here. To configure users, use a
18814 list of pairs, where the first element of the pair is the username, and
18815 the 2nd element of the pair is the password.
18816
18817 @lisp
18818 (tailon-configuration-file
18819 (http-auth "basic")
18820 (users '(("user1" . "password1")
18821 ("user2" . "password2"))))
18822 @end lisp
18823
18824 @end table
18825 @end deftp
18826
18827
18828 @subsubheading Darkstat Service
18829 @cindex darkstat
18830 Darkstat is a packet sniffer that captures network traffic, calculates
18831 statistics about usage, and serves reports over HTTP.
18832
18833 @defvar {Scheme Variable} darkstat-service-type
18834 This is the service type for the
18835 @uref{https://unix4lyfe.org/darkstat/, darkstat}
18836 service, its value must be a @code{darkstat-configuration} record as in
18837 this example:
18838
18839 @lisp
18840 (service darkstat-service-type
18841 (darkstat-configuration
18842 (interface "eno1")))
18843 @end lisp
18844 @end defvar
18845
18846 @deftp {Data Type} darkstat-configuration
18847 Data type representing the configuration of @command{darkstat}.
18848
18849 @table @asis
18850 @item @code{package} (default: @code{darkstat})
18851 The darkstat package to use.
18852
18853 @item @code{interface}
18854 Capture traffic on the specified network interface.
18855
18856 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"667"})
18857 Bind the web interface to the specified port.
18858
18859 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
18860 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
18861
18862 @item @code{base} (default: @code{"/"})
18863 Specify the path of the base URL. This can be useful if
18864 @command{darkstat} is accessed via a reverse proxy.
18865
18866 @end table
18867 @end deftp
18868
18869 @subsubheading Prometheus Node Exporter Service
18870
18871 @cindex prometheus-node-exporter
18872 The Prometheus ``node exporter'' makes hardware and operating system statistics
18873 provided by the Linux kernel available for the Prometheus monitoring system.
18874 This service should be deployed on all physical nodes and virtual machines,
18875 where monitoring these statistics is desirable.
18876
18877 @defvar {Scheme variable} prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
18878 This is the service type for the
18879 @uref{https://github.com/prometheus/node_exporter/, prometheus-node-exporter}
18880 service, its value must be a @code{prometheus-node-exporter-configuration}
18881 record as in this example:
18882
18883 @lisp
18884 (service prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
18885 (prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
18886 (web-listen-address ":9100")))
18887 @end lisp
18888 @end defvar
18889
18890 @deftp {Data Type} prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
18891 Data type representing the configuration of @command{node_exporter}.
18892
18893 @table @asis
18894 @item @code{package} (default: @code{go-github-com-prometheus-node-exporter})
18895 The prometheus-node-exporter package to use.
18896
18897 @item @code{web-listen-address} (default: @code{":9100"})
18898 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
18899
18900 @end table
18901 @end deftp
18902
18903 @subsubheading Zabbix server
18904 @cindex zabbix zabbix-server
18905 Zabbix provides monitoring metrics, among others network utilization, CPU load
18906 and disk space consumption:
18907
18908 @itemize
18909 @item High performance, high capacity (able to monitor hundreds of thousands of devices).
18910 @item Auto-discovery of servers and network devices and interfaces.
18911 @item Low-level discovery, allows to automatically start monitoring new items, file systems or network interfaces among others.
18912 @item Distributed monitoring with centralized web administration.
18913 @item Native high performance agents.
18914 @item SLA, and ITIL KPI metrics on reporting.
18915 @item High-level (business) view of monitored resources through user-defined visual console screens and dashboards.
18916 @item Remote command execution through Zabbix proxies.
18917 @end itemize
18918
18919 @c %start of fragment
18920
18921 Available @code{zabbix-server-configuration} fields are:
18922
18923 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-server
18924 The zabbix-server package.
18925
18926 @end deftypevr
18927
18928 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string user
18929 User who will run the Zabbix server.
18930
18931 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18932
18933 @end deftypevr
18934
18935 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} group group
18936 Group who will run the Zabbix server.
18937
18938 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18939
18940 @end deftypevr
18941
18942 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-host
18943 Database host name.
18944
18945 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
18946
18947 @end deftypevr
18948
18949 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-name
18950 Database name.
18951
18952 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18953
18954 @end deftypevr
18955
18956 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-user
18957 Database user.
18958
18959 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18960
18961 @end deftypevr
18962
18963 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-password
18964 Database password. Please, use @code{include-files} with
18965 @code{DBPassword=SECRET} inside a specified file instead.
18966
18967 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18968
18969 @end deftypevr
18970
18971 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} number db-port
18972 Database port.
18973
18974 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
18975
18976 @end deftypevr
18977
18978 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-type
18979 Specifies where log messages are written to:
18980
18981 @itemize @bullet
18982 @item
18983 @code{system} - syslog.
18984
18985 @item
18986 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
18987
18988 @item
18989 @code{console} - standard output.
18990
18991 @end itemize
18992
18993 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18994
18995 @end deftypevr
18996
18997 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-file
18998 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
18999
19000 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/server.log"}.
19001
19002 @end deftypevr
19003
19004 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
19005 Name of PID file.
19006
19007 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_server.pid"}.
19008
19009 @end deftypevr
19010
19011 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca-location
19012 The location of certificate authority (CA) files for SSL server
19013 certificate verification.
19014
19015 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"}.
19016
19017 @end deftypevr
19018
19019 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-location
19020 Location of SSL client certificates.
19021
19022 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
19023
19024 @end deftypevr
19025
19026 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
19027 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
19028
19029 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19030
19031 @end deftypevr
19032
19033 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
19034 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
19035 configuration file.
19036
19037 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19038
19039 @end deftypevr
19040
19041 @c %end of fragment
19042
19043 @subsubheading Zabbix agent
19044 @cindex zabbix zabbix-agent
19045
19046 Zabbix agent gathers information for Zabbix server.
19047
19048 @c %start of fragment
19049
19050 Available @code{zabbix-agent-configuration} fields are:
19051
19052 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-agent
19053 The zabbix-agent package.
19054
19055 @end deftypevr
19056
19057 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string user
19058 User who will run the Zabbix agent.
19059
19060 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19061
19062 @end deftypevr
19063
19064 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} group group
19065 Group who will run the Zabbix agent.
19066
19067 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19068
19069 @end deftypevr
19070
19071 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string hostname
19072 Unique, case sensitive hostname which is required for active checks and
19073 must match hostname as configured on the server.
19074
19075 Defaults to @samp{"Zabbix server"}.
19076
19077 @end deftypevr
19078
19079 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-type
19080 Specifies where log messages are written to:
19081
19082 @itemize @bullet
19083 @item
19084 @code{system} - syslog.
19085
19086 @item
19087 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
19088
19089 @item
19090 @code{console} - standard output.
19091
19092 @end itemize
19093
19094 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19095
19096 @end deftypevr
19097
19098 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-file
19099 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
19100
19101 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/agent.log"}.
19102
19103 @end deftypevr
19104
19105 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
19106 Name of PID file.
19107
19108 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_agent.pid"}.
19109
19110 @end deftypevr
19111
19112 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server
19113 List of IP addresses, optionally in CIDR notation, or hostnames of
19114 Zabbix servers and Zabbix proxies. Incoming connections will be
19115 accepted only from the hosts listed here.
19116
19117 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
19118
19119 @end deftypevr
19120
19121 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server-active
19122 List of IP:port (or hostname:port) pairs of Zabbix servers and Zabbix
19123 proxies for active checks. If port is not specified, default port is
19124 used. If this parameter is not specified, active checks are disabled.
19125
19126 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
19127
19128 @end deftypevr
19129
19130 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
19131 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
19132
19133 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19134
19135 @end deftypevr
19136
19137 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
19138 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
19139 configuration file.
19140
19141 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19142
19143 @end deftypevr
19144
19145 @c %end of fragment
19146
19147 @subsubheading Zabbix front-end
19148 @cindex zabbix zabbix-front-end
19149
19150 This service provides a WEB interface to Zabbix server.
19151
19152 @c %start of fragment
19153
19154 Available @code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} fields are:
19155
19156 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
19157 NGINX configuration.
19158
19159 @end deftypevr
19160
19161 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-host
19162 Database host name.
19163
19164 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
19165
19166 @end deftypevr
19167
19168 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number db-port
19169 Database port.
19170
19171 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
19172
19173 @end deftypevr
19174
19175 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-name
19176 Database name.
19177
19178 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19179
19180 @end deftypevr
19181
19182 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-user
19183 Database user.
19184
19185 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
19186
19187 @end deftypevr
19188
19189 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-password
19190 Database password. Please, use @code{db-secret-file} instead.
19191
19192 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19193
19194 @end deftypevr
19195
19196 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-secret-file
19197 Secret file which will be appended to @file{zabbix.conf.php} file. This
19198 file contains credentials for use by Zabbix front-end. You are expected
19199 to create it manually.
19200
19201 Defaults to @samp{""}.
19202
19203 @end deftypevr
19204
19205 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string zabbix-host
19206 Zabbix server hostname.
19207
19208 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
19209
19210 @end deftypevr
19211
19212 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number zabbix-port
19213 Zabbix server port.
19214
19215 Defaults to @samp{10051}.
19216
19217 @end deftypevr
19218
19219
19220 @c %end of fragment
19221
19222 @node Kerberos Services
19223 @subsection Kerberos Services
19224 @cindex Kerberos
19225
19226 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
19227 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
19228
19229 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
19230
19231 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
19232 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
19233 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
19234 operating system declaration.
19235 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
19236
19237 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
19238 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
19239 Other implementations have not been tested.
19240
19241 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
19242 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
19243 @end defvr
19244
19245 @noindent
19246 Here is an example of its use:
19247 @lisp
19248 (service krb5-service-type
19249 (krb5-configuration
19250 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
19251 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
19252 (realms (list
19253 (krb5-realm
19254 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
19255 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
19256 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
19257 (krb5-realm
19258 (name "ARGRX.EDU")
19259 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
19260 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
19261 @end lisp
19262
19263 @noindent
19264 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
19265 @itemize
19266 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
19267 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
19268 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
19269 specified by clients;
19270 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
19271 @end itemize
19272
19273 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
19274 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
19275 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
19276 @uref{https://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
19277 documentation.
19278
19279
19280 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
19281 @cindex realm, kerberos
19282 @table @asis
19283 @item @code{name}
19284 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
19285 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
19286 converted to upper case.
19287
19288 @item @code{admin-server}
19289 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
19290 running.
19291
19292 @item @code{kdc}
19293 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
19294 for the realm.
19295 @end table
19296 @end deftp
19297
19298 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
19299
19300 @table @asis
19301 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
19302 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
19303 known to be weak will be accepted.
19304
19305 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
19306 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
19307 realm for the client.
19308 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
19309 If this value is @code{#f}
19310 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
19311 such as @command{kinit}.
19312
19313 @item @code{realms}
19314 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
19315 access.
19316 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
19317 field.
19318 @end table
19319 @end deftp
19320
19321
19322 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
19323 @cindex pam-krb5
19324
19325 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
19326 management via Kerberos.
19327 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
19328 users using Kerberos.
19329
19330 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
19331 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
19332 @end defvr
19333
19334 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
19335 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
19336 This type has the following parameters:
19337 @table @asis
19338 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
19339 The pam-krb5 package to use.
19340
19341 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
19342 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
19343 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
19344 @end table
19345 @end deftp
19346
19347
19348 @node LDAP Services
19349 @subsection LDAP Services
19350 @cindex LDAP
19351 @cindex nslcd, LDAP service
19352
19353 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides the
19354 @code{nslcd-service-type}, which can be used to authenticate against an LDAP
19355 server. In addition to configuring the service itself, you may want to add
19356 @code{ldap} as a name service to the Name Service Switch. @xref{Name Service
19357 Switch} for detailed information.
19358
19359 Here is a simple operating system declaration with a default configuration of
19360 the @code{nslcd-service-type} and a Name Service Switch configuration that
19361 consults the @code{ldap} name service last:
19362
19363 @lisp
19364 (use-service-modules authentication)
19365 (use-modules (gnu system nss))
19366 ...
19367 (operating-system
19368 ...
19369 (services
19370 (cons*
19371 (service nslcd-service-type)
19372 (service dhcp-client-service-type)
19373 %base-services))
19374 (name-service-switch
19375 (let ((services (list (name-service (name "db"))
19376 (name-service (name "files"))
19377 (name-service (name "ldap")))))
19378 (name-service-switch
19379 (inherit %mdns-host-lookup-nss)
19380 (password services)
19381 (shadow services)
19382 (group services)
19383 (netgroup services)
19384 (gshadow services)))))
19385 @end lisp
19386
19387 @c %start of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
19388
19389 Available @code{nslcd-configuration} fields are:
19390
19391 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} package nss-pam-ldapd
19392 The @code{nss-pam-ldapd} package to use.
19393
19394 @end deftypevr
19395
19396 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number threads
19397 The number of threads to start that can handle requests and perform LDAP
19398 queries. Each thread opens a separate connection to the LDAP server.
19399 The default is to start 5 threads.
19400
19401 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19402
19403 @end deftypevr
19404
19405 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string uid
19406 This specifies the user id with which the daemon should be run.
19407
19408 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
19409
19410 @end deftypevr
19411
19412 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string gid
19413 This specifies the group id with which the daemon should be run.
19414
19415 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
19416
19417 @end deftypevr
19418
19419 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} log-option log
19420 This option controls the way logging is done via a list containing
19421 SCHEME and LEVEL. The SCHEME argument may either be the symbols "none"
19422 or "syslog", or an absolute file name. The LEVEL argument is optional
19423 and specifies the log level. The log level may be one of the following
19424 symbols: "crit", "error", "warning", "notice", "info" or "debug". All
19425 messages with the specified log level or higher are logged.
19426
19427 Defaults to @samp{("/var/log/nslcd" info)}.
19428
19429 @end deftypevr
19430
19431 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list uri
19432 The list of LDAP server URIs. Normally, only the first server will be
19433 used with the following servers as fall-back.
19434
19435 Defaults to @samp{("ldap://localhost:389/")}.
19436
19437 @end deftypevr
19438
19439 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ldap-version
19440 The version of the LDAP protocol to use. The default is to use the
19441 maximum version supported by the LDAP library.
19442
19443 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19444
19445 @end deftypevr
19446
19447 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string binddn
19448 Specifies the distinguished name with which to bind to the directory
19449 server for lookups. The default is to bind anonymously.
19450
19451 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19452
19453 @end deftypevr
19454
19455 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string bindpw
19456 Specifies the credentials with which to bind. This option is only
19457 applicable when used with binddn.
19458
19459 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19460
19461 @end deftypevr
19462
19463 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmoddn
19464 Specifies the distinguished name to use when the root user tries to
19465 modify a user's password using the PAM module.
19466
19467 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19468
19469 @end deftypevr
19470
19471 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmodpw
19472 Specifies the credentials with which to bind if the root user tries to
19473 change a user's password. This option is only applicable when used with
19474 rootpwmoddn
19475
19476 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19477
19478 @end deftypevr
19479
19480 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-mech
19481 Specifies the SASL mechanism to be used when performing SASL
19482 authentication.
19483
19484 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19485
19486 @end deftypevr
19487
19488 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-realm
19489 Specifies the SASL realm to be used when performing SASL authentication.
19490
19491 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19492
19493 @end deftypevr
19494
19495 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authcid
19496 Specifies the authentication identity to be used when performing SASL
19497 authentication.
19498
19499 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19500
19501 @end deftypevr
19502
19503 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authzid
19504 Specifies the authorization identity to be used when performing SASL
19505 authentication.
19506
19507 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19508
19509 @end deftypevr
19510
19511 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean sasl-canonicalize?
19512 Determines whether the LDAP server host name should be canonicalised. If
19513 this is enabled the LDAP library will do a reverse host name lookup. By
19514 default, it is left up to the LDAP library whether this check is
19515 performed or not.
19516
19517 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19518
19519 @end deftypevr
19520
19521 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string krb5-ccname
19522 Set the name for the GSS-API Kerberos credentials cache.
19523
19524 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19525
19526 @end deftypevr
19527
19528 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string base
19529 The directory search base.
19530
19531 Defaults to @samp{"dc=example,dc=com"}.
19532
19533 @end deftypevr
19534
19535 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} scope-option scope
19536 Specifies the search scope (subtree, onelevel, base or children). The
19537 default scope is subtree; base scope is almost never useful for name
19538 service lookups; children scope is not supported on all servers.
19539
19540 Defaults to @samp{(subtree)}.
19541
19542 @end deftypevr
19543
19544 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-deref-option deref
19545 Specifies the policy for dereferencing aliases. The default policy is
19546 to never dereference aliases.
19547
19548 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19549
19550 @end deftypevr
19551
19552 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean referrals
19553 Specifies whether automatic referral chasing should be enabled. The
19554 default behaviour is to chase referrals.
19555
19556 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19557
19558 @end deftypevr
19559
19560 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-map-entries maps
19561 This option allows for custom attributes to be looked up instead of the
19562 default RFC 2307 attributes. It is a list of maps, each consisting of
19563 the name of a map, the RFC 2307 attribute to match and the query
19564 expression for the attribute as it is available in the directory.
19565
19566 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19567
19568 @end deftypevr
19569
19570 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-filter-entries filters
19571 A list of filters consisting of the name of a map to which the filter
19572 applies and an LDAP search filter expression.
19573
19574 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19575
19576 @end deftypevr
19577
19578 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number bind-timelimit
19579 Specifies the time limit in seconds to use when connecting to the
19580 directory server. The default value is 10 seconds.
19581
19582 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19583
19584 @end deftypevr
19585
19586 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number timelimit
19587 Specifies the time limit (in seconds) to wait for a response from the
19588 LDAP server. A value of zero, which is the default, is to wait
19589 indefinitely for searches to be completed.
19590
19591 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19592
19593 @end deftypevr
19594
19595 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number idle-timelimit
19596 Specifies the period if inactivity (in seconds) after which the con‐
19597 nection to the LDAP server will be closed. The default is not to time
19598 out connections.
19599
19600 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19601
19602 @end deftypevr
19603
19604 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-sleeptime
19605 Specifies the number of seconds to sleep when connecting to all LDAP
19606 servers fails. By default one second is waited between the first
19607 failure and the first retry.
19608
19609 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19610
19611 @end deftypevr
19612
19613 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-retrytime
19614 Specifies the time after which the LDAP server is considered to be
19615 permanently unavailable. Once this time is reached retries will be done
19616 only once per this time period. The default value is 10 seconds.
19617
19618 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19619
19620 @end deftypevr
19621
19622 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-option ssl
19623 Specifies whether to use SSL/TLS or not (the default is not to). If
19624 'start-tls is specified then StartTLS is used rather than raw LDAP over
19625 SSL.
19626
19627 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19628
19629 @end deftypevr
19630
19631 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-tls-reqcert-option tls-reqcert
19632 Specifies what checks to perform on a server-supplied certificate. The
19633 meaning of the values is described in the ldap.conf(5) manual page.
19634
19635 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19636
19637 @end deftypevr
19638
19639 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertdir
19640 Specifies the directory containing X.509 certificates for peer authen‐
19641 tication. This parameter is ignored when using GnuTLS.
19642
19643 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19644
19645 @end deftypevr
19646
19647 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertfile
19648 Specifies the path to the X.509 certificate for peer authentication.
19649
19650 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19651
19652 @end deftypevr
19653
19654 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-randfile
19655 Specifies the path to an entropy source. This parameter is ignored when
19656 using GnuTLS.
19657
19658 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19659
19660 @end deftypevr
19661
19662 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-ciphers
19663 Specifies the ciphers to use for TLS as a string.
19664
19665 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19666
19667 @end deftypevr
19668
19669 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cert
19670 Specifies the path to the file containing the local certificate for
19671 client TLS authentication.
19672
19673 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19674
19675 @end deftypevr
19676
19677 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-key
19678 Specifies the path to the file containing the private key for client TLS
19679 authentication.
19680
19681 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19682
19683 @end deftypevr
19684
19685 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number pagesize
19686 Set this to a number greater than 0 to request paged results from the
19687 LDAP server in accordance with RFC2696. The default (0) is to not
19688 request paged results.
19689
19690 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19691
19692 @end deftypevr
19693
19694 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ignore-users-option nss-initgroups-ignoreusers
19695 This option prevents group membership lookups through LDAP for the
19696 specified users. Alternatively, the value 'all-local may be used. With
19697 that value nslcd builds a full list of non-LDAP users on startup.
19698
19699 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19700
19701 @end deftypevr
19702
19703 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-min-uid
19704 This option ensures that LDAP users with a numeric user id lower than
19705 the specified value are ignored.
19706
19707 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19708
19709 @end deftypevr
19710
19711 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-uid-offset
19712 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric user
19713 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local users.
19714
19715 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19716
19717 @end deftypevr
19718
19719 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-gid-offset
19720 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric group
19721 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local groups.
19722
19723 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19724
19725 @end deftypevr
19726
19727 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-nested-groups
19728 If this option is set, the member attribute of a group may point to
19729 another group. Members of nested groups are also returned in the higher
19730 level group and parent groups are returned when finding groups for a
19731 specific user. The default is not to perform extra searches for nested
19732 groups.
19733
19734 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19735
19736 @end deftypevr
19737
19738 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-getgrent-skipmembers
19739 If this option is set, the group member list is not retrieved when
19740 looking up groups. Lookups for finding which groups a user belongs to
19741 will remain functional so the user will likely still get the correct
19742 groups assigned on login.
19743
19744 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19745
19746 @end deftypevr
19747
19748 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-disable-enumeration
19749 If this option is set, functions which cause all user/group entries to
19750 be loaded from the directory will not succeed in doing so. This can
19751 dramatically reduce LDAP server load in situations where there are a
19752 great number of users and/or groups. This option is not recommended for
19753 most configurations.
19754
19755 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19756
19757 @end deftypevr
19758
19759 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string validnames
19760 This option can be used to specify how user and group names are verified
19761 within the system. This pattern is used to check all user and group
19762 names that are requested and returned from LDAP.
19763
19764 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19765
19766 @end deftypevr
19767
19768 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean ignorecase
19769 This specifies whether or not to perform searches using case-insensitive
19770 matching. Enabling this could open up the system to authorization
19771 bypass vulnerabilities and introduce nscd cache poisoning
19772 vulnerabilities which allow denial of service.
19773
19774 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19775
19776 @end deftypevr
19777
19778 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean pam-authc-ppolicy
19779 This option specifies whether password policy controls are requested and
19780 handled from the LDAP server when performing user authentication.
19781
19782 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19783
19784 @end deftypevr
19785
19786 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authc-search
19787 By default nslcd performs an LDAP search with the user's credentials
19788 after BIND (authentication) to ensure that the BIND operation was
19789 successful. The default search is a simple check to see if the user's
19790 DN exists. A search filter can be specified that will be used instead.
19791 It should return at least one entry.
19792
19793 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19794
19795 @end deftypevr
19796
19797 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authz-search
19798 This option allows flexible fine tuning of the authorisation check that
19799 should be performed. The search filter specified is executed and if any
19800 entries match, access is granted, otherwise access is denied.
19801
19802 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19803
19804 @end deftypevr
19805
19806 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-password-prohibit-message
19807 If this option is set password modification using pam_ldap will be
19808 denied and the specified message will be presented to the user instead.
19809 The message can be used to direct the user to an alternative means of
19810 changing their password.
19811
19812 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19813
19814 @end deftypevr
19815
19816 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list pam-services
19817 List of pam service names for which LDAP authentication should suffice.
19818
19819 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19820
19821 @end deftypevr
19822
19823 @c %end of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
19824
19825
19826 @node Web Services
19827 @subsection Web Services
19828
19829 @cindex web
19830 @cindex www
19831 @cindex HTTP
19832 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the Apache HTTP Server,
19833 the nginx web server, and also a fastcgi wrapper daemon.
19834
19835 @subsubheading Apache HTTP Server
19836
19837 @deffn {Scheme Variable} httpd-service-type
19838 Service type for the @uref{https://httpd.apache.org/,Apache HTTP} server
19839 (@dfn{httpd}). The value for this service type is a
19840 @code{httpd-configuration} record.
19841
19842 A simple example configuration is given below.
19843
19844 @lisp
19845 (service httpd-service-type
19846 (httpd-configuration
19847 (config
19848 (httpd-config-file
19849 (server-name "www.example.com")
19850 (document-root "/srv/http/www.example.com")))))
19851 @end lisp
19852
19853 Other services can also extend the @code{httpd-service-type} to add to
19854 the configuration.
19855
19856 @lisp
19857 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
19858 (list
19859 (httpd-virtualhost
19860 "*:80"
19861 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
19862 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
19863 "\n")))))
19864 @end lisp
19865 @end deffn
19866
19867 The details for the @code{httpd-configuration}, @code{httpd-module},
19868 @code{httpd-config-file} and @code{httpd-virtualhost} record types are
19869 given below.
19870
19871 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-configuration
19872 This data type represents the configuration for the httpd service.
19873
19874 @table @asis
19875 @item @code{package} (default: @code{httpd})
19876 The httpd package to use.
19877
19878 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
19879 The pid file used by the shepherd-service.
19880
19881 @item @code{config} (default: @code{(httpd-config-file)})
19882 The configuration file to use with the httpd service. The default value
19883 is a @code{httpd-config-file} record, but this can also be a different
19884 G-expression that generates a file, for example a @code{plain-file}. A
19885 file outside of the store can also be specified through a string.
19886
19887 @end table
19888 @end deffn
19889
19890 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-module
19891 This data type represents a module for the httpd service.
19892
19893 @table @asis
19894 @item @code{name}
19895 The name of the module.
19896
19897 @item @code{file}
19898 The file for the module. This can be relative to the httpd package being
19899 used, the absolute location of a file, or a G-expression for a file
19900 within the store, for example @code{(file-append mod-wsgi
19901 "/modules/mod_wsgi.so")}.
19902
19903 @end table
19904 @end deffn
19905
19906 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-httpd-modules
19907 A default list of @code{httpd-module} objects.
19908 @end defvr
19909
19910 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-config-file
19911 This data type represents a configuration file for the httpd service.
19912
19913 @table @asis
19914 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-httpd-modules})
19915 The modules to load. Additional modules can be added here, or loaded by
19916 additional configuration.
19917
19918 For example, in order to handle requests for PHP files, you can use Apache’s
19919 @code{mod_proxy_fcgi} module along with @code{php-fpm-service-type}:
19920
19921 @lisp
19922 (service httpd-service-type
19923 (httpd-configuration
19924 (config
19925 (httpd-config-file
19926 (modules (cons*
19927 (httpd-module
19928 (name "proxy_module")
19929 (file "modules/mod_proxy.so"))
19930 (httpd-module
19931 (name "proxy_fcgi_module")
19932 (file "modules/mod_proxy_fcgi.so"))
19933 %default-httpd-modules))
19934 (extra-config (list "\
19935 <FilesMatch \\.php$>
19936 SetHandler \"proxy:unix:/var/run/php-fpm.sock|fcgi://localhost/\"
19937 </FilesMatch>"))))))
19938 (service php-fpm-service-type
19939 (php-fpm-configuration
19940 (socket "/var/run/php-fpm.sock")
19941 (socket-group "httpd")))
19942 @end lisp
19943
19944 @item @code{server-root} (default: @code{httpd})
19945 The @code{ServerRoot} in the configuration file, defaults to the httpd
19946 package. Directives including @code{Include} and @code{LoadModule} are
19947 taken as relative to the server root.
19948
19949 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{#f})
19950 The @code{ServerName} in the configuration file, used to specify the
19951 request scheme, hostname and port that the server uses to identify
19952 itself.
19953
19954 This doesn't need to be set in the server config, and can be specifyed
19955 in virtual hosts. The default is @code{#f} to not specify a
19956 @code{ServerName}.
19957
19958 @item @code{document-root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
19959 The @code{DocumentRoot} from which files will be served.
19960
19961 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80")})
19962 The list of values for the @code{Listen} directives in the config
19963 file. The value should be a list of strings, when each string can
19964 specify the port number to listen on, and optionally the IP address and
19965 protocol to use.
19966
19967 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
19968 The @code{PidFile} to use. This should match the @code{pid-file} set in
19969 the @code{httpd-configuration} so that the Shepherd service is
19970 configured correctly.
19971
19972 @item @code{error-log} (default: @code{"/var/log/httpd/error_log"})
19973 The @code{ErrorLog} to which the server will log errors.
19974
19975 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
19976 The @code{User} which the server will answer requests as.
19977
19978 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"httpd"})
19979 The @code{Group} which the server will answer requests as.
19980
19981 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{(list "TypesConfig etc/httpd/mime.types")})
19982 A flat list of strings and G-expressions which will be added to the end
19983 of the configuration file.
19984
19985 Any values which the service is extended with will be appended to this
19986 list.
19987
19988 @end table
19989 @end deffn
19990
19991 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-virtualhost
19992 This data type represents a virtualhost configuration block for the httpd service.
19993
19994 These should be added to the extra-config for the httpd-service.
19995
19996 @lisp
19997 (simple-service 'www.example.com-server httpd-service-type
19998 (list
19999 (httpd-virtualhost
20000 "*:80"
20001 (list (string-join '("ServerName www.example.com"
20002 "DocumentRoot /srv/http/www.example.com")
20003 "\n")))))
20004 @end lisp
20005
20006 @table @asis
20007 @item @code{addresses-and-ports}
20008 The addresses and ports for the @code{VirtualHost} directive.
20009
20010 @item @code{contents}
20011 The contents of the @code{VirtualHost} directive, this should be a list
20012 of strings and G-expressions.
20013
20014 @end table
20015 @end deffn
20016
20017 @subsubheading NGINX
20018
20019 @deffn {Scheme Variable} nginx-service-type
20020 Service type for the @uref{https://nginx.org/,NGinx} web server. The
20021 value for this service type is a @code{<nginx-configuration>} record.
20022
20023 A simple example configuration is given below.
20024
20025 @lisp
20026 (service nginx-service-type
20027 (nginx-configuration
20028 (server-blocks
20029 (list (nginx-server-configuration
20030 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
20031 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
20032 @end lisp
20033
20034 In addition to adding server blocks to the service configuration
20035 directly, this service can be extended by other services to add server
20036 blocks, as in this example:
20037
20038 @lisp
20039 (simple-service 'my-extra-server nginx-service-type
20040 (list (nginx-server-configuration
20041 (root "/srv/http/extra-website")
20042 (try-files (list "$uri" "$uri/index.html")))))
20043 @end lisp
20044 @end deffn
20045
20046 At startup, @command{nginx} has not yet read its configuration file, so
20047 it uses a default file to log error messages. If it fails to load its
20048 configuration file, that is where error messages are logged. After the
20049 configuration file is loaded, the default error log file changes as per
20050 configuration. In our case, startup error messages can be found in
20051 @file{/var/run/nginx/logs/error.log}, and after configuration in
20052 @file{/var/log/nginx/error.log}. The second location can be changed
20053 with the @var{log-directory} configuration option.
20054
20055 @deffn {Data Type} nginx-configuration
20056 This data type represents the configuration for NGinx. Some
20057 configuration can be done through this and the other provided record
20058 types, or alternatively, a config file can be provided.
20059
20060 @table @asis
20061 @item @code{nginx} (default: @code{nginx})
20062 The nginx package to use.
20063
20064 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/nginx"})
20065 The directory to which NGinx will write log files.
20066
20067 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/nginx"})
20068 The directory in which NGinx will create a pid file, and write temporary
20069 files.
20070
20071 @item @code{server-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
20072 A list of @dfn{server blocks} to create in the generated configuration
20073 file, the elements should be of type
20074 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>}.
20075
20076 The following example would setup NGinx to serve @code{www.example.com}
20077 from the @code{/srv/http/www.example.com} directory, without using
20078 HTTPS.
20079 @lisp
20080 (service nginx-service-type
20081 (nginx-configuration
20082 (server-blocks
20083 (list (nginx-server-configuration
20084 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
20085 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
20086 @end lisp
20087
20088 @item @code{upstream-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
20089 A list of @dfn{upstream blocks} to create in the generated configuration
20090 file, the elements should be of type
20091 @code{<nginx-upstream-configuration>}.
20092
20093 Configuring upstreams through the @code{upstream-blocks} can be useful
20094 when combined with @code{locations} in the
20095 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>} records. The following example
20096 creates a server configuration with one location configuration, that
20097 will proxy requests to a upstream configuration, which will handle
20098 requests with two servers.
20099
20100 @lisp
20101 (service
20102 nginx-service-type
20103 (nginx-configuration
20104 (server-blocks
20105 (list (nginx-server-configuration
20106 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
20107 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com")
20108 (locations
20109 (list
20110 (nginx-location-configuration
20111 (uri "/path1")
20112 (body '("proxy_pass http://server-proxy;"))))))))
20113 (upstream-blocks
20114 (list (nginx-upstream-configuration
20115 (name "server-proxy")
20116 (servers (list "server1.example.com"
20117 "server2.example.com")))))))
20118 @end lisp
20119
20120 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
20121 If a configuration @var{file} is provided, this will be used, rather than
20122 generating a configuration file from the provided @code{log-directory},
20123 @code{run-directory}, @code{server-blocks} and @code{upstream-blocks}. For
20124 proper operation, these arguments should match what is in @var{file} to ensure
20125 that the directories are created when the service is activated.
20126
20127 This can be useful if you have an existing configuration file, or it's
20128 not possible to do what is required through the other parts of the
20129 nginx-configuration record.
20130
20131 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-size} (default: @code{#f})
20132 Bucket size for the server names hash tables, defaults to @code{#f} to
20133 use the size of the processors cache line.
20134
20135 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-max-size} (default: @code{#f})
20136 Maximum bucket size for the server names hash tables.
20137
20138 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
20139 List of nginx dynamic modules to load. This should be a list of file
20140 names of loadable modules, as in this example:
20141
20142 @lisp
20143 (modules
20144 (list
20145 (file-append nginx-accept-language-module "\
20146 /etc/nginx/modules/ngx_http_accept_language_module.so")))
20147 @end lisp
20148
20149 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
20150 Extra content for the @code{http} block. Should be string or a string
20151 valued G-expression.
20152
20153 @end table
20154 @end deffn
20155
20156 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-server-configuration
20157 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx server block.
20158 This type has the following parameters:
20159
20160 @table @asis
20161 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80" "443 ssl")})
20162 Each @code{listen} directive sets the address and port for IP, or the
20163 path for a UNIX-domain socket on which the server will accept requests.
20164 Both address and port, or only address or only port can be specified.
20165 An address may also be a hostname, for example:
20166
20167 @lisp
20168 '("127.0.0.1:8000" "127.0.0.1" "8000" "*:8000" "localhost:8000")
20169 @end lisp
20170
20171 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
20172 A list of server names this server represents. @code{'default} represents the
20173 default server for connections matching no other server.
20174
20175 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
20176 Root of the website nginx will serve.
20177
20178 @item @code{locations} (default: @code{'()})
20179 A list of @dfn{nginx-location-configuration} or
20180 @dfn{nginx-named-location-configuration} records to use within this
20181 server block.
20182
20183 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
20184 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
20185 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
20186
20187 @item @code{try-files} (default: @code{'()})
20188 A list of files whose existence is checked in the specified order.
20189 @code{nginx} will use the first file it finds to process the request.
20190
20191 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{#f})
20192 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
20193 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
20194
20195 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{#f})
20196 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
20197 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
20198
20199 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
20200 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
20201
20202 @item @code{raw-content} (default: @code{'()})
20203 A list of raw lines added to the server block.
20204
20205 @end table
20206 @end deftp
20207
20208 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-upstream-configuration
20209 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{upstream}
20210 block. This type has the following parameters:
20211
20212 @table @asis
20213 @item @code{name}
20214 Name for this group of servers.
20215
20216 @item @code{servers}
20217 Specify the addresses of the servers in the group. The address can be
20218 specified as a IP address (e.g.@: @samp{127.0.0.1}), domain name
20219 (e.g.@: @samp{backend1.example.com}) or a path to a UNIX socket using the
20220 prefix @samp{unix:}. For addresses using an IP address or domain name,
20221 the default port is 80, and a different port can be specified
20222 explicitly.
20223
20224 @end table
20225 @end deftp
20226
20227 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-location-configuration
20228 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{location}
20229 block. This type has the following parameters:
20230
20231 @table @asis
20232 @item @code{uri}
20233 URI which this location block matches.
20234
20235 @anchor{nginx-location-configuration body}
20236 @item @code{body}
20237 Body of the location block, specified as a list of strings. This can contain
20238 many
20239 configuration directives. For example, to pass requests to a upstream
20240 server group defined using an @code{nginx-upstream-configuration} block,
20241 the following directive would be specified in the body @samp{(list "proxy_pass
20242 http://upstream-name;")}.
20243
20244 @end table
20245 @end deftp
20246
20247 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-named-location-configuration
20248 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx named location
20249 block. Named location blocks are used for request redirection, and not
20250 used for regular request processing. This type has the following
20251 parameters:
20252
20253 @table @asis
20254 @item @code{name}
20255 Name to identify this location block.
20256
20257 @item @code{body}
20258 @xref{nginx-location-configuration body}, as the body for named location
20259 blocks can be used in a similar way to the
20260 @code{nginx-location-configuration body}. One restriction is that the
20261 body of a named location block cannot contain location blocks.
20262
20263 @end table
20264 @end deftp
20265
20266 @subsubheading Varnish Cache
20267 @cindex Varnish
20268 Varnish is a fast cache server that sits in between web applications
20269 and end users. It proxies requests from clients and caches the
20270 accessed URLs such that multiple requests for the same resource only
20271 creates one request to the back-end.
20272
20273 @defvr {Scheme Variable} varnish-service-type
20274 Service type for the Varnish daemon.
20275 @end defvr
20276
20277 @deftp {Data Type} varnish-configuration
20278 Data type representing the @code{varnish} service configuration.
20279 This type has the following parameters:
20280
20281 @table @asis
20282 @item @code{package} (default: @code{varnish})
20283 The Varnish package to use.
20284
20285 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"default"})
20286 A name for this Varnish instance. Varnish will create a directory in
20287 @file{/var/varnish/} with this name and keep temporary files there. If
20288 the name starts with a forward slash, it is interpreted as an absolute
20289 directory name.
20290
20291 Pass the @code{-n} argument to other Varnish programs to connect to the
20292 named instance, e.g.@: @command{varnishncsa -n default}.
20293
20294 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
20295 The backend to use. This option has no effect if @code{vcl} is set.
20296
20297 @item @code{vcl} (default: #f)
20298 The @dfn{VCL} (Varnish Configuration Language) program to run. If this
20299 is @code{#f}, Varnish will proxy @code{backend} using the default
20300 configuration. Otherwise this must be a file-like object with valid
20301 VCL syntax.
20302
20303 @c Varnish does not support HTTPS, so keep this URL to avoid confusion.
20304 For example, to mirror @url{http://www.gnu.org,www.gnu.org} with VCL you
20305 can do something along these lines:
20306
20307 @lisp
20308 (define %gnu-mirror
20309 (plain-file "gnu.vcl"
20310 "vcl 4.1;
20311 backend gnu @{ .host = \"www.gnu.org\"; @}"))
20312
20313 (operating-system
20314 ;; @dots{}
20315 (services (cons (service varnish-service-type
20316 (varnish-configuration
20317 (listen '(":80"))
20318 (vcl %gnu-mirror)))
20319 %base-services)))
20320 @end lisp
20321
20322 The configuration of an already running Varnish instance can be inspected
20323 and changed using the @command{varnishadm} program.
20324
20325 Consult the @url{https://varnish-cache.org/docs/,Varnish User Guide} and
20326 @url{https://book.varnish-software.com/4.0/,Varnish Book} for
20327 comprehensive documentation on Varnish and its configuration language.
20328
20329 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("localhost:80")})
20330 List of addresses Varnish will listen on.
20331
20332 @item @code{storage} (default: @code{'("malloc,128m")})
20333 List of storage backends that will be available in VCL.
20334
20335 @item @code{parameters} (default: @code{'()})
20336 List of run-time parameters in the form @code{'(("parameter" . "value"))}.
20337
20338 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
20339 Additional arguments to pass to the @command{varnishd} process.
20340
20341 @end table
20342 @end deftp
20343
20344 @subsubheading Patchwork
20345 @cindex Patchwork
20346 Patchwork is a patch tracking system. It can collect patches sent to a
20347 mailing list, and display them in a web interface.
20348
20349 @defvr {Scheme Variable} patchwork-service-type
20350 Service type for Patchwork.
20351 @end defvr
20352
20353 The following example is an example of a minimal service for Patchwork, for
20354 the @code{patchwork.example.com} domain.
20355
20356 @lisp
20357 (service patchwork-service-type
20358 (patchwork-configuration
20359 (domain "patchwork.example.com")
20360 (settings-module
20361 (patchwork-settings-module
20362 (allowed-hosts (list domain))
20363 (default-from-email "patchwork@@patchwork.example.com")))
20364 (getmail-retriever-config
20365 (getmail-retriever-configuration
20366 (type "SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever")
20367 (server "imap.example.com")
20368 (port 993)
20369 (username "patchwork")
20370 (password-command
20371 (list (file-append coreutils "/bin/cat")
20372 "/etc/getmail-patchwork-imap-password"))
20373 (extra-parameters
20374 '((mailboxes . ("Patches"))))))))
20375
20376 @end lisp
20377
20378 There are three records for configuring the Patchwork service. The
20379 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} relates to the configuration for Patchwork
20380 within the HTTPD service.
20381
20382 The @code{settings-module} field within the @code{<patchwork-configuration>}
20383 record can be populated with the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record,
20384 which describes a settings module that is generated within the Guix store.
20385
20386 For the @code{database-configuration} field within the
20387 @code{<patchwork-settings-module>}, the
20388 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} must be used.
20389
20390 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-configuration
20391 Data type representing the Patchwork service configuration. This type has the
20392 following parameters:
20393
20394 @table @asis
20395 @item @code{patchwork} (default: @code{patchwork})
20396 The Patchwork package to use.
20397
20398 @item @code{domain}
20399 The domain to use for Patchwork, this is used in the HTTPD service virtual
20400 host.
20401
20402 @item @code{settings-module}
20403 The settings module to use for Patchwork. As a Django application, Patchwork
20404 is configured with a Python module containing the settings. This can either be
20405 an instance of the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record, any other record
20406 that represents the settings in the store, or a directory outside of the
20407 store.
20408
20409 @item @code{static-path} (default: @code{"/static/"})
20410 The path under which the HTTPD service should serve the static files.
20411
20412 @item @code{getmail-retriever-config}
20413 The getmail-retriever-configuration record value to use with
20414 Patchwork. Getmail will be configured with this value, the messages will be
20415 delivered to Patchwork.
20416
20417 @end table
20418 @end deftp
20419
20420 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-settings-module
20421 Data type representing a settings module for Patchwork. Some of these
20422 settings relate directly to Patchwork, but others relate to Django, the web
20423 framework used by Patchwork, or the Django Rest Framework library. This type
20424 has the following parameters:
20425
20426 @table @asis
20427 @item @code{database-configuration} (default: @code{(patchwork-database-configuration)})
20428 The database connection settings used for Patchwork. See the
20429 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} record type for more information.
20430
20431 @item @code{secret-key-file} (default: @code{"/etc/patchwork/django-secret-key"})
20432 Patchwork, as a Django web application uses a secret key for cryptographically
20433 signing values. This file should contain a unique unpredictable value.
20434
20435 If this file does not exist, it will be created and populated with a random
20436 value by the patchwork-setup shepherd service.
20437
20438 This setting relates to Django.
20439
20440 @item @code{allowed-hosts}
20441 A list of valid hosts for this Patchwork service. This should at least include
20442 the domain specified in the @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record.
20443
20444 This is a Django setting.
20445
20446 @item @code{default-from-email}
20447 The email address from which Patchwork should send email by default.
20448
20449 This is a Patchwork setting.
20450
20451 @item @code{static-url} (default: @code{#f})
20452 The URL to use when serving static assets. It can be part of a URL, or a full
20453 URL, but must end in a @code{/}.
20454
20455 If the default value is used, the @code{static-path} value from the
20456 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record will be used.
20457
20458 This is a Django setting.
20459
20460 @item @code{admins} (default: @code{'()})
20461 Email addresses to send the details of errors that occur. Each value should
20462 be a list containing two elements, the name and then the email address.
20463
20464 This is a Django setting.
20465
20466 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
20467 Whether to run Patchwork in debug mode. If set to @code{#t}, detailed error
20468 messages will be shown.
20469
20470 This is a Django setting.
20471
20472 @item @code{enable-rest-api?} (default: @code{#t})
20473 Whether to enable the Patchwork REST API.
20474
20475 This is a Patchwork setting.
20476
20477 @item @code{enable-xmlrpc?} (default: @code{#t})
20478 Whether to enable the XML RPC API.
20479
20480 This is a Patchwork setting.
20481
20482 @item @code{force-https-links?} (default: @code{#t})
20483 Whether to use HTTPS links on Patchwork pages.
20484
20485 This is a Patchwork setting.
20486
20487 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
20488 Extra code to place at the end of the Patchwork settings module.
20489
20490 @end table
20491 @end deftp
20492
20493 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-database-configuration
20494 Data type representing the database configuration for Patchwork.
20495
20496 @table @asis
20497 @item @code{engine} (default: @code{"django.db.backends.postgresql_psycopg2"})
20498 The database engine to use.
20499
20500 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"patchwork"})
20501 The name of the database to use.
20502
20503 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
20504 The user to connect to the database as.
20505
20506 @item @code{password} (default: @code{""})
20507 The password to use when connecting to the database.
20508
20509 @item @code{host} (default: @code{""})
20510 The host to make the database connection to.
20511
20512 @item @code{port} (default: @code{""})
20513 The port on which to connect to the database.
20514
20515 @end table
20516 @end deftp
20517
20518 @subsubheading Mumi
20519
20520 @cindex Mumi, Debbugs Web interface
20521 @cindex Debbugs, Mumi Web interface
20522 @uref{https://git.elephly.net/gitweb.cgi?p=software/mumi.git, Mumi} is a
20523 Web interface to the Debbugs bug tracker, by default for
20524 @uref{https://bugs.gnu.org, the GNU instance}. Mumi is a Web server,
20525 but it also fetches and indexes mail retrieved from Debbugs.
20526
20527 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mumi-service-type
20528 This is the service type for Mumi.
20529 @end defvr
20530
20531 @subsubheading FastCGI
20532 @cindex fastcgi
20533 @cindex fcgiwrap
20534 FastCGI is an interface between the front-end and the back-end of a web
20535 service. It is a somewhat legacy facility; new web services should
20536 generally just talk HTTP between the front-end and the back-end.
20537 However there are a number of back-end services such as PHP or the
20538 optimized HTTP Git repository access that use FastCGI, so we have
20539 support for it in Guix.
20540
20541 To use FastCGI, you configure the front-end web server (e.g., nginx) to
20542 dispatch some subset of its requests to the fastcgi backend, which
20543 listens on a local TCP or UNIX socket. There is an intermediary
20544 @code{fcgiwrap} program that sits between the actual backend process and
20545 the web server. The front-end indicates which backend program to run,
20546 passing that information to the @code{fcgiwrap} process.
20547
20548 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fcgiwrap-service-type
20549 A service type for the @code{fcgiwrap} FastCGI proxy.
20550 @end defvr
20551
20552 @deftp {Data Type} fcgiwrap-configuration
20553 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{fcgiwrap} service.
20554 This type has the following parameters:
20555 @table @asis
20556 @item @code{package} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
20557 The fcgiwrap package to use.
20558
20559 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{tcp:127.0.0.1:9000})
20560 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} process should listen, as a
20561 string. Valid @var{socket} values include
20562 @code{unix:@var{/path/to/unix/socket}},
20563 @code{tcp:@var{dot.ted.qu.ad}:@var{port}} and
20564 @code{tcp6:[@var{ipv6_addr}]:port}.
20565
20566 @item @code{user} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
20567 @itemx @code{group} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
20568 The user and group names, as strings, under which to run the
20569 @code{fcgiwrap} process. The @code{fastcgi} service will ensure that if
20570 the user asks for the specific user or group names @code{fcgiwrap} that
20571 the corresponding user and/or group is present on the system.
20572
20573 It is possible to configure a FastCGI-backed web service to pass HTTP
20574 authentication information from the front-end to the back-end, and to
20575 allow @code{fcgiwrap} to run the back-end process as a corresponding
20576 local user. To enable this capability on the back-end, run
20577 @code{fcgiwrap} as the @code{root} user and group. Note that this
20578 capability also has to be configured on the front-end as well.
20579 @end table
20580 @end deftp
20581
20582 @cindex php-fpm
20583 PHP-FPM (FastCGI Process Manager) is an alternative PHP FastCGI implementation
20584 with some additional features useful for sites of any size.
20585
20586 These features include:
20587 @itemize @bullet
20588 @item Adaptive process spawning
20589 @item Basic statistics (similar to Apache's mod_status)
20590 @item Advanced process management with graceful stop/start
20591 @item Ability to start workers with different uid/gid/chroot/environment
20592 and different php.ini (replaces safe_mode)
20593 @item Stdout & stderr logging
20594 @item Emergency restart in case of accidental opcode cache destruction
20595 @item Accelerated upload support
20596 @item Support for a "slowlog"
20597 @item Enhancements to FastCGI, such as fastcgi_finish_request() -
20598 a special function to finish request & flush all data while continuing to do
20599 something time-consuming (video converting, stats processing, etc.)
20600 @end itemize
20601 ...@: and much more.
20602
20603 @defvr {Scheme Variable} php-fpm-service-type
20604 A Service type for @code{php-fpm}.
20605 @end defvr
20606
20607 @deftp {Data Type} php-fpm-configuration
20608 Data Type for php-fpm service configuration.
20609 @table @asis
20610 @item @code{php} (default: @code{php})
20611 The php package to use.
20612 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.sock")})
20613 The address on which to accept FastCGI requests. Valid syntaxes are:
20614 @table @asis
20615 @item @code{"ip.add.re.ss:port"}
20616 Listen on a TCP socket to a specific address on a specific port.
20617 @item @code{"port"}
20618 Listen on a TCP socket to all addresses on a specific port.
20619 @item @code{"/path/to/unix/socket"}
20620 Listen on a unix socket.
20621 @end table
20622
20623 @item @code{user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
20624 User who will own the php worker processes.
20625 @item @code{group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
20626 Group of the worker processes.
20627 @item @code{socket-user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
20628 User who can speak to the php-fpm socket.
20629 @item @code{socket-group} (default: @code{nginx})
20630 Group that can speak to the php-fpm socket.
20631 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.pid")})
20632 The process id of the php-fpm process is written to this file
20633 once the service has started.
20634 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.log")})
20635 Log for the php-fpm master process.
20636 @item @code{process-manager} (default: @code{(php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration)})
20637 Detailed settings for the php-fpm process manager.
20638 Must be one of:
20639 @table @asis
20640 @item @code{<php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration>}
20641 @item @code{<php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration>}
20642 @item @code{<php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration>}
20643 @end table
20644 @item @code{display-errors} (default @code{#f})
20645 Determines whether php errors and warning should be sent to clients
20646 and displayed in their browsers.
20647 This is useful for local php development, but a security risk for public sites,
20648 as error messages can reveal passwords and personal data.
20649 @item @code{timezone} (default @code{#f})
20650 Specifies @code{php_admin_value[date.timezone]} parameter.
20651 @item @code{workers-logfile} (default @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.www.log")})
20652 This file will log the @code{stderr} outputs of php worker processes.
20653 Can be set to @code{#f} to disable logging.
20654 @item @code{file} (default @code{#f})
20655 An optional override of the whole configuration.
20656 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
20657 @end table
20658 @end deftp
20659
20660 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration
20661 Data Type for the @code{dynamic} php-fpm process manager. With the
20662 @code{dynamic} process manager, spare worker processes are kept around
20663 based on it's configured limits.
20664 @table @asis
20665 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
20666 Maximum of worker processes.
20667 @item @code{start-servers} (default: @code{2})
20668 How many worker processes should be started on start-up.
20669 @item @code{min-spare-servers} (default: @code{1})
20670 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at minimum.
20671 @item @code{max-spare-servers} (default: @code{3})
20672 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at maximum.
20673 @end table
20674 @end deftp
20675
20676 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration
20677 Data Type for the @code{static} php-fpm process manager. With the
20678 @code{static} process manager, an unchanging number of worker processes
20679 are created.
20680 @table @asis
20681 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
20682 Maximum of worker processes.
20683 @end table
20684 @end deftp
20685
20686 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration
20687 Data Type for the @code{on-demand} php-fpm process manager. With the
20688 @code{on-demand} process manager, worker processes are only created as
20689 requests arrive.
20690 @table @asis
20691 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
20692 Maximum of worker processes.
20693 @item @code{process-idle-timeout} (default: @code{10})
20694 The time in seconds after which a process with no requests is killed.
20695 @end table
20696 @end deftp
20697
20698
20699 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-php-fpm-location @
20700 [#:nginx-package nginx] @
20701 [socket (string-append "/var/run/php" @
20702 (version-major (package-version php)) @
20703 "-fpm.sock")]
20704 A helper function to quickly add php to an @code{nginx-server-configuration}.
20705 @end deffn
20706
20707 A simple services setup for nginx with php can look like this:
20708 @lisp
20709 (services (cons* (service dhcp-client-service-type)
20710 (service php-fpm-service-type)
20711 (service nginx-service-type
20712 (nginx-server-configuration
20713 (server-name '("example.com"))
20714 (root "/srv/http/")
20715 (locations
20716 (list (nginx-php-location)))
20717 (listen '("80"))
20718 (ssl-certificate #f)
20719 (ssl-certificate-key #f)))
20720 %base-services))
20721 @end lisp
20722
20723 @cindex cat-avatar-generator
20724 The cat avatar generator is a simple service to demonstrate the use of php-fpm
20725 in @code{Nginx}. It is used to generate cat avatar from a seed, for instance
20726 the hash of a user's email address.
20727
20728 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cat-avatar-generator-service @
20729 [#:cache-dir "/var/cache/cat-avatar-generator"] @
20730 [#:package cat-avatar-generator] @
20731 [#:configuration (nginx-server-configuration)]
20732 Returns an nginx-server-configuration that inherits @code{configuration}. It
20733 extends the nginx configuration to add a server block that serves @code{package},
20734 a version of cat-avatar-generator. During execution, cat-avatar-generator will
20735 be able to use @code{cache-dir} as its cache directory.
20736 @end deffn
20737
20738 A simple setup for cat-avatar-generator can look like this:
20739 @lisp
20740 (services (cons* (cat-avatar-generator-service
20741 #:configuration
20742 (nginx-server-configuration
20743 (server-name '("example.com"))))
20744 ...
20745 %base-services))
20746 @end lisp
20747
20748 @subsubheading Hpcguix-web
20749
20750 @cindex hpcguix-web
20751 The @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/, hpcguix-web}
20752 program is a customizable web interface to browse Guix packages,
20753 initially designed for users of high-performance computing (HPC)
20754 clusters.
20755
20756 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hpcguix-web-service-type
20757 The service type for @code{hpcguix-web}.
20758 @end defvr
20759
20760 @deftp {Data Type} hpcguix-web-configuration
20761 Data type for the hpcguix-web service configuration.
20762
20763 @table @asis
20764 @item @code{specs}
20765 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) specifying the hpcguix-web service
20766 configuration. The main items available in this spec are:
20767
20768 @table @asis
20769 @item @code{title-prefix} (default: @code{"hpcguix | "})
20770 The page title prefix.
20771
20772 @item @code{guix-command} (default: @code{"guix"})
20773 The @command{guix} command.
20774
20775 @item @code{package-filter-proc} (default: @code{(const #t)})
20776 A procedure specifying how to filter packages that are displayed.
20777
20778 @item @code{package-page-extension-proc} (default: @code{(const '())})
20779 Extension package for @code{hpcguix-web}.
20780
20781 @item @code{menu} (default: @code{'()})
20782 Additional entry in page @code{menu}.
20783
20784 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
20785 List of channels from which the package list is built (@pxref{Channels}).
20786
20787 @item @code{package-list-expiration} (default: @code{(* 12 3600)})
20788 The expiration time, in seconds, after which the package list is rebuilt from
20789 the latest instances of the given channels.
20790 @end table
20791
20792 See the hpcguix-web repository for a
20793 @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/blob/master/hpcweb-configuration.scm,
20794 complete example}.
20795
20796 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hpcguix-web})
20797 The hpcguix-web package to use.
20798 @end table
20799 @end deftp
20800
20801 A typical hpcguix-web service declaration looks like this:
20802
20803 @lisp
20804 (service hpcguix-web-service-type
20805 (hpcguix-web-configuration
20806 (specs
20807 #~(define site-config
20808 (hpcweb-configuration
20809 (title-prefix "Guix-HPC - ")
20810 (menu '(("/about" "ABOUT"))))))))
20811 @end lisp
20812
20813 @quotation Note
20814 The hpcguix-web service periodically updates the package list it publishes by
20815 pulling channels from Git. To that end, it needs to access X.509 certificates
20816 so that it can authenticate Git servers when communicating over HTTPS, and it
20817 assumes that @file{/etc/ssl/certs} contains those certificates.
20818
20819 Thus, make sure to add @code{nss-certs} or another certificate package to the
20820 @code{packages} field of your configuration. @ref{X.509 Certificates}, for
20821 more information on X.509 certificates.
20822 @end quotation
20823
20824 @node Certificate Services
20825 @subsection Certificate Services
20826
20827 @cindex Web
20828 @cindex HTTP, HTTPS
20829 @cindex Let's Encrypt
20830 @cindex TLS certificates
20831 The @code{(gnu services certbot)} module provides a service to
20832 automatically obtain a valid TLS certificate from the Let's Encrypt
20833 certificate authority. These certificates can then be used to serve
20834 content securely over HTTPS or other TLS-based protocols, with the
20835 knowledge that the client will be able to verify the server's
20836 authenticity.
20837
20838 @url{https://letsencrypt.org/, Let's Encrypt} provides the
20839 @code{certbot} tool to automate the certification process. This tool
20840 first securely generates a key on the server. It then makes a request
20841 to the Let's Encrypt certificate authority (CA) to sign the key. The CA
20842 checks that the request originates from the host in question by using a
20843 challenge-response protocol, requiring the server to provide its
20844 response over HTTP. If that protocol completes successfully, the CA
20845 signs the key, resulting in a certificate. That certificate is valid
20846 for a limited period of time, and therefore to continue to provide TLS
20847 services, the server needs to periodically ask the CA to renew its
20848 signature.
20849
20850 The certbot service automates this process: the initial key
20851 generation, the initial certification request to the Let's Encrypt
20852 service, the web server challenge/response integration, writing the
20853 certificate to disk, the automated periodic renewals, and the deployment
20854 tasks associated with the renewal (e.g.@: reloading services, copying keys
20855 with different permissions).
20856
20857 Certbot is run twice a day, at a random minute within the hour. It
20858 won't do anything until your certificates are due for renewal or
20859 revoked, but running it regularly would give your service a chance of
20860 staying online in case a Let's Encrypt-initiated revocation happened for
20861 some reason.
20862
20863 By using this service, you agree to the ACME Subscriber Agreement, which
20864 can be found there:
20865 @url{https://acme-v01.api.letsencrypt.org/directory}.
20866
20867 @defvr {Scheme Variable} certbot-service-type
20868 A service type for the @code{certbot} Let's Encrypt client. Its value
20869 must be a @code{certbot-configuration} record as in this example:
20870
20871 @lisp
20872 (define %nginx-deploy-hook
20873 (program-file
20874 "nginx-deploy-hook"
20875 #~(let ((pid (call-with-input-file "/var/run/nginx/pid" read)))
20876 (kill pid SIGHUP))))
20877
20878 (service certbot-service-type
20879 (certbot-configuration
20880 (email "foo@@example.net")
20881 (certificates
20882 (list
20883 (certificate-configuration
20884 (domains '("example.net" "www.example.net"))
20885 (deploy-hook %nginx-deploy-hook))
20886 (certificate-configuration
20887 (domains '("bar.example.net")))))))
20888 @end lisp
20889
20890 See below for details about @code{certbot-configuration}.
20891 @end defvr
20892
20893 @deftp {Data Type} certbot-configuration
20894 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{certbot} service.
20895 This type has the following parameters:
20896
20897 @table @asis
20898 @item @code{package} (default: @code{certbot})
20899 The certbot package to use.
20900
20901 @item @code{webroot} (default: @code{/var/www})
20902 The directory from which to serve the Let's Encrypt challenge/response
20903 files.
20904
20905 @item @code{certificates} (default: @code{()})
20906 A list of @code{certificates-configuration}s for which to generate
20907 certificates and request signatures. Each certificate has a @code{name}
20908 and several @code{domains}.
20909
20910 @item @code{email}
20911 Mandatory email used for registration, recovery contact, and important
20912 account notifications.
20913
20914 @item @code{rsa-key-size} (default: @code{2048})
20915 Size of the RSA key.
20916
20917 @item @code{default-location} (default: @i{see below})
20918 The default @code{nginx-location-configuration}. Because @code{certbot}
20919 needs to be able to serve challenges and responses, it needs to be able
20920 to run a web server. It does so by extending the @code{nginx} web
20921 service with an @code{nginx-server-configuration} listening on the
20922 @var{domains} on port 80, and which has a
20923 @code{nginx-location-configuration} for the @code{/.well-known/} URI
20924 path subspace used by Let's Encrypt. @xref{Web Services}, for more on
20925 these nginx configuration data types.
20926
20927 Requests to other URL paths will be matched by the
20928 @code{default-location}, which if present is added to all
20929 @code{nginx-server-configuration}s.
20930
20931 By default, the @code{default-location} will issue a redirect from
20932 @code{http://@var{domain}/...} to @code{https://@var{domain}/...}, leaving
20933 you to define what to serve on your site via @code{https}.
20934
20935 Pass @code{#f} to not issue a default location.
20936 @end table
20937 @end deftp
20938
20939 @deftp {Data Type} certificate-configuration
20940 Data type representing the configuration of a certificate.
20941 This type has the following parameters:
20942
20943 @table @asis
20944 @item @code{name} (default: @i{see below})
20945 This name is used by Certbot for housekeeping and in file paths; it
20946 doesn't affect the content of the certificate itself. To see
20947 certificate names, run @code{certbot certificates}.
20948
20949 Its default is the first provided domain.
20950
20951 @item @code{domains} (default: @code{()})
20952 The first domain provided will be the subject CN of the certificate, and
20953 all domains will be Subject Alternative Names on the certificate.
20954
20955 @item @code{challenge} (default: @code{#f})
20956 The challenge type that has to be run by certbot. If @code{#f} is specified,
20957 default to the HTTP challenge. If a value is specified, defaults to the
20958 manual plugin (see @code{authentication-hook}, @code{cleanup-hook} and
20959 the documentation at @url{https://certbot.eff.org/docs/using.html#hooks}),
20960 and gives Let's Encrypt permission to log the public IP address of the
20961 requesting machine.
20962
20963 @item @code{authentication-hook} (default: @code{#f})
20964 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge to be
20965 answered. For this command, the shell variable @code{$CERTBOT_DOMAIN}
20966 will contain the domain being authenticated, @code{$CERTBOT_VALIDATION}
20967 contains the validation string and @code{$CERTBOT_TOKEN} contains the
20968 file name of the resource requested when performing an HTTP-01 challenge.
20969
20970 @item @code{cleanup-hook} (default: @code{#f})
20971 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge that
20972 have been answered by the @code{auth-hook}. For this command, the shell
20973 variables available in the @code{auth-hook} script are still available, and
20974 additionally @code{$CERTBOT_AUTH_OUTPUT} will contain the standard output
20975 of the @code{auth-hook} script.
20976
20977 @item @code{deploy-hook} (default: @code{#f})
20978 Command to be run in a shell once for each successfully issued
20979 certificate. For this command, the shell variable
20980 @code{$RENEWED_LINEAGE} will point to the config live subdirectory (for
20981 example, @samp{"/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com"}) containing the new
20982 certificates and keys; the shell variable @code{$RENEWED_DOMAINS} will
20983 contain a space-delimited list of renewed certificate domains (for
20984 example, @samp{"example.com www.example.com"}.
20985
20986 @end table
20987 @end deftp
20988
20989 For each @code{certificate-configuration}, the certificate is saved to
20990 @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/fullchain.pem} and the key is
20991 saved to @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/privkey.pem}.
20992 @node DNS Services
20993 @subsection DNS Services
20994 @cindex DNS (domain name system)
20995 @cindex domain name system (DNS)
20996
20997 The @code{(gnu services dns)} module provides services related to the
20998 @dfn{domain name system} (DNS). It provides a server service for hosting
20999 an @emph{authoritative} DNS server for multiple zones, slave or master.
21000 This service uses @uref{https://www.knot-dns.cz/, Knot DNS}. And also a
21001 caching and forwarding DNS server for the LAN, which uses
21002 @uref{http://www.thekelleys.org.uk/dnsmasq/doc.html, dnsmasq}.
21003
21004 @subsubheading Knot Service
21005
21006 An example configuration of an authoritative server for two zones, one master
21007 and one slave, is:
21008
21009 @lisp
21010 (define-zone-entries example.org.zone
21011 ;; Name TTL Class Type Data
21012 ("@@" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1")
21013 ("@@" "" "IN" "NS" "ns")
21014 ("ns" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1"))
21015
21016 (define master-zone
21017 (knot-zone-configuration
21018 (domain "example.org")
21019 (zone (zone-file
21020 (origin "example.org")
21021 (entries example.org.zone)))))
21022
21023 (define slave-zone
21024 (knot-zone-configuration
21025 (domain "plop.org")
21026 (dnssec-policy "default")
21027 (master (list "plop-master"))))
21028
21029 (define plop-master
21030 (knot-remote-configuration
21031 (id "plop-master")
21032 (address (list "208.76.58.171"))))
21033
21034 (operating-system
21035 ;; ...
21036 (services (cons* (service knot-service-type
21037 (knot-configuration
21038 (remotes (list plop-master))
21039 (zones (list master-zone slave-zone))))
21040 ;; ...
21041 %base-services)))
21042 @end lisp
21043
21044 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-service-type
21045 This is the type for the Knot DNS server.
21046
21047 Knot DNS is an authoritative DNS server, meaning that it can serve multiple
21048 zones, that is to say domain names you would buy from a registrar. This server
21049 is not a resolver, meaning that it can only resolve names for which it is
21050 authoritative. This server can be configured to serve zones as a master server
21051 or a slave server as a per-zone basis. Slave zones will get their data from
21052 masters, and will serve it as an authoritative server. From the point of view
21053 of a resolver, there is no difference between master and slave.
21054
21055 The following data types are used to configure the Knot DNS server:
21056 @end deffn
21057
21058 @deftp {Data Type} knot-key-configuration
21059 Data type representing a key.
21060 This type has the following parameters:
21061
21062 @table @asis
21063 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
21064 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must
21065 be unique and must not be empty.
21066
21067 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{#f})
21068 The algorithm to use. Choose between @code{#f}, @code{'hmac-md5},
21069 @code{'hmac-sha1}, @code{'hmac-sha224}, @code{'hmac-sha256}, @code{'hmac-sha384}
21070 and @code{'hmac-sha512}.
21071
21072 @item @code{secret} (default: @code{""})
21073 The secret key itself.
21074
21075 @end table
21076 @end deftp
21077
21078 @deftp {Data Type} knot-acl-configuration
21079 Data type representing an Access Control List (ACL) configuration.
21080 This type has the following parameters:
21081
21082 @table @asis
21083 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
21084 An identifier for ether configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must be
21085 unique and must not be empty.
21086
21087 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
21088 An ordered list of IP addresses, network subnets, or network ranges represented
21089 with strings. The query must match one of them. Empty value means that
21090 address match is not required.
21091
21092 @item @code{key} (default: @code{'()})
21093 An ordered list of references to keys represented with strings. The string
21094 must match a key ID defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration}. No key means
21095 that a key is not require to match that ACL.
21096
21097 @item @code{action} (default: @code{'()})
21098 An ordered list of actions that are permitted or forbidden by this ACL. Possible
21099 values are lists of zero or more elements from @code{'transfer}, @code{'notify}
21100 and @code{'update}.
21101
21102 @item @code{deny?} (default: @code{#f})
21103 When true, the ACL defines restrictions. Listed actions are forbidden. When
21104 false, listed actions are allowed.
21105
21106 @end table
21107 @end deftp
21108
21109 @deftp {Data Type} zone-entry
21110 Data type represnting a record entry in a zone file.
21111 This type has the following parameters:
21112
21113 @table @asis
21114 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"@@"})
21115 The name of the record. @code{"@@"} refers to the origin of the zone. Names
21116 are relative to the origin of the zone. For example, in the @code{example.org}
21117 zone, @code{"ns.example.org"} actually refers to @code{ns.example.org.example.org}.
21118 Names ending with a dot are absolute, which means that @code{"ns.example.org."}
21119 refers to @code{ns.example.org}.
21120
21121 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{""})
21122 The Time-To-Live (TTL) of this record. If not set, the default TTL is used.
21123
21124 @item @code{class} (default: @code{"IN"})
21125 The class of the record. Knot currently supports only @code{"IN"} and
21126 partially @code{"CH"}.
21127
21128 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"A"})
21129 The type of the record. Common types include A (IPv4 address), AAAA (IPv6
21130 address), NS (Name Server) and MX (Mail eXchange). Many other types are
21131 defined.
21132
21133 @item @code{data} (default: @code{""})
21134 The data contained in the record. For instance an IP address associated with
21135 an A record, or a domain name associated with an NS record. Remember that
21136 domain names are relative to the origin unless they end with a dot.
21137
21138 @end table
21139 @end deftp
21140
21141 @deftp {Data Type} zone-file
21142 Data type representing the content of a zone file.
21143 This type has the following parameters:
21144
21145 @table @asis
21146 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
21147 The list of entries. The SOA record is taken care of, so you don't need to
21148 put it in the list of entries. This list should probably contain an entry
21149 for your primary authoritative DNS server. Other than using a list of entries
21150 directly, you can use @code{define-zone-entries} to define a object containing
21151 the list of entries more easily, that you can later pass to the @code{entries}
21152 field of the @code{zone-file}.
21153
21154 @item @code{origin} (default: @code{""})
21155 The name of your zone. This parameter cannot be empty.
21156
21157 @item @code{ns} (default: @code{"ns"})
21158 The domain of your primary authoritative DNS server. The name is relative to
21159 the origin, unless it ends with a dot. It is mandatory that this primary
21160 DNS server corresponds to an NS record in the zone and that it is associated
21161 to an IP address in the list of entries.
21162
21163 @item @code{mail} (default: @code{"hostmaster"})
21164 An email address people can contact you at, as the owner of the zone. This
21165 is translated as @code{<mail>@@<origin>}.
21166
21167 @item @code{serial} (default: @code{1})
21168 The serial number of the zone. As this is used to keep track of changes by
21169 both slaves and resolvers, it is mandatory that it @emph{never} decreases.
21170 Always increment it when you make a change in your zone.
21171
21172 @item @code{refresh} (default: @code{(* 2 24 3600)})
21173 The frequency at which slaves will do a zone transfer. This value is a number
21174 of seconds. It can be computed by multiplications or with
21175 @code{(string->duration)}.
21176
21177 @item @code{retry} (default: @code{(* 15 60)})
21178 The period after which a slave will retry to contact its master when it fails
21179 to do so a first time.
21180
21181 @item @code{expiry} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
21182 Default TTL of records. Existing records are considered correct for at most
21183 this amount of time. After this period, resolvers will invalidate their cache
21184 and check again that it still exists.
21185
21186 @item @code{nx} (default: @code{3600})
21187 Default TTL of inexistant records. This delay is usually short because you want
21188 your new domains to reach everyone quickly.
21189
21190 @end table
21191 @end deftp
21192
21193 @deftp {Data Type} knot-remote-configuration
21194 Data type representing a remote configuration.
21195 This type has the following parameters:
21196
21197 @table @asis
21198 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
21199 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this remote. IDs must
21200 be unique and must not be empty.
21201
21202 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
21203 An ordered list of destination IP addresses. Addresses are tried in sequence.
21204 An optional port can be given with the @@ separator. For instance:
21205 @code{(list "1.2.3.4" "2.3.4.5@@53")}. Default port is 53.
21206
21207 @item @code{via} (default: @code{'()})
21208 An ordered list of source IP addresses. An empty list will have Knot choose
21209 an appropriate source IP. An optional port can be given with the @@ separator.
21210 The default is to choose at random.
21211
21212 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
21213 A reference to a key, that is a string containing the identifier of a key
21214 defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration} field.
21215
21216 @end table
21217 @end deftp
21218
21219 @deftp {Data Type} knot-keystore-configuration
21220 Data type representing a keystore to hold dnssec keys.
21221 This type has the following parameters:
21222
21223 @table @asis
21224 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
21225 The id of the keystore. It must not be empty.
21226
21227 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{'pem})
21228 The backend to store the keys in. Can be @code{'pem} or @code{'pkcs11}.
21229
21230 @item @code{config} (default: @code{"/var/lib/knot/keys/keys"})
21231 The configuration string of the backend. An example for the PKCS#11 is:
21232 @code{"pkcs11:token=knot;pin-value=1234 /gnu/store/.../lib/pkcs11/libsofthsm2.so"}.
21233 For the pem backend, the string reprensents a path in the file system.
21234
21235 @end table
21236 @end deftp
21237
21238 @deftp {Data Type} knot-policy-configuration
21239 Data type representing a dnssec policy. Knot DNS is able to automatically
21240 sign your zones. It can either generate and manage your keys automatically or
21241 use keys that you generate.
21242
21243 Dnssec is usually implemented using two keys: a Key Signing Key (KSK) that is
21244 used to sign the second, and a Zone Signing Key (ZSK) that is used to sign the
21245 zone. In order to be trusted, the KSK needs to be present in the parent zone
21246 (usually a top-level domain). If your registrar supports dnssec, you will
21247 have to send them your KSK's hash so they can add a DS record in their zone.
21248 This is not automated and need to be done each time you change your KSK.
21249
21250 The policy also defines the lifetime of keys. Usually, ZSK can be changed
21251 easily and use weaker cryptographic functions (they use lower parameters) in
21252 order to sign records quickly, so they are changed often. The KSK however
21253 requires manual interaction with the registrar, so they are changed less often
21254 and use stronger parameters because they sign only one record.
21255
21256 This type has the following parameters:
21257
21258 @table @asis
21259 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
21260 The id of the policy. It must not be empty.
21261
21262 @item @code{keystore} (default: @code{"default"})
21263 A reference to a keystore, that is a string containing the identifier of a
21264 keystore defined in a @code{knot-keystore-configuration} field. The
21265 @code{"default"} identifier means the default keystore (a kasp database that
21266 was setup by this service).
21267
21268 @item @code{manual?} (default: @code{#f})
21269 Whether the key management is manual or automatic.
21270
21271 @item @code{single-type-signing?} (default: @code{#f})
21272 When @code{#t}, use the Single-Type Signing Scheme.
21273
21274 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{"ecdsap256sha256"})
21275 An algorithm of signing keys and issued signatures.
21276
21277 @item @code{ksk-size} (default: @code{256})
21278 The length of the KSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
21279 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
21280
21281 @item @code{zsk-size} (default: @code{256})
21282 The length of the ZSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
21283 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
21284
21285 @item @code{dnskey-ttl} (default: @code{'default})
21286 The TTL value for DNSKEY records added into zone apex. The special
21287 @code{'default} value means same as the zone SOA TTL.
21288
21289 @item @code{zsk-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
21290 The period between ZSK publication and the next rollover initiation.
21291
21292 @item @code{propagation-delay} (default: @code{(* 24 3600)})
21293 An extra delay added for each key rollover step. This value should be high
21294 enough to cover propagation of data from the master server to all slaves.
21295
21296 @item @code{rrsig-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
21297 A validity period of newly issued signatures.
21298
21299 @item @code{rrsig-refresh} (default: @code{(* 7 24 3600)})
21300 A period how long before a signature expiration the signature will be refreshed.
21301
21302 @item @code{nsec3?} (default: @code{#f})
21303 When @code{#t}, NSEC3 will be used instead of NSEC.
21304
21305 @item @code{nsec3-iterations} (default: @code{5})
21306 The number of additional times the hashing is performed.
21307
21308 @item @code{nsec3-salt-length} (default: @code{8})
21309 The length of a salt field in octets, which is appended to the original owner
21310 name before hashing.
21311
21312 @item @code{nsec3-salt-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
21313 The validity period of newly issued salt field.
21314
21315 @end table
21316 @end deftp
21317
21318 @deftp {Data Type} knot-zone-configuration
21319 Data type representing a zone served by Knot.
21320 This type has the following parameters:
21321
21322 @table @asis
21323 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{""})
21324 The domain served by this configuration. It must not be empty.
21325
21326 @item @code{file} (default: @code{""})
21327 The file where this zone is saved. This parameter is ignored by master zones.
21328 Empty means default location that depends on the domain name.
21329
21330 @item @code{zone} (default: @code{(zone-file)})
21331 The content of the zone file. This parameter is ignored by slave zones. It
21332 must contain a zone-file record.
21333
21334 @item @code{master} (default: @code{'()})
21335 A list of master remotes. When empty, this zone is a master. When set, this
21336 zone is a slave. This is a list of remotes identifiers.
21337
21338 @item @code{ddns-master} (default: @code{#f})
21339 The main master. When empty, it defaults to the first master in the list of
21340 masters.
21341
21342 @item @code{notify} (default: @code{'()})
21343 A list of slave remote identifiers.
21344
21345 @item @code{acl} (default: @code{'()})
21346 A list of acl identifiers.
21347
21348 @item @code{semantic-checks?} (default: @code{#f})
21349 When set, this adds more semantic checks to the zone.
21350
21351 @item @code{disable-any?} (default: @code{#f})
21352 When set, this forbids queries of the ANY type.
21353
21354 @item @code{zonefile-sync} (default: @code{0})
21355 The delay between a modification in memory and on disk. 0 means immediate
21356 synchronization.
21357
21358 @item @code{zonefile-load} (default: @code{#f})
21359 The way the zone file contents are applied during zone load. Possible values
21360 are:
21361
21362 @itemize
21363 @item @code{#f} for using the default value from Knot,
21364 @item @code{'none} for not using the zone file at all,
21365 @item @code{'difference} for computing the difference between already available
21366 contents and zone contents and applying it to the current zone contents,
21367 @item @code{'difference-no-serial} for the same as @code{'difference}, but
21368 ignoring the SOA serial in the zone file, while the server takes care of it
21369 automatically.
21370 @item @code{'whole} for loading zone contents from the zone file.
21371 @end itemize
21372
21373 @item @code{journal-content} (default: @code{#f})
21374 The way the journal is used to store zone and its changes. Possible values
21375 are @code{'none} to not use it at all, @code{'changes} to store changes and
21376 @code{'all} to store contents. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
21377 default value from Knot is used.
21378
21379 @item @code{max-journal-usage} (default: @code{#f})
21380 The maximum size for the journal on disk. @code{#f} does not set this option,
21381 so the default value from Knot is used.
21382
21383 @item @code{max-journal-depth} (default: @code{#f})
21384 The maximum size of the history. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
21385 default value from Knot is used.
21386
21387 @item @code{max-zone-size} (default: @code{#f})
21388 The maximum size of the zone file. This limit is enforced for incoming
21389 transfer and updates. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the default
21390 value from Knot is used.
21391
21392 @item @code{dnssec-policy} (default: @code{#f})
21393 A reference to a @code{knot-policy-configuration} record, or the special
21394 name @code{"default"}. If the value is @code{#f}, there is no dnssec signing
21395 on this zone.
21396
21397 @item @code{serial-policy} (default: @code{'increment})
21398 A policy between @code{'increment} and @code{'unixtime}.
21399
21400 @end table
21401 @end deftp
21402
21403 @deftp {Data Type} knot-configuration
21404 Data type representing the Knot configuration.
21405 This type has the following parameters:
21406
21407 @table @asis
21408 @item @code{knot} (default: @code{knot})
21409 The Knot package.
21410
21411 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/knot"})
21412 The run directory. This directory will be used for pid file and sockets.
21413
21414 @item @code{includes} (default: @code{'()})
21415 A list of strings or file-like objects denoting other files that must be
21416 included at the top of the configuration file.
21417
21418 @cindex secrets, Knot service
21419 This can be used to manage secrets out-of-band. For example, secret
21420 keys may be stored in an out-of-band file not managed by Guix, and
21421 thus not visible in @file{/gnu/store}---e.g., you could store secret
21422 key configuration in @file{/etc/knot/secrets.conf} and add this file
21423 to the @code{includes} list.
21424
21425 One can generate a secret tsig key (for nsupdate and zone transfers with the
21426 keymgr command from the knot package. Note that the package is not automatically
21427 installed by the service. The following example shows how to generate a new
21428 tsig key:
21429
21430 @example
21431 keymgr -t mysecret > /etc/knot/secrets.conf
21432 chmod 600 /etc/knot/secrets.conf
21433 @end example
21434
21435 Also note that the generated key will be named @var{mysecret}, so it is the
21436 name that needs to be used in the @var{key} field of the
21437 @code{knot-acl-configuration} record and in other places that need to refer
21438 to that key.
21439
21440 It can also be used to add configuration not supported by this interface.
21441
21442 @item @code{listen-v4} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
21443 An ip address on which to listen.
21444
21445 @item @code{listen-v6} (default: @code{"::"})
21446 An ip address on which to listen.
21447
21448 @item @code{listen-port} (default: @code{53})
21449 A port on which to listen.
21450
21451 @item @code{keys} (default: @code{'()})
21452 The list of knot-key-configuration used by this configuration.
21453
21454 @item @code{acls} (default: @code{'()})
21455 The list of knot-acl-configuration used by this configuration.
21456
21457 @item @code{remotes} (default: @code{'()})
21458 The list of knot-remote-configuration used by this configuration.
21459
21460 @item @code{zones} (default: @code{'()})
21461 The list of knot-zone-configuration used by this configuration.
21462
21463 @end table
21464 @end deftp
21465
21466 @subsubheading Knot Resolver Service
21467
21468 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-resolver-service-type
21469 This this the type of the knot resolver service, whose value should be
21470 an @code{knot-resolver-configuration} object as in this example:
21471
21472 @lisp
21473 (service knot-resolver-service-type
21474 (knot-resolver-configuration
21475 (kresd-config-file (plain-file "kresd.conf" "
21476 net.listen('192.168.0.1', 5353)
21477 user('knot-resolver', 'knot-resolver')
21478 modules = @{ 'hints > iterate', 'stats', 'predict' @}
21479 cache.size = 100 * MB
21480 "))))
21481 @end lisp
21482
21483 For more information, refer its @url{https://knot-resolver.readthedocs.org/en/stable/daemon.html#configuration, manual}.
21484 @end deffn
21485
21486 @deftp {Data Type} knot-resolver-configuration
21487 Data type representing the configuration of knot-resolver.
21488
21489 @table @asis
21490 @item @code{package} (default: @var{knot-resolver})
21491 Package object of the knot DNS resolver.
21492
21493 @item @code{kresd-config-file} (default: %kresd.conf)
21494 File-like object of the kresd configuration file to use, by default it
21495 will listen on @code{127.0.0.1} and @code{::1}.
21496
21497 @item @code{garbage-collection-interval} (default: 1000)
21498 Number of milliseconds for @code{kres-cache-gc} to periodically trim the cache.
21499
21500 @end table
21501 @end deftp
21502
21503
21504 @subsubheading Dnsmasq Service
21505
21506 @deffn {Scheme Variable} dnsmasq-service-type
21507 This is the type of the dnsmasq service, whose value should be an
21508 @code{dnsmasq-configuration} object as in this example:
21509
21510 @lisp
21511 (service dnsmasq-service-type
21512 (dnsmasq-configuration
21513 (no-resolv? #t)
21514 (servers '("192.168.1.1"))))
21515 @end lisp
21516 @end deffn
21517
21518 @deftp {Data Type} dnsmasq-configuration
21519 Data type representing the configuration of dnsmasq.
21520
21521 @table @asis
21522 @item @code{package} (default: @var{dnsmasq})
21523 Package object of the dnsmasq server.
21524
21525 @item @code{no-hosts?} (default: @code{#f})
21526 When true, don't read the hostnames in /etc/hosts.
21527
21528 @item @code{port} (default: @code{53})
21529 The port to listen on. Setting this to zero completely disables DNS
21530 responses, leaving only DHCP and/or TFTP functions.
21531
21532 @item @code{local-service?} (default: @code{#t})
21533 Accept DNS queries only from hosts whose address is on a local subnet,
21534 ie a subnet for which an interface exists on the server.
21535
21536 @item @code{listen-addresses} (default: @code{'()})
21537 Listen on the given IP addresses.
21538
21539 @item @code{resolv-file} (default: @code{"/etc/resolv.conf"})
21540 The file to read the IP address of the upstream nameservers from.
21541
21542 @item @code{no-resolv?} (default: @code{#f})
21543 When true, don't read @var{resolv-file}.
21544
21545 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
21546 Specify IP address of upstream servers directly.
21547
21548 @item @code{cache-size} (default: @code{150})
21549 Set the size of dnsmasq's cache. Setting the cache size to zero
21550 disables caching.
21551
21552 @item @code{negative-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
21553 When false, disable negative caching.
21554
21555 @end table
21556 @end deftp
21557
21558 @subsubheading ddclient Service
21559
21560 @cindex ddclient
21561 The ddclient service described below runs the ddclient daemon, which takes
21562 care of automatically updating DNS entries for service providers such as
21563 @uref{https://dyn.com/dns/, Dyn}.
21564
21565 The following example show instantiates the service with its default
21566 configuration:
21567
21568 @lisp
21569 (service ddclient-service-type)
21570 @end lisp
21571
21572 Note that ddclient needs to access credentials that are stored in a
21573 @dfn{secret file}, by default @file{/etc/ddclient/secrets} (see
21574 @code{secret-file} below.) You are expected to create this file manually, in
21575 an ``out-of-band'' fashion (you @emph{could} make this file part of the
21576 service configuration, for instance by using @code{plain-file}, but it will be
21577 world-readable @i{via} @file{/gnu/store}.) See the examples in the
21578 @file{share/ddclient} directory of the @code{ddclient} package.
21579
21580 @c %start of fragment
21581
21582 Available @code{ddclient-configuration} fields are:
21583
21584 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} package ddclient
21585 The ddclient package.
21586
21587 @end deftypevr
21588
21589 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} integer daemon
21590 The period after which ddclient will retry to check IP and domain name.
21591
21592 Defaults to @samp{300}.
21593
21594 @end deftypevr
21595
21596 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean syslog
21597 Use syslog for the output.
21598
21599 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21600
21601 @end deftypevr
21602
21603 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail
21604 Mail to user.
21605
21606 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
21607
21608 @end deftypevr
21609
21610 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail-failure
21611 Mail failed update to user.
21612
21613 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
21614
21615 @end deftypevr
21616
21617 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string pid
21618 The ddclient PID file.
21619
21620 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/ddclient/ddclient.pid"}.
21621
21622 @end deftypevr
21623
21624 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl
21625 Enable SSL support.
21626
21627 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21628
21629 @end deftypevr
21630
21631 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string user
21632 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running ddclient
21633 program.
21634
21635 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
21636
21637 @end deftypevr
21638
21639 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string group
21640 Group of the user who will run the ddclient program.
21641
21642 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
21643
21644 @end deftypevr
21645
21646 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string secret-file
21647 Secret file which will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file. This
21648 file contains credentials for use by ddclient. You are expected to
21649 create it manually.
21650
21651 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ddclient/secrets.conf"}.
21652
21653 @end deftypevr
21654
21655 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
21656 Extra options will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file.
21657
21658 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21659
21660 @end deftypevr
21661
21662
21663 @c %end of fragment
21664
21665
21666 @node VPN Services
21667 @subsection VPN Services
21668 @cindex VPN (virtual private network)
21669 @cindex virtual private network (VPN)
21670
21671 The @code{(gnu services vpn)} module provides services related to
21672 @dfn{virtual private networks} (VPNs). It provides a @emph{client} service for
21673 your machine to connect to a VPN, and a @emph{server} service for your machine
21674 to host a VPN. Both services use @uref{https://openvpn.net/, OpenVPN}.
21675
21676 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-client-service @
21677 [#:config (openvpn-client-configuration)]
21678
21679 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a client.
21680 @end deffn
21681
21682 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-server-service @
21683 [#:config (openvpn-server-configuration)]
21684
21685 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a server.
21686
21687 Both can be run simultaneously.
21688 @end deffn
21689
21690 @c %automatically generated documentation
21691
21692 Available @code{openvpn-client-configuration} fields are:
21693
21694 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
21695 The OpenVPN package.
21696
21697 @end deftypevr
21698
21699 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
21700 The OpenVPN pid file.
21701
21702 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
21703
21704 @end deftypevr
21705
21706 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} proto proto
21707 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
21708 servers.
21709
21710 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
21711
21712 @end deftypevr
21713
21714 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} dev dev
21715 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
21716
21717 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
21718
21719 @end deftypevr
21720
21721 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string ca
21722 The certificate authority to check connections against.
21723
21724 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
21725
21726 @end deftypevr
21727
21728 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string cert
21729 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
21730 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
21731
21732 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
21733
21734 @end deftypevr
21735
21736 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string key
21737 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
21738 certificate is @code{cert}.
21739
21740 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
21741
21742 @end deftypevr
21743
21744 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
21745 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
21746
21747 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21748
21749 @end deftypevr
21750
21751 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
21752 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
21753
21754 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21755
21756 @end deftypevr
21757
21758 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
21759 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
21760 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
21761
21762 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21763
21764 @end deftypevr
21765
21766 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
21767 Verbosity level.
21768
21769 Defaults to @samp{3}.
21770
21771 @end deftypevr
21772
21773 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-client tls-auth
21774 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
21775 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
21776
21777 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21778
21779 @end deftypevr
21780
21781 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} key-usage verify-key-usage?
21782 Whether to check the server certificate has server usage extension.
21783
21784 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21785
21786 @end deftypevr
21787
21788 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} bind bind?
21789 Bind to a specific local port number.
21790
21791 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21792
21793 @end deftypevr
21794
21795 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} resolv-retry resolv-retry?
21796 Retry resolving server address.
21797
21798 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21799
21800 @end deftypevr
21801
21802 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} openvpn-remote-list remote
21803 A list of remote servers to connect to.
21804
21805 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21806
21807 Available @code{openvpn-remote-configuration} fields are:
21808
21809 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} string name
21810 Server name.
21811
21812 Defaults to @samp{"my-server"}.
21813
21814 @end deftypevr
21815
21816 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} number port
21817 Port number the server listens to.
21818
21819 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
21820
21821 @end deftypevr
21822
21823 @end deftypevr
21824 @c %end of automatic openvpn-client documentation
21825
21826 @c %automatically generated documentation
21827
21828 Available @code{openvpn-server-configuration} fields are:
21829
21830 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
21831 The OpenVPN package.
21832
21833 @end deftypevr
21834
21835 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
21836 The OpenVPN pid file.
21837
21838 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
21839
21840 @end deftypevr
21841
21842 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} proto proto
21843 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
21844 servers.
21845
21846 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
21847
21848 @end deftypevr
21849
21850 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} dev dev
21851 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
21852
21853 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
21854
21855 @end deftypevr
21856
21857 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ca
21858 The certificate authority to check connections against.
21859
21860 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
21861
21862 @end deftypevr
21863
21864 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string cert
21865 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
21866 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
21867
21868 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
21869
21870 @end deftypevr
21871
21872 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string key
21873 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
21874 certificate is @code{cert}.
21875
21876 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
21877
21878 @end deftypevr
21879
21880 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
21881 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
21882
21883 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21884
21885 @end deftypevr
21886
21887 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
21888 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
21889
21890 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21891
21892 @end deftypevr
21893
21894 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
21895 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
21896 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
21897
21898 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21899
21900 @end deftypevr
21901
21902 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
21903 Verbosity level.
21904
21905 Defaults to @samp{3}.
21906
21907 @end deftypevr
21908
21909 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-server tls-auth
21910 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
21911 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
21912
21913 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21914
21915 @end deftypevr
21916
21917 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number port
21918 Specifies the port number on which the server listens.
21919
21920 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
21921
21922 @end deftypevr
21923
21924 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} ip-mask server
21925 An ip and mask specifying the subnet inside the virtual network.
21926
21927 Defaults to @samp{"10.8.0.0 255.255.255.0"}.
21928
21929 @end deftypevr
21930
21931 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} cidr6 server-ipv6
21932 A CIDR notation specifying the IPv6 subnet inside the virtual network.
21933
21934 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21935
21936 @end deftypevr
21937
21938 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string dh
21939 The Diffie-Hellman parameters file.
21940
21941 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/dh2048.pem"}.
21942
21943 @end deftypevr
21944
21945 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ifconfig-pool-persist
21946 The file that records client IPs.
21947
21948 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ipp.txt"}.
21949
21950 @end deftypevr
21951
21952 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} gateway redirect-gateway?
21953 When true, the server will act as a gateway for its clients.
21954
21955 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21956
21957 @end deftypevr
21958
21959 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean client-to-client?
21960 When true, clients are allowed to talk to each other inside the VPN.
21961
21962 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21963
21964 @end deftypevr
21965
21966 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} keepalive keepalive
21967 Causes ping-like messages to be sent back and forth over the link so
21968 that each side knows when the other side has gone down. @code{keepalive}
21969 requires a pair. The first element is the period of the ping sending,
21970 and the second element is the timeout before considering the other side
21971 down.
21972
21973 @end deftypevr
21974
21975 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number max-clients
21976 The maximum number of clients.
21977
21978 Defaults to @samp{100}.
21979
21980 @end deftypevr
21981
21982 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string status
21983 The status file. This file shows a small report on current connection.
21984 It is truncated and rewritten every minute.
21985
21986 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/status"}.
21987
21988 @end deftypevr
21989
21990 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} openvpn-ccd-list client-config-dir
21991 The list of configuration for some clients.
21992
21993 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21994
21995 Available @code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} fields are:
21996
21997 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} string name
21998 Client name.
21999
22000 Defaults to @samp{"client"}.
22001
22002 @end deftypevr
22003
22004 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask iroute
22005 Client own network
22006
22007 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22008
22009 @end deftypevr
22010
22011 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask ifconfig-push
22012 Client VPN IP.
22013
22014 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22015
22016 @end deftypevr
22017
22018 @end deftypevr
22019
22020
22021 @c %end of automatic openvpn-server documentation
22022
22023
22024 @node Network File System
22025 @subsection Network File System
22026 @cindex NFS
22027
22028 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
22029 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
22030 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
22031
22032 While it is possible to use the individual components that together make
22033 up a Network File System service, we recommended to configure an NFS
22034 server with the @code{nfs-service-type}.
22035
22036 @subsubheading NFS Service
22037 @cindex NFS, server
22038
22039 The NFS service takes care of setting up all NFS component services,
22040 kernel configuration file systems, and installs configuration files in
22041 the locations that NFS expects.
22042
22043 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nfs-service-type
22044 A service type for a complete NFS server.
22045 @end defvr
22046
22047 @deftp {Data Type} nfs-configuration
22048 This data type represents the configuration of the NFS service and all
22049 of its subsystems.
22050
22051 It has the following parameters:
22052 @table @asis
22053 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
22054 The nfs-utils package to use.
22055
22056 @item @code{nfs-version} (default: @code{#f})
22057 If a string value is provided, the @command{rpc.nfsd} daemon will be
22058 limited to supporting the given version of the NFS protocol.
22059
22060 @item @code{exports} (default: @code{'()})
22061 This is a list of directories the NFS server should export. Each entry
22062 is a list consisting of two elements: a directory name and a string
22063 containing all options. This is an example in which the directory
22064 @file{/export} is served to all NFS clients as a read-only share:
22065
22066 @lisp
22067 (nfs-configuration
22068 (exports
22069 '(("/export"
22070 "*(ro,insecure,no_subtree_check,crossmnt,fsid=0)"))))
22071 @end lisp
22072
22073 @item @code{rpcmountd-port} (default: @code{#f})
22074 The network port that the @command{rpc.mountd} daemon should use.
22075
22076 @item @code{rpcstatd-port} (default: @code{#f})
22077 The network port that the @command{rpc.statd} daemon should use.
22078
22079 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
22080 The rpcbind package to use.
22081
22082 @item @code{idmap-domain} (default: @code{"localdomain"})
22083 The local NFSv4 domain name.
22084
22085 @item @code{nfsd-port} (default: @code{2049})
22086 The network port that the @command{nfsd} daemon should use.
22087
22088 @item @code{nfsd-threads} (default: @code{8})
22089 The number of threads used by the @command{nfsd} daemon.
22090
22091 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
22092 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
22093
22094 @item @code{debug} (default: @code{'()"})
22095 A list of subsystems for which debugging output should be enabled. This
22096 is a list of symbols. Any of these symbols are valid: @code{nfsd},
22097 @code{nfs}, @code{rpc}, @code{idmap}, @code{statd}, or @code{mountd}.
22098 @end table
22099 @end deftp
22100
22101 If you don't need a complete NFS service or prefer to build it yourself
22102 you can use the individual component services that are documented below.
22103
22104 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
22105 @cindex rpcbind
22106
22107 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
22108 universal addresses.
22109 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
22110 started when a dependent service starts.
22111
22112 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
22113 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
22114 @end defvr
22115
22116
22117 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
22118 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
22119 This type has the following parameters:
22120 @table @asis
22121 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
22122 The rpcbind package to use.
22123
22124 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
22125 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
22126 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
22127 instance.
22128 @end table
22129 @end deftp
22130
22131
22132 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
22133 @cindex pipefs
22134 @cindex rpc_pipefs
22135
22136 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
22137 between the kernel and user space programs.
22138
22139 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
22140 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
22141 @end defvr
22142
22143 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
22144 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
22145 This type has the following parameters:
22146 @table @asis
22147 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
22148 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
22149 @end table
22150 @end deftp
22151
22152
22153 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
22154 @cindex GSSD
22155 @cindex GSS
22156 @cindex global security system
22157
22158 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
22159 based protocols.
22160 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
22161 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
22162 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
22163
22164 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
22165 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
22166 @end defvr
22167
22168 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
22169 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
22170 This type has the following parameters:
22171 @table @asis
22172 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
22173 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
22174
22175 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
22176 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
22177
22178 @end table
22179 @end deftp
22180
22181
22182 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
22183 @cindex idmapd
22184 @cindex name mapper
22185
22186 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
22187 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
22188
22189 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
22190 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
22191 @end defvr
22192
22193 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
22194 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
22195 This type has the following parameters:
22196 @table @asis
22197 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
22198 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
22199
22200 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
22201 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
22202
22203 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
22204 The local NFSv4 domain name.
22205 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
22206 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
22207
22208 @item @code{verbosity} (default: @code{0})
22209 The verbosity level of the daemon.
22210
22211 @end table
22212 @end deftp
22213
22214 @node Continuous Integration
22215 @subsection Continuous Integration
22216
22217 @cindex continuous integration
22218 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix/guix-cuirass.git, Cuirass} is a
22219 continuous integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and
22220 for providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
22221
22222 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
22223
22224 @defvr {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service-type
22225 The type of the Cuirass service. Its value must be a
22226 @code{cuirass-configuration} object, as described below.
22227 @end defvr
22228
22229 To add build jobs, you have to set the @code{specifications} field of the
22230 configuration. Here is an example of a service that polls the Guix repository
22231 and builds the packages from a manifest. Some of the packages are defined in
22232 the @code{"custom-packages"} input, which is the equivalent of
22233 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}.
22234
22235 @lisp
22236 (define %cuirass-specs
22237 #~(list
22238 '((#:name . "my-manifest")
22239 (#:load-path-inputs . ("guix"))
22240 (#:package-path-inputs . ("custom-packages"))
22241 (#:proc-input . "guix")
22242 (#:proc-file . "build-aux/cuirass/gnu-system.scm")
22243 (#:proc . cuirass-jobs)
22244 (#:proc-args . ((subset . "manifests")
22245 (systems . ("x86_64-linux"))
22246 (manifests . (("config" . "guix/manifest.scm")))))
22247 (#:inputs . (((#:name . "guix")
22248 (#:url . "git://git.savannah.gnu.org/guix.git")
22249 (#:load-path . ".")
22250 (#:branch . "master")
22251 (#:no-compile? . #t))
22252 ((#:name . "config")
22253 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/config.git")
22254 (#:load-path . ".")
22255 (#:branch . "master")
22256 (#:no-compile? . #t))
22257 ((#:name . "custom-packages")
22258 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/custom-packages.git")
22259 (#:load-path . ".")
22260 (#:branch . "master")
22261 (#:no-compile? . #t)))))))
22262
22263 (service cuirass-service-type
22264 (cuirass-configuration
22265 (specifications %cuirass-specs)))
22266 @end lisp
22267
22268 While information related to build jobs is located directly in the
22269 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
22270 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
22271
22272 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
22273 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
22274
22275 @table @asis
22276 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass.log"})
22277 Location of the log file.
22278
22279 @item @code{web-log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass-web.log"})
22280 Location of the log file used by the web interface.
22281
22282 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{"/var/cache/cuirass"})
22283 Location of the repository cache.
22284
22285 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
22286 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
22287
22288 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
22289 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
22290
22291 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
22292 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
22293 Cuirass jobs.
22294
22295 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/lib/cuirass/cuirass.db"})
22296 Location of sqlite database which contains the build results and previously
22297 added specifications.
22298
22299 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
22300 Specifies the time-to-live (TTL) in seconds of garbage collector roots that
22301 are registered for build results. This means that build results are protected
22302 from garbage collection for at least @var{ttl} seconds.
22303
22304 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8081})
22305 Port number used by the HTTP server.
22306
22307 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
22308 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
22309 accept connections from localhost.
22310
22311 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{#~'()})
22312 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) that evaluates to a list of specifications,
22313 where a specification is an association list
22314 (@pxref{Associations Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) whose
22315 keys are keywords (@code{#:keyword-example}) as shown in the example
22316 above.
22317
22318 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
22319 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
22320 from source.
22321
22322 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
22323 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
22324
22325 @item @code{fallback?} (default: @code{#f})
22326 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
22327 packages locally.
22328
22329 @item @code{cuirass} (default: @code{cuirass})
22330 The Cuirass package to use.
22331 @end table
22332 @end deftp
22333
22334 @node Power Management Services
22335 @subsection Power Management Services
22336
22337 @cindex tlp
22338 @cindex power management with TLP
22339 @subsubheading TLP daemon
22340
22341 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides a Guix service definition
22342 for the Linux power management tool TLP.
22343
22344 TLP enables various powersaving modes in userspace and kernel.
22345 Contrary to @code{upower-service}, it is not a passive,
22346 monitoring tool, as it will apply custom settings each time a new power
22347 source is detected. More information can be found at
22348 @uref{https://linrunner.de/en/tlp/tlp.html, TLP home page}.
22349
22350 @deffn {Scheme Variable} tlp-service-type
22351 The service type for the TLP tool. Its value should be a valid
22352 TLP configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
22353 write:
22354 @lisp
22355 (service tlp-service-type)
22356 @end lisp
22357 @end deffn
22358
22359 By default TLP does not need much configuration but most TLP parameters
22360 can be tweaked using @code{tlp-configuration}.
22361
22362 Each parameter definition is preceded by its type; for example,
22363 @samp{boolean foo} indicates that the @code{foo} parameter
22364 should be specified as a boolean. Types starting with
22365 @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't show up in TLP config file
22366 when their value is @code{'disabled}.
22367
22368 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
22369 @c (generate-tlp-documentation) in (gnu services pm). Manually maintained
22370 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
22371 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
22372 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
22373 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
22374 @c the churn as TLP updates.
22375
22376 Available @code{tlp-configuration} fields are:
22377
22378 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} package tlp
22379 The TLP package.
22380
22381 @end deftypevr
22382
22383 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean tlp-enable?
22384 Set to true if you wish to enable TLP.
22385
22386 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22387
22388 @end deftypevr
22389
22390 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string tlp-default-mode
22391 Default mode when no power supply can be detected. Alternatives are AC
22392 and BAT.
22393
22394 Defaults to @samp{"AC"}.
22395
22396 @end deftypevr
22397
22398 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-ac
22399 Number of seconds Linux kernel has to wait after the disk goes idle,
22400 before syncing on AC.
22401
22402 Defaults to @samp{0}.
22403
22404 @end deftypevr
22405
22406 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-bat
22407 Same as @code{disk-idle-ac} but on BAT mode.
22408
22409 Defaults to @samp{2}.
22410
22411 @end deftypevr
22412
22413 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-ac
22414 Dirty pages flushing periodicity, expressed in seconds.
22415
22416 Defaults to @samp{15}.
22417
22418 @end deftypevr
22419
22420 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-bat
22421 Same as @code{max-lost-work-secs-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
22422
22423 Defaults to @samp{60}.
22424
22425 @end deftypevr
22426
22427 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac
22428 CPU frequency scaling governor on AC mode. With intel_pstate driver,
22429 alternatives are powersave and performance. With acpi-cpufreq driver,
22430 alternatives are ondemand, powersave, performance and conservative.
22431
22432 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22433
22434 @end deftypevr
22435
22436 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-bat
22437 Same as @code{cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
22438
22439 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22440
22441 @end deftypevr
22442
22443 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-ac
22444 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
22445
22446 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22447
22448 @end deftypevr
22449
22450 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-ac
22451 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
22452
22453 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22454
22455 @end deftypevr
22456
22457 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-bat
22458 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
22459
22460 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22461
22462 @end deftypevr
22463
22464 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-bat
22465 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
22466
22467 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22468
22469 @end deftypevr
22470
22471 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-ac
22472 Limit the min P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
22473 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
22474
22475 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22476
22477 @end deftypevr
22478
22479 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-ac
22480 Limit the max P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
22481 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
22482
22483 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22484
22485 @end deftypevr
22486
22487 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-bat
22488 Same as @code{cpu-min-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
22489
22490 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22491
22492 @end deftypevr
22493
22494 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-bat
22495 Same as @code{cpu-max-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
22496
22497 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22498
22499 @end deftypevr
22500
22501 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-ac?
22502 Enable CPU turbo boost feature on AC mode.
22503
22504 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22505
22506 @end deftypevr
22507
22508 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-bat?
22509 Same as @code{cpu-boost-on-ac?} on BAT mode.
22510
22511 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22512
22513 @end deftypevr
22514
22515 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-ac?
22516 Allow Linux kernel to minimize the number of CPU cores/hyper-threads
22517 used under light load conditions.
22518
22519 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22520
22521 @end deftypevr
22522
22523 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-bat?
22524 Same as @code{sched-powersave-on-ac?} but on BAT mode.
22525
22526 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22527
22528 @end deftypevr
22529
22530 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean nmi-watchdog?
22531 Enable Linux kernel NMI watchdog.
22532
22533 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22534
22535 @end deftypevr
22536
22537 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string phc-controls
22538 For Linux kernels with PHC patch applied, change CPU voltages. An
22539 example value would be @samp{"F:V F:V F:V F:V"}.
22540
22541 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22542
22543 @end deftypevr
22544
22545 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-ac
22546 Set CPU performance versus energy saving policy on AC. Alternatives are
22547 performance, normal, powersave.
22548
22549 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
22550
22551 @end deftypevr
22552
22553 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-bat
22554 Same as @code{energy-perf-policy-ac} but on BAT mode.
22555
22556 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
22557
22558 @end deftypevr
22559
22560 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disks-devices
22561 Hard disk devices.
22562
22563 @end deftypevr
22564
22565 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-ac
22566 Hard disk advanced power management level.
22567
22568 @end deftypevr
22569
22570 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-bat
22571 Same as @code{disk-apm-bat} but on BAT mode.
22572
22573 @end deftypevr
22574
22575 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac
22576 Hard disk spin down timeout. One value has to be specified for each
22577 declared hard disk.
22578
22579 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22580
22581 @end deftypevr
22582
22583 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-bat
22584 Same as @code{disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
22585
22586 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22587
22588 @end deftypevr
22589
22590 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-iosched
22591 Select IO scheduler for disk devices. One value has to be specified for
22592 each declared hard disk. Example alternatives are cfq, deadline and
22593 noop.
22594
22595 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22596
22597 @end deftypevr
22598
22599 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-ac
22600 SATA aggressive link power management (ALPM) level. Alternatives are
22601 min_power, medium_power, max_performance.
22602
22603 Defaults to @samp{"max_performance"}.
22604
22605 @end deftypevr
22606
22607 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-bat
22608 Same as @code{sata-linkpwr-ac} but on BAT mode.
22609
22610 Defaults to @samp{"min_power"}.
22611
22612 @end deftypevr
22613
22614 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sata-linkpwr-blacklist
22615 Exclude specified SATA host devices for link power management.
22616
22617 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22618
22619 @end deftypevr
22620
22621 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac?
22622 Enable Runtime Power Management for AHCI controller and disks on AC
22623 mode.
22624
22625 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22626
22627 @end deftypevr
22628
22629 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-bat?
22630 Same as @code{ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac} on BAT mode.
22631
22632 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22633
22634 @end deftypevr
22635
22636 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer ahci-runtime-pm-timeout
22637 Seconds of inactivity before disk is suspended.
22638
22639 Defaults to @samp{15}.
22640
22641 @end deftypevr
22642
22643 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-ac
22644 PCI Express Active State Power Management level. Alternatives are
22645 default, performance, powersave.
22646
22647 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
22648
22649 @end deftypevr
22650
22651 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-bat
22652 Same as @code{pcie-aspm-ac} but on BAT mode.
22653
22654 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
22655
22656 @end deftypevr
22657
22658 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-ac
22659 Radeon graphics clock speed level. Alternatives are low, mid, high,
22660 auto, default.
22661
22662 Defaults to @samp{"high"}.
22663
22664 @end deftypevr
22665
22666 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-bat
22667 Same as @code{radeon-power-ac} but on BAT mode.
22668
22669 Defaults to @samp{"low"}.
22670
22671 @end deftypevr
22672
22673 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-ac
22674 Radeon dynamic power management method (DPM). Alternatives are battery,
22675 performance.
22676
22677 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
22678
22679 @end deftypevr
22680
22681 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-bat
22682 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-state-ac} but on BAT mode.
22683
22684 Defaults to @samp{"battery"}.
22685
22686 @end deftypevr
22687
22688 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-ac
22689 Radeon DPM performance level. Alternatives are auto, low, high.
22690
22691 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
22692
22693 @end deftypevr
22694
22695 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-bat
22696 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-perf-ac} but on BAT mode.
22697
22698 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
22699
22700 @end deftypevr
22701
22702 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-ac?
22703 Wifi power saving mode.
22704
22705 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22706
22707 @end deftypevr
22708
22709 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-bat?
22710 Same as @code{wifi-power-ac?} but on BAT mode.
22711
22712 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22713
22714 @end deftypevr
22715
22716 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean wol-disable?
22717 Disable wake on LAN.
22718
22719 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22720
22721 @end deftypevr
22722
22723 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-ac
22724 Timeout duration in seconds before activating audio power saving on
22725 Intel HDA and AC97 devices. A value of 0 disables power saving.
22726
22727 Defaults to @samp{0}.
22728
22729 @end deftypevr
22730
22731 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-bat
22732 Same as @code{sound-powersave-ac} but on BAT mode.
22733
22734 Defaults to @samp{1}.
22735
22736 @end deftypevr
22737
22738 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean sound-power-save-controller?
22739 Disable controller in powersaving mode on Intel HDA devices.
22740
22741 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22742
22743 @end deftypevr
22744
22745 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean bay-poweroff-on-bat?
22746 Enable optical drive in UltraBay/MediaBay on BAT mode. Drive can be
22747 powered on again by releasing (and reinserting) the eject lever or by
22748 pressing the disc eject button on newer models.
22749
22750 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22751
22752 @end deftypevr
22753
22754 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string bay-device
22755 Name of the optical drive device to power off.
22756
22757 Defaults to @samp{"sr0"}.
22758
22759 @end deftypevr
22760
22761 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-ac
22762 Runtime Power Management for PCI(e) bus devices. Alternatives are on
22763 and auto.
22764
22765 Defaults to @samp{"on"}.
22766
22767 @end deftypevr
22768
22769 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-bat
22770 Same as @code{runtime-pm-ac} but on BAT mode.
22771
22772 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
22773
22774 @end deftypevr
22775
22776 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean runtime-pm-all?
22777 Runtime Power Management for all PCI(e) bus devices, except blacklisted
22778 ones.
22779
22780 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22781
22782 @end deftypevr
22783
22784 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-blacklist
22785 Exclude specified PCI(e) device addresses from Runtime Power Management.
22786
22787 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22788
22789 @end deftypevr
22790
22791 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-driver-blacklist
22792 Exclude PCI(e) devices assigned to the specified drivers from Runtime
22793 Power Management.
22794
22795 @end deftypevr
22796
22797 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-autosuspend?
22798 Enable USB autosuspend feature.
22799
22800 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22801
22802 @end deftypevr
22803
22804 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-blacklist
22805 Exclude specified devices from USB autosuspend.
22806
22807 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22808
22809 @end deftypevr
22810
22811 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-blacklist-wwan?
22812 Exclude WWAN devices from USB autosuspend.
22813
22814 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22815
22816 @end deftypevr
22817
22818 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-whitelist
22819 Include specified devices into USB autosuspend, even if they are already
22820 excluded by the driver or via @code{usb-blacklist-wwan?}.
22821
22822 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22823
22824 @end deftypevr
22825
22826 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean usb-autosuspend-disable-on-shutdown?
22827 Enable USB autosuspend before shutdown.
22828
22829 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22830
22831 @end deftypevr
22832
22833 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean restore-device-state-on-startup?
22834 Restore radio device state (bluetooth, wifi, wwan) from previous
22835 shutdown on system startup.
22836
22837 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22838
22839 @end deftypevr
22840
22841 @cindex thermald
22842 @cindex CPU frequency scaling with thermald
22843 @subsubheading Thermald daemon
22844
22845 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides an interface to
22846 thermald, a CPU frequency scaling service which helps prevent overheating.
22847
22848 @defvr {Scheme Variable} thermald-service-type
22849 This is the service type for
22850 @uref{https://01.org/linux-thermal-daemon/, thermald}, the Linux
22851 Thermal Daemon, which is responsible for controlling the thermal state
22852 of processors and preventing overheating.
22853 @end defvr
22854
22855 @deftp {Data Type} thermald-configuration
22856 Data type representing the configuration of @code{thermald-service-type}.
22857
22858 @table @asis
22859 @item @code{ignore-cpuid-check?} (default: @code{#f})
22860 Ignore cpuid check for supported CPU models.
22861
22862 @item @code{thermald} (default: @var{thermald})
22863 Package object of thermald.
22864
22865 @end table
22866 @end deftp
22867
22868 @node Audio Services
22869 @subsection Audio Services
22870
22871 The @code{(gnu services audio)} module provides a service to start MPD
22872 (the Music Player Daemon).
22873
22874 @cindex mpd
22875 @subsubheading Music Player Daemon
22876
22877 The Music Player Daemon (MPD) is a service that can play music while
22878 being controlled from the local machine or over the network by a variety
22879 of clients.
22880
22881 The following example shows how one might run @code{mpd} as user
22882 @code{"bob"} on port @code{6666}. It uses pulseaudio for output.
22883
22884 @lisp
22885 (service mpd-service-type
22886 (mpd-configuration
22887 (user "bob")
22888 (port "6666")))
22889 @end lisp
22890
22891 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mpd-service-type
22892 The service type for @command{mpd}
22893 @end defvr
22894
22895 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-configuration
22896 Data type representing the configuration of @command{mpd}.
22897
22898 @table @asis
22899 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"mpd"})
22900 The user to run mpd as.
22901
22902 @item @code{music-dir} (default: @code{"~/Music"})
22903 The directory to scan for music files.
22904
22905 @item @code{playlist-dir} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/playlists"})
22906 The directory to store playlists.
22907
22908 @item @code{db-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/tag_cache"})
22909 The location of the music database.
22910
22911 @item @code{state-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/state"})
22912 The location of the file that stores current MPD's state.
22913
22914 @item @code{sticker-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/sticker.sql"})
22915 The location of the sticker database.
22916
22917 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"6600"})
22918 The port to run mpd on.
22919
22920 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"any"})
22921 The address that mpd will bind to. To use a Unix domain socket,
22922 an absolute path can be specified here.
22923
22924 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{"(list (mpd-output))"})
22925 The audio outputs that MPD can use. By default this is a single output using pulseaudio.
22926
22927 @end table
22928 @end deftp
22929
22930 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-output
22931 Data type representing an @command{mpd} audio output.
22932
22933 @table @asis
22934 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"MPD"})
22935 The name of the audio output.
22936
22937 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"pulse"})
22938 The type of audio output.
22939
22940 @item @code{enabled?} (default: @code{#t})
22941 Specifies whether this audio output is enabled when MPD is started. By
22942 default, all audio outputs are enabled. This is just the default
22943 setting when there is no state file; with a state file, the previous
22944 state is restored.
22945
22946 @item @code{tags?} (default: @code{#t})
22947 If set to @code{#f}, then MPD will not send tags to this output. This
22948 is only useful for output plugins that can receive tags, for example the
22949 @code{httpd} output plugin.
22950
22951 @item @code{always-on?} (default: @code{#f})
22952 If set to @code{#t}, then MPD attempts to keep this audio output always
22953 open. This may be useful for streaming servers, when you don’t want to
22954 disconnect all listeners even when playback is accidentally stopped.
22955
22956 @item @code{mixer-type}
22957 This field accepts a symbol that specifies which mixer should be used
22958 for this audio output: the @code{hardware} mixer, the @code{software}
22959 mixer, the @code{null} mixer (allows setting the volume, but with no
22960 effect; this can be used as a trick to implement an external mixer
22961 External Mixer) or no mixer (@code{none}).
22962
22963 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()"})
22964 An association list of option symbols to string values to be appended to
22965 the audio output configuration.
22966
22967 @end table
22968 @end deftp
22969
22970 The following example shows a configuration of @code{mpd} that provides
22971 an HTTP audio streaming output.
22972
22973 @lisp
22974 (service mpd-service-type
22975 (mpd-configuration
22976 (outputs
22977 (list (mpd-output
22978 (name "streaming")
22979 (type "httpd")
22980 (mixer-type 'null)
22981 (extra-options
22982 `((encoder . "vorbis")
22983 (port . "8080"))))))))
22984 @end lisp
22985
22986
22987 @node Virtualization Services
22988 @subsection Virtualization services
22989
22990 The @code{(gnu services virtualization)} module provides services for
22991 the libvirt and virtlog daemons, as well as other virtualization-related
22992 services.
22993
22994 @subsubheading Libvirt daemon
22995 @code{libvirtd} is the server side daemon component of the libvirt
22996 virtualization management system. This daemon runs on host servers
22997 and performs required management tasks for virtualized guests.
22998
22999 @deffn {Scheme Variable} libvirt-service-type
23000 This is the type of the @uref{https://libvirt.org, libvirt daemon}.
23001 Its value must be a @code{libvirt-configuration}.
23002
23003 @lisp
23004 (service libvirt-service-type
23005 (libvirt-configuration
23006 (unix-sock-group "libvirt")
23007 (tls-port "16555")))
23008 @end lisp
23009 @end deffn
23010
23011 @c Auto-generated with (generate-libvirt-documentation)
23012 Available @code{libvirt-configuration} fields are:
23013
23014 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} package libvirt
23015 Libvirt package.
23016
23017 @end deftypevr
23018
23019 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tls?
23020 Flag listening for secure TLS connections on the public TCP/IP port.
23021 must set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
23022
23023 It is necessary to setup a CA and issue server certificates before using
23024 this capability.
23025
23026 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23027
23028 @end deftypevr
23029
23030 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tcp?
23031 Listen for unencrypted TCP connections on the public TCP/IP port. must
23032 set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
23033
23034 Using the TCP socket requires SASL authentication by default. Only SASL
23035 mechanisms which support data encryption are allowed. This is
23036 DIGEST_MD5 and GSSAPI (Kerberos5)
23037
23038 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23039
23040 @end deftypevr
23041
23042 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-port
23043 Port for accepting secure TLS connections This can be a port number, or
23044 service name
23045
23046 Defaults to @samp{"16514"}.
23047
23048 @end deftypevr
23049
23050 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tcp-port
23051 Port for accepting insecure TCP connections This can be a port number,
23052 or service name
23053
23054 Defaults to @samp{"16509"}.
23055
23056 @end deftypevr
23057
23058 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string listen-addr
23059 IP address or hostname used for client connections.
23060
23061 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
23062
23063 @end deftypevr
23064
23065 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean mdns-adv?
23066 Flag toggling mDNS advertisement of the libvirt service.
23067
23068 Alternatively can disable for all services on a host by stopping the
23069 Avahi daemon.
23070
23071 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23072
23073 @end deftypevr
23074
23075 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string mdns-name
23076 Default mDNS advertisement name. This must be unique on the immediate
23077 broadcast network.
23078
23079 Defaults to @samp{"Virtualization Host <hostname>"}.
23080
23081 @end deftypevr
23082
23083 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-group
23084 UNIX domain socket group ownership. This can be used to allow a
23085 'trusted' set of users access to management capabilities without
23086 becoming root.
23087
23088 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
23089
23090 @end deftypevr
23091
23092 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-ro-perms
23093 UNIX socket permissions for the R/O socket. This is used for monitoring
23094 VM status only.
23095
23096 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
23097
23098 @end deftypevr
23099
23100 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-rw-perms
23101 UNIX socket permissions for the R/W socket. Default allows only root.
23102 If PolicyKit is enabled on the socket, the default will change to allow
23103 everyone (eg, 0777)
23104
23105 Defaults to @samp{"0770"}.
23106
23107 @end deftypevr
23108
23109 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-admin-perms
23110 UNIX socket permissions for the admin socket. Default allows only owner
23111 (root), do not change it unless you are sure to whom you are exposing
23112 the access to.
23113
23114 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
23115
23116 @end deftypevr
23117
23118 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-dir
23119 The directory in which sockets will be found/created.
23120
23121 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/libvirt"}.
23122
23123 @end deftypevr
23124
23125 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-ro
23126 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-only sockets. By default socket
23127 permissions allow anyone to connect
23128
23129 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
23130
23131 @end deftypevr
23132
23133 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-rw
23134 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-write sockets. By default socket
23135 permissions only allow root. If PolicyKit support was compiled into
23136 libvirt, the default will be to use 'polkit' auth.
23137
23138 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
23139
23140 @end deftypevr
23141
23142 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tcp
23143 Authentication scheme for TCP sockets. If you don't enable SASL, then
23144 all TCP traffic is cleartext. Don't do this outside of a dev/test
23145 scenario.
23146
23147 Defaults to @samp{"sasl"}.
23148
23149 @end deftypevr
23150
23151 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tls
23152 Authentication scheme for TLS sockets. TLS sockets already have
23153 encryption provided by the TLS layer, and limited authentication is done
23154 by certificates.
23155
23156 It is possible to make use of any SASL authentication mechanism as well,
23157 by using 'sasl' for this option
23158
23159 Defaults to @samp{"none"}.
23160
23161 @end deftypevr
23162
23163 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list access-drivers
23164 API access control scheme.
23165
23166 By default an authenticated user is allowed access to all APIs. Access
23167 drivers can place restrictions on this.
23168
23169 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23170
23171 @end deftypevr
23172
23173 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string key-file
23174 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no private key is
23175 loaded.
23176
23177 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23178
23179 @end deftypevr
23180
23181 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string cert-file
23182 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no certificate is
23183 loaded.
23184
23185 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23186
23187 @end deftypevr
23188
23189 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string ca-file
23190 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no CA certificate
23191 is loaded.
23192
23193 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23194
23195 @end deftypevr
23196
23197 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string crl-file
23198 Certificate revocation list path. If set to an empty string, then no
23199 CRL is loaded.
23200
23201 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23202
23203 @end deftypevr
23204
23205 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-sanity-cert
23206 Disable verification of our own server certificates.
23207
23208 When libvirtd starts it performs some sanity checks against its own
23209 certificates.
23210
23211 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23212
23213 @end deftypevr
23214
23215 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-verify-cert
23216 Disable verification of client certificates.
23217
23218 Client certificate verification is the primary authentication mechanism.
23219 Any client which does not present a certificate signed by the CA will be
23220 rejected.
23221
23222 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23223
23224 @end deftypevr
23225
23226 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list tls-allowed-dn-list
23227 Whitelist of allowed x509 Distinguished Name.
23228
23229 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23230
23231 @end deftypevr
23232
23233 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list sasl-allowed-usernames
23234 Whitelist of allowed SASL usernames. The format for username depends on
23235 the SASL authentication mechanism.
23236
23237 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23238
23239 @end deftypevr
23240
23241 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-priority
23242 Override the compile time default TLS priority string. The default is
23243 usually "NORMAL" unless overridden at build time. Only set this is it
23244 is desired for libvirt to deviate from the global default settings.
23245
23246 Defaults to @samp{"NORMAL"}.
23247
23248 @end deftypevr
23249
23250 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
23251 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
23252 sockets combined.
23253
23254 Defaults to @samp{5000}.
23255
23256 @end deftypevr
23257
23258 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-queued-clients
23259 Maximum length of queue of connections waiting to be accepted by the
23260 daemon. Note, that some protocols supporting retransmission may obey
23261 this so that a later reattempt at connection succeeds.
23262
23263 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
23264
23265 @end deftypevr
23266
23267 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-anonymous-clients
23268 Maximum length of queue of accepted but not yet authenticated clients.
23269 Set this to zero to turn this feature off
23270
23271 Defaults to @samp{20}.
23272
23273 @end deftypevr
23274
23275 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer min-workers
23276 Number of workers to start up initially.
23277
23278 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23279
23280 @end deftypevr
23281
23282 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-workers
23283 Maximum number of worker threads.
23284
23285 If the number of active clients exceeds @code{min-workers}, then more
23286 threads are spawned, up to max_workers limit. Typically you'd want
23287 max_workers to equal maximum number of clients allowed.
23288
23289 Defaults to @samp{20}.
23290
23291 @end deftypevr
23292
23293 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer prio-workers
23294 Number of priority workers. If all workers from above pool are stuck,
23295 some calls marked as high priority (notably domainDestroy) can be
23296 executed in this pool.
23297
23298 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23299
23300 @end deftypevr
23301
23302 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-requests
23303 Total global limit on concurrent RPC calls.
23304
23305 Defaults to @samp{20}.
23306
23307 @end deftypevr
23308
23309 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-client-requests
23310 Limit on concurrent requests from a single client connection. To avoid
23311 one client monopolizing the server this should be a small fraction of
23312 the global max_requests and max_workers parameter.
23313
23314 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23315
23316 @end deftypevr
23317
23318 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-min-workers
23319 Same as @code{min-workers} but for the admin interface.
23320
23321 Defaults to @samp{1}.
23322
23323 @end deftypevr
23324
23325 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-workers
23326 Same as @code{max-workers} but for the admin interface.
23327
23328 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23329
23330 @end deftypevr
23331
23332 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-clients
23333 Same as @code{max-clients} but for the admin interface.
23334
23335 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23336
23337 @end deftypevr
23338
23339 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-queued-clients
23340 Same as @code{max-queued-clients} but for the admin interface.
23341
23342 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23343
23344 @end deftypevr
23345
23346 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-client-requests
23347 Same as @code{max-client-requests} but for the admin interface.
23348
23349 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23350
23351 @end deftypevr
23352
23353 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
23354 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
23355
23356 Defaults to @samp{3}.
23357
23358 @end deftypevr
23359
23360 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
23361 Logging filters.
23362
23363 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
23364 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
23365
23366 @itemize @bullet
23367 @item
23368 x:name
23369
23370 @item
23371 x:+name
23372
23373 @end itemize
23374
23375 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
23376 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
23377 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
23378 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
23379 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
23380 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
23381 where matching messages should be logged:
23382
23383 @itemize @bullet
23384 @item
23385 1: DEBUG
23386
23387 @item
23388 2: INFO
23389
23390 @item
23391 3: WARNING
23392
23393 @item
23394 4: ERROR
23395
23396 @end itemize
23397
23398 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
23399 need to be separated by spaces.
23400
23401 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
23402
23403 @end deftypevr
23404
23405 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
23406 Logging outputs.
23407
23408 An output is one of the places to save logging information. The format
23409 for an output can be:
23410
23411 @table @code
23412 @item x:stderr
23413 output goes to stderr
23414
23415 @item x:syslog:name
23416 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
23417
23418 @item x:file:file_path
23419 output to a file, with the given filepath
23420
23421 @item x:journald
23422 output to journald logging system
23423
23424 @end table
23425
23426 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
23427
23428 @itemize @bullet
23429 @item
23430 1: DEBUG
23431
23432 @item
23433 2: INFO
23434
23435 @item
23436 3: WARNING
23437
23438 @item
23439 4: ERROR
23440
23441 @end itemize
23442
23443 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
23444 spaces.
23445
23446 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
23447
23448 @end deftypevr
23449
23450 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer audit-level
23451 Allows usage of the auditing subsystem to be altered
23452
23453 @itemize @bullet
23454 @item
23455 0: disable all auditing
23456
23457 @item
23458 1: enable auditing, only if enabled on host
23459
23460 @item
23461 2: enable auditing, and exit if disabled on host.
23462
23463 @end itemize
23464
23465 Defaults to @samp{1}.
23466
23467 @end deftypevr
23468
23469 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean audit-logging
23470 Send audit messages via libvirt logging infrastructure.
23471
23472 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23473
23474 @end deftypevr
23475
23476 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-string host-uuid
23477 Host UUID. UUID must not have all digits be the same.
23478
23479 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23480
23481 @end deftypevr
23482
23483 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string host-uuid-source
23484 Source to read host UUID.
23485
23486 @itemize @bullet
23487 @item
23488 @code{smbios}: fetch the UUID from @code{dmidecode -s system-uuid}
23489
23490 @item
23491 @code{machine-id}: fetch the UUID from @code{/etc/machine-id}
23492
23493 @end itemize
23494
23495 If @code{dmidecode} does not provide a valid UUID a temporary UUID will
23496 be generated.
23497
23498 Defaults to @samp{"smbios"}.
23499
23500 @end deftypevr
23501
23502 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-interval
23503 A keepalive message is sent to a client after @code{keepalive_interval}
23504 seconds of inactivity to check if the client is still responding. If
23505 set to -1, libvirtd will never send keepalive requests; however clients
23506 can still send them and the daemon will send responses.
23507
23508 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23509
23510 @end deftypevr
23511
23512 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-count
23513 Maximum number of keepalive messages that are allowed to be sent to the
23514 client without getting any response before the connection is considered
23515 broken.
23516
23517 In other words, the connection is automatically closed approximately
23518 after @code{keepalive_interval * (keepalive_count + 1)} seconds since
23519 the last message received from the client. When @code{keepalive-count}
23520 is set to 0, connections will be automatically closed after
23521 @code{keepalive-interval} seconds of inactivity without sending any
23522 keepalive messages.
23523
23524 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23525
23526 @end deftypevr
23527
23528 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-interval
23529 Same as above but for admin interface.
23530
23531 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23532
23533 @end deftypevr
23534
23535 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-count
23536 Same as above but for admin interface.
23537
23538 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23539
23540 @end deftypevr
23541
23542 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer ovs-timeout
23543 Timeout for Open vSwitch calls.
23544
23545 The @code{ovs-vsctl} utility is used for the configuration and its
23546 timeout option is set by default to 5 seconds to avoid potential
23547 infinite waits blocking libvirt.
23548
23549 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23550
23551 @end deftypevr
23552
23553 @c %end of autogenerated docs
23554
23555 @subsubheading Virtlog daemon
23556 The virtlogd service is a server side daemon component of libvirt that is
23557 used to manage logs from virtual machine consoles.
23558
23559 This daemon is not used directly by libvirt client applications, rather it
23560 is called on their behalf by @code{libvirtd}. By maintaining the logs in a
23561 standalone daemon, the main @code{libvirtd} daemon can be restarted without
23562 risk of losing logs. The @code{virtlogd} daemon has the ability to re-exec()
23563 itself upon receiving @code{SIGUSR1}, to allow live upgrades without downtime.
23564
23565 @deffn {Scheme Variable} virtlog-service-type
23566 This is the type of the virtlog daemon.
23567 Its value must be a @code{virtlog-configuration}.
23568
23569 @lisp
23570 (service virtlog-service-type
23571 (virtlog-configuration
23572 (max-clients 1000)))
23573 @end lisp
23574 @end deffn
23575
23576 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
23577 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
23578
23579 Defaults to @samp{3}.
23580
23581 @end deftypevr
23582
23583 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
23584 Logging filters.
23585
23586 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
23587 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
23588
23589 @itemize @bullet
23590 @item
23591 x:name
23592
23593 @item
23594 x:+name
23595
23596 @end itemize
23597
23598 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
23599 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
23600 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
23601 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
23602 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
23603 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
23604 where matching messages should be logged:
23605
23606 @itemize @bullet
23607 @item
23608 1: DEBUG
23609
23610 @item
23611 2: INFO
23612
23613 @item
23614 3: WARNING
23615
23616 @item
23617 4: ERROR
23618
23619 @end itemize
23620
23621 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
23622 need to be separated by spaces.
23623
23624 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
23625
23626 @end deftypevr
23627
23628 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
23629 Logging outputs.
23630
23631 An output is one of the places to save logging information The format
23632 for an output can be:
23633
23634 @table @code
23635 @item x:stderr
23636 output goes to stderr
23637
23638 @item x:syslog:name
23639 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
23640
23641 @item x:file:file_path
23642 output to a file, with the given filepath
23643
23644 @item x:journald
23645 output to journald logging system
23646
23647 @end table
23648
23649 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
23650
23651 @itemize @bullet
23652 @item
23653 1: DEBUG
23654
23655 @item
23656 2: INFO
23657
23658 @item
23659 3: WARNING
23660
23661 @item
23662 4: ERROR
23663
23664 @end itemize
23665
23666 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
23667 spaces.
23668
23669 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
23670
23671 @end deftypevr
23672
23673 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
23674 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
23675 sockets combined.
23676
23677 Defaults to @samp{1024}.
23678
23679 @end deftypevr
23680
23681 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-size
23682 Maximum file size before rolling over.
23683
23684 Defaults to @samp{2MB}
23685
23686 @end deftypevr
23687
23688 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-backups
23689 Maximum number of backup files to keep.
23690
23691 Defaults to @samp{3}
23692
23693 @end deftypevr
23694
23695 @subsubheading Transparent Emulation with QEMU
23696
23697 @cindex emulation
23698 @cindex @code{binfmt_misc}
23699 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type} provides support for transparent
23700 emulation of program binaries built for different architectures---e.g.,
23701 it allows you to transparently execute an ARMv7 program on an x86_64
23702 machine. It achieves this by combining the @uref{https://www.qemu.org,
23703 QEMU} emulator and the @code{binfmt_misc} feature of the kernel Linux.
23704
23705 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qemu-binfmt-service-type
23706 This is the type of the QEMU/binfmt service for transparent emulation.
23707 Its value must be a @code{qemu-binfmt-configuration} object, which
23708 specifies the QEMU package to use as well as the architecture we want to
23709 emulated:
23710
23711 @lisp
23712 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
23713 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
23714 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm" "aarch64" "mips64el"))))
23715 @end lisp
23716
23717 In this example, we enable transparent emulation for the ARM and aarch64
23718 platforms. Running @code{herd stop qemu-binfmt} turns it off, and
23719 running @code{herd start qemu-binfmt} turns it back on (@pxref{Invoking
23720 herd, the @command{herd} command,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
23721 @end defvr
23722
23723 @deftp {Data Type} qemu-binfmt-configuration
23724 This is the configuration for the @code{qemu-binfmt} service.
23725
23726 @table @asis
23727 @item @code{platforms} (default: @code{'()})
23728 The list of emulated QEMU platforms. Each item must be a @dfn{platform
23729 object} as returned by @code{lookup-qemu-platforms} (see below).
23730
23731 @item @code{guix-support?} (default: @code{#f})
23732 When it is true, QEMU and all its dependencies are added to the build
23733 environment of @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
23734 @code{--chroot-directory} option}). This allows the @code{binfmt_misc}
23735 handlers to be used within the build environment, which in turn means
23736 that you can transparently build programs for another architecture.
23737
23738 For example, let's suppose you're on an x86_64 machine and you have this
23739 service:
23740
23741 @lisp
23742 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
23743 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
23744 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm"))
23745 (guix-support? #t)))
23746 @end lisp
23747
23748 You can run:
23749
23750 @example
23751 guix build -s armhf-linux inkscape
23752 @end example
23753
23754 @noindent
23755 and it will build Inkscape for ARMv7 @emph{as if it were a native
23756 build}, transparently using QEMU to emulate the ARMv7 CPU. Pretty handy
23757 if you'd like to test a package build for an architecture you don't have
23758 access to!
23759
23760 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu})
23761 The QEMU package to use.
23762 @end table
23763 @end deftp
23764
23765 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-qemu-platforms @var{platforms}@dots{}
23766 Return the list of QEMU platform objects corresponding to
23767 @var{platforms}@dots{}. @var{platforms} must be a list of strings
23768 corresponding to platform names, such as @code{"arm"}, @code{"sparc"},
23769 @code{"mips64el"}, and so on.
23770 @end deffn
23771
23772 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform? @var{obj}
23773 Return true if @var{obj} is a platform object.
23774 @end deffn
23775
23776 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform-name @var{platform}
23777 Return the name of @var{platform}---a string such as @code{"arm"}.
23778 @end deffn
23779
23780 @node Version Control Services
23781 @subsection Version Control Services
23782
23783 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides a service to
23784 allow remote access to local Git repositories. There are three options:
23785 the @code{git-daemon-service}, which provides access to repositories via
23786 the @code{git://} unsecured TCP-based protocol, extending the
23787 @code{nginx} web server to proxy some requests to
23788 @code{git-http-backend}, or providing a web interface with
23789 @code{cgit-service-type}.
23790
23791 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
23792
23793 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
23794 expose repositories over the Git protocol for anonymous access.
23795
23796 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
23797 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
23798 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
23799 "git-daemon-export-ok" in the repository directory.} repositories under
23800 @file{/srv/git}.
23801
23802 @end deffn
23803
23804 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
23805 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
23806
23807 @table @asis
23808 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
23809 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
23810
23811 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
23812 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
23813 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
23814
23815 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
23816 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
23817 If you run git daemon with @var{(base-path "/srv/git")} on example.com,
23818 then if you later try to pull @code{git://example.com/hello.git}, git
23819 daemon will interpret the path as @code{/srv/git/hello.git}.
23820
23821 @item @code{user-path} (default: @var{#f})
23822 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
23823 specified with empty string, requests to @code{git://host/~alice/foo} is
23824 taken as a request to access @code{foo} repository in the home directory
23825 of user @code{alice}. If @var{(user-path "path")} is specified, the
23826 same request is taken as a request to access @code{path/foo} repository
23827 in the home directory of user @code{alice}.
23828
23829 @item @code{listen} (default: @var{'()})
23830 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
23831 all.
23832
23833 @item @code{port} (default: @var{#f})
23834 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
23835
23836 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @var{'()})
23837 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
23838
23839 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
23840 Extra options will be passed to @code{git daemon}, please run
23841 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
23842
23843 @end table
23844 @end deftp
23845
23846 The @code{git://} protocol lacks authentication. When you pull from a
23847 repository fetched via @code{git://}, you don't know whether the data you
23848 receive was modified or is even coming from the specified host, and your
23849 connection is subject to eavesdropping. It's better to use an authenticated
23850 and encrypted transport, such as @code{https}. Although Git allows you
23851 to serve repositories using unsophisticated file-based web servers,
23852 there is a faster protocol implemented by the @code{git-http-backend}
23853 program. This program is the back-end of a proper Git web service. It
23854 is designed to sit behind a FastCGI proxy. @xref{Web Services}, for more
23855 on running the necessary @code{fcgiwrap} daemon.
23856
23857 Guix has a separate configuration data type for serving Git repositories
23858 over HTTP.
23859
23860 @deftp {Data Type} git-http-configuration
23861 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-http-service}.
23862
23863 @table @asis
23864 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
23865 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
23866
23867 @item @code{git-root} (default: @file{/srv/git})
23868 Directory containing the Git repositories to expose to the world.
23869
23870 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
23871 Whether to expose access for all Git repositories in @var{git-root},
23872 even if they do not have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
23873
23874 @item @code{uri-path} (default: @file{/git/})
23875 Path prefix for Git access. With the default @code{/git/} prefix, this
23876 will map @code{http://@var{server}/git/@var{repo}.git} to
23877 @code{/srv/git/@var{repo}.git}. Requests whose URI paths do not begin
23878 with this prefix are not passed on to this Git instance.
23879
23880 @item @code{fcgiwrap-socket} (default: @code{127.0.0.1:9000})
23881 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} daemon is listening. @xref{Web
23882 Services}.
23883 @end table
23884 @end deftp
23885
23886 There is no @code{git-http-service-type}, currently; instead you can
23887 create an @code{nginx-location-configuration} from a
23888 @code{git-http-configuration} and then add that location to a web
23889 server.
23890
23891 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-http-nginx-location-configuration @
23892 [config=(git-http-configuration)]
23893 Compute an @code{nginx-location-configuration} that corresponds to the
23894 given Git http configuration. An example nginx service definition to
23895 serve the default @file{/srv/git} over HTTPS might be:
23896
23897 @lisp
23898 (service nginx-service-type
23899 (nginx-configuration
23900 (server-blocks
23901 (list
23902 (nginx-server-configuration
23903 (listen '("443 ssl"))
23904 (server-name "git.my-host.org")
23905 (ssl-certificate
23906 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/fullchain.pem")
23907 (ssl-certificate-key
23908 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/privkey.pem")
23909 (locations
23910 (list
23911 (git-http-nginx-location-configuration
23912 (git-http-configuration (uri-path "/"))))))))))
23913 @end lisp
23914
23915 This example assumes that you are using Let's Encrypt to get your TLS
23916 certificate. @xref{Certificate Services}. The default @code{certbot}
23917 service will redirect all HTTP traffic on @code{git.my-host.org} to
23918 HTTPS. You will also need to add an @code{fcgiwrap} proxy to your
23919 system services. @xref{Web Services}.
23920 @end deffn
23921
23922 @subsubheading Cgit Service
23923
23924 @cindex Cgit service
23925 @cindex Git, web interface
23926 @uref{https://git.zx2c4.com/cgit/, Cgit} is a web frontend for Git
23927 repositories written in C.
23928
23929 The following example will configure the service with default values.
23930 By default, Cgit can be accessed on port 80 (@code{http://localhost:80}).
23931
23932 @lisp
23933 (service cgit-service-type)
23934 @end lisp
23935
23936 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
23937 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a string.
23938
23939 @c %start of fragment
23940
23941 Available @code{cgit-configuration} fields are:
23942
23943 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} package package
23944 The CGIT package.
23945
23946 @end deftypevr
23947
23948 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
23949 NGINX configuration.
23950
23951 @end deftypevr
23952
23953 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object about-filter
23954 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format the content of about
23955 pages (both top-level and for each repository).
23956
23957 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23958
23959 @end deftypevr
23960
23961 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string agefile
23962 Specifies a path, relative to each repository path, which can be used to
23963 specify the date and time of the youngest commit in the repository.
23964
23965 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23966
23967 @end deftypevr
23968
23969 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object auth-filter
23970 Specifies a command that will be invoked for authenticating repository
23971 access.
23972
23973 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23974
23975 @end deftypevr
23976
23977 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string branch-sort
23978 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
23979 ref list, and when set @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
23980
23981 Defaults to @samp{"name"}.
23982
23983 @end deftypevr
23984
23985 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string cache-root
23986 Path used to store the cgit cache entries.
23987
23988 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cgit"}.
23989
23990 @end deftypevr
23991
23992 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-static-ttl
23993 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
23994 version of repository pages accessed with a fixed SHA1.
23995
23996 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
23997
23998 @end deftypevr
23999
24000 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-dynamic-ttl
24001 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
24002 version of repository pages accessed without a fixed SHA1.
24003
24004 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24005
24006 @end deftypevr
24007
24008 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-repo-ttl
24009 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
24010 version of the repository summary page.
24011
24012 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24013
24014 @end deftypevr
24015
24016 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-root-ttl
24017 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
24018 version of the repository index page.
24019
24020 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24021
24022 @end deftypevr
24023
24024 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-scanrc-ttl
24025 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the result of
24026 scanning a path for Git repositories.
24027
24028 Defaults to @samp{15}.
24029
24030 @end deftypevr
24031
24032 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-about-ttl
24033 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
24034 version of the repository about page.
24035
24036 Defaults to @samp{15}.
24037
24038 @end deftypevr
24039
24040 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-snapshot-ttl
24041 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
24042 version of snapshots.
24043
24044 Defaults to @samp{5}.
24045
24046 @end deftypevr
24047
24048 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-size
24049 The maximum number of entries in the cgit cache. When set to @samp{0},
24050 caching is disabled.
24051
24052 Defaults to @samp{0}.
24053
24054 @end deftypevr
24055
24056 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean case-sensitive-sort?
24057 Sort items in the repo list case sensitively.
24058
24059 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
24060
24061 @end deftypevr
24062
24063 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-prefix
24064 List of common prefixes which, when combined with a repository URL,
24065 generates valid clone URLs for the repository.
24066
24067 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24068
24069 @end deftypevr
24070
24071 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-url
24072 List of @code{clone-url} templates.
24073
24074 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24075
24076 @end deftypevr
24077
24078 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object commit-filter
24079 Command which will be invoked to format commit messages.
24080
24081 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24082
24083 @end deftypevr
24084
24085 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string commit-sort
24086 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
24087 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
24088 ordering.
24089
24090 Defaults to @samp{"git log"}.
24091
24092 @end deftypevr
24093
24094 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object css
24095 URL which specifies the css document to include in all cgit pages.
24096
24097 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.css"}.
24098
24099 @end deftypevr
24100
24101 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object email-filter
24102 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format names and email
24103 address of committers, authors, and taggers, as represented in various
24104 places throughout the cgit interface.
24105
24106 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24107
24108 @end deftypevr
24109
24110 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean embedded?
24111 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate a HTML
24112 fragment suitable for embedding in other HTML pages.
24113
24114 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24115
24116 @end deftypevr
24117
24118 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-commit-graph?
24119 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print an ASCII-art
24120 commit history graph to the left of the commit messages in the
24121 repository log page.
24122
24123 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24124
24125 @end deftypevr
24126
24127 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-filter-overrides?
24128 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows all filter settings to be
24129 overridden in repository-specific cgitrc files.
24130
24131 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24132
24133 @end deftypevr
24134
24135 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-follow-links?
24136 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows users to follow a file in the
24137 log view.
24138
24139 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24140
24141 @end deftypevr
24142
24143 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-http-clone?
24144 If set to @samp{#t}, cgit will act as an dumb HTTP endpoint for Git
24145 clones.
24146
24147 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
24148
24149 @end deftypevr
24150
24151 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-links?
24152 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate extra links
24153 "summary", "commit", "tree" for each repo in the repository index.
24154
24155 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24156
24157 @end deftypevr
24158
24159 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-owner?
24160 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit display the owner of
24161 each repo in the repository index.
24162
24163 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
24164
24165 @end deftypevr
24166
24167 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-filecount?
24168 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
24169 modified files for each commit on the repository log page.
24170
24171 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24172
24173 @end deftypevr
24174
24175 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-linecount?
24176 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
24177 added and removed lines for each commit on the repository log page.
24178
24179 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24180
24181 @end deftypevr
24182
24183 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-remote-branches?
24184 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
24185 branches in the summary and refs views.
24186
24187 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24188
24189 @end deftypevr
24190
24191 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-subject-links?
24192 Flag which, when set to @code{1}, will make cgit use the subject of the
24193 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
24194 commit view.
24195
24196 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24197
24198 @end deftypevr
24199
24200 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-html-serving?
24201 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit use the subject of the
24202 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
24203 commit view.
24204
24205 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24206
24207 @end deftypevr
24208
24209 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-tree-linenumbers?
24210 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate linenumber
24211 links for plaintext blobs printed in the tree view.
24212
24213 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
24214
24215 @end deftypevr
24216
24217 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-git-config?
24218 Flag which, when set to @samp{#f}, will allow cgit to use Git config to
24219 set any repo specific settings.
24220
24221 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24222
24223 @end deftypevr
24224
24225 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object favicon
24226 URL used as link to a shortcut icon for cgit.
24227
24228 Defaults to @samp{"/favicon.ico"}.
24229
24230 @end deftypevr
24231
24232 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string footer
24233 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24234 verbatim at the bottom of all pages (i.e.@: it replaces the standard
24235 "generated by..."@: message).
24236
24237 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24238
24239 @end deftypevr
24240
24241 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string head-include
24242 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24243 verbatim in the HTML HEAD section on all pages.
24244
24245 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24246
24247 @end deftypevr
24248
24249 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string header
24250 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24251 verbatim at the top of all pages.
24252
24253 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24254
24255 @end deftypevr
24256
24257 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object include
24258 Name of a configfile to include before the rest of the current config-
24259 file is parsed.
24260
24261 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24262
24263 @end deftypevr
24264
24265 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-header
24266 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24267 verbatim above the repository index.
24268
24269 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24270
24271 @end deftypevr
24272
24273 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-info
24274 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24275 verbatim below the heading on the repository index page.
24276
24277 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24278
24279 @end deftypevr
24280
24281 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean local-time?
24282 Flag which, if set to @samp{#t}, makes cgit print commit and tag times
24283 in the servers timezone.
24284
24285 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24286
24287 @end deftypevr
24288
24289 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object logo
24290 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
24291 on all cgit pages.
24292
24293 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.png"}.
24294
24295 @end deftypevr
24296
24297 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string logo-link
24298 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
24299
24300 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24301
24302 @end deftypevr
24303
24304 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object owner-filter
24305 Command which will be invoked to format the Owner column of the main
24306 page.
24307
24308 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24309
24310 @end deftypevr
24311
24312 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-atom-items
24313 Number of items to display in atom feeds view.
24314
24315 Defaults to @samp{10}.
24316
24317 @end deftypevr
24318
24319 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-commit-count
24320 Number of entries to list per page in "log" view.
24321
24322 Defaults to @samp{50}.
24323
24324 @end deftypevr
24325
24326 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-message-length
24327 Number of commit message characters to display in "log" view.
24328
24329 Defaults to @samp{80}.
24330
24331 @end deftypevr
24332
24333 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repo-count
24334 Specifies the number of entries to list per page on the repository index
24335 page.
24336
24337 Defaults to @samp{50}.
24338
24339 @end deftypevr
24340
24341 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repodesc-length
24342 Specifies the maximum number of repo description characters to display
24343 on the repository index page.
24344
24345 Defaults to @samp{80}.
24346
24347 @end deftypevr
24348
24349 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-blob-size
24350 Specifies the maximum size of a blob to display HTML for in KBytes.
24351
24352 Defaults to @samp{0}.
24353
24354 @end deftypevr
24355
24356 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string max-stats
24357 Maximum statistics period. Valid values are @samp{week},@samp{month},
24358 @samp{quarter} and @samp{year}.
24359
24360 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24361
24362 @end deftypevr
24363
24364 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} mimetype-alist mimetype
24365 Mimetype for the specified filename extension.
24366
24367 Defaults to @samp{((gif "image/gif") (html "text/html") (jpg
24368 "image/jpeg") (jpeg "image/jpeg") (pdf "application/pdf") (png
24369 "image/png") (svg "image/svg+xml"))}.
24370
24371 @end deftypevr
24372
24373 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object mimetype-file
24374 Specifies the file to use for automatic mimetype lookup.
24375
24376 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24377
24378 @end deftypevr
24379
24380 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string module-link
24381 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
24382 submodule is printed in a directory listing.
24383
24384 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24385
24386 @end deftypevr
24387
24388 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean nocache?
24389 If set to the value @samp{#t} caching will be disabled.
24390
24391 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24392
24393 @end deftypevr
24394
24395 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noplainemail?
24396 If set to @samp{#t} showing full author email addresses will be
24397 disabled.
24398
24399 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24400
24401 @end deftypevr
24402
24403 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noheader?
24404 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit omit the standard
24405 header on all pages.
24406
24407 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24408
24409 @end deftypevr
24410
24411 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} project-list project-list
24412 A list of subdirectories inside of @code{repository-directory}, relative
24413 to it, that should loaded as Git repositories. An empty list means that
24414 all subdirectories will be loaded.
24415
24416 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24417
24418 @end deftypevr
24419
24420 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object readme
24421 Text which will be used as default value for @code{cgit-repo-readme}.
24422
24423 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24424
24425 @end deftypevr
24426
24427 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean remove-suffix?
24428 If set to @code{#t} and @code{repository-directory} is enabled, if any
24429 repositories are found with a suffix of @code{.git}, this suffix will be
24430 removed for the URL and name.
24431
24432 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24433
24434 @end deftypevr
24435
24436 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer renamelimit
24437 Maximum number of files to consider when detecting renames.
24438
24439 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
24440
24441 @end deftypevr
24442
24443 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string repository-sort
24444 The way in which repositories in each section are sorted.
24445
24446 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24447
24448 @end deftypevr
24449
24450 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} robots-list robots
24451 Text used as content for the @code{robots} meta-tag.
24452
24453 Defaults to @samp{("noindex" "nofollow")}.
24454
24455 @end deftypevr
24456
24457 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-desc
24458 Text printed below the heading on the repository index page.
24459
24460 Defaults to @samp{"a fast webinterface for the git dscm"}.
24461
24462 @end deftypevr
24463
24464 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-readme
24465 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
24466 verbatim below thef "about" link on the repository index page.
24467
24468 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24469
24470 @end deftypevr
24471
24472 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-title
24473 Text printed as heading on the repository index page.
24474
24475 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24476
24477 @end deftypevr
24478
24479 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean scan-hidden-path
24480 If set to @samp{#t} and repository-directory is enabled,
24481 repository-directory will recurse into directories whose name starts
24482 with a period. Otherwise, repository-directory will stay away from such
24483 directories, considered as "hidden". Note that this does not apply to
24484 the ".git" directory in non-bare repos.
24485
24486 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24487
24488 @end deftypevr
24489
24490 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list snapshots
24491 Text which specifies the default set of snapshot formats that cgit
24492 generates links for.
24493
24494 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24495
24496 @end deftypevr
24497
24498 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-directory repository-directory
24499 Name of the directory to scan for repositories (represents
24500 @code{scan-path}).
24501
24502 Defaults to @samp{"/srv/git"}.
24503
24504 @end deftypevr
24505
24506 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section
24507 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
24508 after this option will inherit the current section name.
24509
24510 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24511
24512 @end deftypevr
24513
24514 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section-sort
24515 Flag which, when set to @samp{1}, will sort the sections on the
24516 repository listing by name.
24517
24518 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24519
24520 @end deftypevr
24521
24522 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer section-from-path
24523 A number which, if defined prior to repository-directory, specifies how
24524 many path elements from each repo path to use as a default section name.
24525
24526 Defaults to @samp{0}.
24527
24528 @end deftypevr
24529
24530 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean side-by-side-diffs?
24531 If set to @samp{#t} shows side-by-side diffs instead of unidiffs per
24532 default.
24533
24534 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24535
24536 @end deftypevr
24537
24538 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object source-filter
24539 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format plaintext blobs in
24540 the tree view.
24541
24542 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24543
24544 @end deftypevr
24545
24546 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-branches
24547 Specifies the number of branches to display in the repository "summary"
24548 view.
24549
24550 Defaults to @samp{10}.
24551
24552 @end deftypevr
24553
24554 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-log
24555 Specifies the number of log entries to display in the repository
24556 "summary" view.
24557
24558 Defaults to @samp{10}.
24559
24560 @end deftypevr
24561
24562 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-tags
24563 Specifies the number of tags to display in the repository "summary"
24564 view.
24565
24566 Defaults to @samp{10}.
24567
24568 @end deftypevr
24569
24570 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string strict-export
24571 Filename which, if specified, needs to be present within the repository
24572 for cgit to allow access to that repository.
24573
24574 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24575
24576 @end deftypevr
24577
24578 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string virtual-root
24579 URL which, if specified, will be used as root for all cgit links.
24580
24581 Defaults to @samp{"/"}.
24582
24583 @end deftypevr
24584
24585 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-cgit-configuration-list repositories
24586 A list of @dfn{cgit-repo} records to use with config.
24587
24588 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24589
24590 Available @code{repository-cgit-configuration} fields are:
24591
24592 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list snapshots
24593 A mask of snapshot formats for this repo that cgit generates links for,
24594 restricted by the global @code{snapshots} setting.
24595
24596 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24597
24598 @end deftypevr
24599
24600 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object source-filter
24601 Override the default @code{source-filter}.
24602
24603 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24604
24605 @end deftypevr
24606
24607 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string url
24608 The relative URL used to access the repository.
24609
24610 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24611
24612 @end deftypevr
24613
24614 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object about-filter
24615 Override the default @code{about-filter}.
24616
24617 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24618
24619 @end deftypevr
24620
24621 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string branch-sort
24622 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
24623 ref list, and when set to @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
24624
24625 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24626
24627 @end deftypevr
24628
24629 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list clone-url
24630 A list of URLs which can be used to clone repo.
24631
24632 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24633
24634 @end deftypevr
24635
24636 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object commit-filter
24637 Override the default @code{commit-filter}.
24638
24639 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24640
24641 @end deftypevr
24642
24643 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string commit-sort
24644 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
24645 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
24646 ordering.
24647
24648 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24649
24650 @end deftypevr
24651
24652 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string defbranch
24653 The name of the default branch for this repository. If no such branch
24654 exists in the repository, the first branch name (when sorted) is used as
24655 default instead. By default branch pointed to by HEAD, or "master" if
24656 there is no suitable HEAD.
24657
24658 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24659
24660 @end deftypevr
24661
24662 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string desc
24663 The value to show as repository description.
24664
24665 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24666
24667 @end deftypevr
24668
24669 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string homepage
24670 The value to show as repository homepage.
24671
24672 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24673
24674 @end deftypevr
24675
24676 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object email-filter
24677 Override the default @code{email-filter}.
24678
24679 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24680
24681 @end deftypevr
24682
24683 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-commit-graph?
24684 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
24685 @code{enable-commit-graph?}.
24686
24687 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24688
24689 @end deftypevr
24690
24691 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-filecount?
24692 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
24693 @code{enable-log-filecount?}.
24694
24695 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24696
24697 @end deftypevr
24698
24699 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-linecount?
24700 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
24701 @code{enable-log-linecount?}.
24702
24703 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24704
24705 @end deftypevr
24706
24707 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-remote-branches?
24708 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
24709 branches in the summary and refs views.
24710
24711 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24712
24713 @end deftypevr
24714
24715 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-subject-links?
24716 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
24717 @code{enable-subject-links?}.
24718
24719 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24720
24721 @end deftypevr
24722
24723 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-html-serving?
24724 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
24725 @code{enable-html-serving?}.
24726
24727 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
24728
24729 @end deftypevr
24730
24731 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean hide?
24732 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, hides the repository from the
24733 repository index.
24734
24735 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24736
24737 @end deftypevr
24738
24739 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean ignore?
24740 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, ignores the repository.
24741
24742 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
24743
24744 @end deftypevr
24745
24746 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object logo
24747 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
24748 on this repo’s pages.
24749
24750 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24751
24752 @end deftypevr
24753
24754 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string logo-link
24755 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
24756
24757 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24758
24759 @end deftypevr
24760
24761 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object owner-filter
24762 Override the default @code{owner-filter}.
24763
24764 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24765
24766 @end deftypevr
24767
24768 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string module-link
24769 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
24770 submodule is printed in a directory listing. The arguments for the
24771 formatstring are the path and SHA1 of the submodule commit.
24772
24773 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24774
24775 @end deftypevr
24776
24777 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} module-link-path module-link-path
24778 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
24779 submodule with the specified subdirectory path is printed in a directory
24780 listing.
24781
24782 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24783
24784 @end deftypevr
24785
24786 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string max-stats
24787 Override the default maximum statistics period.
24788
24789 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24790
24791 @end deftypevr
24792
24793 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string name
24794 The value to show as repository name.
24795
24796 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24797
24798 @end deftypevr
24799
24800 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string owner
24801 A value used to identify the owner of the repository.
24802
24803 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24804
24805 @end deftypevr
24806
24807 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string path
24808 An absolute path to the repository directory.
24809
24810 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24811
24812 @end deftypevr
24813
24814 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string readme
24815 A path (relative to repo) which specifies a file to include verbatim as
24816 the "About" page for this repo.
24817
24818 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24819
24820 @end deftypevr
24821
24822 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string section
24823 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
24824 after this option will inherit the current section name.
24825
24826 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24827
24828 @end deftypevr
24829
24830 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list extra-options
24831 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
24832
24833 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24834
24835 @end deftypevr
24836
24837 @end deftypevr
24838
24839 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
24840 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
24841
24842 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24843
24844 @end deftypevr
24845
24846
24847 @c %end of fragment
24848
24849 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{cgitrc} up and
24850 running. In that case, you can pass an @code{opaque-cgit-configuration}
24851 as a record to @code{cgit-service-type}. As its name indicates, an
24852 opaque configuration does not have easy reflective capabilities.
24853
24854 Available @code{opaque-cgit-configuration} fields are:
24855
24856 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} package cgit
24857 The cgit package.
24858 @end deftypevr
24859
24860 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} string string
24861 The contents of the @code{cgitrc}, as a string.
24862 @end deftypevr
24863
24864 For example, if your @code{cgitrc} is just the empty string, you
24865 could instantiate a cgit service like this:
24866
24867 @lisp
24868 (service cgit-service-type
24869 (opaque-cgit-configuration
24870 (cgitrc "")))
24871 @end lisp
24872
24873 @subsubheading Gitolite Service
24874
24875 @cindex Gitolite service
24876 @cindex Git, hosting
24877 @uref{https://gitolite.com/gitolite/, Gitolite} is a tool for hosting Git
24878 repositories on a central server.
24879
24880 Gitolite can handle multiple repositories and users, and supports flexible
24881 configuration of the permissions for the users on the repositories.
24882
24883 The following example will configure Gitolite using the default @code{git}
24884 user, and the provided SSH public key.
24885
24886 @lisp
24887 (service gitolite-service-type
24888 (gitolite-configuration
24889 (admin-pubkey (plain-file
24890 "yourname.pub"
24891 "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com"))))
24892 @end lisp
24893
24894 Gitolite is configured through a special admin repository which you can clone,
24895 for example, if you setup Gitolite on @code{example.com}, you would run the
24896 following command to clone the admin repository.
24897
24898 @example
24899 git clone git@@example.com:gitolite-admin
24900 @end example
24901
24902 When the Gitolite service is activated, the provided @code{admin-pubkey} will
24903 be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory in the gitolite-admin
24904 repository. If this results in a change in the repository, it will be
24905 committed using the message ``gitolite setup by GNU Guix''.
24906
24907 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-configuration
24908 Data type representing the configuration for @code{gitolite-service-type}.
24909
24910 @table @asis
24911 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gitolite})
24912 Gitolite package to use.
24913
24914 @item @code{user} (default: @var{git})
24915 User to use for Gitolite. This will be user that you use when accessing
24916 Gitolite over SSH.
24917
24918 @item @code{group} (default: @var{git})
24919 Group to use for Gitolite.
24920
24921 @item @code{home-directory} (default: @var{"/var/lib/gitolite"})
24922 Directory in which to store the Gitolite configuration and repositories.
24923
24924 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @var{(gitolite-rc-file)})
24925 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}),
24926 representing the configuration for Gitolite.
24927
24928 @item @code{admin-pubkey} (default: @var{#f})
24929 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) used to
24930 setup Gitolite. This will be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory
24931 within the gitolite-admin repository.
24932
24933 To specify the SSH key as a string, use the @code{plain-file} function.
24934
24935 @lisp
24936 (plain-file "yourname.pub" "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com")
24937 @end lisp
24938
24939 @end table
24940 @end deftp
24941
24942 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-rc-file
24943 Data type representing the Gitolite RC file.
24944
24945 @table @asis
24946 @item @code{umask} (default: @code{#o0077})
24947 This controls the permissions Gitolite sets on the repositories and their
24948 contents.
24949
24950 A value like @code{#o0027} will give read access to the group used by Gitolite
24951 (by default: @code{git}). This is necessary when using Gitolite with software
24952 like cgit or gitweb.
24953
24954 @item @code{git-config-keys} (default: @code{""})
24955 Gitolite allows you to set git config values using the "config" keyword. This
24956 setting allows control over the config keys to accept.
24957
24958 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'(("READERS" . 1) ("WRITERS" . ))})
24959 Set the role names allowed to be used by users running the perms command.
24960
24961 @item @code{enable} (default: @code{'("help" "desc" "info" "perms" "writable" "ssh-authkeys" "git-config" "daemon" "gitweb")})
24962 This setting controls the commands and features to enable within Gitolite.
24963
24964 @end table
24965 @end deftp
24966
24967
24968 @node Game Services
24969 @subsection Game Services
24970
24971 @subsubheading The Battle for Wesnoth Service
24972 @cindex wesnothd
24973 @uref{https://wesnoth.org, The Battle for Wesnoth} is a fantasy, turn
24974 based tactical strategy game, with several single player campaigns, and
24975 multiplayer games (both networked and local).
24976
24977 @defvar {Scheme Variable} wesnothd-service-type
24978 Service type for the wesnothd service. Its value must be a
24979 @code{wesnothd-configuration} object. To run wesnothd in the default
24980 configuration, instantiate it as:
24981
24982 @lisp
24983 (service wesnothd-service-type)
24984 @end lisp
24985 @end defvar
24986
24987 @deftp {Data Type} wesnothd-configuration
24988 Data type representing the configuration of @command{wesnothd}.
24989
24990 @table @asis
24991 @item @code{package} (default: @code{wesnoth-server})
24992 The wesnoth server package to use.
24993
24994 @item @code{port} (default: @code{15000})
24995 The port to bind the server to.
24996 @end table
24997 @end deftp
24998
24999
25000 @node PAM Mount Service
25001 @subsection PAM Mount Service
25002 @cindex pam-mount
25003
25004 The @code{(gnu services pam-mount)} module provides a service allowing
25005 users to mount volumes when they log in. It should be able to mount any
25006 volume format supported by the system.
25007
25008 @defvar {Scheme Variable} pam-mount-service-type
25009 Service type for PAM Mount support.
25010 @end defvar
25011
25012 @deftp {Data Type} pam-mount-configuration
25013 Data type representing the configuration of PAM Mount.
25014
25015 It takes the following parameters:
25016
25017 @table @asis
25018 @item @code{rules}
25019 The configuration rules that will be used to generate
25020 @file{/etc/security/pam_mount.conf.xml}.
25021
25022 The configuration rules are SXML elements (@pxref{SXML,,, guile, GNU
25023 Guile Reference Manual}), and the the default ones don't mount anything
25024 for anyone at login:
25025
25026 @lisp
25027 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
25028 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
25029 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
25030 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
25031 "allow_root" "allow_other")
25032 ","))))
25033 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
25034 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
25035 (hup "0")
25036 (term "no")
25037 (kill "no")))
25038 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
25039 (remove "true"))))
25040 @end lisp
25041
25042 Some @code{volume} elements must be added to automatically mount volumes
25043 at login. Here's an example allowing the user @code{alice} to mount her
25044 encrypted @code{HOME} directory and allowing the user @code{bob} to mount
25045 the partition where he stores his data:
25046
25047 @lisp
25048 (define pam-mount-rules
25049 `((debug (@@ (enable "0")))
25050 (volume (@@ (user "alice")
25051 (fstype "crypt")
25052 (path "/dev/sda2")
25053 (mountpoint "/home/alice")))
25054 (volume (@@ (user "bob")
25055 (fstype "auto")
25056 (path "/dev/sdb3")
25057 (mountpoint "/home/bob/data")
25058 (options "defaults,autodefrag,compress")))
25059 (mntoptions (@@ (allow ,(string-join
25060 '("nosuid" "nodev" "loop"
25061 "encryption" "fsck" "nonempty"
25062 "allow_root" "allow_other")
25063 ","))))
25064 (mntoptions (@@ (require "nosuid,nodev")))
25065 (logout (@@ (wait "0")
25066 (hup "0")
25067 (term "no")
25068 (kill "no")))
25069 (mkmountpoint (@@ (enable "1")
25070 (remove "true")))))
25071
25072 (service pam-mount-service-type
25073 (pam-mount-configuration
25074 (rules pam-mount-rules)))
25075 @end lisp
25076
25077 The complete list of possible options can be found in the man page for
25078 @uref{http://pam-mount.sourceforge.net/pam_mount.conf.5.html, pam_mount.conf}.
25079 @end table
25080 @end deftp
25081
25082
25083 @node Guix Services
25084 @subsection Guix Services
25085
25086 @subsubheading Guix Data Service
25087 The @uref{http://data.guix.gnu.org,Guix Data Service} processes, stores
25088 and provides data about GNU Guix. This includes information about
25089 packages, derivations and lint warnings.
25090
25091 The data is stored in a PostgreSQL database, and available through a web
25092 interface.
25093
25094 @defvar {Scheme Variable} guix-data-service-type
25095 Service type for the Guix Data Service. Its value must be a
25096 @code{guix-data-service-configuration} object. The service optionally
25097 extends the getmail service, as the guix-commits mailing list is used to
25098 find out about changes in the Guix git repository.
25099 @end defvar
25100
25101 @deftp {Data Type} guix-data-service-configuration
25102 Data type representing the configuration of the Guix Data Service.
25103
25104 @table @asis
25105 @item @code{package} (default: @code{guix-data-service})
25106 The Guix Data Service package to use.
25107
25108 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
25109 The system user to run the service as.
25110
25111 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"guix-data-service"})
25112 The system group to run the service as.
25113
25114 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8765})
25115 The port to bind the web service to.
25116
25117 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
25118 The host to bind the web service to.
25119
25120 @item @code{getmail-idle-mailboxes} (default: @code{#f})
25121 If set, this is the list of mailboxes that the getmail service will be
25122 configured to listen to.
25123
25124 @item @code{commits-getmail-retriever-configuration} (default: @code{#f})
25125 If set, this is the @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} object with
25126 which to configure getmail to fetch mail from the guix-commits mailing
25127 list.
25128
25129 @end table
25130 @end deftp
25131
25132
25133 @node Miscellaneous Services
25134 @subsection Miscellaneous Services
25135
25136 @cindex fingerprint
25137 @subsubheading Fingerprint Service
25138
25139 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides a DBus service to
25140 read and identify fingerprints via a fingerprint sensor.
25141
25142 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fprintd-service-type
25143 The service type for @command{fprintd}, which provides the fingerprint
25144 reading capability.
25145
25146 @lisp
25147 (service fprintd-service-type)
25148 @end lisp
25149 @end defvr
25150
25151 @cindex sysctl
25152 @subsubheading System Control Service
25153
25154 The @code{(gnu services sysctl)} provides a service to configure kernel
25155 parameters at boot.
25156
25157 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sysctl-service-type
25158 The service type for @command{sysctl}, which modifies kernel parameters
25159 under @file{/proc/sys/}. To enable IPv4 forwarding, it can be
25160 instantiated as:
25161
25162 @lisp
25163 (service sysctl-service-type
25164 (sysctl-configuration
25165 (settings '(("net.ipv4.ip_forward" . "1")))))
25166 @end lisp
25167 @end defvr
25168
25169 @deftp {Data Type} sysctl-configuration
25170 The data type representing the configuration of @command{sysctl}.
25171
25172 @table @asis
25173 @item @code{sysctl} (default: @code{(file-append procps "/sbin/sysctl"})
25174 The @command{sysctl} executable to use.
25175
25176 @item @code{settings} (default: @code{'()})
25177 An association list specifies kernel parameters and their values.
25178 @end table
25179 @end deftp
25180
25181 @cindex pcscd
25182 @subsubheading PC/SC Smart Card Daemon Service
25183
25184 The @code{(gnu services security-token)} module provides the following service
25185 to run @command{pcscd}, the PC/SC Smart Card Daemon. @command{pcscd} is the
25186 daemon program for pcsc-lite and the MuscleCard framework. It is a resource
25187 manager that coordinates communications with smart card readers, smart cards
25188 and cryptographic tokens that are connected to the system.
25189
25190 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pcscd-service-type
25191 Service type for the @command{pcscd} service. Its value must be a
25192 @code{pcscd-configuration} object. To run pcscd in the default
25193 configuration, instantiate it as:
25194
25195 @lisp
25196 (service pcscd-service-type)
25197 @end lisp
25198 @end defvr
25199
25200 @deftp {Data Type} pcscd-configuration
25201 The data type representing the configuration of @command{pcscd}.
25202
25203 @table @asis
25204 @item @code{pcsc-lite} (default: @code{pcsc-lite})
25205 The pcsc-lite package that provides pcscd.
25206 @item @code{usb-drivers} (default: @code{(list ccid)})
25207 List of packages that provide USB drivers to pcscd. Drivers are expected to be
25208 under @file{pcsc/drivers} in the store directory of the package.
25209 @end table
25210 @end deftp
25211
25212 @cindex lirc
25213 @subsubheading Lirc Service
25214
25215 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
25216
25217 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
25218 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
25219 [#:extra-options '()]
25220 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
25221 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
25222
25223 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
25224 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
25225 for details.
25226
25227 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
25228 passed to @command{lircd}.
25229 @end deffn
25230
25231 @cindex spice
25232 @subsubheading Spice Service
25233
25234 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
25235
25236 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
25237 Returns a service that runs @url{https://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
25238 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
25239 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
25240 @end deffn
25241
25242 @cindex inputattach
25243 @subsubheading inputattach Service
25244
25245 @cindex tablet input, for Xorg
25246 @cindex touchscreen input, for Xorg
25247 The @uref{https://linuxwacom.github.io/, inputattach} service allows you to
25248 use input devices such as Wacom tablets, touchscreens, or joysticks with the
25249 Xorg display server.
25250
25251 @deffn {Scheme Variable} inputattach-service-type
25252 Type of a service that runs @command{inputattach} on a device and
25253 dispatches events from it.
25254 @end deffn
25255
25256 @deftp {Data Type} inputattach-configuration
25257 @table @asis
25258 @item @code{device-type} (default: @code{"wacom"})
25259 The type of device to connect to. Run @command{inputattach --help}, from the
25260 @code{inputattach} package, to see the list of supported device types.
25261
25262 @item @code{device} (default: @code{"/dev/ttyS0"})
25263 The device file to connect to the device.
25264
25265 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
25266 Baud rate to use for the serial connection.
25267 Should be a number or @code{#f}.
25268
25269 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{#f})
25270 If true, this must be the name of a file to log messages to.
25271 @end table
25272 @end deftp
25273
25274 @subsection Dictionary Services
25275 @cindex dictionary
25276 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
25277
25278 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
25279 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
25280 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25281
25282 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
25283 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
25284 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictonary of English.
25285
25286 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
25287 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
25288 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25289 @end deffn
25290
25291 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
25292 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
25293
25294 @table @asis
25295 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
25296 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
25297
25298 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
25299 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
25300 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
25301 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25302
25303 @item @code{handlers} (default: @var{'()})
25304 List of @code{<dicod-handler>} objects denoting handlers (module instances).
25305
25306 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
25307 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
25308 @end table
25309 @end deftp
25310
25311 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-handler
25312 Data type representing a dictionary handler (module instance).
25313
25314 @table @asis
25315 @item @code{name}
25316 Name of the handler (module instance).
25317
25318 @item @code{module} (default: @var{#f})
25319 Name of the dicod module of the handler (instance). If it is @code{#f},
25320 the module has the same name as the handler.
25321 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25322
25323 @item @code{options}
25324 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
25325 @end table
25326 @end deftp
25327
25328 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
25329 Data type representing a dictionary database.
25330
25331 @table @asis
25332 @item @code{name}
25333 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
25334
25335 @item @code{handler}
25336 Name of the dicod handler (module instance) used by this database
25337 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25338
25339 @item @code{complex?} (default: @var{#f})
25340 Whether the database configuration complex. The complex configuration
25341 will need a corresponding @code{<dicod-handler>} object, otherwise not.
25342
25343 @item @code{options}
25344 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the database
25345 (@pxref{Databases,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
25346 @end table
25347 @end deftp
25348
25349 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
25350 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
25351 Dictionary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
25352 @end defvr
25353
25354 The following is an example @code{dicod-service} configuration.
25355
25356 @lisp
25357 (dicod-service #:config
25358 (dicod-configuration
25359 (handlers (list (dicod-handler
25360 (name "wordnet")
25361 (module "dictorg")
25362 (options
25363 (list #~(string-append "dbdir=" #$wordnet))))))
25364 (databases (list (dicod-database
25365 (name "wordnet")
25366 (complex? #t)
25367 (handler "wordnet")
25368 (options '("database=wn")))
25369 %dicod-database:gcide))))
25370 @end lisp
25371
25372 @cindex Docker
25373 @subsubheading Docker Service
25374
25375 The @code{(gnu services docker)} module provides the following services.
25376
25377 @defvr {Scheme Variable} docker-service-type
25378
25379 This is the type of the service that runs @url{https://www.docker.com,Docker},
25380 a daemon that can execute application bundles (sometimes referred to as
25381 ``containers'') in isolated environments.
25382
25383 @end defvr
25384
25385 @deftp {Data Type} docker-configuration
25386 This is the data type representing the configuration of Docker and Containerd.
25387
25388 @table @asis
25389
25390 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker})
25391 The Docker package to use.
25392
25393 @item @code{containerd} (default: @var{containerd})
25394 The Containerd package to use.
25395
25396 @end table
25397 @end deftp
25398
25399 @cindex Audit
25400 @subsubheading Auditd Service
25401
25402 The @code{(gnu services auditd)} module provides the following service.
25403
25404 @defvr {Scheme Variable} auditd-service-type
25405
25406 This is the type of the service that runs
25407 @url{https://people.redhat.com/sgrubb/audit/,auditd},
25408 a daemon that tracks security-relevant information on your system.
25409
25410 Examples of things that can be tracked:
25411
25412 @enumerate
25413 @item
25414 File accesses
25415 @item
25416 System calls
25417 @item
25418 Invoked commands
25419 @item
25420 Failed login attempts
25421 @item
25422 Firewall filtering
25423 @item
25424 Network access
25425 @end enumerate
25426
25427 @command{auditctl} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
25428 to add or remove events to be tracked (until the next reboot).
25429 In order to permanently track events, put the command line arguments
25430 of auditctl into @file{/etc/audit/audit.rules}.
25431 @command{aureport} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
25432 to view a report of all recorded events.
25433 The audit daemon usually logs into the directory @file{/var/log/audit}.
25434
25435 @end defvr
25436
25437 @deftp {Data Type} auditd-configuration
25438 This is the data type representing the configuration of auditd.
25439
25440 @table @asis
25441
25442 @item @code{audit} (default: @code{audit})
25443 The audit package to use.
25444
25445 @end table
25446 @end deftp
25447
25448 @defvr {Scheme Variable} singularity-service-type
25449 This is the type of the service that allows you to run
25450 @url{https://www.sylabs.io/singularity/, Singularity}, a Docker-style tool to
25451 create and run application bundles (aka. ``containers''). The value for this
25452 service is the Singularity package to use.
25453
25454 The service does not install a daemon; instead, it installs helper programs as
25455 setuid-root (@pxref{Setuid Programs}) such that unprivileged users can invoke
25456 @command{singularity run} and similar commands.
25457 @end defvr
25458
25459 @cindex Nix
25460 @subsubheading Nix service
25461
25462 The @code{(gnu services nix)} module provides the following service.
25463
25464 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nix-service-type
25465
25466 This is the type of the service that runs build daemon of the
25467 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix} package manager. Here is an example showing
25468 how to use it:
25469
25470 @lisp
25471 (use-modules (gnu))
25472 (use-service-modules nix)
25473 (use-package-modules package-management)
25474
25475 (operating-system
25476 ;; @dots{}
25477 (packages (append (list nix)
25478 %base-packages))
25479
25480 (services (append (list (service nix-service-type))
25481 %base-services)))
25482 @end lisp
25483
25484 After @command{guix system reconfigure} configure Nix for your user:
25485
25486 @itemize
25487 @item Add a Nix channel and update it. See
25488 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/manual/, Nix Package Manager Guide}.
25489
25490 @item Create a symlink to your profile and activate Nix profile:
25491 @end itemize
25492
25493 @example
25494 $ ln -s "/nix/var/nix/profiles/per-user/$USER/profile" ~/.nix-profile
25495 $ source /run/current-system/profile/etc/profile.d/nix.sh
25496 @end example
25497
25498 @end defvr
25499
25500 @node Setuid Programs
25501 @section Setuid Programs
25502
25503 @cindex setuid programs
25504 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
25505 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
25506 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
25507 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
25508 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
25509 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
25510 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
25511 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
25512 for more info about the setuid mechanism.)
25513
25514 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
25515 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
25516 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
25517 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
25518 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
25519 should be setuid root.
25520
25521 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
25522 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
25523 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
25524 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
25525 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
25526
25527 @example
25528 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
25529 @end example
25530
25531 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
25532 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
25533
25534 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
25535 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
25536
25537 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
25538 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
25539 @end defvr
25540
25541 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
25542 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
25543 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
25544 store.
25545
25546 @node X.509 Certificates
25547 @section X.509 Certificates
25548
25549 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
25550 @cindex X.509 certificates
25551 @cindex TLS
25552 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
25553 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
25554 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
25555 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
25556 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
25557 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
25558
25559 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
25560 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
25561 out-of-the-box.
25562
25563 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
25564 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
25565 certificates can be found.
25566
25567 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
25568 In Guix, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
25569 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
25570 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). Guix includes one such package,
25571 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
25572 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
25573
25574 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @code{%base-packages}, so you need to
25575 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
25576 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
25577 to the certificates installed globally.
25578
25579 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
25580 can also install their own certificate package in
25581 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
25582 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
25583 OpenSSL library honors the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @code{SSL_CERT_FILE}
25584 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
25585 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
25586 pointed to by the @code{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
25587 would typically run something like:
25588
25589 @example
25590 $ guix install nss-certs
25591 $ export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
25592 $ export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
25593 $ export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
25594 @end example
25595
25596 As another example, R requires the @code{CURL_CA_BUNDLE} environment
25597 variable to point to a certificate bundle, so you would have to run
25598 something like this:
25599
25600 @example
25601 $ guix install nss-certs
25602 $ export CURL_CA_BUNDLE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
25603 @end example
25604
25605 For other applications you may want to look up the required environment
25606 variable in the relevant documentation.
25607
25608
25609 @node Name Service Switch
25610 @section Name Service Switch
25611
25612 @cindex name service switch
25613 @cindex NSS
25614 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
25615 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
25616 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
25617 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
25618 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
25619 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
25620 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
25621 C Library Reference Manual}).
25622
25623 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
25624 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
25625 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
25626 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
25627 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
25628 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
25629
25630 @cindex nss-mdns
25631 @cindex .local, host name lookup
25632 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
25633 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
25634 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
25635 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
25636
25637 @lisp
25638 (name-service-switch
25639 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
25640
25641 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
25642 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
25643 (name-service
25644 (name "mdns_minimal")
25645
25646 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
25647 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
25648 ;; no need to try the next methods.
25649 (reaction (lookup-specification
25650 (not-found => return))))
25651
25652 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
25653 (name-service
25654 (name "dns"))
25655
25656 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
25657 (name-service
25658 (name "mdns")))))
25659 @end lisp
25660
25661 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
25662 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
25663 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
25664
25665 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
25666 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
25667 you also need to use @code{avahi-service-type} (@pxref{Networking Services,
25668 @code{avahi-service-type}}), or @code{%desktop-services}, which includes it
25669 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
25670 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
25671 @code{nscd-service}}).
25672
25673 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
25674 configurations.
25675
25676 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
25677 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
25678 @code{name-service-switch} object.
25679 @end defvr
25680
25681 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
25682 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
25683 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
25684 @end defvr
25685
25686 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
25687 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
25688 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
25689 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
25690 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
25691 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
25692 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
25693 run @command{guix system}.
25694
25695 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
25696
25697 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
25698 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
25699 system databases.
25700
25701 @table @code
25702 @item aliases
25703 @itemx ethers
25704 @itemx group
25705 @itemx gshadow
25706 @itemx hosts
25707 @itemx initgroups
25708 @itemx netgroup
25709 @itemx networks
25710 @itemx password
25711 @itemx public-key
25712 @itemx rpc
25713 @itemx services
25714 @itemx shadow
25715 The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
25716 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
25717 @end table
25718 @end deftp
25719
25720 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
25721
25722 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
25723 associated lookup action.
25724
25725 @table @code
25726 @item name
25727 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
25728 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
25729
25730 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
25731 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
25732 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
25733 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
25734
25735 @item reaction
25736 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
25737 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
25738 Reference Manual}). For example:
25739
25740 @lisp
25741 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
25742 (success => return))
25743 @end lisp
25744 @end table
25745 @end deftp
25746
25747 @node Initial RAM Disk
25748 @section Initial RAM Disk
25749
25750 @cindex initrd
25751 @cindex initial RAM disk
25752 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
25753 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
25754 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
25755 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
25756 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
25757
25758 The @code{initrd-modules} field of an @code{operating-system}
25759 declaration allows you to specify Linux-libre kernel modules that must
25760 be available in the initrd. In particular, this is where you would list
25761 modules needed to actually drive the hard disk where your root partition
25762 is---although the default value of @code{initrd-modules} should cover
25763 most use cases. For example, assuming you need the @code{megaraid_sas}
25764 module in addition to the default modules to be able to access your root
25765 file system, you would write:
25766
25767 @lisp
25768 (operating-system
25769 ;; @dots{}
25770 (initrd-modules (cons "megaraid_sas" %base-initrd-modules)))
25771 @end lisp
25772
25773 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-initrd-modules
25774 This is the list of kernel modules included in the initrd by default.
25775 @end defvr
25776
25777 Furthermore, if you need lower-level customization, the @code{initrd}
25778 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
25779 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
25780 system linux-initrd)} module provides three ways to build an initrd: the
25781 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure and the low-level
25782 @code{raw-initrd} and @code{expression->initrd} procedures.
25783
25784 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
25785 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
25786 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
25787 system declaration like this:
25788
25789 @lisp
25790 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
25791 ;; Create a standard initrd but set up networking
25792 ;; with the parameters QEMU expects by default.
25793 (apply base-initrd file-systems
25794 #:qemu-networking? #t
25795 rest)))
25796 @end lisp
25797
25798 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
25799 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
25800 volatile root file system.
25801
25802 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is built from @code{raw-initrd} procedure.
25803 Unlike @code{base-initrd}, @code{raw-initrd} doesn't do anything high-level,
25804 such as trying to guess which kernel modules and packages should be included
25805 to the initrd. An example use of @code{raw-initrd} is when a user has
25806 a custom Linux kernel configuration and default kernel modules included by
25807 @code{base-initrd} are not available.
25808
25809 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} or @code{raw-initrd}
25810 honors several options passed on the Linux kernel command line
25811 (that is, arguments passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
25812 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
25813
25814 @table @code
25815 @item --load=@var{boot}
25816 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
25817 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
25818
25819 Guix uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
25820 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
25821 initialization system.
25822
25823 @item --root=@var{root}
25824 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a
25825 device name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a file system label, or a file system
25826 UUID.
25827
25828 @item --system=@var{system}
25829 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
25830 @var{system}.
25831
25832 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
25833 @cindex module, black-listing
25834 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
25835 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
25836 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
25837 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
25838 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
25839
25840 @item --repl
25841 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
25842 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
25843 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
25844 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
25845 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
25846
25847 @end table
25848
25849 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
25850 @code{base-initrd} and @code{raw-initrd} provide,
25851 here is how to use it and customize it further.
25852
25853 @cindex initrd
25854 @cindex initial RAM disk
25855 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} raw-initrd @var{file-systems} @
25856 [#:linux-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()] @
25857 [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
25858 [#:helper-packages '()] [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f]
25859 Return a derivation that builds a raw initrd. @var{file-systems} is
25860 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
25861 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @code{--root}.
25862 @var{linux-modules} is a list of kernel modules to be loaded at boot time.
25863 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
25864 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
25865 @var{helper-packages} is a list of packages to be copied in the initrd. It may
25866 include @code{e2fsck/static} or other packages needed by the initrd to check
25867 the root file system.
25868
25869 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
25870 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
25871 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
25872 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
25873 intended keyboard layout.
25874
25875 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
25876 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
25877 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
25878
25879 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
25880 to it are lost.
25881 @end deffn
25882
25883 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
25884 [#:mapped-devices '()] [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
25885 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
25886 [#:linux-modules '()]
25887 Return as a file-like object a generic initrd, with kernel
25888 modules taken from @var{linux}. @var{file-systems} is a list of file-systems to be
25889 mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to the root file system specified
25890 on the kernel command line via @code{--root}. @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device
25891 mappings to realize before @var{file-systems} are mounted.
25892
25893 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
25894 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
25895 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
25896 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
25897 intended keyboard layout.
25898
25899 @var{qemu-networking?} and @var{volatile-root?} behaves as in @code{raw-initrd}.
25900
25901 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
25902 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. Additional kernel
25903 modules can be listed in @var{linux-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
25904 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
25905 @end deffn
25906
25907 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
25908 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
25909 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
25910 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
25911 program to run in that initrd.
25912
25913 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
25914 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
25915 Return as a file-like object a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
25916 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
25917 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
25918 automatically copied to the initrd.
25919 @end deffn
25920
25921 @node Bootloader Configuration
25922 @section Bootloader Configuration
25923
25924 @cindex bootloader
25925 @cindex boot loader
25926
25927 The operating system supports multiple bootloaders. The bootloader is
25928 configured using @code{bootloader-configuration} declaration. All the
25929 fields of this structure are bootloader agnostic except for one field,
25930 @code{bootloader} that indicates the bootloader to be configured and
25931 installed.
25932
25933 Some of the bootloaders do not honor every field of
25934 @code{bootloader-configuration}. For instance, the extlinux
25935 bootloader does not support themes and thus ignores the @code{theme}
25936 field.
25937
25938 @deftp {Data Type} bootloader-configuration
25939 The type of a bootloader configuration declaration.
25940
25941 @table @asis
25942
25943 @item @code{bootloader}
25944 @cindex EFI, bootloader
25945 @cindex UEFI, bootloader
25946 @cindex BIOS, bootloader
25947 The bootloader to use, as a @code{bootloader} object. For now
25948 @code{grub-bootloader}, @code{grub-efi-bootloader},
25949 @code{extlinux-bootloader} and @code{u-boot-bootloader} are supported.
25950
25951 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
25952 @code{grub-efi-bootloader} allows to boot on modern systems using the
25953 @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI). This is what you should
25954 use if the installation image contains a @file{/sys/firmware/efi} directory
25955 when you boot it on your system.
25956
25957 @vindex grub-bootloader
25958 @code{grub-bootloader} allows you to boot in particular Intel-based machines
25959 in ``legacy'' BIOS mode.
25960
25961 @cindex ARM, bootloaders
25962 @cindex AArch64, bootloaders
25963 Available bootloaders are described in @code{(gnu bootloader @dots{})}
25964 modules. In particular, @code{(gnu bootloader u-boot)} contains definitions
25965 of bootloaders for a wide range of ARM and AArch64 systems, using the
25966 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot bootloader}.
25967
25968 @item @code{target}
25969 This is a string denoting the target onto which to install the
25970 bootloader.
25971
25972 The interpretation depends on the bootloader in question. For
25973 @code{grub-bootloader}, for example, it should be a device name understood by
25974 the bootloader @command{installer} command, such as @code{/dev/sda} or
25975 @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). For
25976 @code{grub-efi-bootloader}, it should be the mount point of the EFI file
25977 system, usually @file{/boot/efi}.
25978
25979 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
25980 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
25981 entries to appear in the bootloader menu, in addition to the current
25982 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
25983
25984 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
25985 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
25986 current system.
25987
25988 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
25989 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
25990 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
25991
25992 @cindex keyboard layout, for the bootloader
25993 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
25994 If this is @code{#f}, the bootloader's menu (if any) uses the default keyboard
25995 layout, usually US@tie{}English (``qwerty'').
25996
25997 Otherwise, this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object (@pxref{Keyboard
25998 Layout}).
25999
26000 @quotation Note
26001 This option is currently ignored by bootloaders other than @code{grub} and
26002 @code{grub-efi}.
26003 @end quotation
26004
26005 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{#f})
26006 The bootloader theme object describing the theme to use. If no theme
26007 is provided, some bootloaders might use a default theme, that's true
26008 for GRUB.
26009
26010 @item @code{terminal-outputs} (default: @code{'(gfxterm)})
26011 The output terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
26012 symbols. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console}, @code{serial},
26013 @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{gfxterm}, @code{vga_text},
26014 @code{mda_text}, @code{morse}, and @code{pkmodem}. This field
26015 corresponds to the GRUB variable @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_OUTPUT} (@pxref{Simple
26016 configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
26017
26018 @item @code{terminal-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
26019 The input terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
26020 symbols. For GRUB, the default is the native platform terminal as
26021 determined at run-time. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console},
26022 @code{serial}, @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{at_keyboard}, and
26023 @code{usb_keyboard}. This field corresponds to the GRUB variable
26024 @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_INPUT} (@pxref{Simple configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB
26025 manual}).
26026
26027 @item @code{serial-unit} (default: @code{#f})
26028 The serial unit used by the bootloader, as an integer from 0 to 3.
26029 For GRUB, it is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses 0, which
26030 corresponds to COM1 (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
26031
26032 @item @code{serial-speed} (default: @code{#f})
26033 The speed of the serial interface, as an integer. For GRUB, the
26034 default value is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses
26035 9600@tie{}bps (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
26036 @end table
26037
26038 @end deftp
26039
26040 @cindex dual boot
26041 @cindex boot menu
26042 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
26043 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
26044 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
26045 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
26046 along these lines:
26047
26048 @lisp
26049 (menu-entry
26050 (label "The Other Distro")
26051 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
26052 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
26053 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
26054 @end lisp
26055
26056 Details below.
26057
26058 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
26059 The type of an entry in the bootloader menu.
26060
26061 @table @asis
26062
26063 @item @code{label}
26064 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
26065
26066 @item @code{linux}
26067 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
26068
26069 @lisp
26070 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
26071 @end lisp
26072
26073 For GRUB, it is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the
26074 file path using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming
26075 convention,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
26076
26077 @example
26078 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
26079 @end example
26080
26081 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
26082 field is ignored entirely.
26083
26084 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
26085 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
26086 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
26087
26088 @item @code{initrd}
26089 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
26090 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
26091 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
26092 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., for GRUB,
26093 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
26094
26095 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
26096 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case
26097 the bootloader will search the device containing the file specified by
26098 the @code{linux} field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It
26099 must @emph{not} be an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
26100
26101 @end table
26102 @end deftp
26103
26104 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
26105 For now only GRUB has theme support. GRUB themes are created using
26106 the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not documented yet.
26107
26108 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
26109 This is the default GRUB theme used by the operating system if no
26110 @code{theme} field is specified in @code{bootloader-configuration}
26111 record.
26112
26113 It comes with a fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix
26114 logos.
26115 @end defvr
26116
26117
26118 @node Invoking guix system
26119 @section Invoking @code{guix system}
26120
26121 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
26122 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
26123 system} command. The synopsis is:
26124
26125 @example
26126 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
26127 @end example
26128
26129 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
26130 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
26131 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
26132 supported:
26133
26134 @table @code
26135 @item search
26136 Display available service type definitions that match the given regular
26137 expressions, sorted by relevance:
26138
26139 @cindex HDPI
26140 @cindex HiDPI
26141 @cindex resolution
26142 @example
26143 $ guix system search console
26144 name: console-fonts
26145 location: gnu/services/base.scm:806:2
26146 extends: shepherd-root
26147 description: Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are per
26148 + virtual console on GNU/Linux). The value of this service is a list of
26149 + tty/font pairs. The font can be the name of a font provided by the `kbd'
26150 + package or any valid argument to `setfont', as in this example:
26151 +
26152 + '(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16")
26153 + ("tty2" . (file-append
26154 + font-tamzen
26155 + "/share/kbd/consolefonts/TamzenForPowerline10x20.psf"))
26156 + ("tty3" . (file-append
26157 + font-terminus
26158 + "/share/consolefonts/ter-132n"))) ; for HDPI
26159 relevance: 9
26160
26161 name: mingetty
26162 location: gnu/services/base.scm:1190:2
26163 extends: shepherd-root
26164 description: Provide console login using the `mingetty' program.
26165 relevance: 2
26166
26167 name: login
26168 location: gnu/services/base.scm:860:2
26169 extends: pam
26170 description: Provide a console log-in service as specified by its
26171 + configuration value, a `login-configuration' object.
26172 relevance: 2
26173
26174 @dots{}
26175 @end example
26176
26177 As for @command{guix package --search}, the result is written in
26178 @code{recutils} format, which makes it easy to filter the output
26179 (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}).
26180
26181 @item reconfigure
26182 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
26183 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
26184 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
26185 systems already running Guix System.}.
26186
26187 @quotation Note
26188 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
26189 @c <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
26190 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
26191 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
26192 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
26193 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
26194 @end quotation
26195
26196 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
26197 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
26198 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
26199 currently running; if a service is currently running this command will
26200 arrange for it to be upgraded the next time it is stopped (e.g.@: by
26201 @code{herd stop X} or @code{herd restart X}).
26202
26203 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
26204 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
26205 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
26206 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
26207 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
26208
26209 It also adds a bootloader menu entry for the new OS configuration,
26210 ---unless @option{--no-bootloader} is passed. For GRUB, it moves
26211 entries for older configurations to a submenu, allowing you to choose
26212 an older system generation at boot time should you need it.
26213
26214 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
26215 Upon completion, the new system is deployed under
26216 @file{/run/current-system}. This directory contains @dfn{provenance
26217 meta-data}: the list of channels in use (@pxref{Channels}) and
26218 @var{file} itself, when available. This information is useful should
26219 you later want to inspect how this particular generation was built.
26220
26221 In fact, assuming @var{file} is self-contained, you can later rebuild
26222 generation @var{n} of your operating system with:
26223
26224 @example
26225 guix time-machine \
26226 -C /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/channels.scm -- \
26227 system reconfigure \
26228 /var/guix/profiles/system-@var{n}-link/configuration.scm
26229 @end example
26230
26231 You can think of it as some sort of built-in version control! Your
26232 system is not just a binary artifact: @emph{it carries its own source}.
26233 @xref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}, for more
26234 information on provenance tracking.
26235
26236 @item switch-generation
26237 @cindex generations
26238 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
26239 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It
26240 also rearranges the system's existing bootloader menu entries. It
26241 makes the menu entry for the specified system generation the default,
26242 and it moves the entries for the other generatiors to a submenu, if
26243 supported by the bootloader being used. The next time the system
26244 boots, it will use the specified system generation.
26245
26246 The bootloader itself is not being reinstalled when using this
26247 command. Thus, the installed bootloader is used with an updated
26248 configuration file.
26249
26250 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
26251 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
26252 generation 7:
26253
26254 @example
26255 guix system switch-generation 7
26256 @end example
26257
26258 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
26259 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
26260 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
26261 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
26262 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
26263 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
26264
26265 @example
26266 guix system switch-generation -- -1
26267 @end example
26268
26269 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
26270 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the
26271 bootloader menu entries. To actually start using the target system
26272 generation, you must reboot after running this action. In the future,
26273 it will be updated to do the same things as @command{reconfigure},
26274 like activating and deactivating services.
26275
26276 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
26277
26278 @item roll-back
26279 @cindex rolling back
26280 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
26281 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
26282 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
26283 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
26284
26285 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
26286 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
26287 generation.
26288
26289 @item delete-generations
26290 @cindex deleting system generations
26291 @cindex saving space
26292 Delete system generations, making them candidates for garbage collection
26293 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}, for information on how to run the ``garbage
26294 collector'').
26295
26296 This works in the same way as @command{guix package --delete-generations}
26297 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{--delete-generations}}). With no
26298 arguments, all system generations but the current one are deleted:
26299
26300 @example
26301 guix system delete-generations
26302 @end example
26303
26304 You can also select the generations you want to delete. The example below
26305 deletes all the system generations that are more than two month old:
26306
26307 @example
26308 guix system delete-generations 2m
26309 @end example
26310
26311 Running this command automatically reinstalls the bootloader with an updated
26312 list of menu entries---e.g., the ``old generations'' sub-menu in GRUB no
26313 longer lists the generations that have been deleted.
26314
26315 @item build
26316 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
26317 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
26318 This action does not actually install anything.
26319
26320 @item init
26321 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
26322 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
26323 installations of Guix System. For instance:
26324
26325 @example
26326 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
26327 @end example
26328
26329 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
26330 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
26331 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
26332 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
26333 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
26334
26335 This command also installs bootloader on the target specified in
26336 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-bootloader} option was
26337 passed.
26338
26339 @item vm
26340 @cindex virtual machine
26341 @cindex VM
26342 @anchor{guix system vm}
26343 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
26344 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
26345
26346 @quotation Note
26347 The @code{vm} action and others below
26348 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
26349 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
26350 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
26351 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
26352 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
26353 @end quotation
26354
26355 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU as in the example
26356 below, which enables networking and requests 1@tie{}GiB of RAM for the
26357 emulated machine:
26358
26359 @example
26360 $ /gnu/store/@dots{}-run-vm.sh -m 1024 -smp 2 -net user,model=virtio-net-pci
26361 @end example
26362
26363 The VM shares its store with the host system.
26364
26365 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
26366 the @code{--share} and @code{--expose} command-line options: the former
26367 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
26368 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
26369
26370 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
26371 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
26372 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
26373
26374 @example
26375 guix system vm my-config.scm \
26376 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
26377 @end example
26378
26379 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
26380 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
26381 store of the host can then be mounted.
26382
26383 The @code{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
26384 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
26385 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
26386 be created. The @code{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
26387 size of the image.
26388
26389 @cindex System images, creation in various formats
26390 @cindex Creating system images in various formats
26391 @item vm-image
26392 @itemx disk-image
26393 @itemx docker-image
26394 Return a virtual machine, disk image, or Docker image of the operating
26395 system declared in @var{file} that stands alone. By default,
26396 @command{guix system} estimates the size of the image needed to store
26397 the system, but you can use the @option{--image-size} option to specify
26398 a value. Docker images are built to contain exactly what they need, so
26399 the @option{--image-size} option is ignored in the case of
26400 @code{docker-image}.
26401
26402 You can specify the root file system type by using the
26403 @option{--file-system-type} option. It defaults to @code{ext4}.
26404
26405 When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
26406 the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running Guix in a VM},
26407 for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
26408
26409 When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
26410 copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
26411 the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image to it
26412 using the following command:
26413
26414 @example
26415 # dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc
26416 @end example
26417
26418 When using @code{docker-image}, a Docker image is produced. Guix builds
26419 the image from scratch, not from a pre-existing Docker base image. As a
26420 result, it contains @emph{exactly} what you define in the operating
26421 system configuration file. You can then load the image and launch a
26422 Docker container using commands like the following:
26423
26424 @example
26425 image_id="`docker load < guix-system-docker-image.tar.gz`"
26426 container_id="`docker create $image_id`"
26427 docker start $container_id
26428 @end example
26429
26430 This command starts a new Docker container from the specified image. It
26431 will boot the Guix system in the usual manner, which means it will
26432 start any services you have defined in the operating system
26433 configuration. You can get an interactive shell running in the container
26434 using @command{docker exec}:
26435
26436 @example
26437 docker exec -ti $container_id /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
26438 @end example
26439
26440 Depending on what you run in the Docker container, it
26441 may be necessary to give the container additional permissions. For
26442 example, if you intend to build software using Guix inside of the Docker
26443 container, you may need to pass the @option{--privileged} option to
26444 @code{docker create}.
26445
26446 @item container
26447 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
26448 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
26449 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
26450 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
26451 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
26452 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
26453
26454 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
26455 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
26456 system.
26457
26458 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
26459 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
26460 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
26461
26462 @example
26463 guix system container my-config.scm \
26464 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
26465 @end example
26466
26467 @quotation Note
26468 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
26469 @end quotation
26470
26471 @end table
26472
26473 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
26474 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
26475 following:
26476
26477 @table @option
26478 @item --expression=@var{expr}
26479 @itemx -e @var{expr}
26480 Consider the operating-system @var{expr} evaluates to.
26481 This is an alternative to specifying a file which evaluates to an
26482 operating system.
26483 This is used to generate the Guix system installer @pxref{Building the
26484 Installation Image}).
26485
26486 @item --system=@var{system}
26487 @itemx -s @var{system}
26488 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
26489 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
26490
26491 @item --derivation
26492 @itemx -d
26493 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
26494 building anything.
26495
26496 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
26497 @item --save-provenance
26498 As discussed above, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
26499 reconfigure} always save provenance information @i{via} a dedicated
26500 service (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{provenance-service-type}}).
26501 However, other commands don't do that by default. If you wish to, say,
26502 create a virtual machine image that contains provenance information, you
26503 can run:
26504
26505 @example
26506 guix system vm-image --save-provenance config.scm
26507 @end example
26508
26509 That way, the resulting image will effectively ``embed its own source''
26510 in the form of meta-data in @file{/run/current-system}. With that
26511 information, one can rebuild the image to make sure it really contains
26512 what it pretends to contain; or they could use that to derive a variant
26513 of the image.
26514
26515 @item --file-system-type=@var{type}
26516 @itemx -t @var{type}
26517 For the @code{disk-image} action, create a file system of the given
26518 @var{type} on the image.
26519
26520 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} uses @code{ext4}.
26521
26522 @cindex ISO-9660 format
26523 @cindex CD image format
26524 @cindex DVD image format
26525 @code{--file-system-type=iso9660} produces an ISO-9660 image, suitable
26526 for burning on CDs and DVDs.
26527
26528 @item --image-size=@var{size}
26529 For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
26530 of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
26531 include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
26532 coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
26533
26534 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} computes an estimate
26535 of the image size as a function of the size of the system declared in
26536 @var{file}.
26537
26538 @item --network
26539 @itemx -N
26540 For the @code{container} action, allow containers to access the host network,
26541 that is, do not create a network namespace.
26542
26543 @item --root=@var{file}
26544 @itemx -r @var{file}
26545 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
26546 collector root.
26547
26548 @item --skip-checks
26549 Skip pre-installation safety checks.
26550
26551 By default, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
26552 reconfigure} perform safety checks: they make sure the file systems that
26553 appear in the @code{operating-system} declaration actually exist
26554 (@pxref{File Systems}), and that any Linux kernel modules that may be
26555 needed at boot time are listed in @code{initrd-modules} (@pxref{Initial
26556 RAM Disk}). Passing this option skips these tests altogether.
26557
26558 @cindex on-error
26559 @cindex on-error strategy
26560 @cindex error strategy
26561 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
26562 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
26563 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
26564
26565 @table @code
26566 @item nothing-special
26567 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
26568
26569 @item backtrace
26570 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
26571
26572 @item debug
26573 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
26574 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
26575 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
26576 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
26577 a list of available debugging commands.
26578 @end table
26579 @end table
26580
26581 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
26582 your Guix installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
26583 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
26584 bootloader boot menu:
26585
26586 @table @code
26587
26588 @item describe
26589 Describe the current system generation: its file name, the kernel and
26590 bootloader used, etc., as well as provenance information when available.
26591
26592 @item list-generations
26593 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
26594 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
26595 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
26596 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
26597
26598 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
26599 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
26600 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
26601 generations that are up to 10 days old:
26602
26603 @example
26604 $ guix system list-generations 10d
26605 @end example
26606
26607 @end table
26608
26609 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
26610 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
26611 each other:
26612
26613 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
26614 @table @code
26615
26616 @item extension-graph
26617 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
26618 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
26619 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
26620 extensions.)
26621
26622 The command:
26623
26624 @example
26625 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | dot -Tpdf > services.pdf
26626 @end example
26627
26628 produces a PDF file showing the extension relations among services.
26629
26630 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
26631 @item shepherd-graph
26632 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
26633 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
26634 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
26635 example graph.
26636
26637 @end table
26638
26639 @node Invoking guix deploy
26640 @section Invoking @code{guix deploy}
26641
26642 We've already seen @code{operating-system} declarations used to manage a
26643 machine's configuration locally. Suppose you need to configure multiple
26644 machines, though---perhaps you're managing a service on the web that's
26645 comprised of several servers. @command{guix deploy} enables you to use those
26646 same @code{operating-system} declarations to manage multiple remote hosts at
26647 once as a logical ``deployment''.
26648
26649 @quotation Note
26650 The functionality described in this section is still under development
26651 and is subject to change. Get in touch with us on
26652 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}!
26653 @end quotation
26654
26655 @example
26656 guix deploy @var{file}
26657 @end example
26658
26659 Such an invocation will deploy the machines that the code within @var{file}
26660 evaluates to. As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this:
26661
26662 @lisp
26663 ;; This is a Guix deployment of a "bare bones" setup, with
26664 ;; no X11 display server, to a machine with an SSH daemon
26665 ;; listening on localhost:2222. A configuration such as this
26666 ;; may be appropriate for virtual machine with ports
26667 ;; forwarded to the host's loopback interface.
26668
26669 (use-service-modules networking ssh)
26670 (use-package-modules bootloaders)
26671
26672 (define %system
26673 (operating-system
26674 (host-name "gnu-deployed")
26675 (timezone "Etc/UTC")
26676 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
26677 (bootloader grub-bootloader)
26678 (target "/dev/vda")
26679 (terminal-outputs '(console))))
26680 (file-systems (cons (file-system
26681 (mount-point "/")
26682 (device "/dev/vda1")
26683 (type "ext4"))
26684 %base-file-systems))
26685 (services
26686 (append (list (service dhcp-client-service-type)
26687 (service openssh-service-type
26688 (openssh-configuration
26689 (permit-root-login #t)
26690 (allow-empty-passwords? #t))))
26691 %base-services))))
26692
26693 (list (machine
26694 (operating-system %system)
26695 (environment managed-host-environment-type)
26696 (configuration (machine-ssh-configuration
26697 (host-name "localhost")
26698 (system "x86_64-linux")
26699 (user "alice")
26700 (identity "./id_rsa")
26701 (port 2222)))))
26702 @end lisp
26703
26704 The file should evaluate to a list of @var{machine} objects. This example,
26705 upon being deployed, will create a new generation on the remote system
26706 realizing the @code{operating-system} declaration @var{%system}.
26707 @var{environment} and @var{configuration} specify how the machine should be
26708 provisioned---that is, how the computing resources should be created and
26709 managed. The above example does not create any resources, as a
26710 @code{'managed-host} is a machine that is already running the Guix system and
26711 available over the network. This is a particularly simple case; a more
26712 complex deployment may involve, for example, starting virtual machines through
26713 a Virtual Private Server (VPS) provider. In such a case, a different
26714 @var{environment} type would be used.
26715
26716 Do note that you first need to generate a key pair on the coordinator machine
26717 to allow the daemon to export signed archives of files from the store
26718 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
26719
26720 @example
26721 # guix archive --generate-key
26722 @end example
26723
26724 @noindent
26725 Each target machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that it
26726 accepts store items it receives from the coordinator:
26727
26728 @example
26729 # guix archive --authorize < coordinator-public-key.txt
26730 @end example
26731
26732 @code{user}, in this example, specifies the name of the user account to log in
26733 as to perform the deployment. Its default value is @code{root}, but root
26734 login over SSH may be forbidden in some cases. To work around this,
26735 @command{guix deploy} can log in as an unprivileged user and employ
26736 @code{sudo} to escalate privileges. This will only work if @code{sudo} is
26737 currently installed on the remote and can be invoked non-interactively as
26738 @code{user}. That is: the line in @code{sudoers} granting @code{user} the
26739 ability to use @code{sudo} must contain the @code{NOPASSWD} tag.
26740
26741 @deftp {Data Type} machine
26742 This is the data type representing a single machine in a heterogeneous Guix
26743 deployment.
26744
26745 @table @asis
26746 @item @code{operating-system}
26747 The object of the operating system configuration to deploy.
26748
26749 @item @code{environment}
26750 An @code{environment-type} describing how the machine should be provisioned.
26751
26752 @item @code{configuration} (default: @code{#f})
26753 An object describing the configuration for the machine's @code{environment}.
26754 If the @code{environment} has a default configuration, @code{#f} may be used.
26755 If @code{#f} is used for an environment with no default configuration,
26756 however, an error will be thrown.
26757 @end table
26758 @end deftp
26759
26760 @deftp {Data Type} machine-ssh-configuration
26761 This is the data type representing the SSH client parameters for a machine
26762 with an @code{environment} of @code{managed-host-environment-type}.
26763
26764 @table @asis
26765 @item @code{host-name}
26766 @item @code{build-locally?} (default: @code{#t})
26767 If false, system derivations will be built on the machine being deployed to.
26768 @item @code{system}
26769 The system type describing the architecture of the machine being deployed
26770 to---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
26771 @item @code{authorize?} (default: @code{#t})
26772 If true, the coordinator's signing key will be added to the remote's ACL
26773 keyring.
26774 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
26775 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"root"})
26776 @item @code{identity} (default: @code{#f})
26777 If specified, the path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the
26778 remote host.
26779
26780 @item @code{host-key} (default: @code{#f})
26781 This should be the SSH host key of the machine, which looks like this:
26782
26783 @example
26784 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nz@dots{} root@@example.org
26785 @end example
26786
26787 When @code{host-key} is @code{#f}, the server is authenticated against
26788 the @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} file, just like the OpenSSH @command{ssh}
26789 client does.
26790
26791 @end table
26792 @end deftp
26793
26794 @deftp {Data Type} digital-ocean-configuration
26795 This is the data type describing the Droplet that should be created for a
26796 machine with an @code{environment} of @code{digital-ocean-environment-type}.
26797
26798 @table @asis
26799 @item @code{ssh-key}
26800 The path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the remote
26801 host. In the future, this field may not exist.
26802 @item @code{tags}
26803 A list of string ``tags'' that uniquely identify the machine. Must be given
26804 such that no two machines in the deployment have the same set of tags.
26805 @item @code{region}
26806 A Digital Ocean region slug, such as @code{"nyc3"}.
26807 @item @code{size}
26808 A Digital Ocean size slug, such as @code{"s-1vcpu-1gb"}
26809 @item @code{enable-ipv6?}
26810 Whether or not the droplet should be created with IPv6 networking.
26811 @end table
26812 @end deftp
26813
26814 @node Running Guix in a VM
26815 @section Running Guix in a Virtual Machine
26816
26817 @cindex virtual machine
26818 To run Guix in a virtual machine (VM), one can use the pre-built Guix VM image
26819 distributed at
26820 @url{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-vm-image-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.xz}.
26821 This image is a compressed image in QCOW format. You will first need to
26822 decompress with @command{xz -d}, and then you can pass it to an emulator such
26823 as QEMU (see below for details).
26824
26825 This image boots the Xfce graphical environment and it contains some
26826 commonly-used tools. You can install more software in the image by running
26827 @command{guix package} in a terminal (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). You can
26828 also reconfigure the system based on its initial configuration file available
26829 as @file{/etc/config.scm} (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
26830
26831 Instead of using this pre-built image, one can also build their own virtual
26832 machine image using @command{guix system vm-image} (@pxref{Invoking guix
26833 system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format, which the
26834 @uref{https://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
26835
26836 @cindex QEMU
26837 If you built your own image, you must copy it out of the store
26838 (@pxref{The Store}) and give yourself permission to write to the copy
26839 before you can use it. When invoking QEMU, you must choose a system
26840 emulator that is suitable for your hardware platform. Here is a minimal
26841 QEMU invocation that will boot the result of @command{guix system
26842 vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
26843
26844 @example
26845 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
26846 -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci \
26847 -enable-kvm -m 1024 \
26848 -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd \
26849 -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
26850 @end example
26851
26852 Here is what each of these options means:
26853
26854 @table @code
26855 @item qemu-system-x86_64
26856 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
26857 host.
26858
26859 @item -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci
26860 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
26861 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
26862 guest OS online. @code{model} specifies which network device to emulate:
26863 @code{virtio-net-pci} is a special device made for virtualized operating
26864 systems and recommended for most uses. Assuming your hardware platform is
26865 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
26866 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -nic model=help}.
26867
26868 @item -enable-kvm
26869 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
26870 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
26871 faster.
26872
26873 @c To run Xfce + 'guix pull', we need at least 1G of RAM.
26874 @item -m 1024
26875 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
26876 which may be insufficient for some operations.
26877
26878 @item -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd
26879 Create a @code{virtio-blk} drive called ``myhd''. @code{virtio-blk} is a
26880 ``paravirtualization'' mechanism for block devices that allows QEMU to achieve
26881 better performance than if it were emulating a complete disk drive. See the
26882 QEMU and KVM documentation for more info.
26883
26884 @item -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
26885 Use our QCOW image, the @file{/tmp/qemu-image} file, as the backing store the
26886 the ``myhd'' drive.
26887 @end table
26888
26889 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invocation of
26890 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-nic user} flag by default.
26891 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
26892 to your system definition and start the VM using
26893 @command{`guix system vm config.scm` -nic user}. An important caveat of using
26894 @command{-nic user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
26895 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
26896 network connectivity, for example @command{guix download}.
26897
26898 @subsection Connecting Through SSH
26899
26900 @cindex SSH
26901 @cindex SSH server
26902 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add an SSH server like
26903 @code{openssh-service-type} to your VM (@pxref{Networking Services,
26904 @code{openssh-service-type}}). In addition you need to forward the SSH port,
26905 22 by default, to the host. You can do this with
26906
26907 @example
26908 `guix system vm config.scm` -nic user,model=virtio-net-pci,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
26909 @end example
26910
26911 To connect to the VM you can run
26912
26913 @example
26914 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022
26915 @end example
26916
26917 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
26918 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
26919 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
26920 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
26921 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
26922
26923 @subsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
26924
26925 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
26926 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
26927 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
26928 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
26929
26930 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
26931 VM. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
26932
26933 @example
26934 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
26935 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
26936 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
26937 name=com.redhat.spice.0
26938 @end example
26939
26940 You'll also need to add the @pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}.
26941
26942 @node Defining Services
26943 @section Defining Services
26944
26945 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
26946 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
26947 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
26948
26949 @menu
26950 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
26951 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
26952 * Service Reference:: API reference.
26953 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
26954 @end menu
26955
26956 @node Service Composition
26957 @subsection Service Composition
26958
26959 @cindex services
26960 @cindex daemons
26961 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
26962 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
26963 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
26964 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
26965 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
26966 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
26967 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
26968 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
26969 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
26970 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
26971 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
26972 of the system.
26973
26974 @cindex service extensions
26975 Guix system services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
26976 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the
26977 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
26978 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
26979 Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
26980 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
26981 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
26982 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
26983 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
26984 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
26985 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
26986
26987 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
26988 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
26989 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
26990
26991 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
26992
26993 @cindex system service
26994 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
26995 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
26996 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
26997 to learn about the other service types shown here.
26998 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
26999 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
27000 particular operating system definition.
27001
27002 @cindex service types
27003 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
27004 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
27005 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
27006 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @code{lsh-service-type}, with
27007 different parameters.
27008
27009 The following section describes the programming interface for service
27010 types and services.
27011
27012 @node Service Types and Services
27013 @subsection Service Types and Services
27014
27015 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
27016 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
27017 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
27018
27019 @lisp
27020 (define guix-service-type
27021 (service-type
27022 (name 'guix)
27023 (extensions
27024 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
27025 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
27026 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))
27027 (default-value (guix-configuration))))
27028 @end lisp
27029
27030 @noindent
27031 It defines three things:
27032
27033 @enumerate
27034 @item
27035 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
27036
27037 @item
27038 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
27039 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
27040 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
27041
27042 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
27043 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
27044
27045 @item
27046 Optionally, a default value for instances of this type.
27047 @end enumerate
27048
27049 In this example, @code{guix-service-type} extends three services:
27050
27051 @table @code
27052 @item shepherd-root-service-type
27053 The @code{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
27054 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
27055 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
27056 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
27057
27058 @item account-service-type
27059 This extension for this service is computed by @code{guix-accounts},
27060 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
27061 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
27062 guix-daemon}).
27063
27064 @item activation-service-type
27065 Here @code{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
27066 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
27067 booted.
27068 @end table
27069
27070 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
27071
27072 @lisp
27073 (service guix-service-type
27074 (guix-configuration
27075 (build-accounts 5)
27076 (use-substitutes? #f)))
27077 @end lisp
27078
27079 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
27080 the parameters of this specific service instance.
27081 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
27082 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type. When the
27083 value is omitted, the default value specified by
27084 @code{guix-service-type} is used:
27085
27086 @lisp
27087 (service guix-service-type)
27088 @end lisp
27089
27090 @code{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
27091 services but is not extensible itself.
27092
27093 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
27094
27095 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
27096
27097 @lisp
27098 (define udev-service-type
27099 (service-type (name 'udev)
27100 (extensions
27101 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
27102 udev-shepherd-service)))
27103
27104 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
27105 (extend (lambda (config rules)
27106 (match config
27107 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
27108 (udev-configuration
27109 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
27110 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
27111 @end lisp
27112
27113 This is the service type for the
27114 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
27115 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
27116 extension of @code{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
27117
27118 @table @code
27119 @item compose
27120 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
27121 services of this type.
27122
27123 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
27124 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
27125
27126 @item extend
27127 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
27128 the composition of the extensions.
27129
27130 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
27131 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
27132 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
27133 list of contributed rules.
27134
27135 @item description
27136 This is a string giving an overview of the service type. The string can
27137 contain Texinfo markup (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). The
27138 @command{guix system search} command searches these strings and displays
27139 them (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
27140 @end table
27141
27142 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
27143 @code{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
27144 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
27145
27146 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
27147 interface for services.
27148
27149 @node Service Reference
27150 @subsection Service Reference
27151
27152 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
27153 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
27154 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
27155 @code{(gnu services)} module.
27156
27157 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} [@var{value}]
27158 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
27159 below.) @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
27160 this particular service instance.
27161
27162 When @var{value} is omitted, the default value specified by @var{type}
27163 is used; if @var{type} does not specify a default value, an error is
27164 raised.
27165
27166 For instance, this:
27167
27168 @lisp
27169 (service openssh-service-type)
27170 @end lisp
27171
27172 @noindent
27173 is equivalent to this:
27174
27175 @lisp
27176 (service openssh-service-type
27177 (openssh-configuration))
27178 @end lisp
27179
27180 In both cases the result is an instance of @code{openssh-service-type}
27181 with the default configuration.
27182 @end deffn
27183
27184 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
27185 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
27186 @end deffn
27187
27188 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
27189 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
27190 @end deffn
27191
27192 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-value @var{service}
27193 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
27194 parameters.
27195 @end deffn
27196
27197 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
27198
27199 @lisp
27200 (define s
27201 (service nginx-service-type
27202 (nginx-configuration
27203 (nginx nginx)
27204 (log-directory log-directory)
27205 (run-directory run-directory)
27206 (file config-file))))
27207
27208 (service? s)
27209 @result{} #t
27210
27211 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
27212 @result{} #t
27213 @end lisp
27214
27215 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
27216 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
27217 @code{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
27218 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
27219 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
27220 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
27221 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
27222 common pattern.
27223
27224 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
27225 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
27226
27227 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
27228 clauses. Each clause has the form:
27229
27230 @example
27231 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
27232 @end example
27233
27234 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
27235 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
27236 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
27237 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
27238 @var{type}.
27239
27240 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
27241 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
27242 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
27243 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
27244 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
27245 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
27246
27247 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
27248
27249 @end deffn
27250
27251 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
27252 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
27253 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
27254 @code{operating-system} declaration.
27255
27256 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
27257 @cindex service type
27258 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
27259 and Services}).
27260
27261 @table @asis
27262 @item @code{name}
27263 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
27264
27265 @item @code{extensions}
27266 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
27267
27268 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
27269 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
27270 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
27271 services.
27272
27273 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
27274 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
27275 extensions. It may return any single value.
27276
27277 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
27278 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
27279
27280 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
27281 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first
27282 argument and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension
27283 values as the second argument. It must return a value that is a valid
27284 parameter value for the service instance.
27285 @end table
27286
27287 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
27288 @end deftp
27289
27290 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
27291 @var{compute}
27292 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
27293 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
27294 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
27295 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
27296 @end deffn
27297
27298 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
27299 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
27300 @end deffn
27301
27302 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
27303 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
27304 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
27305 provides a shorthand for this.
27306
27307 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
27308 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
27309 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
27310 service is an instance.
27311
27312 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
27313 an additional job:
27314
27315 @lisp
27316 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
27317 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
27318 @end lisp
27319 @end deffn
27320
27321 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
27322 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
27323 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
27324 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
27325 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
27326 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
27327 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
27328
27329 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
27330 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
27331 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
27332 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
27333 @end deffn
27334
27335 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
27336 service types, some of which are listed below.
27337
27338 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
27339 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
27340 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
27341 @end defvr
27342
27343 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
27344 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
27345 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
27346 @end defvr
27347
27348 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
27349 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service is used to create
27350 files under @file{/etc} and can be extended by
27351 passing it name/file tuples such as:
27352
27353 @lisp
27354 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
27355 @end lisp
27356
27357 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
27358 pointing to the given file.
27359 @end defvr
27360
27361 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
27362 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
27363 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
27364 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
27365 @end defvr
27366
27367 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
27368 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
27369 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
27370 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
27371 @end defvr
27372
27373 @cindex provenance tracking, of the operating system
27374 @defvr {Scheme Variable} provenance-service-type
27375 This is the type of the service that records @dfn{provenance meta-data}
27376 in the system itself. It creates several files under
27377 @file{/run/current-system}:
27378
27379 @table @file
27380 @item channels.scm
27381 This is a ``channel file'' that can be passed to @command{guix pull -C}
27382 or @command{guix time-machine -C}, and which describes the channels used
27383 to build the system, if that information was available
27384 (@pxref{Channels}).
27385
27386 @item configuration.scm
27387 This is the file that was passed as the value for this
27388 @code{provenance-service-type} service. By default, @command{guix
27389 system reconfigure} automatically passes the OS configuration file it
27390 received on the command line.
27391
27392 @item provenance
27393 This contains the same information as the two other files but in a
27394 format that is more readily processable.
27395 @end table
27396
27397 In general, these two pieces of information (channels and configuration
27398 file) are enough to reproduce the operating system ``from source''.
27399
27400 @quotation Caveats
27401 This information is necessary to rebuild your operating system, but it
27402 is not always sufficient. In particular, @file{configuration.scm}
27403 itself is insufficient if it is not self-contained---if it refers to
27404 external Guile modules or to extra files. If you want
27405 @file{configuration.scm} to be self-contained, we recommend that modules
27406 or files it refers to be part of a channel.
27407
27408 Besides, provenance meta-data is ``silent'' in the sense that it does
27409 not change the bits contained in your system, @emph{except for the
27410 meta-data bits themselves}. Two different OS configurations or sets of
27411 channels can lead to the same system, bit-for-bit; when
27412 @code{provenance-service-type} is used, these two systems will have
27413 different meta-data and thus different store file names, which makes
27414 comparison less trivial.
27415 @end quotation
27416
27417 This service is automatically added to your operating system
27418 configuration when you use @command{guix system reconfigure},
27419 @command{guix system init}, or @command{guix deploy}.
27420 @end defvr
27421
27422 @node Shepherd Services
27423 @subsection Shepherd Services
27424
27425 @cindex shepherd services
27426 @cindex PID 1
27427 @cindex init system
27428 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
27429 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the
27430 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
27431 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
27432 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
27433
27434 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
27435 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
27436 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
27437 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
27438 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
27439
27440 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
27441
27442 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
27443 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
27444 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
27445
27446 The @code{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
27447 PID@tie{}1, of type @code{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
27448 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
27449
27450 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
27451 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
27452
27453 @table @asis
27454 @item @code{provision}
27455 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
27456
27457 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
27458 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
27459 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
27460 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
27461
27462 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'()})
27463 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
27464
27465 @cindex one-shot services, for the Shepherd
27466 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
27467 Whether this service is @dfn{one-shot}. One-shot services stop immediately
27468 after their @code{start} action has completed. @xref{Slots of services,,,
27469 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more info.
27470
27471 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
27472 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
27473 underlying process dies.
27474
27475 @item @code{start}
27476 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
27477 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
27478 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
27479 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
27480 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
27481 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
27482
27483 @item @code{actions} (default: @code{'()})
27484 @cindex actions, of Shepherd services
27485 This is a list of @code{shepherd-action} objects (see below) defining
27486 @dfn{actions} supported by the service, in addition to the standard
27487 @code{start} and @code{stop} actions. Actions listed here become available as
27488 @command{herd} sub-commands:
27489
27490 @example
27491 herd @var{action} @var{service} [@var{arguments}@dots{}]
27492 @end example
27493
27494 @item @code{auto-start?} (default: @code{#t})
27495 Whether this service should be started automatically by the Shepherd. If it
27496 is @code{#f} the service has to be started manually with @code{herd start}.
27497
27498 @item @code{documentation}
27499 A documentation string, as shown when running:
27500
27501 @example
27502 herd doc @var{service-name}
27503 @end example
27504
27505 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @code{provision}
27506 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
27507
27508 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-modules})
27509 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
27510 @code{stop} are evaluated.
27511
27512 @end table
27513 @end deftp
27514
27515 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-action
27516 This is the data type that defines additional actions implemented by a
27517 Shepherd service (see above).
27518
27519 @table @code
27520 @item name
27521 Symbol naming the action.
27522
27523 @item documentation
27524 This is a documentation string for the action. It can be viewed by running:
27525
27526 @example
27527 herd doc @var{service} action @var{action}
27528 @end example
27529
27530 @item procedure
27531 This should be a gexp that evaluates to a procedure of at least one argument,
27532 which is the ``running value'' of the service (@pxref{Slots of services,,,
27533 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
27534 @end table
27535
27536 The following example defines an action called @code{say-hello} that kindly
27537 greets the user:
27538
27539 @lisp
27540 (shepherd-action
27541 (name 'say-hello)
27542 (documentation "Say hi!")
27543 (procedure #~(lambda (running . args)
27544 (format #t "Hello, friend! arguments: ~s\n"
27545 args)
27546 #t)))
27547 @end lisp
27548
27549 Assuming this action is added to the @code{example} service, then you can do:
27550
27551 @example
27552 # herd say-hello example
27553 Hello, friend! arguments: ()
27554 # herd say-hello example a b c
27555 Hello, friend! arguments: ("a" "b" "c")
27556 @end example
27557
27558 This, as you can see, is a fairly sophisticated way to say hello.
27559 @xref{Service Convenience,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more
27560 info on actions.
27561 @end deftp
27562
27563 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
27564 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
27565
27566 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
27567 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
27568 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
27569 @end defvr
27570
27571 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
27572 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
27573 @end defvr
27574
27575
27576 @node Documentation
27577 @chapter Documentation
27578
27579 @cindex documentation, searching for
27580 @cindex searching for documentation
27581 @cindex Info, documentation format
27582 @cindex man pages
27583 @cindex manual pages
27584 In most cases packages installed with Guix come with documentation.
27585 There are two main documentation formats: ``Info'', a browseable
27586 hypertext format used for GNU software, and ``manual pages'' (or ``man
27587 pages''), the linear documentation format traditionally found on Unix.
27588 Info manuals are accessed with the @command{info} command or with Emacs,
27589 and man pages are accessed using @command{man}.
27590
27591 You can look for documentation of software installed on your system by
27592 keyword. For example, the following command searches for information
27593 about ``TLS'' in Info manuals:
27594
27595 @example
27596 $ info -k TLS
27597 "(emacs)Network Security" -- STARTTLS
27598 "(emacs)Network Security" -- TLS
27599 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_flags
27600 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_function
27601 @dots{}
27602 @end example
27603
27604 @noindent
27605 The command below searches for the same keyword in man pages:
27606
27607 @example
27608 $ man -k TLS
27609 SSL (7) - OpenSSL SSL/TLS library
27610 certtool (1) - GnuTLS certificate tool
27611 @dots {}
27612 @end example
27613
27614 These searches are purely local to your computer so you have the
27615 guarantee that documentation you find corresponds to what you have
27616 actually installed, you can access it off-line, and your privacy is
27617 respected.
27618
27619 Once you have these results, you can view the relevant documentation by
27620 running, say:
27621
27622 @example
27623 $ info "(gnutls)Core TLS API"
27624 @end example
27625
27626 @noindent
27627 or:
27628
27629 @example
27630 $ man certtool
27631 @end example
27632
27633 Info manuals contain sections and indices as well as hyperlinks like
27634 those found in Web pages. The @command{info} reader (@pxref{Top, Info
27635 reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU Info}) and its Emacs counterpart
27636 (@pxref{Misc Help,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}) provide intuitive key
27637 bindings to navigate manuals. @xref{Getting Started,,, info, Info: An
27638 Introduction}, for an introduction to Info navigation.
27639
27640 @node Installing Debugging Files
27641 @chapter Installing Debugging Files
27642
27643 @cindex debugging files
27644 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
27645 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
27646 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
27647 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
27648 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
27649
27650 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
27651 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
27652 weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
27653 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
27654 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
27655 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
27656 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
27657
27658 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
27659 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
27660 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
27661 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
27662 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
27663 with GDB}).
27664
27665 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
27666 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
27667 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
27668 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
27669 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
27670 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
27671 Guile:
27672
27673 @example
27674 guix install glibc:debug guile:debug
27675 @end example
27676
27677 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
27678 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
27679 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
27680 GDB}):
27681
27682 @example
27683 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
27684 @end example
27685
27686 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
27687 @code{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
27688
27689 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
27690 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
27691 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
27692 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
27693 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
27694 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
27695
27696 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
27697 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
27698 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
27699 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages
27700 with definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. This may be
27701 changed to opt-out in the future if our build farm servers can handle
27702 the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
27703 @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
27704
27705
27706 @node Security Updates
27707 @chapter Security Updates
27708
27709 @cindex security updates
27710 @cindex security vulnerabilities
27711 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
27712 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
27713 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
27714 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
27715 containing only security updates.) The @command{guix lint} tool helps
27716 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
27717 distribution:
27718
27719 @smallexample
27720 $ guix lint -c cve
27721 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc@@2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
27722 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc@@4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
27723 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg@@2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
27724 @dots{}
27725 @end smallexample
27726
27727 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
27728
27729 Guix follows a functional
27730 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
27731 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
27732 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
27733 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
27734 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
27735 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
27736 desired.
27737
27738 @cindex grafts
27739 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
27740 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
27741 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
27742 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
27743 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
27744 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
27745 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
27746
27747 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
27748 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
27749 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
27750 Bash, say @code{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
27751 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
27752 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
27753
27754 @lisp
27755 (define bash
27756 (package
27757 (name "bash")
27758 ;; @dots{}
27759 (replacement bash-fixed)))
27760 @end lisp
27761
27762 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
27763 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
27764 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
27765 @code{bash-fixed} instead of @code{bash}. This grafting process takes
27766 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
27767 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
27768 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
27769 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
27770
27771 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
27772 the package it replaces (@code{bash-fixed} and @code{bash} in the example
27773 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
27774 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
27775 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
27776 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
27777 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
27778
27779 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
27780 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
27781 Thus, the command:
27782
27783 @example
27784 guix build bash --no-grafts
27785 @end example
27786
27787 @noindent
27788 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
27789
27790 @example
27791 guix build bash
27792 @end example
27793
27794 @noindent
27795 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
27796 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
27797
27798 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
27799 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
27800
27801 @example
27802 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
27803 @end example
27804
27805 @noindent
27806 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
27807 Likewise for a complete Guix system generation:
27808
27809 @example
27810 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
27811 @end example
27812
27813 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
27814 @command{lsof} command:
27815
27816 @example
27817 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
27818 @end example
27819
27820
27821 @node Bootstrapping
27822 @chapter Bootstrapping
27823
27824 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
27825
27826 @cindex bootstrapping
27827
27828 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
27829 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
27830 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
27831 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
27832 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
27833 a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
27834 user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
27835 a ``regular user''.
27836
27837 @cindex bootstrap binaries
27838 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
27839 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
27840 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
27841 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
27842 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
27843 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
27844 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
27845 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
27846 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
27847
27848 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
27849 re-create them if needed (more on that later).
27850
27851 For @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux} the Guix bootstrap process is
27852 more elaborate, @pxref{Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap}.
27853
27854 @menu
27855 * Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap:: A Bootstrap worthy of GNU.
27856 * Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries:: Building that what matters most.
27857 @end menu
27858
27859 @node Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
27860 @section The Reduced Binary Seed Bootstrap
27861
27862 Guix---like other GNU/Linux distributions---is traditionally bootstrapped from
27863 a set of bootstrap binaries: Bourne shell, command-line tools provided by GNU
27864 Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and `grep' and Guile, GCC, Binutils, and the
27865 GNU C Library (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). Usually, these bootstrap binaries are
27866 ``taken for granted.''
27867
27868 Taking these binaries for granted means that we consider them to be a correct
27869 and trustworthy `seed' for building the complete system. Therein lies a
27870 problem: the current combined size of these bootstrap binaries is about 250MB
27871 (@pxref{Bootstrappable Builds,,, mes, GNU Mes}). Auditing or even inspecting
27872 these is next to impossible.
27873
27874 For @code{i686-linux} and @code{x86_64-linux}, Guix now features a ``Reduced
27875 Binary Seed'' bootstrap @footnote{We would like to say: ``Full Source
27876 Bootstrap'' and while we are working towards that goal it would be hyperbole
27877 to use that term for what we do now.}.
27878
27879 The Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap removes the most critical tools---from a
27880 trust perspective---from the bootstrap binaries: GCC, Binutils and the GNU C
27881 Library are replaced by: @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools} (a tiny assembler and
27882 linker) and @code{bootstrap-mes} (a small Scheme Interpreter and a C compiler
27883 written in Scheme and the Mes C Library, built for TinyCC and for GCC). Using
27884 these new binary seeds and a new set of
27885 @c
27886 packages@footnote{@c
27887 nyacc-boot,
27888 mes-boot,
27889 tcc-boot0,
27890 tcc-boot,
27891 make-mesboot0,
27892 diffutils-mesboot,
27893 binutils-mesboot0,
27894 gcc-core-mesboot,
27895 mesboot-headers,
27896 glibc-mesboot0,
27897 gcc-mesboot0,
27898 binutils-mesboot,
27899 make-mesboot,
27900 gcc-mesboot1,
27901 gcc-mesboot1-wrapper,
27902 glibc-headers-mesboot,
27903 glibc-mesboot,
27904 gcc-mesboot,
27905 and
27906 gcc-mesboot-wrapper.
27907 }
27908 @c
27909 the ``missing'' Binutils, GCC, and the GNU C Library are built from source.
27910 From here on the more traditional bootstrap process resumes. This approach
27911 has reduced the bootstrap binaries in size to about 130MB. Work is ongoing to
27912 reduce this further. If you are interested, join us on @code{#bootstrappable}
27913 on the Freenode IRC network.
27914
27915 @c ./pre-inst-env guix graph --type=bag -e '(begin (use-modules (guix packages)) (%current-system "i686-linux") (@@ (gnu packages commencement) gcc-mesboot))' > doc/images/gcc-mesboot-bag-graph.dot
27916 @c dot -T png doc/images/gcc-mesboot-bag-graph.dot > doc/images/gcc-mesboot-bag-graph.png
27917
27918 Below is the generated dependency graph for @code{gcc-mesboot}, the bootstrap
27919 compiler used to build the rest of GuixSD.
27920
27921 @image{images/gcc-mesboot-bag-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the gcc-mesboot}
27922
27923 @node Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
27924 @section Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
27925
27926 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
27927 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
27928 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
27929
27930 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
27931 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
27932 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
27933 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
27934
27935 @example
27936 guix graph -t derivation \
27937 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
27938 | dot -Tps > gcc.ps
27939 @end example
27940
27941 or, for the Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap
27942
27943 @example
27944 guix graph -t derivation \
27945 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-mes)' \
27946 | dot -Tps > mes.ps
27947 @end example
27948
27949 At this level of detail, things are
27950 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
27951 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
27952 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
27953 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
27954 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
27955 (@pxref{The Store}).
27956
27957 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
27958 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
27959 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
27960 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
27961 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
27962 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
27963 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
27964 tarball to be unpacked.
27965
27966 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
27967 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
27968 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
27969 is what the @code{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
27970 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
27971 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
27972 in the store, using the original layout. The
27973 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
27974 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
27975 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
27976 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
27977
27978 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the derivations
27979 @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv}, or
27980 @code{bootstrap-mes-0.drv} and @code{bootstrap-mescc-tools-0.drv}, at which
27981 point we have a working C tool chain.
27982
27983 @unnumberedsec Building the Build Tools
27984
27985 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
27986 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
27987 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
27988 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
27989 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
27990 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
27991 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
27992
27993 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
27994 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
27995 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
27996 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
27997 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
27998 package from source. The command:
27999
28000 @example
28001 guix graph -t bag \
28002 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
28003 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | dot -Tps > t.ps
28004 @end example
28005
28006 @noindent
28007 produces the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
28008 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
28009 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
28010 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
28011
28012 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
28013
28014 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
28015 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
28016 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
28017 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
28018 built.
28019
28020 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
28021 tools---i.e., with @code{--target} equal to @code{--host}. They are
28022 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
28023 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
28024
28025 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built.
28026 GCC uses @code{ld}
28027 from the final Binutils, and links programs against the just-built libc.
28028 This tool chain is used to build the other packages used by Guix and by
28029 the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash, Coreutils, etc.
28030
28031 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
28032 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
28033 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
28034 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
28035 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
28036
28037
28038 @unnumberedsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
28039
28040 @cindex bootstrap binaries
28041 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
28042 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
28043 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
28044 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
28045
28046 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap binaries
28047 (Binutils, GCC, glibc, for the traditional bootstrap and linux-libre-headers,
28048 bootstrap-mescc-tools, bootstrap-mes for the Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap,
28049 and Guile, and a tarball containing a mixture of Coreutils and other basic
28050 command-line tools):
28051
28052 @example
28053 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
28054 @end example
28055
28056 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
28057 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
28058 this section.
28059
28060 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
28061 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
28062 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
28063 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
28064 know.
28065
28066 @unnumberedsec Reducing the Set of Bootstrap Binaries
28067
28068 Our traditional bootstrap includes GCC, GNU Libc, Guile, etc. That's a lot of
28069 binary code! Why is that a problem? It's a problem because these big chunks
28070 of binary code are practically non-auditable, which makes it hard to establish
28071 what source code produced them. Every unauditable binary also leaves us
28072 vulnerable to compiler backdoors as described by Ken Thompson in the 1984
28073 paper @emph{Reflections on Trusting Trust}.
28074
28075 This is mitigated by the fact that our bootstrap binaries were generated
28076 from an earlier Guix revision. Nevertheless it lacks the level of
28077 transparency that we get in the rest of the package dependency graph,
28078 where Guix always gives us a source-to-binary mapping. Thus, our goal
28079 is to reduce the set of bootstrap binaries to the bare minimum.
28080
28081 The @uref{http://bootstrappable.org, Bootstrappable.org web site} lists
28082 on-going projects to do that. One of these is about replacing the
28083 bootstrap GCC with a sequence of assemblers, interpreters, and compilers
28084 of increasing complexity, which could be built from source starting from
28085 a simple and auditable assembler.
28086
28087 Our first major achievement is the replacement of of GCC, the GNU C Library
28088 and Binutils by MesCC-Tools (a simple hex linker and macro assembler) and Mes
28089 (@pxref{Top, GNU Mes Reference Manual,, mes, GNU Mes}, a Scheme interpreter
28090 and C compiler in Scheme). Neither MesCC-Tools nor Mes can be fully
28091 bootstrapped yet and thus we inject them as binary seeds. We call this the
28092 Reduced Binary Seed bootstrap, as it has halved the size of our bootstrap
28093 binaries! Also, it has eliminated the C compiler binary; i686-linux and
28094 x86_64-linux Guix packages are now bootstrapped without any binary C compiler.
28095
28096 Work is ongoing to make MesCC-Tools and Mes fully bootstrappable and we are
28097 also looking at any other bootstrap binaries. Your help is welcome!
28098
28099 @node Porting
28100 @chapter Porting to a New Platform
28101
28102 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
28103 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
28104 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
28105 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
28106 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
28107 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
28108 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
28109
28110 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
28111 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
28112 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
28113 one:
28114
28115 @example
28116 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
28117 @end example
28118
28119 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
28120 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
28121 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
28122 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
28123 taught about the new platform.
28124
28125 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
28126 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
28127 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
28128 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
28129 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
28130 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules to download it for
28131 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
28132 as well.
28133
28134 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
28135 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
28136 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
28137 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @code{--with-abi}
28138 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
28139 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
28140 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
28141 reason.
28142
28143 @c *********************************************************************
28144 @include contributing.texi
28145
28146 @c *********************************************************************
28147 @node Acknowledgments
28148 @chapter Acknowledgments
28149
28150 Guix is based on the @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
28151 which was designed and
28152 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
28153 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix.) Nix pioneered functional package
28154 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
28155 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
28156 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
28157
28158 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
28159 an inspiration for Guix.
28160
28161 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
28162 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
28163 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
28164 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
28165 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
28166
28167
28168 @c *********************************************************************
28169 @node GNU Free Documentation License
28170 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
28171 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
28172 @include fdl-1.3.texi
28173
28174 @c *********************************************************************
28175 @node Concept Index
28176 @unnumbered Concept Index
28177 @printindex cp
28178
28179 @node Programming Index
28180 @unnumbered Programming Index
28181 @syncodeindex tp fn
28182 @syncodeindex vr fn
28183 @printindex fn
28184
28185 @bye
28186
28187 @c Local Variables:
28188 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
28189 @c End: